This is a modern-English version of The Coral Island, originally written by Ballantyne, R. M. (Robert Michael).
It has been thoroughly updated, including changes to sentence structure, words, spelling,
and grammar—to ensure clarity for contemporary readers, while preserving the original spirit and nuance. If
you click on a paragraph, you will see the original text that we modified, and you can toggle between the two versions.
Scroll to the bottom of this page and you will find a free ePUB download link for this book.
R.M. Ballantyne
"The Coral Island"
Chapter One.
Beginning—My early life and character—I thirst for adventure in foreign lands, and go to sea.
Roving has always been, and still is, my ruling passion, the joy of my heart, the very sunshine of my existence. In childhood, in boyhood, and in man’s estate I have been a rover; not a mere rambler among the woody glens and upon the hill-tops of my own native land, but an enthusiastic rover throughout the length and breadth of the wide, wide world.
Roving has always been, and still is, my main passion, the joy of my heart, the very sunshine of my life. Since childhood and into my teenage years and adulthood, I've been a wanderer; not just someone who meanders through the forests and hills of my homeland, but an enthusiastic traveler across the vast, wide world.
It was a wild, black night of howling storm, the night on which I was born on the foaming bosom of the broad Atlantic Ocean. My father was a sea-captain; my grandfather was a sea-captain; my great-grandfather had been a marine. Nobody could tell positively what occupation his father had followed; but my dear mother used to assert that he had been a midshipman, whose grandfather, on the mother’s side, had been an admiral in the Royal Navy. At any rate, we knew that as far back as our family could be traced, it had been intimately connected with the great watery waste. Indeed, this was the case on both sides of the house; for my mother always went to sea with my father on his long voyages, and so spent the greater part of her life upon the water.
It was a wild, stormy night, the night I was born on the churning waves of the Atlantic Ocean. My dad was a sea captain; my grandfather was a sea captain; my great-grandfather had been in the navy. No one could say for sure what job his father had, but my mom always claimed he had been a midshipman, whose grandfather on her side had been an admiral in the Royal Navy. Anyway, we knew that our family had been closely tied to the sea for generations. This was true on both sides; my mom always accompanied my dad on his long voyages and spent most of her life on the water.
Thus it was, I suppose, that I came to inherit a roving disposition. Soon after I was born, my father, being old, retired from a seafaring life, purchased a small cottage in a fishing village on the west coast of England, and settled down to spend the evening of his life on the shores of that sea which had for so many years been his home. It was not long after this that I began to show the roving spirit that dwelt within me. For some time past my infant legs had been gaining strength, so that I came to be dissatisfied with rubbing the skin off my chubby knees by walking on them, and made many attempts to stand up and walk like a man—all of which attempts, however, resulted in my sitting down violently and in sudden surprise. One day I took advantage of my dear mother’s absence to make another effort; and, to my joy, I actually succeeded in reaching the doorstep, over which I tumbled into a pool of muddy water that lay before my father’s cottage door. Ah, how vividly I remember the horror of my poor mother when she found me sweltering in the mud amongst a group of cackling ducks, and the tenderness with which she stripped off my dripping clothes and washed my dirty little body! From this time forth my rambles became more frequent and, as I grew older, more distant, until at last I had wandered far and near on the shore and in the woods around our humble dwelling, and did not rest content until my father bound me apprentice to a coasting-vessel and let me go to sea.
So, I guess that's how I ended up with a wandering spirit. Soon after I was born, my father, who was elderly, retired from life at sea, bought a small cottage in a fishing village on the west coast of England, and settled down to spend his later years by the sea that had been his home for so long. Not long after that, I started to show the adventurous side that was inside me. My baby legs had been getting stronger for a while, and I grew restless with crawling on my knees, so I tried to stand and walk like a grown-up—though every time I did, I ended up sitting down abruptly and in surprise. One day, while my mother was out, I decided to give it another shot, and to my delight, I managed to reach the doorstep, only to tumble into a puddle of muddy water right in front of my father's cottage door. I can still vividly recall my poor mother's shock when she found me squirming in the mud among a bunch of quacking ducks, and how gently she took off my soaking wet clothes and cleaned my dirty little body! From that point on, my adventures became more frequent and, as I got older, they extended farther away, until I had explored the shores and woods around our little home enough that my father decided to make me an apprentice on a coastal ship and let me go to sea.
For some years I was happy in visiting the seaports, and in coasting along the shores, of my native land. My Christian name was Ralph; and my comrades added to this the name of Rover, in consequence of the passion which I always evinced for travelling. Rover was not my real name; but as I never received any other, I came at last to answer to it as naturally as to my proper name. And as it is not a bad one, I see no good reason why I should not introduce myself to the reader as Ralph Rover. My shipmates were kind, good-natured fellows, and they and I got on very well together. They did, indeed, very frequently make game of and banter me, but not unkindly; and I overheard them sometimes saying that Ralph Rover was a “queer, old-fashioned fellow.” This, I must confess, surprised me much; and I pondered the saying long, but could come at no satisfactory conclusion as to that wherein my old-fashionedness lay. It is true I was a quiet lad, and seldom spoke except when spoken to. Moreover, I never could understand the jokes of my companions even when they were explained to me, which dulness in apprehension occasioned me much grief. However, I tried to make up for it by smiling and looking pleased when I observed that they were laughing at some witticism which I had failed to detect. I was also very fond of inquiring into the nature of things and their causes, and often fell into fits of abstraction while thus engaged in my mind. But in all this I saw nothing that did not seem to be exceedingly natural, and could by no means understand why my comrades should call me “an old-fashioned fellow.”
For several years, I enjoyed visiting the seaports and traveling along the coasts of my home country. My first name was Ralph, and my friends called me Rover because of my love for traveling. Rover wasn’t my actual name, but since I never had another, I eventually responded to it just as easily as I did to my real name. Since it’s not a bad nickname, I see no reason not to introduce myself as Ralph Rover to the reader. My shipmates were nice, friendly guys, and we got along well. They often teased and joked about me, but not in a mean way; I even heard them call Ralph Rover a “quirky, old-fashioned guy” sometimes. I must admit, that surprised me a lot, and I thought about it for a long time, but I couldn’t figure out what made me old-fashioned. It’s true that I was a quiet guy and usually only spoke when someone talked to me. Plus, I never really got my friends' jokes, even when they explained them to me, which was really frustrating. Still, I tried to make up for it by smiling and looking happy when I noticed they were laughing at something I didn’t get. I was also very curious about how things work and why, and I often found myself lost in thought while pondering these questions. However, I didn’t see anything weird about that, and I couldn’t understand why my friends would call me “an old-fashioned guy.”
Now, while engaged in the coasting trade I fell in with many seamen who had travelled to almost every quarter of the globe; and I freely confess that my heart glowed ardently within me as they recounted their wild adventures in foreign lands—the dreadful storms they had weathered, the appalling dangers they had escaped, the wonderful creatures they had seen both on the land and in the sea, and the interesting lands and strange people they had visited. But of all the places of which they told me, none captivated and charmed my imagination so much as the Coral Islands of the Southern Seas. They told me of thousands of beautiful, fertile islands that had been formed by a small creature called the coral insect, where summer reigned nearly all the year round, where the trees were laden with a constant harvest of luxuriant fruit, where the climate was almost perpetually delightful; yet where, strange to say, men were wild, bloodthirsty savages, excepting in those favoured isles to which the Gospel of our Saviour had been conveyed. These exciting accounts had so great an effect upon my mind that, when I reached the age of fifteen, I resolved to make a voyage to the South Seas.
While I was working in the coastal trade, I met many sailors who had traveled nearly everywhere in the world. I have to admit that I felt a rush of excitement as they shared their wild adventures in far-off lands—the terrible storms they had weathered, the frightening dangers they had avoided, the amazing creatures they had encountered both on land and in the sea, and the fascinating places and unusual people they had visited. But of all the places they described, none captured my imagination as much as the Coral Islands of the Southern Seas. They spoke of thousands of beautiful, fertile islands created by tiny coral insects, where summer lasted almost all year, where trees were always heavy with lush fruit, and where the weather was nearly always pleasant. Yet, strangely, the inhabitants were wild, bloodthirsty savages, except in the blessed islands where the Gospel of our Savior had been spread. These thrilling stories had such a profound impact on me that when I turned fifteen, I made up my mind to go on a voyage to the South Seas.
I had no little difficulty, at first, in prevailing on my dear parents to let me go; but when I urged on my father that he would never have become a great captain had he remained in the coasting trade, he saw the truth of what I said and gave his consent. My dear mother, seeing that my father had made up his mind, no longer offered opposition to my wishes. “But, oh Ralph!” she said on the day I bade her adieu, “come back soon to us, my dear boy; for we are getting old now, Ralph, and may not have many years to live.”
I had a lot of trouble at first convincing my dear parents to let me go; but when I pointed out to my father that he would never have become a great captain if he had stayed in the coasting trade, he realized I was right and gave his approval. My dear mother, seeing that my father had made his decision, stopped opposing my wishes. “But, oh Ralph!” she said on the day I said goodbye to her, “please come back to us soon, my dear boy; because we are getting old now, Ralph, and may not have many years left.”
I will not take up my readers’ time with a minute account of all that occurred before I took my final leave of my dear parents. Suffice it to say that my father placed me under the charge of an old messmate of his own, a merchant captain, who was on the point of sailing to the South Seas in his own ship, the Arrow. My mother gave me her blessing and a small Bible; and her last request was that I would never forget to read a chapter every day and say my prayers, which I promised, with tears in my eyes, that I would certainly do.
I won’t waste my readers’ time with a detailed account of everything that happened before I finally said goodbye to my beloved parents. It’s enough to say that my father entrusted me to an old friend of his, a merchant captain, who was about to set sail to the South Seas on his ship, the Arrow. My mother gave me her blessing along with a small Bible, and her last wish was for me to remember to read a chapter every day and say my prayers, which I promised, with tears in my eyes, that I would definitely do.
Soon afterwards I went on board the Arrow, which was a fine, large ship, and set sail for the islands of the Pacific Ocean.
Soon afterwards, I boarded the Arrow, a beautiful, large ship, and set sail for the islands of the Pacific Ocean.
Chapter Two.
The departure—The sea—My companions—Some account of the wonderful sights we saw on the great deep—A dreadful storm and a frightful wreck.
It was a bright, beautiful, warm day when our ship spread her canvas to the breeze and sailed for the regions of the south. Oh, how my heart bounded with delight as I listened to the merry chorus of the sailors while they hauled at the ropes and got in the anchor! The captain shouted; the men ran to obey; the noble ship bent over to the breeze, and the shore gradually faded from my view; while I stood looking on, with a kind of feeling that the whole was a delightful dream.
It was a bright, beautiful, warm day when our ship set its sails to the breeze and headed for the southern regions. Oh, how my heart leaped with joy as I listened to the cheerful chorus of the sailors while they pulled on the ropes and brought up the anchor! The captain shouted; the men hurried to comply; the majestic ship tilted in the breeze, and the shore slowly disappeared from my sight while I stood there, feeling like it was all a wonderful dream.
The first thing that struck me as being different from anything I had yet seen during my short career on the sea, was the hoisting of the anchor on deck and lashing it firmly down with ropes, as if we had now bid adieu to the land for ever and would require its services no more.
The first thing that stood out to me as different from anything I had seen in my short time at sea was when they hoisted the anchor onto the deck and secured it tightly with ropes, as if we were saying goodbye to land forever and wouldn’t need its help again.
“There, lass!” cried a broad-shouldered jack-tar, giving the fluke of the anchor a hearty slap with his hand after the housing was completed—“there, lass, take a good nap now, for we sha’n’t ask you to kiss the mud again for many a long day to come!”
“There, girl!” shouted a broad-shouldered sailor, giving the fluke of the anchor a hearty slap with his hand after the housing was finished—“there, girl, take a good nap now, because we won’t be asking you to kiss the mud again for a long time to come!”
And so it was. That anchor did not “kiss the mud” for many long days afterwards; and when at last it did, it was for the last time!
And so it was. That anchor didn’t “kiss the mud” for many long days afterward; and when it finally did, it was for the last time!
There were a number of boys in the ship, but two of them were my special favourites. Jack Martin was a tall, strapping, broad-shouldered youth of eighteen, with a handsome, good-humoured, firm face. He had had a good education, was clever and hearty and lion-like in his actions, but mild and quiet in disposition. Jack was a general favourite, and had a peculiar fondness for me. My other companion was Peterkin Gay. He was little, quick, funny, decidedly mischievous, and about fourteen years old. But Peterkin’s mischief was almost always harmless, else he could not have been so much beloved as he was.
There were several boys on the ship, but two of them were my absolute favorites. Jack Martin was a tall, strong, broad-shouldered eighteen-year-old with a handsome, cheerful, and determined face. He had a solid education, was smart and energetic, and acted with a lion-like confidence, yet he was gentle and reserved in nature. Jack was a favorite among everyone and had a special affection for me. My other friend was Peterkin Gay. He was short, quick, funny, definitely mischievous, and about fourteen years old. However, Peterkin’s mischief was almost always harmless, or else he wouldn’t have been so well-liked.
“Hallo, youngster!” cried Jack Martin, giving me a slap on the shoulder the day I joined the ship, “come below and I’ll show you your berth. You and I are to be messmates; and I think we shall be good friends, for I like the look o’ you.”
“Hey there, kid!” shouted Jack Martin, giving me a slap on the shoulder the day I joined the ship, “come down below and I’ll show you your bunk. You and I are going to be messmates, and I think we’re going to be good friends, because I like the way you look.”
Jack was right. He and I, and Peterkin afterwards, became the best and staunchest friends that ever tossed together on the stormy waves.
Jack was right. He, Peterkin, and I became the best and most loyal friends who ever navigated the stormy seas together.
I shall say little about the first part of our voyage. We had the usual amount of rough weather and calm; also we saw many strange fish rolling in the sea, and I was greatly delighted one day by seeing a shoal of flying-fish dart out of the water and skim through the air about a foot above the surface. They were pursued by dolphins, which feed on them; and one flying-fish, in its terror, flew over the ship, struck on the rigging, and fell upon the deck. Its wings were just fins elongated; and we found that they could never fly far at a time, and never mounted into the air like birds, but skimmed along the surface of the sea. Jack and I had it for dinner, and found it remarkably good.
I won't say much about the first part of our trip. We dealt with the usual mix of rough weather and calm seas; we also spotted a lot of strange fish swimming around, and one day I was really excited to see a school of flying fish leap out of the water and glide through the air about a foot above the surface. They were being chased by dolphins, which eat them; and one flying fish, scared out of its mind, flew over the ship, hit the rigging, and fell onto the deck. Its wings were just elongated fins, and we found that they couldn't fly far at a time, nor did they soar like birds, but skimmed along the surface of the sea. Jack and I had it for dinner, and we thought it was surprisingly good.
When we approached Cape Horn, at the southern extremity of America, the weather became very cold and stormy, and the sailors began to tell stories about the furious gales and the dangers of that terrible cape.
When we got close to Cape Horn, at the southern tip of America, the weather turned really cold and stormy, and the sailors started sharing stories about the fierce winds and the dangers of that notorious cape.
“Cape Horn,” said one, “is the most horrible headland I ever doubled. I’ve sailed round it twice already, and both times the ship was a’most blow’d out o’ the water.”
“Cape Horn,” said one, “is the most terrifying headland I’ve ever rounded. I’ve sailed around it twice already, and both times the ship was almost blown out of the water.”
“I’ve been round it once,” said another; “an’ that time the sails were split, and the ropes frozen in the blocks so that they wouldn’t work, and we wos all but lost.”
“I’ve gone around it once,” said another; “and that time the sails were torn, and the ropes were frozen in the blocks so they wouldn’t move, and we were almost lost.”
“An’ I’ve been round it five times,” cried a third; “an’ every time wos wuss than another, the gales wos so tree-mendous!”
“Honestly, I've gone around it five times,” shouted a third person; “and every time was worse than the last, the winds were so intense!”
“And I’ve been round it, no times at all,” cried Peterkin with an impudent wink in his eye, “an’ that time I wos blow’d inside out!”
“And I’ve been around it, not at all,” Peterkin exclaimed with a cheeky wink in his eye, “and that time I was flipped inside out!”
Nevertheless we passed the dreaded cape without much rough weather, and in the course of a few weeks afterwards were sailing gently, before a warm tropical breeze, over the Pacific Ocean. Thus we proceeded on our voyage—sometimes bounding merrily before a fair breeze; at other times floating calmly on the glassy wave and fishing for the curious inhabitants of the deep, all of which, although the sailors thought little of them, were strange, and interesting, and very wonderful to me.
Nevertheless, we crossed the feared cape without encountering much rough weather, and a few weeks later, we were sailing smoothly, with a warm tropical breeze, over the Pacific Ocean. We continued on our journey—sometimes happily racing with a good breeze; other times, drifting peacefully on the calm water and fishing for the intriguing creatures of the sea, all of which, even though the sailors didn’t think much of them, were strange, fascinating, and truly amazing to me.
At last we came among the Coral Islands of the Pacific; and I shall never forget the delight with which I gazed—when we chanced to pass one—at the pure white, dazzling shores, and the verdant palm-trees, which looked bright and beautiful in the sunshine. And often did we three long to be landed on one, imagining that we should certainly find perfect happiness there! Our wish was granted sooner than we expected.
At last, we arrived at the Coral Islands of the Pacific, and I'll never forget the joy I felt when we happened to pass one. The pure white, dazzling shores and the lush palm trees looked bright and beautiful in the sunlight. We often dreamed of being able to step foot on one, imagining we would definitely find perfect happiness there! Our wish came true sooner than we expected.
One night, soon after we entered the tropics, an awful storm burst upon our ship. The first squall of wind carried away two of our masts, and left only the foremast standing. Even this, however, was more than enough, for we did not dare to hoist a rag of sail on it. For five days the tempest raged in all its fury. Everything was swept off the decks, except one small boat. The steersman was lashed to the wheel lest he should be washed away, and we all gave ourselves up for lost. The captain said that he had no idea where we were, as we had been blown far out of our course; and we feared much that we might get among the dangerous coral reefs which are so numerous in the Pacific. At daybreak on the sixth morning of the gale we saw land ahead; it was an island encircled by a reef of coral, on which the waves broke in fury. There was calm water within this reef, but we could see only one narrow opening into it. For this opening we steered; but ere we reached it a tremendous wave broke on our stern, tore the rudder completely off, and left us at the mercy of the winds and waves.
One night, soon after we entered the tropics, a terrible storm hit our ship. The first gust of wind took down two of our masts, leaving only the foremast standing. Even that was too much for us, so we didn’t dare raise any sail on it. For five days, the tempest raged with all its might. Everything was swept off the decks, except for one small boat. The helmsman was strapped to the wheel to prevent being washed away, and we all feared we were doomed. The captain said he had no idea where we were since we had been blown far off course; we worried we might end up among the dangerous coral reefs that are so common in the Pacific. At dawn on the sixth day of the storm, we spotted land ahead; it was an island surrounded by a coral reef, where the waves crashed violently. There was calm water inside this reef, but we could see only one narrow entrance to it. We steered towards that entrance; but before we got there, a massive wave crashed into our stern, completely tore off the rudder, and left us at the mercy of the winds and waves.
“It’s all over with us now, lads!” said the captain to the men. “Get the boat ready to launch; we shall be on the rocks in less than half-an-hour.”
“It’s all over for us now, guys!” said the captain to the crew. “Get the boat ready to launch; we’ll be on the rocks in less than thirty minutes.”
The men obeyed in gloomy silence, for they felt that there was little hope of so small a boat living in such a sea.
The men complied in somber silence, aware that there was little chance of such a small boat surviving in such rough seas.
“Come, boys,” said Jack Martin, in a grave tone, to me and Peterkin, as we stood on the quarter-deck awaiting our fate—“come, boys; we three shall stick together. You see it is impossible that the little boat can reach the shore, crowded with men. It will be sure to upset, so I mean rather to trust myself to a large oar. I see through the telescope that the ship will strike at the tail of the reef, where the waves break into the quiet water inside; so if we manage to cling to the oar till it is driven over the breakers, we may perhaps gain the shore. What say you? Will you join me?”
“Come on, guys,” Jack Martin said seriously to me and Peterkin as we stood on the quarter-deck waiting for our fate. “Let’s stick together. You can see that the little boat can’t make it to shore, packed with people like that. It will definitely capsize, so I’d rather trust myself to a big oar. I can see through the telescope that the ship will hit the edge of the reef, where the waves crash into the calm water inside. If we can hold on to the oar until it’s pushed over the waves, we might make it to shore. What do you say? Will you join me?”
We gladly agreed to follow Jack, for he inspired us with confidence—although I could perceive, by the sad tone of his voice, that he had little hope; and indeed, when I looked at the white waves that lashed the reef and boiled against the rocks as if in fury, I felt that there was but a step between us and death. My heart sank within me; but at that moment my thoughts turned to my beloved mother, and I remembered those words, which were among the last that she said to me: “Ralph, my dearest child, always remember, in the hour of danger, to look to your Lord and Saviour Jesus Christ. He alone is both able and willing to save your body and your soul.” So I felt much comforted when I thought thereon.
We gladly agreed to follow Jack because he inspired us with confidence—though I could tell from the sad tone of his voice that he had little hope; and honestly, when I looked at the white waves crashing against the reef and boiling against the rocks like they were furious, I felt like we were just one step away from death. My heart sank; but in that moment, my thoughts turned to my beloved mother, and I remembered her words, which were among the last she said to me: “Ralph, my dearest child, always remember, in times of danger, to look to your Lord and Savior Jesus Christ. He alone is able and willing to save your body and your soul.” So I found a lot of comfort in thinking about that.
The ship was now very near the rocks. The men were ready with the boat, and the captain beside them giving orders, when a tremendous wave came towards us. We three ran towards the bow to lay hold of our oar, and had barely reached it when the wave fell on the deck with a crash like thunder. At the same moment the ship struck; the foremast broke off close to the deck and went over the side, carrying the boat and men along with it. Our oar got entangled with the wreck, and Jack seized an axe to cut it free; but owing to the motion of the ship, he missed the cordage and struck the axe deep into the oar. Another wave, however, washed it clear of the wreck. We all seized hold of it, and the next instant we were struggling in the wild sea. The last thing I saw was the boat whirling in the surf, and all the sailors tossed into the foaming waves. Then I became insensible.
The ship was now very close to the rocks. The men were ready with the boat, and the captain was giving orders beside them when a huge wave came toward us. The three of us ran to the bow to grab our oar, and we had barely reached it when the wave crashed onto the deck like thunder. At the same moment, the ship struck; the foremast snapped off close to the deck and went over the side, taking the boat and the men with it. Our oar got tangled in the wreckage, and Jack grabbed an axe to cut it free, but because of the ship’s movement, he missed the rope and struck the axe deep into the oar. Another wave, however, washed it clear of the wreck. We all grabbed it, and the next instant we were struggling in the rough sea. The last thing I saw was the boat spinning in the surf, and all the sailors thrown into the foaming waves. Then I lost consciousness.
On recovering from my swoon I found myself lying on a bank of soft grass, under shelter of an overhanging rock, with Peterkin on his knees by my side, tenderly bathing my temples with water, and endeavouring to stop the blood that flowed from a wound in my forehead.
On waking up from my faint, I found myself lying on a patch of soft grass, under a rock ledge, with Peterkin kneeling beside me, gently wiping my forehead with water and trying to stop the bleeding from a cut on my head.
Chapter Three.
The Coral Island—Our first cogitations after landing and the result of them—We conclude that the island is uninhabited.
There is a strange and peculiar sensation experienced in recovering from a state of insensibility which is almost indescribable: a sort of dreamy, confused consciousness; a half-waking, half-sleeping condition, accompanied with a feeling of weariness, which, however, is by no means disagreeable. As I slowly recovered, and heard the voice of Peterkin inquiring whether I felt better, I thought that I must have overslept myself, and should be sent to the masthead for being lazy; but before I could leap up in haste, the thought seemed to vanish suddenly away, and I fancied that I must have been ill. Then a balmy breeze fanned my cheek; and I thought of home, and the garden at the back of my father’s cottage with its luxuriant flowers, and the sweet-scented honeysuckle that my dear mother trained so carefully upon the trellised porch. But the roaring of the surf put these delightful thoughts to flight, and I was back again at sea, watching the dolphins and the flying-fish, and reefing topsails off the wild and stormy Cape Horn. Gradually the roar of the surf became louder and more distinct. I thought of being wrecked far, far away from my native land, and slowly opened my eyes to meet those of my companion Jack, who, with a look of intense anxiety, was gazing into my face.
There’s a strange feeling that comes when you’re waking up from a daze, and it’s hard to describe: it’s kind of dreamy and confused; a mix of waking and sleeping, with a sense of tiredness that isn’t really unpleasant. As I slowly came to, I heard Peterkin’s voice asking if I felt better. I thought maybe I had just slept too long and would be sent to the masthead for being lazy. But before I could jump up quickly, that thought faded away, and I figured I must have been sick. Then a gentle breeze brushed against my cheek, and I thought about home, about the garden behind my dad's cottage with its vibrant flowers, and the sweet-smelling honeysuckle that my mom carefully trained on the trellised porch. But the loud crashing of the waves chased those lovely thoughts away, and I was back at sea, watching the dolphins and flying fish, reefing the topsails off the wild and stormy Cape Horn. Gradually, the sound of the surf grew louder and clearer. I thought about being shipwrecked far from home, and I slowly opened my eyes to see my friend Jack, staring at me with a look of deep concern.
“Speak to us, my dear Ralph!” whispered Jack tenderly. “Are you better now?”
“Talk to us, my dear Ralph!" Jack whispered gently. "Are you feeling better now?”
I smiled and looked up, saying, “Better! Why, what do you mean, Jack? I’m quite well.”
I smiled and looked up, saying, “Better! What do you mean, Jack? I’m doing fine.”
“Then what are you shamming for, and frightening us in this way?” said Peterkin, smiling through his tears; for the poor boy had been really under the impression that I was dying.
“Then why are you pretending and scaring us like this?” said Peterkin, smiling through his tears; because the poor boy truly thought I was dying.
I now raised myself on my elbow, and putting my hand to my forehead, found that it had been cut pretty severely, and that I had lost a good deal of blood.
I pushed myself up on my elbow and, touching my forehead, realized it had been cut pretty badly, and I had lost a lot of blood.
“Come, come, Ralph,” said Jack, pressing me gently backward, “lie down, my boy; you’re not right yet. Wet your lips with this water; it’s cool and clear as crystal. I got it from a spring close at hand. There, now, don’t say a word—hold your tongue,” he said, seeing me about to speak. “I’ll tell you all about it, but you must not utter a syllable till you have rested well.”
“Come on, Ralph,” said Jack, gently pushing me back, “lie down, buddy; you’re not fully recovered yet. Wet your lips with this water; it’s cool and clear like crystal. I got it from a nearby spring. There, now, don’t say anything—keep quiet,” he said, noticing I was about to speak. “I’ll explain everything, but you can’t say a word until you’ve rested properly.”
“Oh, don’t stop him from speaking, Jack!” said Peterkin, who, now that his fears for my safety were removed, busied himself in erecting a shelter of broken branches in order to protect me from the wind—which, however, was almost unnecessary, for the rock beside which I had been laid completely broke the force of the gale. “Let him speak, Jack; it’s a comfort to hear that he’s alive after lying there stiff and white and sulky for a whole hour, just like an Egyptian mummy.—Never saw such a fellow as you are, Ralph—always up to mischief. You’ve almost knocked out all my teeth and more than half-choked me, and now you go shamming dead! It’s very wicked of you, indeed it is.”
“Oh, don’t stop him from talking, Jack!” said Peterkin, who, now that he wasn’t worried about my safety anymore, got to work building a shelter out of broken branches to shield me from the wind—though it was almost unnecessary, since the rock I was lying next to blocked most of the strong winds. “Let him talk, Jack; it’s nice to know he’s alive after lying there stiff and pale and grumpy for a whole hour, just like an Egyptian mummy. I’ve never seen anyone like you, Ralph—always getting into trouble. You’ve nearly knocked all my teeth out and choked me half to death, and now you pretend to be dead! It’s really naughty of you, it truly is.”
While Peterkin ran on in this style my faculties became quite clear again, and I began to understand my position. “What do you mean by saying I half-choked you, Peterkin?” said I.
While Peterkin kept talking like that, my mind finally cleared up, and I started to grasp my situation. “What do you mean when you say I half-choked you, Peterkin?” I said.
“What do I mean? Is English not your mother-tongue? or do you want me to repeat it in French by way of making it clearer? Don’t you remember?”
“What do I mean? Is English not your first language? Or do you want me to say it again in French to make it clearer? Don’t you remember?”
“I remember nothing,” said I, interrupting him, “after we were thrown into the sea.”
“I remember nothing,” I interrupted, “after we were thrown into the sea.”
“Hush, Peterkin!” said Jack; “you’re exciting Ralph with your nonsense.—I’ll explain it to you. You recollect that, after the ship struck, we three sprang over the bow into the sea? Well, I noticed that the oar struck your head and gave you that cut on the brow which nearly stunned you, so that you grasped Peterkin round the neck without knowing apparently what you were about. In doing so, you pushed the telescope—which you clung to as if it had been your life—against Peterkin’s mouth—”
“Hush, Peterkin!” Jack said. “You’re getting Ralph worked up with your nonsense. Let me explain. Remember that after the ship hit something, the three of us jumped over the bow into the water? I noticed that the oar hit your head and gave you that cut on your forehead that almost knocked you out, so you grabbed Peterkin around the neck without really knowing what you were doing. In the process, you shoved the telescope—which you were holding on to as if it were your life—against Peterkin’s mouth—”
“Pushed it against his mouth!” interrupted Peterkin; “say crammed it down his throat! Why, there’s a distinct mark of the brass rim on the back of my gullet at this moment!”
“Pushed it against his mouth!” interrupted Peterkin; “say crammed it down his throat! Honestly, there’s a clear mark from the brass rim on the back of my throat right now!”
“Well, well, be that as it may,” continued Jack, “you clung to him, Ralph, till I feared you really would choke him. But I saw that he had a good hold of the oar; so I exerted myself to the utmost to push you towards the shore, which we luckily reached without much trouble, for the water inside the reef is quite calm.”
“Well, well, anyway,” continued Jack, “you were hanging onto him, Ralph, to the point where I thought you might actually choke him. But I noticed he had a good grip on the oar; so I did my best to push you towards the shore, which we fortunately reached without much trouble, since the water inside the reef is pretty calm.”
“But the captain and crew, what of them?” I inquired anxiously.
“But what about the captain and crew?” I asked worriedly.
Jack shook his head.
Jack nodded.
“Are they lost?”
“Are they missing?”
“No, they are not lost, I hope; but, I fear, there is not much chance of their being saved. The ship struck at the very tail of the island on which we are cast. When the boat was tossed into the sea it fortunately did not upset, although it shipped a good deal of water, and all the men managed to scramble into it; but before they could get the oars out, the gale carried them past the point and away to leeward of the island. After we landed I saw them endeavouring to pull towards us; but as they had only one pair of oars out of the eight that belonged to the boat, and as the wind was blowing right in their teeth, they gradually lost ground. Then I saw them put about and hoist some sort of sail—a blanket, I fancy, for it was too small for the boat—and in half-an-hour they were out of sight.”
“No, they aren’t lost, I hope; but I’m afraid there’s not much chance of them being saved. The ship hit the very edge of the island where we’ve ended up. When the boat was thrown into the sea, it luckily didn’t capsize, even though it took on a lot of water, and all the men managed to climb in. But before they could start rowing, the strong wind pushed them past the point and away from the island. After we landed, I saw them trying to paddle toward us, but since they only had one pair of oars out of the eight that belonged to the boat, and the wind was blowing directly against them, they slowly lost ground. Then I noticed them turn around and set up some sort of sail—a blanket, I think, since it was too small for the boat—and in half an hour they were out of sight.”
“Poor fellows!” I murmured sorrowfully.
"Poor guys!" I murmured sorrowfully.
“But the more I think about it I’ve better hope of them,” continued Jack in a more cheerful tone. “You see, Ralph, I’ve read a great deal about these South Sea Islands, and I know that in many places they are scattered about in thousands over the sea, so they’re almost sure to fall in with one of them before long.”
“But the more I think about it, I have a better chance of them,” Jack continued, sounding more upbeat. “You see, Ralph, I’ve read a lot about these South Sea Islands, and I know that in many areas they’re spread out in thousands across the ocean, so they’re almost guaranteed to come across one of them soon.”
“I’m sure I hope so,” said Peterkin earnestly. “But what has become of the wreck, Jack? I saw you clambering up the rocks there while I was watching Ralph. Did you say she had gone to pieces?”
“I really hope so,” Peterkin said earnestly. “But what happened to the wreck, Jack? I saw you climbing up the rocks while I was watching Ralph. Did you say it had broken apart?”
“No, she has not gone to pieces; but she has gone to the bottom,” replied Jack. “As I said before, she struck on the tail of the island and stove in her bow; but the next breaker swung her clear, and she floated away to leeward. The poor fellows in the boat made a hard struggle to reach her, but long before they came near her she filled and went down. It was after she had foundered that I saw them trying to pull to the island.”
“No, she hasn't fallen apart; but she's sunk,” replied Jack. “As I mentioned earlier, she hit the back of the island and smashed her front; but the next wave swung her free, and she drifted away to the side. The poor guys in the boat made a tough effort to get to her, but long before they could get close, she filled up and went under. It was after she had sunk that I saw them trying to paddle to the island.”
There was a long silence after Jack had ceased speaking, and I have no doubt that each was revolving in his mind our extraordinary position. For my part, I cannot say that my reflections were very agreeable. I knew that we were on an island, for Jack had said so; but whether it was inhabited or not, I did not know. If it should be inhabited, I felt certain, from all I had heard of South Sea Islanders, that we should be roasted alive and eaten. If it should turn out to be uninhabited, I fancied that we should be starved to death. “Oh,” thought I, “if the ship had only struck on the rocks we might have done pretty well, for we could have obtained provisions from her, and tools to enable us to build a shelter; but now—alas! alas! we are lost!” These last words I uttered aloud in my distress.
There was a long silence after Jack stopped speaking, and I’m sure everyone was thinking about our strange situation. For my part, I can't say my thoughts were very comforting. I knew we were on an island, since Jack had mentioned it, but I didn't know if it was inhabited or not. If there were people living here, I felt sure, based on everything I had heard about South Sea Islanders, that we would be cooked and eaten. On the other hand, if it turned out to be uninhabited, I imagined we would starve to death. “Oh,” I thought, “if only the ship had hit a rock, we might have been better off because we could have gotten food from it and tools to help us build a shelter. But now—oh no! We are lost!” I exclaimed these last words in my distress.
“Lost, Ralph!” exclaimed Jack, while a smile overspread his hearty countenance. “Saved, you should have said. Your cogitations seem to have taken a wrong road, and led you to a wrong conclusion.”
“Lost, Ralph!” Jack exclaimed, a broad smile spreading across his face. “Saved, you should have said. Your thoughts seem to have taken a wrong turn and led you to the wrong conclusion.”
“Do you know what conclusion I have come to?” said Peterkin. “I have made up my mind that it’s capital—first-rate—the best thing that ever happened to us, and the most splendid prospect that ever lay before three jolly young tars. We’ve got an island all to ourselves. We’ll take possession in the name of the king. We’ll go and enter the service of its black inhabitants. Of course we’ll rise, naturally, to the top of affairs: white men always do in savage countries. You shall be king, Jack; Ralph, prime minister; and I shall be—”
“Do you know what conclusion I’ve come to?” Peterkin said. “I’ve decided that it’s amazing—absolutely the best thing that ever happened to us, and the greatest opportunity that three happy young sailors could ever hope for. We’ve got an island all to ourselves. We’ll claim it in the name of the king. We’ll go and join the service of its black inhabitants. Of course, we’ll rise to the top of things naturally: white men always do in uncivilized places. You’ll be king, Jack; Ralph, prime minister; and I’ll be—”
“The court-jester,” interrupted Jack.
"The court jester," interrupted Jack.
“No,” retorted Peterkin; “I’ll have no title at all. I shall merely accept a highly responsible situation under government; for you see, Jack, I’m fond of having an enormous salary and nothing to do.”
“No,” replied Peterkin; “I don’t want any title at all. I’ll just take on a very responsible position in the government; because you see, Jack, I like having a huge salary and doing nothing.”
“But suppose there are no natives?”
“But what if there are no locals?”
“Then we’ll build a charming villa, and plant a lovely garden round it, stuck all full of the most splendiferous tropical flowers; and we’ll farm the land, plant, sow, reap, eat, sleep, and be merry.”
“Then we’ll build a beautiful villa and surround it with a lovely garden filled with amazing tropical flowers. We’ll farm the land, planting, sowing, harvesting, eating, sleeping, and enjoying life.”
“But to be serious,” said Jack, assuming a grave expression of countenance—which, I observed, always had the effect of checking Peterkin’s disposition to make fun of everything—“we are really in rather an uncomfortable position. If this is a desert island, we shall have to live very much like the wild beasts; for we have not a tool of any kind—not even a knife.”
“But to be serious,” Jack said, adopting a serious look—something I noticed always made Peterkin stop making jokes—“we’re actually in a pretty tough spot. If this is a desert island, we’re going to have to live like wild animals because we don’t have any tools at all—not even a knife.”
“Yes, we have that,” said Peterkin, fumbling in his trousers pocket, from which he drew forth a small penknife with only one blade, and that was broken.
“Yes, we have that,” Peterkin said, digging into his pants pocket, from which he pulled out a small penknife with just one blade, and it was broken.
“Well, that’s better than nothing.—But come,” said Jack, rising; “we are wasting our time in talking instead of doing.—You seem well enough to walk now, Ralph.—Let us see what we have got in our pockets; and then let us climb some hill and ascertain what sort of island we have been cast upon, for, whether good or bad, it seems likely to be our home for some time to come.”
“Well, that’s better than nothing. But come on,” said Jack, getting up. “We’re wasting time talking instead of doing. You seem good enough to walk now, Ralph. Let’s check what we have in our pockets, and then let's climb a hill and figure out what kind of island we’ve ended up on, because whether it’s good or bad, it looks like this will be our home for a while.”
Chapter Four.
We examine into our personal property, and make a happy discovery—Our island described—Jack proves himself to be learned and sagacious above his fellows—Curious discoveries—Natural lemonade!
We now seated ourselves upon a rock, and began to examine into our personal property. When we reached the shore after being wrecked, my companions had taken off part of their clothes and spread them out in the sun to dry; for although the gale was raging fiercely, there was not a single cloud in the bright sky. They had also stripped off most part of my wet clothes and spread them also on the rocks. Having resumed our garments, we now searched all our pockets with the utmost care, and laid their contents out on a flat stone before us; and now that our minds were fully alive to our condition, it was with no little anxiety that we turned our several pockets inside out in order that nothing might escape us. When all was collected together, we found that our worldly goods consisted of the following articles:
We sat down on a rock and started to check our belongings. After being shipwrecked, my friends had removed some of their clothes and laid them out in the sun to dry; even though the storm was raging, the sky was clear and bright. They had also taken off most of my wet clothes and spread them on the rocks. Once we put our clothes back on, we carefully searched all our pockets and laid everything out on a flat stone in front of us. Now that we were fully aware of our situation, we anxiously turned our pockets inside out to make sure we didn’t miss anything. When everything was gathered, we discovered that our possessions included the following items:
First, a small penknife with a single blade, broken off about the middle and very rusty, besides having two or three notches on its edge. (Peterkin said of this, with his usual pleasantry, that it would do for a saw as well as a knife, which was a great advantage.) Second, an old German-silver pencil-case without any lead in it. Third, a piece of whip-cord about six yards long. Fourth, a sailmaker’s needle of a small size. Fifth, a ship’s telescope, which I happened to have in my hand at the time the ship struck, and which I had clung to firmly all the time I was in the water; indeed, it was with difficulty that Jack got it out of my grasp when I was lying insensible on the shore. I cannot understand why I kept such a firm hold of this telescope. They say that a drowning man will clutch at a straw. Perhaps it may have been some such feeling in me, for I did not know that it was in my hand at the time we were wrecked. However, we felt some pleasure in having it with us now—although we did not see that it could be of much use to us, as the glass at the small end was broken to pieces. Our sixth article was a brass ring which Jack always wore on his little finger. I never understood why he wore it; for Jack was not vain of his appearance, and did not seem to care for ornaments of any kind. Peterkin said, “it was in memory of the girl he left behind him!” But as he never spoke of this girl to either of us, I am inclined to think that Peterkin was either jesting or mistaken. In addition to these articles, we had a little bit of tinder and the clothes on our backs. These last were as follows:
First, there was a small penknife with one blade, broken around the middle and really rusty, plus it had a couple of notches on its edge. (Peterkin joked that it could be used as a saw as well as a knife, which was quite an advantage.) Second, an old German-silver pencil case with no lead in it. Third, a piece of whip-cord about six yards long. Fourth, a small sailmaker’s needle. Fifth, a ship’s telescope that I happened to have in my hand when the ship crashed, and I held onto it tightly the whole time I was in the water; in fact, Jack had a hard time prying it from my grip when I was lying unconscious on the shore. I don’t understand why I clung to that telescope so tightly. They say a drowning person will grab onto anything. Maybe that was what I felt, since I didn’t even know I was holding it when we were shipwrecked. Still, it was nice to have it with us now, even though we didn’t think it would be very useful since the glass at the small end was shattered. Our sixth item was a brass ring that Jack always wore on his little finger. I never understood why he kept it; Jack wasn’t vain about his looks and didn’t seem to care about jewelry. Peterkin said, “It’s to remember the girl he left behind!” But since Jack never mentioned this girl to either of us, I think Peterkin was either joking or mistaken. Along with these items, we had a small piece of tinder and the clothes on our backs. These were as follows:
Each of us had on a pair of stout canvas trousers and a pair of sailors’ thick shoes. Jack wore a red flannel shirt, a blue jacket, and a red Kilmarnock bonnet or nightcap, besides a pair of worsted socks, and a cotton pocket-handkerchief with sixteen portraits of Lord Nelson printed on it and a union-jack in the middle. Peterkin had on a striped flannel shirt—which he wore outside his trousers and belted round his waist, after the manner of a tunic—and a round black straw hat. He had no jacket, having thrown it off just before we were cast into the sea; but this was not of much consequence, as the climate of the island proved to be extremely mild—so much so, indeed, that Jack and I often preferred to go about without our jackets. Peterkin had also a pair of white cotton socks and a blue handkerchief with white spots all over it. My own costume consisted of a blue flannel shirt, a blue jacket, a black cap, and a pair of worsted socks, besides the shoes and canvas trousers already mentioned. This was all we had, and besides these things we had nothing else; but when we thought of the danger from which we had escaped, and how much worse off we might have been had the ship struck on the reef during the night, we felt very thankful that we were possessed of so much, although, I must confess, we sometimes wished that we had had a little more.
Each of us was wearing a pair of sturdy canvas pants and thick sailor shoes. Jack had on a red flannel shirt, a blue jacket, and a red wool cap, along with a pair of wool socks and a cotton handkerchief featuring sixteen pictures of Lord Nelson with a Union Jack in the center. Peterkin wore a striped flannel shirt, which he left untucked and cinched at the waist like a tunic, and a round black straw hat. He didn’t have a jacket since he had thrown it off just before we were thrown into the sea; but this didn’t matter much, as the island’s climate turned out to be really mild—so much so that Jack and I often liked to walk around without our jackets. Peterkin also had a pair of white cotton socks and a blue handkerchief covered in white spots. My own outfit included a blue flannel shirt, a blue jacket, a black cap, and a pair of wool socks, in addition to the shoes and canvas pants mentioned earlier. This was all we had, and besides these items, we had nothing else; but when we thought about the danger we had escaped and how much worse things could have been if the ship had hit the reef during the night, we felt very grateful to have so much, although I must admit we sometimes wished we had a bit more.
While we were examining these things and talking about them, Jack suddenly started and exclaimed:
While we were looking at these things and discussing them, Jack suddenly jumped and shouted:
“The oar! We have forgotten the oar!”
“The oar! We forgot the oar!”
“What good will that do us?” said Peterkin. “There’s wood enough on the island to make a thousand oars.”
“What good will that do us?” Peterkin said. “There’s enough wood on the island to make a thousand oars.”
“Ay, lad,” replied Jack; “but there’s a bit of hoop-iron at the end of it, and that may be of much use to us.”
“Ay, dude,” replied Jack; “but there’s a piece of hoop-iron at the end of it, and that might be really useful to us.”
“Very true,” said I; “let us go fetch it.” And with that we all three rose and hastened down to the beach. I still felt a little weak from loss of blood, so that my companions soon began to leave me behind; but Jack perceived this, and, with his usual considerate good-nature, turned back to help me. This was now the first time that I had looked well about me since landing, as the spot where I had been laid was covered with thick bushes, which almost hid the country from our view. As we now emerged from among these and walked down the sandy beach together, I cast my eyes about, and truly my heart glowed within me and my spirits rose at the beautiful prospect which I beheld on every side. The gale had suddenly died away, just as if it had blown furiously till it dashed our ship upon the rocks, and had nothing more to do after accomplishing that. The island on which we stood was hilly, and covered almost everywhere with the most beautiful and richly coloured trees, bushes, and shrubs, none of which I knew the names of at that time—except, indeed, the cocoa-nut palms, which I recognised at once from the many pictures that I had seen of them before I left home. A sandy beach of dazzling whiteness lined this bright-green shore, and upon it there fell a gentle ripple of the sea. This last astonished me much, for I recollected that at home the sea used to fall in huge billows on the shore long after a storm had subsided. But on casting my glance out to sea the cause became apparent. About a mile distant from the shore I saw the great billows of the ocean rolling like a green wall, and falling with a long, loud roar upon a low coral reef, where they were dashed into white foam and flung up in clouds of spray. This spray sometimes flew exceedingly high, and every here and there a beautiful rainbow was formed for a moment among the falling drops. We afterwards found that this coral reef extended quite round the island, and formed a natural breakwater to it. Beyond this, the sea rose and tossed violently from the effects of the storm; but between the reef and the shore it was as calm and as smooth as a pond.
“Very true,” I said; “let’s go get it.” With that, the three of us stood up and hurried down to the beach. I still felt a bit weak from blood loss, so my friends quickly started to outpace me. But Jack noticed and, with his usual thoughtful nature, turned back to help me. This was the first time I had really looked around since landing, as the place where I had been laid was covered with thick bushes that almost blocked our view. As we stepped out of the bushes and walked down the sandy beach together, I glanced around, and truly my heart swelled with joy as my spirits lifted at the beautiful sights everywhere. The wind had suddenly calmed down, as if it had blown fiercely until it crashed our ship onto the rocks, and now had no further purpose. The island we were on was hilly and almost completely covered with the most stunning and vibrantly colored trees, bushes, and shrubs, none of which I knew the names of at that time—except for the coconut palms, which I recognized right away from the many pictures I had seen before leaving home. A dazzling white sandy beach lined this bright green shore, and the sea gently lapped against it. This surprised me because I remembered that back home, the sea used to crash in huge waves on the shore long after a storm passed. But when I looked out to sea, the reason became clear. About a mile from the shore, I saw large ocean waves rolling like a green wall before crashing with a loud roar onto a low coral reef, where they broke into white foam and shot up in clouds of spray. This spray sometimes shot up really high, and here and there, a beautiful rainbow appeared for a moment among the falling drops. We later found out that this coral reef went all the way around the island, acting as a natural breakwater. Beyond that, the sea was rising and tossing violently due to the storm; but between the reef and the shore, it was as calm and smooth as a pond.
My heart was filled with more delight than I can express at sight of so many glorious objects, and my thoughts turned suddenly to the contemplation of the Creator of them all. I mention this the more gladly, because at that time, I am ashamed to say, I very seldom thought of my Creator, although I was constantly surrounded by the most beautiful and wonderful of His works. I observed, from the expression of my companion’s countenance, that he too derived much joy from the splendid scenery, which was all the more agreeable to us after our long voyage on the salt sea. There the breeze was fresh and cold; but here it was delightfully mild, and when a puff blew off the land it came laden with the most exquisite perfume that can be imagined. While we thus gazed we were startled by a loud “Huzza!” from Peterkin, and on looking towards the edge of the sea we saw him capering and jumping about like a monkey, and ever and anon tugging with all his might at something that lay upon the shore.
My heart was filled with more joy than I can express at the sight of so many amazing things, and my thoughts suddenly turned to the Creator of them all. I mention this more gladly because, at that time, I’m ashamed to say, I rarely thought of my Creator, even though I was constantly surrounded by the most beautiful and wonderful of His creations. I could tell from my companion’s expression that he was also finding a lot of joy in the stunning scenery, which felt even better after our long journey across the salty sea. There, the breeze was fresh and cold; but here it was wonderfully mild, and when a gust blew in from the land, it carried the most exquisite fragrance imaginable. While we were looking around, we were startled by a loud “Huzza!” from Peterkin, and when we turned toward the edge of the sea, we saw him dancing around like a monkey, and every now and then pulling with all his strength at something on the shore.
“What an odd fellow he is, to be sure!” said Jack, taking me by the arm and hurrying forward. “Come, let us hasten to see what it is.”
“What a strange guy he is, for sure!” said Jack, grabbing my arm and speeding up. “Come on, let’s hurry to see what it is.”
“Here it is, boys—hurrah! Come along! Just what we want!” cried Peterkin as we drew near, still tugging with all his power. “First-rate; just the very ticket!”
“Here it is, guys—yay! Let’s go! Exactly what we need!” shouted Peterkin as we got closer, still pulling with all his strength. “Awesome; just perfect!”
I need scarcely say to my readers that my companion Peterkin was in the habit of using very remarkable and peculiar phrases. And I am free to confess that I did not well understand the meaning of some of them—such, for instance, as “the very ticket;” but I think it my duty to recount everything relating to my adventures with a strict regard to truthfulness in as far as my memory serves me, so I write, as nearly as possible, the exact words that my companions spoke. I often asked Peterkin to explain what he meant by “ticket,” but he always answered me by going into fits of laughter. However, by observing the occasions on which he used it, I came to understand that it meant to show that something was remarkably good or fortunate.
I hardly need to tell my readers that my friend Peterkin had a habit of using very unique and strange phrases. I admit I didn’t really get the meaning of some of them—like “the very ticket”—but I feel it’s my duty to share everything related to my adventures as truthfully as my memory allows, so I write down, as closely as possible, the exact words my friends said. I often asked Peterkin to clarify what he meant by “ticket,” but he would just burst out laughing. However, by paying attention to when he used it, I figured out that it meant to indicate that something was exceptionally good or lucky.
On coming up we found that Peterkin was vainly endeavouring to pull the axe out of the oar into which, it will be remembered, Jack struck it while endeavouring to cut away the cordage among which it had become entangled at the bow of the ship. Fortunately for us, the axe had remained fast in the oar, and even now all Peterkin’s strength could not draw it out of the cut.
On our way up, we found that Peterkin was unsuccessfully trying to pull the axe out of the oar, into which, you’ll recall, Jack had struck it while trying to cut away the ropes it had gotten stuck in at the front of the ship. Luckily for us, the axe was still stuck in the oar, and even now, Peterkin couldn't pull it out with all his strength.
“Ah, that is capital indeed!” cried Jack, at the same time giving the axe a wrench that plucked it out of the tough wood. “How fortunate this is! It will be of more value to us than a hundred knives, and the edge is quite new and sharp.”
“Wow, that’s great!” exclaimed Jack, as he twisted the axe and pulled it free from the tough wood. “How lucky this is! It’ll be worth more to us than a hundred knives, and the blade is brand new and sharp.”
“I’ll answer for the toughness of the handle, at any rate!” cried Peterkin; “my arms are nearly pulled out of the sockets. But see here, our luck is great. There is iron on the blade.” He pointed to a piece of hoop-iron as he spoke, which had been nailed round the blade of the oar to prevent it from splitting.
“I’ll take responsibility for how tough the handle is, anyway!” shouted Peterkin; “my arms feel like they’re about to pop out of their sockets. But look, we’re in luck. There’s iron on the blade.” He pointed to a strip of hoop iron that had been nailed around the blade of the oar to keep it from splitting.
This also was a fortunate discovery. Jack went down on his knees, and with the edge of the axe began carefully to force out the nails. But as they were firmly fixed in, and the operation blunted our axe, we carried the oar up with us to the place where we had left the rest of our things, intending to burn the wood away from the iron at a more convenient time.
This was also a lucky find. Jack knelt down and started carefully prying out the nails with the edge of the axe. But since they were tightly secured and the effort dulled our axe, we took the oar back with us to the spot where we had left the rest of our stuff, planning to burn the wood off the iron later when it was easier.
“Now, lads,” said Jack after we had laid it on the stone which contained our little all, “I propose that we should go to the tail of the island, where the ship struck, which is only a quarter of a mile off; and see if anything else has been thrown ashore. I don’t expect anything, but it is well to see. When we get back here it will be time to have our supper and prepare our beds.”
“Alright, guys,” said Jack after we had placed it on the stone that held our little treasure, “I suggest we head to the back of the island, where the ship ran aground, which is just a quarter of a mile away; and check if anything else has washed up on shore. I don’t really expect to find anything, but it’s good to look. When we return, it’ll be time for supper and to set up our beds.”
“Agreed!” cried Peterkin and I together, as, indeed, we would have agreed to any proposal that Jack made; for, besides his being older and much stronger and taller than either of us, he was a very clever fellow, and, I think, would have induced people much older than himself to choose him for their leader, especially if they required to be led on a bold enterprise.
“Agreed!” shouted Peterkin and I at the same time, as we honestly would have agreed to any suggestion Jack made; because, aside from being older and much stronger and taller than us, he was really smart, and I believe he could have convinced people much older than him to pick him as their leader, especially if they needed someone to guide them on a daring mission.
Now as we hastened along the white beach, which shone so brightly in the rays of the setting sun that our eyes were quite dazzled by its glare, it suddenly came into Peterkin’s head that we had nothing to eat except the wild berries which grew in profusion at our feet.
Now as we hurried along the white beach, which was shining so brightly in the rays of the setting sun that our eyes were dazzled by its glare, it suddenly occurred to Peterkin that we had nothing to eat except for the wild berries that grew abundantly at our feet.
“What shall we do, Jack?” said he with a rueful look. “Perhaps they may be poisonous!”
“What should we do, Jack?” he said, looking regretful. “Maybe they could be poisonous!”
“No fear,” replied Jack confidently. “I have observed that a few of them are not unlike some of the berries that grow wild on our own native hills. Besides, I saw one or two strange birds eating them just a few minutes ago, and what won’t kill the birds won’t kill us. But look up there, Peterkin,” continued Jack, pointing to the branched head of a cocoa-nut palm. “There are nuts for us in all stages.”
“No worries,” Jack replied confidently. “I’ve noticed that some of them are similar to the wild berries that grow on our native hills. Plus, I saw a couple of unusual birds eating them just a few minutes ago, and what doesn’t harm the birds won’t harm us. But look up there, Peterkin,” Jack continued, pointing to the branched top of a coconut palm. “There are nuts for us at every stage.”
“So there are!” cried Peterkin, who, being of a very unobservant nature, had been too much taken up with other things to notice anything so high above his head as the fruit of a palm-tree. But whatever faults my young comrade had, he could not be blamed for want of activity or animal spirits. Indeed, the nuts had scarcely been pointed out to him when he bounded up the tall stem of the tree like a squirrel, and in a few minutes returned with three nuts, each as large as a man’s fist.
“So there are!” shouted Peterkin, who, being quite oblivious, had been too distracted by other things to notice something as high above his head as the fruit of a palm tree. But despite his shortcomings, my young friend couldn’t be criticized for lacking energy or enthusiasm. In fact, the moment the nuts were pointed out to him, he sprang up the tall trunk of the tree like a squirrel and, within minutes, came back with three nuts, each as big as a man’s fist.
“You had better keep them till we return,” said Jack. “Let us finish our work before eating.”
“You should hang onto them until we get back,” Jack said. “Let’s wrap up our work before we eat.”
“So be it, captain; go ahead!” cried Peterkin, thrusting the nuts into his trousers pocket. “In fact, I don’t want to eat just now; but I would give a good deal for a drink. Oh, that I could find a spring! but I don’t see the smallest sign of one hereabouts. I say, Jack, how does it happen that you seem to be up to everything? You have told us the names of half-a-dozen trees already, and yet you say that you were never in the South Seas before.”
“Okay, captain; do your thing!” shouted Peterkin, stuffing the nuts into his pants pocket. “Honestly, I’m not really hungry right now; but I’d pay a lot for a drink. If only I could find a spring! But I can’t see even the slightest sign of one around here. Hey, Jack, how come you seem to know everything? You've already named half a dozen trees, and yet you say you’ve never been to the South Seas before.”
“I’m not up to everything, Peterkin, as you’ll find out ere long,” replied Jack with a smile; “but I have been a great reader of books of travel and adventure all my life, and that has put me up to a good many things that you are, perhaps, not acquainted with.”
“I’m not capable of everything, Peterkin, as you’ll see soon enough,” Jack replied with a smile; “but I’ve been a huge reader of travel and adventure books my whole life, and that has taught me quite a few things that you might not know.”
“Oh, Jack, that’s all humbug! If you begin to lay everything to the credit of books, I’ll quite lose my opinion of you,” cried Peterkin with a look of contempt. “I’ve seen a lot o’ fellows that were always poring over books, and when they came to try to do anything, they were no better than baboons!”
“Oh, Jack, that’s all nonsense! If you start giving all the credit to books, I’ll totally lose my respect for you,” Peterkin said with a look of disdain. “I’ve seen plenty of guys who were always buried in books, and when they actually tried to do something, they were no better than monkeys!”
“You are quite right,” retorted Jack; “and I have seen a lot of fellows, who never looked into books at all, who knew nothing about anything except the things they had actually seen, and very little they knew even about these. Indeed, some were so ignorant that they did not know that cocoa-nuts grew on cocoa-nut trees!”
“You're absolutely right,” Jack shot back; “and I've come across a lot of guys who never bothered to look at books, who didn’t know anything except what they had actually seen, and even then they didn’t know much about that. In fact, some were so clueless that they didn’t even know that coconuts grow on coconut trees!”
I could not refrain from laughing at this rebuke, for there was much truth in it as to Peterkin’s ignorance.
I couldn't help but laugh at this criticism, because it had a lot of truth regarding Peterkin's lack of knowledge.
“Humph! maybe you’re right,” answered Peterkin; “but I would not give tuppence for a man of books if he had nothing else in him.”
“Humph! Maybe you’re right,” replied Peterkin; “but I wouldn’t give two cents for a bookish guy if he had nothing else to offer.”
“Neither would I,” said Jack; “but that’s no reason why you should run books down, or think less of me for having read them. Suppose, now, Peterkin, that you wanted to build a ship, and I were to give you a long and particular account of the way to do it, would not that be very useful?”
“Neither would I,” said Jack; “but that’s not a reason to talk badly about books or think less of me for reading them. Imagine, Peterkin, if you wanted to build a ship, and I gave you a detailed guide on how to do it—wouldn't that be really helpful?”
“No doubt of it,” said Peterkin, laughing.
“No doubt about it,” Peterkin said, laughing.
“And suppose I were to write the account in a letter instead of telling you in words, would that be less useful?”
“And what if I wrote the account in a letter instead of telling you verbally? Would that be less helpful?”
“Well—no, perhaps not.”
"Well, maybe not."
“Well, suppose I were to print it and send it to you in the form of a book, would it not be as good and useful as ever?”
“Well, if I printed it and sent it to you as a book, wouldn’t it still be just as good and useful?”
“Oh, bother! Jack, you’re a philosopher, and that’s worse than anything!” cried Peterkin with a look of pretended horror.
“Oh, come on! Jack, you’re a philosopher, and that’s worse than anything!” Peterkin exclaimed with a feigned look of shock.
“Very well, Peterkin, we shall see,” returned Jack, halting under the shade of a cocoa-nut tree. “You said you were thirsty just a minute ago. Now jump up that tree and bring down a nut—not a ripe one; bring a green, unripe one.”
“Alright, Peterkin, we’ll see,” Jack replied, stopping under the shade of a coconut tree. “You said you were thirsty a minute ago. Now climb up that tree and bring down a nut—not a ripe one; bring a green, unripe one.”
Peterkin looked surprised, but seeing that Jack was in earnest, he obeyed.
Peterkin looked surprised, but when he saw that Jack was serious, he went along with it.
“Now cut a hole in it with your penknife and clap it to your mouth, old fellow,” said Jack.
“Now make a hole in it with your penknife and hold it to your mouth, buddy,” said Jack.
Peterkin did as he was directed, and we both burst into uncontrollable laughter at the changes that instantly passed over his expressive countenance. No sooner had he put the nut to his mouth, and thrown back his head in order to catch what came out of it, than his eyes opened to twice their ordinary size with astonishment, while his throat moved vigorously in the act of swallowing. Then a smile and a look of intense delight overspread his face, except, indeed, the mouth, which, being firmly fixed to the hole in the nut, could not take part in the expression; but he endeavoured to make up for this by winking at us excessively with his right eye. At length he stopped, and drawing a long breath, exclaimed:
Peterkin did as he was told, and we both burst into uncontrollable laughter at the changes that quickly crossed his expressive face. No sooner had he put the nut to his mouth and tilted his head back to catch whatever came out of it than his eyes widened to twice their usual size in shock, while his throat worked hard to swallow. Then a smile and a look of intense joy spread across his face, except for his mouth, which was stuck to the hole in the nut and couldn’t join in the expression; but he tried to make up for this by excessively winking at us with his right eye. Finally, he stopped, took a deep breath, and exclaimed:
“Nectar! perfect nectar!—I say, Jack, you’re a Briton—the best fellow I ever met in my life—Only taste that!” said he, turning to me and holding the nut to my mouth. I immediately drank, and certainly I was much surprised at the delightful liquid that flowed copiously down my throat. It was extremely cool, and had a sweet taste, mingled with acid; in fact, it was the likest thing to lemonade I ever tasted, and was most grateful and refreshing. I handed the nut to Jack, who, after tasting it, said, “Now, Peterkin, you unbeliever! I never saw or tasted a cocoa-nut in my life before, except those sold in shops at home; but I once read that the green nuts contain that stuff; and you see it is true.”
“Nectar! Perfect nectar!—I tell you, Jack, you’re a true Brit—best guy I’ve ever met in my life—Just taste this!” he said, turning to me and holding the nut to my mouth. I took a sip, and I was really surprised by the delightful liquid that flowed smoothly down my throat. It was super cool and had a sweet, tangy flavor; honestly, it was the closest thing to lemonade I’ve ever tasted, and it was incredibly satisfying and refreshing. I passed the nut to Jack, who, after trying it, said, “Now, Peterkin, you skeptic! I’ve never seen or tasted a coconut in my life before, aside from those sold in stores back home; but I once read that the green nuts have that stuff inside, and you see it’s true.”
“And, pray,” asked Peterkin, “what sort of ‘stuff’ does the ripe nut contain?”
“And, please,” asked Peterkin, “what kind of ‘stuff’ does the ripe nut have?”
“A hollow kernel,” answered Jack, “with a liquid like milk in it; but it does not satisfy thirst so well as hunger. It is very wholesome food, I believe.”
“A hollow kernel,” Jack replied, “with a milk-like liquid inside; but it doesn't quench thirst as well as it satisfies hunger. I believe it's very nutritious food.”
“Meat and drink on the same tree!” cried Peterkin; “washing in the sea, lodging on the ground—and all for nothing! My dear boys, we’re set up for life! It must be the ancient Paradise—hurrah!” and Peterkin tossed his straw hat in the air and ran along the beach, hallooing like a madman with delight.
“Food and drink on the same tree!” shouted Peterkin; “swimming in the sea, sleeping on the ground—and all for free! My dear friends, we’re set for life! This must be the ancient Paradise—hurrah!” and Peterkin threw his straw hat in the air and ran along the beach, shouting like a madman with joy.
We afterwards found, however, that these lovely islands were very unlike Paradise in many things. But more of this in its proper place.
We later realized, however, that these beautiful islands were quite different from Paradise in many ways. But more on that later.
We had now come to the point of rocks on which the ship had struck, but did not find a single article, although we searched carefully among the coral rocks, which at this place jutted out so far as nearly to join the reef that encircled the island. Just as we were about to return, however, we saw something black floating in a little cove that had escaped our observation. Running forward, we drew it from the water, and found it to be a long, thick, leather boot, such as fishermen at home wear; and a few paces farther on, we picked up its fellow. We at once recognised these as having belonged to our captain, for he had worn them during the whole of the storm in order to guard his legs from the waves and spray that constantly washed over our decks. My first thought on seeing them was that our dear captain had been drowned; but Jack soon put my mind more at rest on that point by saying that if the captain had been drowned with the boots on, he would certainly have been washed ashore along with them, and that he had no doubt whatever he had kicked them off while in the sea that he might swim more easily.
We had now reached the rocky area where the ship had hit, but we didn’t find anything, even after carefully searching among the coral rocks, which at this spot extended out almost to meet the reef that surrounded the island. Just as we were about to head back, we noticed something black floating in a small cove that we had missed. Running over, we pulled it from the water and discovered it was a long, thick leather boot like the ones fishermen wear back home; a few steps further, we found the matching boot. We immediately recognized these as belonging to our captain, who had worn them throughout the storm to protect his legs from the waves and spray that constantly hit our decks. My first thought upon seeing them was that our dear captain had drowned; however, Jack quickly reassured me by saying that if the captain had drowned with the boots on, they would definitely have washed up on shore with him, and he was sure he had kicked them off in the water to swim more easily.
Peterkin immediately put them on; but they were so large that, as Jack said, they would have done for boots, trousers, and vest too. I also tried them; but although I was long enough in the legs for them, they were much too large in the feet for me. So we handed them to Jack, who was anxious to make me keep them; but as they fitted his large limbs and feet as if they had been made for him, I would not hear of it, so he consented at last to use them. I may remark, however, that Jack did not use them often, as they were extremely heavy.
Peterkin immediately put them on; but they were so big that, as Jack said, they could have worked as boots, pants, and a vest too. I also tried them on; but even though my legs were long enough for them, they were way too big in the feet for me. So we gave them to Jack, who really wanted me to keep them; but since they fit his big limbs and feet as if they were made for him, I wouldn’t hear of it, so he finally agreed to use them. I should note, though, that Jack didn’t use them often because they were really heavy.
It was beginning to grow dark when we returned to our encampment; so we put off our visit to the top of a hill till next day, and employed the light that yet remained to us in cutting down a quantity of boughs and the broad leaves of a tree of which none of us knew the name. With these we erected a sort of rustic bower, in which we meant to pass the night. There was no absolute necessity for this, because the air of our island was so genial and balmy that we could have slept quite well without any shelter; but we were so little used to sleeping in the open air that we did not quite relish the idea of lying down without any covering over us. Besides, our bower would shelter us from the night-dews or rain, if any should happen to fall. Having strewed the floor with leaves and dry grass, we bethought ourselves of supper.
It was starting to get dark when we got back to our campsite, so we decided to postpone our trip to the top of the hill until the next day. We used the remaining light to cut down some branches and the large leaves of a tree none of us recognized. With these, we built a sort of rustic shelter where we planned to spend the night. Although it wasn't absolutely necessary, since the air on our island was so pleasant that we could have slept just fine without any cover, we weren't really used to sleeping outside and didn't feel comfortable lying down without some sort of protection. Plus, our shelter would keep us safe from any dew or rain that might come during the night. After covering the ground with leaves and dry grass, we thought about dinner.
But it now occurred to us, for the first time, that we had no means of making a fire.
But it just hit us for the first time that we had no way to start a fire.
“Now, there’s a fix! What shall we do?” said Peterkin, while we both turned our eyes to Jack, to whom we always looked in our difficulties. Jack seemed not a little perplexed.
“Now, there's a solution! What should we do?” said Peterkin, as we both looked at Jack, who we always turned to in tough situations. Jack seemed quite confused.
“There are flints enough, no doubt, on the beach,” said he; “but they are of no use at all without a steel. However, we must try.” So saying, he went to the beach, and soon returned with two flints. On one of these he placed the tinder, and endeavoured to ignite it; but it was with great difficulty that a very small spark was struck out of the flints, and the tinder, being a bad, hard piece, would not catch. He then tried the bit of hoop-iron, which would not strike fire at all; and after that the back of the axe, with no better success. During all these trials Peterkin sat with his hands in his pockets, gazing with a most melancholy visage at our comrade, his face growing longer and more miserable at each successive failure.
“There are definitely enough flints on the beach,” he said, “but they’re completely useless without steel. Still, we have to give it a shot.” With that, he headed to the beach and soon came back with two flints. He placed the tinder on one of them and tried to light it, but it took a lot of effort to get a tiny spark from the flints, and the tinder, being a tough, poor-quality piece, wouldn’t catch fire. He then tried using a piece of hoop iron, which didn’t produce any sparks at all, and after that, he attempted the back of the axe, but had no better luck. While all this was happening, Peterkin sat with his hands in his pockets, staring at our friend with a very sad face, looking increasingly miserable with each failed attempt.
“Oh dear!” he sighed; “I would not care a button for the cooking of our victuals—perhaps they don’t need it—but it’s so dismal to eat one’s supper in the dark, and we have had such a capital day that it’s a pity to finish off in this glum style. Oh, I have it!” he cried, starting up: “the spy-glass—the big glass at the end is a burning-glass!”
“Oh no!” he sighed; “I wouldn’t care at all about cooking our food—maybe it doesn’t even need it—but it’s so gloomy to eat dinner in the dark, and we’ve had such a great day that it’s a shame to end it like this. Oh, I’ve got it!” he exclaimed, jumping up: “the spyglass—the big lens at the end is a magnifying glass!”
“You forget that we have no sun,” said I.
“You forget that we don’t have any sun,” I said.
Peterkin was silent. In his sudden recollection of the telescope he had quite overlooked the absence of the sun.
Peterkin was quiet. In his sudden memory of the telescope, he completely forgot that the sun was missing.
“Ah, boys, I’ve got it now!” exclaimed Jack, rising and cutting a branch from a neighbouring bush, which he stripped of its leaves. “I recollect seeing this done once at home. Hand me the bit of whip-cord.” With the cord and branch Jack soon formed a bow. Then he cut a piece about three inches long off the end of a dead branch, which he pointed at the two ends. Round this he passed the cord of the bow, and placed one end against his chest, which was protected from its point by a chip of wood; the other point he placed against the bit of tinder, and then began to saw vigorously with the bow, just as a blacksmith does with his drill while boring a hole in a piece of iron. In a few seconds the tinder began to smoke; in less than a minute it caught fire; and in less than a quarter of an hour we were drinking our lemonade and eating cocoa-nuts round a fire that would have roasted an entire sheep, while the smoke, flames, and sparks flew up among the broad leaves of the overhanging palm-trees, and cast a warm glow upon our leafy bower.
“Ah, guys, I’ve got it now!” Jack exclaimed, getting up and cutting a branch from a nearby bush, which he stripped of its leaves. “I remember seeing this done once at home. Hand me the piece of whip-cord.” With the cord and branch, Jack quickly made a bow. Then he cut a piece about three inches long from the end of a dead branch and pointed both ends. He wrapped the cord of the bow around it and pressed one end against his chest, which was protected from the tip by a piece of wood; he placed the other tip against the tinder and then started sawing vigorously with the bow, just like a blacksmith does with his drill when boring a hole in iron. In a few seconds, the tinder began to smoke; in less than a minute, it caught fire; and in less than fifteen minutes, we were drinking our lemonade and eating coconuts around a fire that could have roasted an entire sheep, while the smoke, flames, and sparks danced up among the broad leaves of the palm trees overhead, casting a warm glow on our leafy shelter.
That night the starry sky looked down through the gently rustling trees upon our slumbers, and the distant roaring of the surf upon the coral reef was our lullaby.
That night, the starry sky looked down through the softly rustling trees on our sleep, and the distant sound of the waves crashing on the coral reef was our lullaby.
Chapter Five.
Morning, and cogitations connected therewith—We luxuriate in the sea, try our diving powers, and make enchanting excursions among the coral groves at the bottom of the ocean—The wonders of the deep enlarged upon.
What a joyful thing it is to awaken on a fresh, glorious morning, and find the rising sun staring into your face with dazzling brilliancy! to hear the birds twittering in the bushes, and to hear the murmuring of a rill, or the soft, hissing ripples as they fall upon the seashore! At any time, and in any place, such sights and sounds are most charming; but more especially are they so when one awakens to them, for the first time, in a novel and romantic situation, with the soft, sweet air of a tropical climate mingling with the fresh smell of the sea, and stirring the strange leaves that flutter overhead and around one, or ruffling the plumage of the stranger birds that fly inquiringly around as if to demand what business we have to intrude uninvited on their domains. When I awoke on the morning after the shipwreck, I found myself in this most delightful condition; and as I lay on my back upon my bed of leaves, gazing up through the branches of the cocoa-nut trees into the clear blue sky, and watched the few fleecy clouds that passed slowly across it, my heart expanded more and more with an exulting gladness, the like of which I had never felt before. While I meditated, my thoughts again turned to the great and kind Creator of this beautiful world, as they had done on the previous day when I first beheld the sea and the coral reef, with the mighty waves dashing over it into the calm waters of the lagoon.
What a joy it is to wake up on a fresh, beautiful morning and see the rising sun shining brightly in your face! To hear the birds chirping in the bushes and the gentle sound of a stream, or the soft, hissing waves as they crash onto the shore! Anytime and anywhere, these sights and sounds are delightful; but they’re even more so when you wake up to them for the first time in a new and romantic setting, with the warm, sweet air of a tropical climate mixing with the fresh scent of the sea and rustling the strange leaves fluttering overhead and around you, or ruffling the feathers of the unfamiliar birds flying curiously nearby as if questioning why we’ve intruded uninvited into their territory. When I woke up the morning after the shipwreck, I found myself in this wonderful situation; and as I lay on my back on my bed of leaves, gazing up through the branches of the coconut trees into the clear blue sky and watching the few fluffy clouds drift slowly across it, my heart swelled more and more with an overwhelming joy like I had never felt before. As I reflected, my thoughts turned once again to the great and kind Creator of this beautiful world, just as they had the previous day when I first saw the sea and the coral reef, with the mighty waves crashing over it into the calm waters of the lagoon.
While thus meditating, I naturally bethought me of my Bible, for I had faithfully kept the promise which I gave at parting to my beloved mother—that I would read it every morning; and it was with a feeling of dismay that I remembered I had left it in the ship. I was much troubled about this. However, I consoled myself with reflecting that I could keep the second part of my promise to her—namely, that I should never omit to say my prayers. So I rose quietly lest I should disturb my companions, who were still asleep, and stepped aside into the bushes for this purpose.
While I was thinking about everything, I naturally remembered my Bible, because I had kept my promise to my beloved mother—that I would read it every morning. I felt a wave of dismay when I remembered I had left it on the ship. This troubled me a lot. However, I comforted myself by realizing that I could still keep the second part of my promise to her—that I would always say my prayers. So, I got up quietly so I wouldn’t wake my companions, who were still asleep, and stepped into the bushes to do this.
On my return I found them still slumbering, so I again lay down to think over our situation. Just at that moment I was attracted by the sight of a very small parrot, which Jack afterwards told me was called a paroquet. It was seated on a twig that overhung Peterkin’s head, and I was speedily lost in admiration of its bright-green plumage, which was mingled with other gay colours. While I looked I observed that the bird turned its head slowly from side to side and looked downwards, first with the one eye and then with the other. On glancing downwards I observed that Peterkin’s mouth was wide open, and that this remarkable bird was looking into it. Peterkin used to say that I had not an atom of fun in my composition, and that I never could understand a joke. In regard to the latter, perhaps he was right; yet I think that, when they were explained to me, I understood jokes as well as most people. But in regard to the former, he must certainly have been wrong, for this bird seemed to me to be extremely funny; and I could not help thinking that if it should happen to faint, or slip its foot, and fall off the twig into Peterkin’s mouth, he would perhaps think it funny too! Suddenly the paroquet bent down its head and uttered a loud scream in his face. This awoke him, and with a cry of surprise, he started up, while the foolish bird flew precipitately away.
On my return, I found them still sleeping, so I lay down again to think about our situation. Just then, I spotted a very small parrot, which Jack later told me was called a paroquet. It was perched on a twig that hung over Peterkin’s head, and I quickly became captivated by its bright green feathers, which were mixed with other vibrant colors. As I watched, I noticed the bird slowly turned its head from side to side and looked down, first with one eye and then the other. When I looked down, I saw that Peterkin’s mouth was wide open, and this quirky bird was peering inside it. Peterkin always claimed I had no sense of humor and that I never understood jokes. Regarding the latter, he might have been right; yet I believe that when jokes were explained to me, I understood them as well as anyone else. But on the first point, he was definitely wrong, because this bird seemed really funny to me; I couldn't help but think that if it happened to faint or lose its grip and fall into Peterkin’s mouth, he would probably find it funny too! Suddenly, the paroquet leaned down and let out a loud scream right in his face. This startled him awake, and with a surprised shout, he leapt up, while the silly bird flew away in a hurry.
“Oh, you monster!” cried Peterkin, shaking his fist at the bird. Then he yawned, and rubbed his eyes, and asked what o’clock it was.
“Oh, you monster!” shouted Peterkin, shaking his fist at the bird. Then he yawned, rubbed his eyes, and asked what time it was.
I smiled at this question, and answered that, as our watches were at the bottom of the sea, I could not tell, but it was a little past sunrise.
I smiled at the question and replied that since our watches were at the bottom of the ocean, I couldn't say for sure, but it was just after sunrise.
Peterkin now began to remember where we were. As he looked up into the bright sky, and snuffed the scented air, his eyes glistened with delight, and he uttered a faint “Hurrah!” and yawned again. Then he gazed slowly round, till, observing the calm sea through an opening in the bushes, he started suddenly up as if he had received an electric shock, uttered a vehement shout, flung off his garments, and rushing over the white sands, plunged into the water. The cry awoke Jack, who rose on his elbow with a look of grave surprise; but this was followed by a quiet smile of intelligence on seeing Peterkin in the water. With an energy that he only gave way to in moments of excitement, Jack bounded to his feet, threw off his clothes, shook back his hair, and with a lion-like spring, dashed over the sands and plunged into the sea with such force as quite to envelop Peterkin in a shower of spray. Jack was a remarkably good swimmer and diver, so that after his plunge we saw no sign of him for nearly a minute, after which he suddenly emerged, with a cry of joy, a good many yards out from the shore. My spirits were so much raised by seeing all this that I, too, hastily threw off my garments and endeavoured to imitate Jack’s vigorous bound; but I was so awkward that my foot caught on a stump, and I fell to the ground. Then I slipped on a stone while running over the sand and nearly fell again, much to the amusement of Peterkin, who laughed heartily and called me a “slow coach;” while Jack cried out, “Come along, Ralph, and I’ll help you!” However, when I got into the water I managed very well; for I was really a good swimmer and diver too. I could not, indeed, equal Jack, who was superior to any Englishman I ever saw; but I infinitely surpassed Peterkin, who could only swim a little, and could not dive at all.
Peterkin started to remember where we were. As he looked up at the bright sky and inhaled the fragrant air, his eyes sparkled with joy, and he let out a quiet “Hurrah!” before yawning again. Then he slowly took in his surroundings, and when he noticed the calm sea through a gap in the bushes, he suddenly jumped up as if jolted by electricity, shouted excitedly, threw off his clothes, and rushed across the white sand to dive into the water. His shout woke Jack, who propped himself up on his elbow with a surprised expression, but then a knowing smile crossed his face when he saw Peterkin in the water. With a burst of energy that only came out in moments of excitement, Jack sprang to his feet, stripped off his clothes, tossed back his hair, and with a powerful leap, bolted over the sand and plunged into the sea, sending a spray of water that completely drenched Peterkin. Jack was an excellent swimmer and diver, so after his dive, we didn't see him for almost a minute, then he suddenly surfaced, shouting with joy, quite a distance from the shore. Seeing all this lifted my spirits, so I quickly took off my clothes and tried to mimic Jack’s energetic leap, but I was so clumsy that my foot caught on a stump and I fell. Then I tripped on a stone while rushing over the sand and almost fell again, which made Peterkin laugh heartily and call me a “slow coach,” while Jack shouted, “Come on, Ralph, I’ll help you!” However, once I got into the water, I did quite well; I was actually a good swimmer and diver too. I couldn't quite match Jack, who was better than any Englishman I had ever seen, but I far outperformed Peterkin, who could only swim a little and couldn't dive at all.
While Peterkin enjoyed himself in the shallow water and in running along the beach, Jack and I swam out into the deep water and occasionally dived for stones. I shall never forget my surprise and delight on first beholding the bottom of the sea. As I have before stated, the water within the reef was as calm as a pond; and as there was no wind, it was quite clear from the surface to the bottom, so that we could see down easily even at a depth of twenty or thirty yards. When Jack and I dived into shallower water we expected to have found sand and stones, instead of which we found ourselves in what appeared really to be an enchanted garden. The whole of the bottom of the lagoon, as we called the calm water within the reef, was covered with coral of every shape, size, and hue. Some portions were formed like large mushrooms; others appeared like the brain of a man, having stalks or necks attached to them; but the most common kind was a species of branching coral, and some portions were of a lovely pale-pink colour, others were pure white. Among this there grew large quantities of seaweed of the richest hues imaginable, and of the most graceful forms; while innumerable fishes—blue, red, yellow, green, and striped—sported in and out amongst the flower-beds of this submarine garden, and did not appear to be at all afraid of our approaching them.
While Peterkin had fun in the shallow water and running along the beach, Jack and I swam out into the deeper water and occasionally dove for stones. I’ll never forget my surprise and excitement the first time I saw the bottom of the sea. As I mentioned earlier, the water inside the reef was as calm as a pond; and with no wind, it was completely clear from the surface to the bottom, so we could easily see down even at a depth of twenty or thirty yards. When Jack and I dove into shallower water, we expected to find sand and stones, but instead, we discovered what truly seemed like an enchanted garden. The whole bottom of the lagoon, as we called the calm water inside the reef, was covered with coral of every shape, size, and color. Some parts looked like large mushrooms; others resembled a human brain, with stalks or necks attached to them; but the most common type was a branching coral, with some portions a lovely pale pink and others pure white. Among this, there were large amounts of seaweed in the richest shades imaginable, with the most graceful forms; while countless fish—blue, red, yellow, green, and striped—darted in and out among the flower beds of this underwater garden and didn’t seem at all afraid of our presence.
On darting to the surface for breath after our first dive, Jack and I rose close to each other.
On surfacing for air after our first dive, Jack and I came up near each other.
“Did you ever in your life, Ralph, see anything so lovely?” said Jack as he flung the spray from his hair.
“Have you ever in your life, Ralph, seen anything so beautiful?” Jack said as he shook the water from his hair.
“Never,” I replied. “It appears to me like fairy realms. I can scarcely believe that we are not dreaming.”
“Never,” I replied. “It feels like we’re in a fairy tale. I can hardly believe we’re not dreaming.”
“Dreaming!” cried Jack. “Do you know, Ralph, I’m half-tempted to think that we really are dreaming! But if so, I am resolved to make the most of it and dream another dive; so here goes—down again, my boy!”
“Dreaming!” shouted Jack. “You know, Ralph, I'm kind of tempted to think that we really are dreaming! But if that’s the case, I’m determined to make the most of it and dive again; so here we go—down again, my friend!”
We took the second dive together, and kept beside each other while under water; and I was greatly surprised to find that we could keep down much longer than I ever recollect having done in our own seas at home. I believe that this was owing to the heat of the water, which was so warm that we afterwards found we could remain in it for two and three hours at a time without feeling any unpleasant effects such as we used to experience in the sea at home. When Jack reached the bottom, he grasped the coral stems and crept along on his hands and knees, peeping under the seaweed and among the rocks. I observed him, also, pick up one or two large oysters and retain them in his grasp, as if he meant to take them up with him; so I also gathered a few. Suddenly he made a grasp at a fish with blue and yellow stripes on its back, and actually touched its tail, but did not catch it. At this he turned towards me and attempted to smile; but no sooner had he done so than he sprang like an arrow to the surface, where, on following him, I found him gasping and coughing and spitting water from his mouth. In a few minutes he recovered, and we both turned to swim ashore.
We dived down together for the second time and stayed close to each other while underwater. I was really surprised to find that we could stay down much longer than I remembered ever doing in the seas back home. I think this was because the water was so warm that we later discovered we could stay in it for two to three hours at a time without feeling any bad effects like we usually did in the ocean at home. When Jack reached the bottom, he grabbed onto the coral and crawled on his hands and knees, peeking under the seaweed and around the rocks. I noticed him pick up a couple of large oysters and hold onto them as if he planned to take them back with him, so I grabbed a few, too. Suddenly, he lunged for a fish with blue and yellow stripes on its back and actually touched its tail, but he didn’t catch it. At that, he turned to me and tried to smile, but as soon as he did, he shot up to the surface like an arrow. When I followed him, I found him gasping and coughing up water. In a few minutes, he recovered, and we both started swimming back to shore.
“I declare, Ralph,” said he, “that I actually tried to laugh under water!”
“I swear, Ralph,” he said, “that I really tried to laugh underwater!”
“So I saw,” I replied; “and I observed that you very nearly caught that fish by the tail. It would have done capitally for breakfast, if you had.”
“So I saw,” I replied; “and I noticed that you almost caught that fish by the tail. It would have been perfect for breakfast if you had.”
“Breakfast enough here,” said he, holding up the oysters as we landed and ran up the beach.—“Hallo, Peterkin! Here you are, boy! split open these fellows while Ralph and I put on our clothes. They’ll agree with the cocoa-nuts excellently, I have no doubt.”
“There's enough breakfast here,” he said, holding up the oysters as we landed and rushed up the beach. “Hey, Peterkin! There you are, buddy! Open these up while Ralph and I get dressed. I'm sure they'll go perfectly with the coconuts.”
Peterkin, who was already dressed, took the oysters and opened them with the edge of our axe, exclaiming, “Now, that’s capital! There’s nothing I’m so fond of.”
Peterkin, who was already dressed, took the oysters and opened them with the edge of our axe, exclaiming, “Now, that’s great! There’s nothing I love more.”
“Ah! that’s lucky,” remarked Jack. “I’ll be able to keep you in good order now, Master Peterkin. You know you can’t dive any better than a cat. So, sir, whenever you behave ill you shall have no oysters for breakfast.”
“Ah! that’s lucky,” said Jack. “I can keep you in line now, Master Peterkin. You know you can’t swim any better than a cat. So, if you act up, you won’t get any oysters for breakfast.”
“I’m very glad that our prospect of breakfast is so good,” said I, “for I’m very hungry.”
“I’m really happy that we have such a great breakfast ahead of us,” I said, “because I’m really hungry.”
“Here, then, stop your mouth with that, Ralph,” said Peterkin, holding a large oyster to my lips. I opened my mouth and swallowed it in silence, and really it was remarkably good.
“Here, then, shut up and eat this, Ralph,” said Peterkin, holding a large oyster to my lips. I opened my mouth and swallowed it in silence, and honestly, it was surprisingly delicious.
We now set ourselves earnestly about our preparations for spending the day. We had no difficulty with the fire this morning as our burning-glass was an admirable one; and while we roasted a few oysters and ate our cocoa-nuts, we held a long, animated conversation about our plans for the future. What those plans were, and how we carried them into effect, the reader shall see hereafter.
We now got to work seriously on preparing for our day. We had no trouble with the fire this morning since our magnifying glass was excellent; and while we roasted some oysters and enjoyed our coconuts, we had a long, lively conversation about our future plans. What those plans were and how we put them into action, the reader will find out later.
Chapter Six.
An excursion into the interior in which we make many valuable and interesting discoveries—We get a dreadful fright—The bread-fruit tree—Wonderful peculiarity of some of the fruit-trees—Signs of former inhabitants.
Our first care, after breakfast, was to place the few articles we possessed in the crevice of a rock at the farther end of a small cave which we discovered near our encampment. This cave, we hoped, might be useful to us afterwards as a storehouse. Then we cut two large clubs off a species of very hard tree which grew near at hand. One of these was given to Peterkin, the other to me, and Jack armed himself with the axe. We took these precautions because we purposed to make an excursion to the top of the mountains of the interior, in order to obtain a better view of our island. Of course we knew not what dangers might befall us by the way, so thought it best to be prepared.
After breakfast, our first priority was to stash the few belongings we had in a crevice of a rock at the far end of a small cave we found near our campsite. We hoped this cave would come in handy later as a storage space. Then we cut two large sticks from a very hard tree that grew nearby. One stick went to Peterkin, the other to me, while Jack took the axe. We took these precautions because we planned to hike to the top of the mountains in the interior for a better view of our island. Naturally, we didn't know what dangers might be ahead, so we thought it was best to be prepared.
Having completed our arrangements and carefully extinguished our fire, we sallied forth and walked a short distance along the sea-beach till we came to the entrance of a valley, through which flowed the rivulet before mentioned. Here we turned our backs on the sea and struck into the interior.
Having finished our preparations and put out our fire, we set off and walked a short way along the beach until we reached the entrance of a valley, where the stream I mentioned earlier flowed. Here, we turned away from the sea and headed inland.
The prospect that burst upon our view on entering the valley was truly splendid. On either side of us there was a gentle rise in the land, which thus formed two ridges, about a mile apart, on each side of the valley. These ridges—which, as well as the low grounds between them, were covered with trees and shrubs of the most luxuriant kind—continued to recede inland for about two miles, when they joined the foot of a small mountain. This hill rose rather abruptly from the head of the valley, and was likewise entirely covered, even to the top, with trees—except on one particular spot near the left shoulder, where was a bare and rocky place of a broken and savage character. Beyond this hill we could not see, and we therefore directed our course up the banks of the rivulet towards the foot of it, intending to climb to the top, should that be possible—as, indeed, we had no doubt it was.
The view that greeted us as we entered the valley was absolutely stunning. On either side, the land gently rose, creating two ridges about a mile apart along the valley. These ridges, along with the lush low ground between them, were filled with dense trees and shrubs. They continued to stretch inland for about two miles before meeting the base of a small mountain. This hill rose steeply from the end of the valley and was completely covered in trees, except for one specific spot near the left side where there was a bare and rocky area that looked rough and wild. We couldn't see beyond this hill, so we made our way up the banks of the stream toward its base, planning to climb to the top if we could—though we were confident we would be able to.
Jack, being the wisest and boldest among us, took the lead, carrying the axe on his shoulder. Peterkin, with his enormous club, came second, as he said he should like to be in a position to defend me if any danger should threaten. I brought up the rear; but having been more taken up with the wonderful and curious things I saw at starting than with thoughts of possible danger, I had very foolishly left my club behind me. Although, as I have said, the trees and bushes were very luxuriant, they were not so thickly crowded together as to hinder our progress among them. We were able to wind in and out, and to follow the banks of the stream quite easily, although, it is true, the height and thickness of the foliage prevented us from seeing far ahead. But sometimes a jutting-out rock on the hillsides afforded us a position whence we could enjoy the romantic view and mark our progress towards the foot of the hill. I was particularly struck, during the walk, with the richness of the undergrowth in most places, and recognised many berries and plants that resembled those of my native land, especially a tall, elegantly formed fern, which emitted an agreeable perfume. There were several kinds of flowers, too; but I did not see so many of these as I should have expected in such a climate. We also saw a great variety of small birds of bright plumage, and many paroquets similar to the one, that awoke Peterkin so rudely in the morning.
Jack, the smartest and bravest among us, took the lead, carrying the axe on his shoulder. Peterkin followed closely with his huge club, saying he wanted to be ready to defend me if any danger approached. I brought up the rear; however, I had been more fascinated by the amazing and curious things I saw at the beginning than by thoughts of potential danger, so I foolishly left my club behind. Even though the trees and bushes were lush, they weren't so thickly packed that they obstructed our path. We could easily navigate through them and follow the stream's banks, though the height and density of the foliage made it hard to see far ahead. Occasionally, a protruding rock on the hillsides gave us a place to admire the stunning view and track our progress down the hill. During our walk, I was particularly impressed by the richness of the undergrowth in most areas and recognized many berries and plants that reminded me of home, especially a tall, gracefully shaped fern that emitted a pleasant scent. There were several types of flowers as well, but I didn’t see as many as I would have expected in this climate. We also spotted a wide variety of small, brightly colored birds, along with many parrots like the one that startled Peterkin so abruptly in the morning.
Thus we advanced to the foot of the hill without encountering anything to alarm us, except, indeed, once, when we were passing close under a part of the hill which was hidden from our view by the broad leaves of the banana-trees, which grew in great luxuriance in that part. Jack was just preparing to force his way through this thicket when we were startled and arrested by a strange pattering or rumbling sound, which appeared to us quite different from any of the sounds we had heard during the previous part of our walk.
Thus we moved to the bottom of the hill without running into anything alarming, except for one moment when we were passing close under a section of the hill that was blocked from our sight by the wide leaves of the banana trees, which grew abundantly in that area. Jack was just getting ready to push his way through this thicket when we were caught off guard by a strange pattering or rumbling noise, which sounded completely different from anything we had heard earlier in our walk.
“Hallo!” cried Peterkin, stopping short, and grasping his club with both hands; “what’s that?”
“Hey!” shouted Peterkin, stopping abruptly and gripping his club with both hands. “What’s that?”
Neither of us replied; but Jack seized his axe in his right hand, while with the other he pushed aside the broad leaves and endeavoured to peer amongst them.
Neither of us said anything; but Jack grabbed his axe with one hand while using the other to push aside the large leaves and tried to look through them.
“I can see nothing,” he said after a short pause. “I think it—”
“I can’t see anything,” he said after a brief pause. “I think it—”
Again the rumbling sound came, louder than before, and we all sprang back and stood on the defensive. For myself, having forgotten my club, and not having taken the precaution to cut another, I buttoned my jacket, doubled my fists, and threw myself into a boxing attitude. I must say, however, that I felt somewhat uneasy; and my companions afterwards confessed that their thoughts at this moment had been instantly filled with all they had ever heard or read of wild beasts and savages, torturings at the stake, roastings alive, and such-like horrible things. Suddenly the pattering noise increased with tenfold violence. It was followed by a fearful crash among the bushes, which was rapidly repeated, as if some gigantic animal were bounding towards us. In another moment an enormous rock came crashing through the shrubbery, followed by a cloud of dust and small stones, and flew close past the spot where we stood, carrying bushes and young trees along with it.
Once again, a rumbling sound hit us, louder than before, and we all jumped back and got ready to defend ourselves. I had forgotten my club and hadn’t made a new one, so I buttoned my jacket, clenched my fists, and got into a boxing stance. I have to admit, though, I felt pretty uneasy; my friends later admitted that at that moment, their minds were flooded with everything they had ever heard or read about wild animals and savages, tortures at the stake, being roasted alive, and all those other horrific things. Suddenly, the pattering noise intensified dramatically. It was followed by a terrifying crash in the bushes, which echoed rapidly as if some gigantic creature were charging toward us. In an instant, a massive rock came crashing through the foliage, followed by a cloud of dust and small stones, narrowly missing us as it carried shrubs and young trees along with it.
“Pooh! is that all?” exclaimed Peterkin, wiping the perspiration off his forehead. “Why, I thought it was all the wild men and beasts in the South Sea Islands, galloping on in one grand charge to sweep us off the face of the earth, instead of a mere stone tumbling down the mountain-side!”
“Ugh! Is that it?” shouted Peterkin, wiping the sweat from his forehead. “I thought it was all the wild men and beasts from the South Sea Islands rushing in a huge wave to wipe us off the face of the earth, instead of just a rock rolling down the mountain!”
“Nevertheless,” remarked Jack, “if that same stone had hit any of us it would have rendered the charge you speak of quite unnecessary, Peterkin.”
“Still,” said Jack, “if that same stone had hit any of us, it would have made the charge you’re talking about completely unnecessary, Peterkin.”
This was true, and I felt very thankful for our escape. On examining the spot more narrowly, we found that it lay close to the foot of a very rugged precipice, from which stones of various sizes were always tumbling at intervals. Indeed, the numerous fragments lying scattered all round might have suggested the cause of the sound had we not been too suddenly alarmed to think of anything.
This was true, and I felt really grateful for our escape. When we looked more closely at the spot, we noticed it was right by the base of a steep cliff, from which rocks of different sizes were constantly falling down. In fact, the many pieces scattered around might have hinted at the source of the noise if we hadn't been too shocked to think about anything.
We now resumed our journey, resolving that, in our future excursions into the interior, we would be careful to avoid this dangerous precipice.
We continued our journey, deciding that in our future trips into the interior, we would be sure to steer clear of this dangerous cliff.
Soon afterwards we arrived at the foot of the hill, and prepared to ascend it. Here Jack made a discovery which caused us all very great joy. This was a tree of a remarkably beautiful appearance, which Jack confidently declared to be the celebrated bread-fruit tree.
Soon after, we arrived at the base of the hill and got ready to climb it. At this point, Jack made a discovery that brought us all a lot of joy. He spotted a tree that looked incredibly beautiful, which Jack confidently identified as the famous breadfruit tree.
“Is it celebrated?” inquired Peterkin with a look of great simplicity.
“Is it celebrated?” Peterkin asked with a look of complete innocence.
“It is,” replied Jack.
“It is,” said Jack.
“That’s odd, now,” rejoined Peterkin; “I never heard of it before.”
"That's strange now," replied Peterkin; "I've never heard of that before."
“Then it’s not so celebrated as I thought it was,” returned Jack, quietly squeezing Peterkin’s hat over his eyes; “but listen, you ignorant boobie! and hear of it now.”
“Then it’s not as famous as I thought it was,” Jack replied, quietly pushing Peterkin’s hat down over his eyes. “But listen, you clueless fool! Let me tell you about it now.”
Peterkin readjusted his hat, and was soon listening with as much interest as myself while Jack told us that this tree is one of the most valuable in the islands of the south; that it bears two, sometimes three, crops of fruit in the year; that the fruit is very like wheaten bread in appearance, and that it constitutes the principal food of many of the islanders.
Peterkin adjusted his hat and quickly became just as interested as I was while Jack shared that this tree is one of the most valuable in the southern islands; that it produces two, sometimes three, crops of fruit each year; that the fruit looks a lot like wheat bread, and that it is the main food source for many of the islanders.
“So,” said Peterkin, “we seem to have everything ready prepared to our hands in this wonderful island—lemonade ready bottled in nuts, and loaf-bread growing on the trees!”
“So,” Peterkin said, “it looks like we have everything we need right here in this amazing island—lemonade already bottled in nuts, and bread growing on the trees!”
Peterkin, as usual, was jesting; nevertheless, it is a curious fact that he spoke almost the literal truth.
Peterkin was joking, as usual; however, it's interesting to note that he was telling almost the exact truth.
“Moreover,” continued Jack, “the bread-fruit tree affords a capital gum, which serves the natives for pitching their canoes; the bark of the young branches is made by them into cloth; and of the wood, which is durable and of a good colour, they build their houses. So you see, lads, that we have no lack of material here to make us comfortable, if we are only clever enough to use it.”
“Also,” Jack continued, “the breadfruit tree provides a great gum that the locals use to waterproof their canoes; they make cloth from the bark of the young branches, and they build their homes from the strong, nicely colored wood. So, you see, guys, we have everything we need to be comfortable here, as long as we’re smart enough to take advantage of it.”
“But are you sure that that’s it?” asked Peterkin.
“But are you sure that’s all there is?” asked Peterkin.
“Quite sure,” replied Jack; “for I was particularly interested in the account I once read of it, and I remember the description well. I am sorry, however that I have forgotten the descriptions of many other trees which I am sure we have seen to-day, if we could but recognise them. So you see, Peterkin, I’m not up to everything yet.”
“Absolutely,” replied Jack; “I was really curious about the account I read about it, and I remember the description clearly. I do wish, though, that I hadn’t forgotten the descriptions of many other trees we’ve definitely seen today, if only we could recognize them. So, you see, Peterkin, I’m not quite on top of everything yet.”
“Never mind, Jack,” said Peterkin with a grave, patronising expression of countenance, patting his tall companion on the shoulder—“never mind, Jack; you know a good deal for your age. You’re a clever boy, sir—a promising young man; and if you only go on as you have begun, sir, you will—”
“Don’t worry about it, Jack,” Peterkin said with a serious, condescending look, giving his tall friend a pat on the shoulder. “Don’t worry, Jack; you know a lot for your age. You’re a smart kid, sir—a promising young man; and if you keep going like you have been, sir, you will—”
The end of this speech was suddenly cut short by Jack tripping up Peterkin’s heels and tumbling him into a mass of thick shrubs, where, finding himself comfortable, he lay still, basking in the sunshine, while Jack and I examined the bread-fruit tree.
The end of this speech was suddenly interrupted when Jack tripped Peterkin, sending him tumbling into a thick patch of bushes. Once there, feeling cozy, he lay still and soaked up the sun, while Jack and I checked out the bread-fruit tree.
We were much struck with the deep, rich green colour of its broad leaves, which were twelve or eighteen inches long, deeply indented, and of a glossy smoothness, like the laurel. The fruit, with which it was loaded, was nearly round, and appeared to be about six inches in diameter, with a rough rind, marked with lozenge-shaped divisions. It was of various colours, from light pea-green to brown and rich yellow. Jack said that the yellow was the ripe fruit. We afterwards found that most of the fruit-trees on the island were evergreens, and that we might, when we wished, pluck the blossom and the ripe fruit from the same tree. Such a wonderful difference from the trees of our own country surprised us not a little. The bark of the tree was rough and light-coloured; the trunk was about two feet in diameter, and it appeared to be twenty feet high, being quite destitute of branches up to that height, where it branched off into a beautiful and umbrageous head. We noticed that the fruit hung in clusters of twos and threes on the branches; but as we were anxious to get to the top of the hill, we refrained from attempting to pluck any at that time.
We were really impressed by the deep, rich green color of its wide leaves, which were about twelve to eighteen inches long, deeply indented, and had a glossy smoothness like laurel. The fruit, which was abundant, was nearly round and seemed to be about six inches in diameter, with a rough skin marked by diamond-shaped sections. It came in various colors, from light pea-green to brown and rich yellow. Jack said that the yellow ones were ripe. We later discovered that most of the fruit trees on the island were evergreens, and we could pick both blossoms and ripe fruit from the same tree whenever we wanted. The striking difference from the trees in our own country surprised us quite a bit. The bark of the tree was rough and light-colored; the trunk was about two feet in diameter and appeared to be twenty feet tall, with no branches up to that height, where it branched out into a beautiful, leafy canopy. We noticed that the fruit hung in clusters of two or three on the branches, but since we were eager to reach the top of the hill, we decided not to try to pick any at that moment.
Our hearts were now very much cheered by our good fortune, and it was with light and active steps that we clambered up the steep sides of the hill. On reaching the summit a new, and if possible a grander, prospect met our gaze. We found that this was not the highest part of the island, but that another hill lay beyond, with a wide valley between it and the one on which we stood. This valley, like the first, was also full of rich trees—some dark and some light green, some heavy and thick in foliage, and others light, feathery, and graceful, while the beautiful blossoms on many of them threw a sort of rainbow tint over all, and gave to the valley the appearance of a garden of flowers. Among these we recognised many of the bread-fruit trees, laden with yellow fruit, and also a great many cocoa-nut palms. After gazing our fill we pushed down the hillside, crossed the valley, and soon began to ascend the second mountain. It was clothed with trees nearly to the top; but the summit was bare, and in some places broken.
Our hearts were really lifted by our good luck, and we climbed the steep hill with light, quick steps. When we reached the top, we were greeted by an even more stunning view. We realized this wasn’t the highest point on the island; another hill lay ahead, separated by a wide valley. This valley, like the first, was filled with vibrant trees—some dark and some light green, some dense and leafy, while others were light, feathery, and elegant, and the beautiful blossoms on many of them cast a rainbow-like hue over everything, making the valley look like a flower garden. Among these, we spotted several breadfruit trees heavy with yellow fruit, along with many coconut palms. After taking it all in, we descended the hillside, crossed the valley, and soon began to climb the second mountain. It was covered in trees almost to the top, but the summit was bare and somewhat jagged in places.
While on our way up we came to an object which filled us with much interest. This was the stump of a tree that had evidently been cut down with an axe! So, then, we were not the first who had viewed this beautiful isle. The hand of man had been at work there before us. It now began to recur to us again that perhaps the island was inhabited, although we had not seen any traces of man until now. But a second glance at the stump convinced us that we had not more reason to think so now than formerly; for the surface of the wood was quite decayed and partly covered with fungus and green matter, so that it must have been cut many years ago.
While we were making our way up, we stumbled upon something that caught our attention. It was the stump of a tree that had clearly been chopped down with an axe! So, we realized we weren't the first ones to set eyes on this beautiful island. Someone had been here before us. It started to occur to us again that maybe the island was inhabited, although we hadn’t seen any signs of people until now. But a closer look at the stump made us think that we had no more reason to believe that now than we did before; the surface of the wood was pretty decayed and partly covered with fungus and green growth, which meant it must have been cut down many years ago.
“Perhaps,” said Peterkin, “some ship or other has touched here long ago for wood, and only taken one tree.”
“Maybe,” said Peterkin, “some ship came here a long time ago for wood and just took one tree.”
We did not think this likely, however, because, in such circumstances, the crew of a ship would cut wood of small size and near the shore; whereas this was a large tree, and stood near the top of the mountain. In fact, it was the highest large tree on the mountain, all above it being wood of very recent growth.
We didn’t think this was likely, though, because in that situation, a ship’s crew would usually cut down smaller trees closer to the shore; instead, this was a large tree that stood near the mountain’s peak. In fact, it was the tallest large tree on the mountain, with everything above it being very recent growth.
“I can’t understand it,” said Jack, scratching the surface of the stump with his axe. “I can only suppose that the savages have been here and cut it for some purpose known only to themselves. But, hallo! what have we here?”
“I can’t figure it out,” said Jack, scratching the surface of the stump with his axe. “I can only guess that the natives have been here and cut it for some reason known only to them. But, wait! What do we have here?”
As he spoke Jack began carefully to scrape away the moss and fungus from the stump, and soon laid bare three distinct traces of marks, as if some inscription or initials had been cut thereon. But although the traces were distinct, beyond all doubt, the exact form of the letters could not be made out. Jack thought they looked like JS, but we could not be certain. They had apparently been carelessly cut, and long exposure to the weather had so broken them up that we could not make out what they were. We were exceedingly perplexed at this discovery, and stayed a long time at the place conjecturing what these marks could have been, but without avail; so, as the day was advancing, we left it, and quickly reached the top of the mountain.
As he spoke, Jack started to carefully scrape away the moss and fungus from the stump and soon uncovered three distinct marks, almost like some sort of inscription or initials had been carved there. Even though the marks were clear, we couldn't quite make out the exact shape of the letters. Jack thought they resembled "JS," but we couldn’t be sure. They seemed to have been cut carelessly, and years of exposure to the elements had worn them down, making it impossible for us to figure out what they were. We were really puzzled by this discovery and spent a long time at the spot trying to guess what these marks might have been, but we had no luck. So, as the day was getting late, we left and quickly made our way to the top of the mountain.
We found this to be the highest point of the island, and from it we saw our kingdom lying, as it were, like a map around us. As I have always thought it impossible to get a thing properly into one’s understanding without comprehending it, I shall beg the reader’s patience for a little while I describe our island, thus, shortly:
We found this to be the highest point of the island, and from there we saw our kingdom spread out around us like a map. Since I've always believed that you can't truly understand something without fully grasping it, I ask for the reader's patience for a moment while I briefly describe our island:
It consisted of two mountains: the one we guessed at five hundred feet; the other, on which we stood, at one thousand. Between these lay a rich, beautiful valley, as already said. This valley crossed the island from one end to the other, being high in the middle and sloping on each side towards the sea. The large mountain sloped, on the side farthest from where we had been wrecked, gradually towards the sea; but although, when viewed at a glance, it had thus a regular sloping appearance, a more careful observation showed that it was broken up into a multitude of very small vales—or, rather, dells and glens—intermingled with little rugged spots and small but abrupt precipices here and there, with rivulets tumbling over their edges and wandering down the slopes in little white streams, sometimes glistening among the broad leaves of the bread-fruit and cocoa-nut trees, or hiding altogether beneath the rich underwood. At the base of this mountain lay a narrow bright-green plain or meadow, which terminated abruptly at the shore. On the other side of the island, whence we had come, stood the smaller hill, at the foot of which diverged three valleys—one being that which we had ascended, with a smaller vale on each side of it, and separated from it by the two ridges before mentioned. In these smaller valleys there were no streams, but they were clothed with the same luxuriant vegetation.
It was made up of two mountains: one we estimated to be about five hundred feet high; the other, where we stood, was around one thousand feet. Between them stretched a beautiful, lush valley, as mentioned earlier. This valley ran across the island from one end to the other, rising in the middle and sloping down towards the sea on both sides. The larger mountain sloped gradually towards the sea on the side that was farthest from where we had wrecked; however, while it appeared evenly sloped at first glance, a closer look revealed it was filled with many small valleys—or rather, dells and glens—interspersed with rugged patches and small steep cliffs here and there, with streams tumbling over the edges and meandering down the slopes in little white streams, sometimes sparkling among the large leaves of the breadfruit and coconut trees or completely hidden beneath the lush undergrowth. At the base of this mountain was a narrow, bright green meadow that ended sharply at the shoreline. On the opposite side of the island, where we had come from, was the smaller hill, at the foot of which three valleys branched off—one being the one we had climbed, flanked by two smaller valleys on each side, separated from it by the two ridges previously mentioned. In these smaller valleys, there were no streams, but they were covered with the same rich vegetation.
The diameter of the island seemed to be about ten miles, and as it was almost circular in form, its circumference must have been thirty miles—perhaps a little more, if allowance be made for the numerous bays and indentations of the shore. The entire island was belted by a beach of pure white sand, on which laved the gentle ripples of the lagoon. We now also observed that the coral reef completely encircled the island; but it varied its distance from it here and there—in some places being a mile from the beach, in others a few hundred yards, but the average distance was half-a-mile. The reef lay very low, and the spray of the surf broke quite over it in many places. This surf never ceased its roar; for, however calm the weather might be, there is always a gentle swaying motion in the great Pacific, which, although scarce noticeable out at sea, reaches the shore at last in a huge billow. The water within the lagoon, as before said, was perfectly still. There were three narrow openings in the reef: one opposite each end of the valley which I have described as crossing the island; the other opposite our own valley, which we afterwards named the Valley of the Wreck. At each of these openings the reef rose into two small green islets, covered with bushes, and having one or two cocoa-nut palms on each. These islets were very singular, and appeared as if planted expressly for the purpose of marking the channel into the lagoon. Our captain was making for one of these openings the day we were wrecked—and would have reached it, too, I doubt not, had not the rudder been torn away. Within the lagoon were several pretty, low coral islands, just opposite our encampment; and immediately beyond these, out at sea, lay about a dozen other islands, at various distances, from half-a-mile to ten miles—all of them, as far as we could discern, smaller than ours and apparently uninhabited. They seemed to be low coral islands, raised but little above the sea, yet covered with cocoa-nut trees.
The island's diameter seemed to be about ten miles, and since it was almost circular, its circumference must have been around thirty miles—maybe a bit more, considering the many bays and indentations along the shore. The whole island was surrounded by a beach of pure white sand, gently lapped by the calm waters of the lagoon. We also noticed that the coral reef completely surrounded the island, varying in distance from it in different places—sometimes a mile from the beach and other times just a few hundred yards, with an average distance of half a mile. The reef was quite low, and in many spots, the surf broke over it. This surf never stopped roaring; no matter how calm the weather, there's always a gentle swaying motion in the vast Pacific that, although barely noticeable out at sea, eventually reaches the shore in a large wave. The water inside the lagoon, as mentioned before, was perfectly still. There were three narrow openings in the reef: one across from each end of the valley I described that runs through the island, and the other across from our own valley, which we later named the Valley of the Wreck. At each of these openings, the reef rose into two small green islets, covered with bushes and featuring one or two coconut palms each. These islets were quite unique and seemed like they were planted specifically to mark the entrance to the lagoon. Our captain was heading toward one of these openings the day we got shipwrecked—and I believe he would have made it if the rudder hadn’t been torn away. Inside the lagoon were several charming, low coral islands, just opposite our campsite; and immediately beyond these, out at sea, lay about a dozen other islands, scattered at various distances from half a mile to ten miles—all of which appeared to be smaller than ours and seemingly uninhabited. They looked like low coral islands, only slightly above the water, yet covered with coconut trees.
All this we noted, and a great deal more, while we sat on the top of the mountain. After we had satisfied ourselves we prepared to return; but here, again, we discovered traces of the presence of man. These were a pole or staff, and one or two pieces of wood which had been squared with an axe. All of these were, however, very much decayed, and they had evidently not been touched for many years.
All this we observed, and much more, while sitting at the top of the mountain. After we felt satisfied, we got ready to head back; but again, we found signs of human presence. There was a pole or staff, and one or two pieces of wood that had been cut with an axe. However, all of these were quite rotted, and it was clear they hadn't been touched in many years.
Full of these discoveries, we returned to our encampment. On the way we fell in with the traces of some four-footed animal, but whether old or of recent date none of us were able to guess. This also tended to raise our hopes of obtaining some animal food on the island; so we reached home in good spirits, quite prepared for supper, and highly satisfied with our excursion.
Full of these discoveries, we made our way back to our campsite. On the way, we came across the tracks of a four-legged animal, but none of us could tell if they were old or new. This also boosted our hopes of finding some food on the island; so we returned in good spirits, ready for dinner, and very pleased with our adventure.
After much discussion, in which Peterkin took the lead, we came to the conclusion that the island was uninhabited, and went to bed.
After a lot of discussion, with Peterkin leading the conversation, we concluded that the island was uninhabited and went to bed.
Chapter Seven.
Jack’s ingenuity—We get into difficulties about fishing, and get out of them by a method which gives us a cold bath—Horrible encounter with a shark.
For several days after the excursion related in the last chapter we did not wander far from our encampment, but gave ourselves up to forming plans for the future and making our present abode comfortable.
For several days after the trip described in the last chapter, we didn't venture far from our camp, but focused on making plans for the future and getting our current place comfortable.
There were various causes that induced this state of comparative inaction. In the first place, although everything around us was so delightful, and we could without difficulty obtain all that we required for our bodily comfort, we did not quite like the idea of settling down here for the rest of our lives, far away from our friends and our native land. To set energetically about preparations for a permanent residence seemed so like making up our minds to saying adieu to home and friends for ever that we tacitly shrank from it, and put off our preparations, for one reason and another, as long as we could. Then there was a little uncertainty still as to there being natives on the island, and we entertained a kind of faint hope that a ship might come and take us off. But as day after day passed, and neither savages nor ships appeared, we gave up all hope of an early deliverance, and set diligently to work at our homestead.
There were several reasons that led to this state of relative inactivity. First of all, even though everything around us was so enjoyable, and we could easily get everything we needed for our physical comfort, we weren't quite keen on the idea of settling down here for the rest of our lives, far away from our friends and our homeland. Preparing for permanent residence felt too much like deciding to say goodbye to home and friends forever, so we hesitated and delayed our preparations for as long as we could. There was also a bit of uncertainty about whether there were any natives on the island, and we held onto a faint hope that a ship might come and rescue us. But as days turned into weeks with no sign of either natives or ships, we lost all hope of an early escape and got to work on our new homestead.
During this time, however, we had not been altogether idle. We made several experiments in cooking the cocoa-nut, most of which did not improve it. Then we removed our goods and took up our abode in the cave, but found the change so bad that we returned gladly to the bower. Besides this, we bathed very frequently, and talked a great deal—at least Jack and Peterkin did; I listened. Among other useful things, Jack, who was ever the most active and diligent, converted about three inches of the hoop-iron into an excellent knife. First, he beat it quite flat with the axe; then he made a rude handle, and tied the hoop-iron to it with our piece of whip-cord, and ground it to an edge on a piece of sandstone. When it was finished he used it to shape a better handle, to which he fixed it with a strip of his cotton handkerchief—in which operation he had, as Peterkin pointed out, torn off one of Lord Nelson’s noses. However, the whip-cord, thus set free, was used by Peterkin as a fishing-line. He merely tied a piece of oyster to the end of it. This the fish were allowed to swallow, and then they were pulled quickly ashore. But as the line was very short and we had no boat, the fish we caught were exceedingly small.
During this time, though, we hadn’t been completely idle. We tried several ways of cooking the coconut, most of which didn’t make it any better. Then we moved our stuff and set up in the cave, but found it so uncomfortable that we happily returned to the bower. Besides that, we bathed a lot and talked quite a bit—at least Jack and Peterkin did; I just listened. Among other useful things, Jack, who was always the most active and diligent, turned about three inches of the hoop iron into a great knife. First, he flattened it with the axe; then he made a rough handle and tied the hoop iron to it with our piece of whip cord, and sharpened it on a piece of sandstone. When it was done, he used it to shape a better handle, which he attached with a strip of his cotton handkerchief—in this process, he accidentally tore off one of Lord Nelson’s noses, as Peterkin pointed out. However, the whip cord, now freed up, was used by Peterkin as a fishing line. He simply tied a piece of oyster to the end of it. The fish were allowed to swallow it, and then we yanked them quickly ashore. But since the line was really short and we didn’t have a boat, the fish we caught were incredibly small.
One day Peterkin came up from the beach, where he had been angling, and said in a very cross tone, “I’ll tell you what, Jack, I’m not going to be humbugged with catching such contemptible things any longer. I want you to swim out with me on your back, and let me fish in deep water!”
One day, Peterkin came up from the beach, where he had been fishing, and said in a very annoyed tone, “I’ll tell you what, Jack, I’m not going to waste my time catching such worthless things anymore. I want you to swim out with me on your back, so I can fish in deep water!”
“Dear me, Peterkin!” replied Jack; “I had no idea you were taking the thing so much to heart, else I would have got you out of that difficulty long ago. Let me see;” and Jack looked down at a piece of timber, on which he had been labouring, with a peculiar gaze of abstraction which he always assumed when trying to invent or discover anything.
“Wow, Peterkin!” replied Jack; “I had no idea you were feeling so upset about this, or I would have helped you out of that problem a long time ago. Let me think;” and Jack glanced at a piece of wood he had been working on, with a focused look of deep thought that he always wore when he was trying to come up with an idea or figure something out.
“What say you to building a boat?” he inquired, looking up hastily.
“What do you think about building a boat?” he asked, glancing up quickly.
“Take far too long,” was the reply; “can’t be bothered waiting. I want to begin at once!”
“Taking too long,” was the response; “I can’t be bothered waiting. I want to start right now!”
Again Jack considered. “I have it!” he cried. “We’ll fell a large tree and launch the trunk of it in the water, so that when you want to fish you’ve nothing to do but to swim out to it.”
Again, Jack thought for a moment. “I’ve got it!” he exclaimed. “We’ll cut down a big tree and put its trunk in the water, so when you want to fish, all you have to do is swim out to it.”
“Would not a small raft do better?” said I.
“Wouldn’t a small raft be better?” I said.
“Much better; but we have no ropes to bind it together with. Perhaps we may find something hereafter that will do as well, but in the meantime let us try the tree.”
“Much better; but we have no ropes to tie it together with. Maybe we’ll find something later that will work just as well, but for now, let’s try the tree.”
This was agreed on; so we started off to a spot, not far distant, where we knew of a tree that would suit us which grew near the water’s edge. As soon as we reached it Jack threw off his coat, and wielding the axe with his sturdy arms, hacked and hewed at it for a quarter of an hour without stopping. Then he paused, and while he sat down to rest I continued the work. Then Peterkin made a vigorous attack on it; so that when Jack renewed his powerful blows, a few minutes’ cutting brought it down with a terrible crash.
This was agreed upon, so we set off to a nearby spot where we knew of a tree by the water's edge that would work for us. As soon as we got there, Jack took off his coat and, using his strong arms, chopped at it with the axe for about fifteen minutes without a break. Then he took a seat to rest, and I kept working on it. Peterkin then jumped in and put a lot of effort into it, so when Jack started swinging the axe again, just a few more minutes of cutting brought it down with a loud crash.
“Hurrah! Now for it!” cried Jack. “Let us off with its head!”
“Yay! Let’s do this!” shouted Jack. “Let’s take its head off!”
So saying, he began to cut through the stem again at about six yards from the thick end. This done, he cut three strong, short poles or levers from the stout branches, with which to roll the log down the beach into the sea; for, as it was nearly two feet thick at the large end, we could not move it without such helps. With the levers, however, we rolled it slowly into the sea.
So saying, he started to cut through the stem again about six yards from the thick end. Once that was done, he cut three sturdy, short poles or levers from the strong branches to help roll the log down the beach into the sea; since it was nearly two feet thick at the large end, we couldn’t move it without these tools. With the levers, we managed to roll it slowly into the sea.
Having been thus successful in launching our vessel, we next shaped the levers into rude oars or paddles, and then attempted to embark. This was easy enough to do; but after seating ourselves astride the log, it was with the utmost difficulty we kept it from rolling round and plunging us into the water. Not that we minded that much; but we preferred, if possible, to fish in dry clothes. To be sure, our trousers were necessarily wet, as our legs were dangling in the water on each side of the log; but as they could be easily dried, we did not care. After half-an-hour’s practice, we became expert enough to keep our balance pretty steadily. Then Peterkin laid down his paddle, and having baited his line with a whole oyster, dropped it into deep water.
Having successfully launched our boat, we next shaped the levers into makeshift oars or paddles and then tried to get on board. This was pretty easy to do, but once we sat straddling the log, it was extremely difficult to keep it from rolling over and throwing us into the water. Not that we cared too much; we just preferred to fish with dry clothes if we could. It was true that our pants were wet since our legs were dangling in the water on either side of the log, but since they could dry easily, we didn’t mind. After about half an hour of practice, we got good enough to keep our balance pretty steadily. Then Peterkin set down his paddle, and after baiting his line with a whole oyster, he dropped it into the deep water.
“Now, then, Jack,” said he, “be cautious; steer clear o’ that seaweed. There! that’s it; gently, now—gently. I see a fellow at least a foot long down there coming to — Ha! that’s it! Oh bother! he’s off!”
“Alright, Jack,” he said, “be careful; avoid that seaweed. There! That’s it; easy now—easy. I see a guy down there at least a foot long coming—Ha! there it is! Oh man! he’s gone!”
“Did he bite?” said Jack, urging the log onwards a little with his paddle.
“Did he bite?” Jack asked, nudging the log forward a bit with his paddle.
“Bite? Ay! he took it into his mouth, but the moment I began to haul he opened his jaws and let it out again.”
“Bite? Yeah! He took it in his mouth, but as soon as I started to pull, he opened his jaws and let it go again.”
“Let him swallow it next time,” said Jack, laughing at the melancholy expression of Peterkin’s visage.
“Let him swallow it next time,” Jack said, laughing at the sad look on Peterkin’s face.
“There he’s again!” cried Peterkin, his eyes flashing with excitement. “Look out! Now, then! No! Yes! No! Why, the brute won’t swallow it!”
“There he is again!” cried Peterkin, his eyes sparkling with excitement. “Watch out! Now, come on! No! Yes! No! Wow, the beast won’t swallow it!”
“Try to haul him up by the mouth, then!” cried Jack. “Do it gently.”
“Try to pull him up by his mouth, then!” shouted Jack. “Do it carefully.”
A heavy sigh and a look of blank despair showed that poor Peterkin had tried and failed again.
A heavy sigh and a look of blank despair showed that poor Peterkin had tried and failed yet again.
“Never mind, lad,” said Jack in a voice of sympathy; “we’ll move on and offer it to some other fish.” So saying, Jack plied his paddle; but scarcely had he moved from the spot when a fish with an enormous head and a little body darted from under a rock and swallowed the bait at once.
“Don’t worry about it, buddy,” Jack said sympathetically. “We’ll just keep going and try it with another fish.” With that, Jack started paddling. But just as he was about to leave the spot, a fish with a huge head and a tiny body shot out from under a rock and gobbled up the bait immediately.
“Got him this time—that’s a fact!” cried Peterkin, hauling in the line. “He’s swallowed the bait right down to his tail, I declare! Oh, what a thumper!”
“Got him this time—that’s for sure!” shouted Peterkin, pulling in the line. “He’s gulped down the bait all the way to his tail, I swear! Oh, what a big one!”
As the fish came struggling to the surface we leaned forward to see it, and overbalanced the log. Peterkin threw his arms round the fish’s neck, and in another instant we were all floundering in the water!
As the fish came struggling to the surface, we leaned forward to get a better look and lost our balance on the log. Peterkin wrapped his arms around the fish's neck, and in the next moment, we were all splashing in the water!
A shout of laughter burst from us as we rose to the surface, like three drowned rats, and seized hold of the log. We soon recovered our position, and sat more warily; while Peterkin secured the fish, which had well-nigh escaped in the midst of our struggles. It was little worth having, however. But, as Peterkin remarked, it was better than the smouts he had been catching for the last two or three days; so we laid it on the log before us, and having re-baited the line, dropped it in again for another.
A shout of laughter erupted from us as we surfaced, looking like three drowned rats, and grabbed the log. We quickly regained our position and sat more cautiously, while Peterkin secured the fish that had nearly escaped during our struggles. It wasn’t much, though. But as Peterkin pointed out, it was better than the small fish he had been catching for the past couple of days; so we placed it on the log in front of us, and after re-baiting the line, dropped it back in for another catch.
Now, while we were thus intent upon our sport, our attention was suddenly attracted by a ripple on the sea, just a few yards away from us. Peterkin shouted to us to paddle in that direction, as he thought it was a big fish and we might have a chance of catching it. But Jack, instead of complying, said, in a deep, earnest tone of voice, which I never before heard him use, “Haul up your line, Peterkin; seize your paddle. Quick—it’s a shark!”
Now, while we were focused on our fun, something suddenly caught our attention—a ripple on the sea, just a few yards away. Peterkin yelled for us to paddle over there, thinking it was a big fish and that we might have a shot at catching it. But Jack, instead of following his suggestion, replied in a serious tone I had never heard from him before, “Reel in your line, Peterkin; grab your paddle. Hurry—it’s a shark!”
The horror with which we heard this may well be imagined; for it must be remembered that our legs were hanging down in the water, and we could not venture to pull them up without upsetting the log. Peterkin instantly hauled up the line, and grasping his paddle, exerted himself to the utmost, while we also did our best to make for shore. But we were a good way off, and the log being, as I have before said, very heavy, moved but slowly through the water. We now saw the shark quite distinctly swimming round and round us, its sharp fin every now and then protruding above the water. From its active and unsteady motions, Jack knew it was making up its mind to attack us; so he urged us vehemently to paddle for our lives, while he himself set us the example. Suddenly he shouted, “Look out! there he comes!” and in a second we saw the monstrous fish dive close under us and turn half-over on his side. But we all made a great commotion with our paddles, which, no doubt, frightened it away for that time, as we saw it immediately after circling round us as before.
The panic we felt when we heard this was intense; we had to remember our legs were dangling in the water, and pulling them up might tip the log over. Peterkin quickly pulled in the line and grabbed his paddle, pushing himself to the limit, while we did our best to paddle toward shore too. However, we were quite far away, and the log, as I mentioned earlier, was very heavy and moved slowly through the water. We could now see the shark clearly swimming around us, its sharp fin occasionally breaking the surface. From its quick and erratic movements, Jack realized it was getting ready to attack, so he urged us strongly to paddle for our lives while he led by example. Suddenly, he yelled, “Watch out! Here it comes!” and in an instant, we saw the huge fish dive right beneath us and roll onto its side. But we all created a huge splash with our paddles, which likely scared it off for the moment, as we then saw it circling us again just like before.
“Throw the fish to him!” cried Jack in a quick, suppressed voice; “we’ll make the shore in time yet if we can keep him off for a few minutes.”
“Throw the fish to him!” Jack shouted in a quick, hushed voice; “we’ll make it to shore in time if we can keep him off for a few more minutes.”
Peterkin stopped one instant to obey the command, and then plied his paddle again with all his might. No sooner had the fish fallen on the water than we observed the shark to sink. In another second we saw its white breast rising; for sharks always turn over on their sides when about to seize their prey, their mouths being not at the point of their heads like those of other fish, but, as it were, under their chins. In another moment his snout rose above the water; his wide jaws, armed with a terrific double row of teeth, appeared; the dead fish was engulfed, and the shark sank out of sight. But Jack was mistaken in supposing that it would be satisfied. In a very few minutes it returned to us, and its quick motions led us to fear that it would attack us at once.
Peterkin paused for just a moment to follow the command, then paddled with all his strength again. As soon as the fish hit the water, we noticed the shark disappearing. A second later, we saw its white belly surface; sharks always roll onto their sides before going after their prey, since their mouths aren’t at the front of their heads like other fish, but somewhat underneath. Moments later, its snout broke the surface; its wide jaws, filled with a terrifying double row of teeth, came into view; the dead fish was swallowed whole, and the shark disappeared from sight. But Jack was wrong to think it would be satisfied. Just a few minutes later, it came back to us, and its rapid movements made us worry that it would attack right away.
“Stop paddling!” cried Jack suddenly. “I see it coming up behind us. Now, obey my orders quickly. Our lives may depend on it. Ralph—Peterkin—do your best to balance the log. Don’t look out for the shark. Don’t glance behind you. Do nothing but balance the log.”
“Stop paddling!” Jack shouted suddenly. “I see it coming up behind us. Now, follow my orders quickly. Our lives might depend on it. Ralph—Peterkin—do your best to balance the log. Don’t look for the shark. Don’t glance back. Just focus on balancing the log.”
Peterkin and I instantly did as we were ordered, being only too glad to do anything that afforded us a chance or a hope of escape, for we had implicit confidence in Jack’s courage and wisdom. For a few seconds, that seemed long minutes to my mind, we sat thus silently; but I could not resist glancing backward, despite the orders to the contrary. On doing so, I saw Jack sitting rigid like a statue, with his paddle raised, his lips compressed, and his eyebrows bent over his eyes, which glared savagely from beneath them down into the water.
Peterkin and I immediately followed the instructions, grateful for any chance we had to escape, as we fully trusted Jack’s bravery and intelligence. For a few seconds, which felt like long minutes to me, we sat there quietly; but I couldn’t help but look back, even though we’d been told not to. When I did, I saw Jack sitting there like a statue, his paddle raised, lips pressed together, and his eyebrows furrowed over his eyes, which were glaring fiercely at the water beneath them.
I also saw the shark, to my horror, quite close under the log, in the act of darting towards Jack’s foot. I could scarce suppress a cry on beholding this. In another moment the shark rose. Jack drew his leg suddenly from the water and threw it over the log. The monster’s snout rubbed against the log as it passed, and revealed its hideous jaws, into which Jack instantly plunged the paddle and thrust it down its throat. So violent was this act that Jack rose to his feet in performing it; the log was thereby rolled completely over, and we were once more plunged into the water. We all rose, spluttering and gasping, in a moment.
I was horrified to see the shark close under the log, about to lunge at Jack’s foot. I could barely hold back a scream at the sight. In an instant, the shark surfaced. Jack quickly pulled his leg out of the water and threw it over the log. The shark’s snout brushed against the log as it passed, exposing its terrifying jaws, and Jack immediately shoved the paddle into its mouth and forced it down its throat. The force of this action made Jack stand up, causing the log to roll completely over, and we were thrown back into the water. We all surfaced, spluttering and gasping, in no time.
“Now, then, strike out for shore!” cried Jack.—“Here, Peterkin, catch hold of my collar, and kick out with a will!”
“Alright, let’s head for shore!” yelled Jack. “Here, Peterkin, grab my collar and kick hard!”
Peterkin did as he was desired, and Jack struck out with such force that he cut through the water like a boat; while I, being free from all encumbrance, succeeded in keeping up with him. As we had by this time drawn pretty near to the shore, a few minutes more sufficed to carry us into shallow water; and finally, we landed in safety, though very much exhausted, and not a little frightened, by our terrible adventure.
Peterkin did what he was told, and Jack paddled with such power that he sliced through the water like a boat; while I, being free of any extra weight, managed to keep up with him. As we had gotten pretty close to the shore by this point, just a few more minutes brought us into shallow water; and in the end, we landed safely, though we were very tired and quite scared by our frightening experience.
Chapter Eight.
The beauties of the bottom of the sea tempt Peterkin to dive—How he did it—More difficulties overcome—The water garden—Curious creatures of the sea—The tank—Candles missed very much, and the candle-nut tree discovered—Wonderful account of Peterkin’s first voyage—Cloth found growing on a tree—A plan projected, and arms prepared for offence and defence—A dreadful cry.
Our encounter with the shark was the first great danger that had befallen us since landing on this island; and we felt very seriously affected by it, especially when we considered that we had so often unwittingly incurred the same danger before while bathing. We were now forced to take to fishing again in the shallow water until we should succeed in constructing a raft. What troubled us most, however, was that we were compelled to forego our morning swimming-excursions. We did, indeed, continue to enjoy our bathe in the shallow water; but Jack and I found that one great source of our enjoyment was gone when we could no longer dive down among the beautiful coral groves at the bottom of the lagoon. We had come to be so fond of this exercise, and to take such an interest in watching the formations of coral and the gambols of the many beautiful fish amongst the forest of red and green seaweeds, that we had become quite familiar with the appearance of the fish and the localities that they chiefly haunted. We had also become expert divers. But we made it a rule never to stay long under water at a time. Jack told me that to do so often was bad for the lungs, and instead of affording us enjoyment, would ere long do us a serious injury. So we never stayed at the bottom as long as we might have done, but came up frequently to the top for fresh air, and dived down again immediately. Sometimes, when Jack happened to be in a humorous frame, he would seat himself at the bottom of the sea on one of the brain-corals, as if he were seated on a large paddock-stool, and then make faces at me in order, if possible, to make me laugh under water. At first, when he took me unawares, he nearly succeeded, and I had to shoot to the surface in order to laugh; but afterwards I became aware of his intentions, and being naturally of a grave disposition, I had no difficulty in restraining myself. I used often to wonder how poor Peterkin would have liked to be with us; and he sometimes expressed much regret at being unable to join us. I used to do my best to gratify him, poor fellow, by relating all the wonders that we saw; but this, instead of satisfying, seemed only to whet his curiosity the more, so one day we prevailed on him to try to go down with us. But although a brave boy in every other way, Peterkin was very nervous in the water; and it was with difficulty we got him to consent to be taken down, for he could never have managed to push himself down to the bottom without assistance. But no sooner had we pulled him down a yard or so into the deep, clear water than he began to struggle and kick violently; so we were forced to let him go, when he rose out of the water like a cork, gave a loud gasp and a frightful roar, and struck out for the land with the utmost possible haste.
Our encounter with the shark was the first significant danger we faced since landing on this island, and it really hit us hard, especially when we realized how often we had unknowingly risked the same situation before while swimming. We now had to go back to fishing in the shallow water until we could build a raft. What bothered us most, though, was that we had to give up our morning swims. We still enjoyed our time bathing in the shallow water, but Jack and I found that a big part of our fun was gone since we could no longer dive among the beautiful coral reefs at the bottom of the lagoon. We had grown so fond of this activity, taking a keen interest in the coral formations and the playful fish among the red and green seaweeds, that we got pretty familiar with the fish and the areas they usually occupied. We had also become skilled divers. But we made it a rule not to stay underwater for too long. Jack told me that doing so frequently was bad for our lungs, and instead of being fun, it could end up harming us. So we never lingered at the bottom longer than we needed to, surfacing often for fresh air before diving back down. Sometimes, when Jack was in a playful mood, he would sit on one of the brain corals at the sea floor, as if he were on a big stool, and then make faces at me in hopes of making me laugh underwater. At first, when he surprised me, he almost succeeded, and I had to shoot up to the surface to laugh. But eventually, I caught on to his game, and being naturally serious, I found it easy to keep a straight face. I often wondered how much Peterkin would have enjoyed being with us, and he sometimes expressed regret at not being able to join in. I tried to make it up to him by sharing all the amazing things we saw, but instead of satisfying him, it just made his curiosity grow, so one day we convinced him to try going down with us. But even though Peterkin was brave in every other way, he was very anxious in the water, and it took some effort to get him to agree to be taken down since he wouldn't have been able to push himself down without help. However, as soon as we pulled him a couple of yards into the deep, clear water, he started to struggle and kick violently, so we had to let him go. He shot up to the surface like a cork, gasping loudly and let out a terrifying roar, then swam for shore as fast as he could.
Now all this pleasure we were to forego, and when we thought thereon, Jack and I felt very much depressed in our spirits. I could see, also, that Peterkin grieved and sympathised with us; for, when talking about this matter, he refrained from jesting and bantering us upon it.
Now all this joy we were about to miss out on made Jack and me feel really down. I could also tell that Peterkin was sad and felt for us; when we talked about it, he held back from joking and teasing us about it.
As, however, a man’s difficulties usually set him upon devising methods to overcome them, whereby he often discovers better things than those he may have lost, so this our difficulty induced us to think of searching for a large pool among the rocks, where the water should be deep enough for diving, yet so surrounded by rocks as to prevent sharks from getting at us. And such a pool we afterwards found, which proved to be very much better than our most sanguine hopes anticipated. It was situated not more than ten minutes’ walk from our camp, and was in the form of a small, deep bay or basin, the entrance to which, besides being narrow, was so shallow that no fish so large as a shark could get in—at least, not unless he should be a remarkably thin one.
As a man's challenges often push him to come up with ways to overcome them, leading him to discover even better things than what he may have lost, our difficulty motivated us to look for a large pool among the rocks, where the water would be deep enough for diving but surrounded by rocks to keep sharks away. We eventually found such a pool, which turned out to be much better than we had hoped. It was located no more than a ten-minute walk from our camp and was shaped like a small, deep bay or basin. The entrance was not only narrow but also so shallow that no fish as large as a shark could enter—unless it happened to be an unusually thin one.
Inside of this basin, which we called our Water Garden, the coral formations were much more wonderful, and the seaweed plants far more lovely and vividly coloured, than in the lagoon itself. And the water was so clear and still that, although very deep, you could see the minutest object at the bottom. Besides this, there was a ledge of rock which overhung the basin at its deepest part, from which we could dive pleasantly, and whereon Peterkin could sit and see not only all the wonders I had described to him, but also see Jack and me creeping amongst the marine shrubbery at the bottom, like—as he expressed it—“two great white sea-monsters.” During these excursions of ours to the bottom of the sea we began to get an insight into the manners and customs of its inhabitants, and to make discoveries of wonderful things, the like of which we never before conceived. Among other things, we were deeply interested with the operations of the little coral insect, which, I was informed by Jack, is supposed to have entirely constructed many of the numerous islands in the Pacific Ocean. And certainly, when we considered the great reef which these insects had formed round the island on which we were cast, and observed their ceaseless activity in building their myriad cells, it did at first seem as if this might be true; but then, again, when I looked at the mountains of the island, and reflected that there were thousands of such (many of them much higher) in the South Seas, I doubted that there must be some mistake here. But more of this hereafter.
Inside this basin, which we called our Water Garden, the coral formations were much more spectacular, and the seaweed plants were far more beautiful and colorful than in the lagoon itself. The water was so clear and calm that, even though it was very deep, you could see the tiniest objects at the bottom. Additionally, there was a ledge of rock that hung over the basin at its deepest point, from which we could dive joyfully, and where Peterkin could sit and see not only all the wonders I had described to him but also watch Jack and me exploring the marine plants at the bottom, like— as he put it— “two big white sea monsters.” During these dives to the ocean floor, we began to learn about the habits and customs of its residents and discover amazing things we had never imagined before. Among other things, we were fascinated by the activities of the tiny coral insect, which Jack informed me is believed to have created many of the numerous islands in the Pacific Ocean. And certainly, when we thought about the massive reef these insects had built around the island where we had ended up and observed their tireless work constructing countless cells, it initially seemed like this could be true. However, when I looked at the mountains of the island and considered that there were thousands of similar ones (many of them much taller) in the South Seas, I started to doubt that there could be some mistake here. But more on this later.
I also became much taken up with the manners and appearance of the anemones, and starfish, and crabs, and sea-urchins, and such-like creatures; and was not content with watching those I saw during my dives in the Water Garden, but I must needs scoop out a hole in the coral rock close to it, which I filled with salt water, and stocked with sundry specimens of anemones and shell-fish, in order to watch more closely how they were in the habit of passing their time. Our burning-glass, also, now became a great treasure to me, as it enabled me to magnify, and so to perceive more clearly, the forms and actions of these curious creatures of the deep.
I also became really interested in the behavior and appearance of anemones, starfish, crabs, sea urchins, and similar creatures. I wasn’t satisfied just watching them during my dives in the Water Garden; I felt the need to dig a hole in the coral rock nearby, which I filled with salt water and stocked with various anemones and shellfish to observe how they spent their time more closely. Our magnifying glass also became really valuable to me, as it allowed me to enlarge and better see the shapes and actions of these fascinating deep-sea creatures.
Having now got ourselves into a very comfortable condition, we began to talk of a project which we had long had in contemplation—namely, to travel entirely round the island, in order, first, to ascertain whether it contained any other productions which might be useful to us; and, second, to see whether there might be any place more convenient and suitable for our permanent residence than that on which we were now encamped. Not that we were in any degree dissatisfied with it. On the contrary, we entertained quite a home-feeling to our bower and its neighbourhood; but if a better place did exist, there was no reason why we should not make use of it. At any rate, it would be well to know of its existence.
Having settled into a comfortable situation, we started discussing a project we had been thinking about for a while—specifically, to travel all the way around the island. Our goals were twofold: first, to find out if there were any other resources that could be useful to us, and second, to see if there might be a more convenient and suitable location for our permanent home than where we were currently set up. Not that we were unhappy with our current spot. On the contrary, we felt a strong sense of home in our shelter and its surroundings. But if a better location was out there, we had no reason not to explore it. At the very least, it would be good to know if it existed.
We had much earnest talk over this matter. But Jack proposed that, before undertaking such an excursion, we should supply ourselves with good defensive arms; for, as we intended not only to go round all the shore, but to descend most of the valleys, before returning home, we should be likely to meet in with—he would not say dangers—but at least with everything that existed on the island, whatever that might be.
We had a serious discussion about this. But Jack suggested that, before going on such a trip, we should get some good defensive gear. Since we planned to explore the entire coastline and travel down most of the valleys before heading home, we were likely to encounter—he wouldn’t call them dangers—but at least everything that was on the island, whatever that might be.
“Besides,” said Jack, “it won’t do for us to live on cocoa-nuts and oysters always. No doubt they are very excellent in their way, but I think a little animal food now and then would be agreeable as well as good for us; and as there are many small birds among the trees, some of which are probably very good to eat, I think it would be a capital plan to make bows and arrows, with which we could easily knock them over.”
“Besides,” said Jack, “we can't just live on coconuts and oysters all the time. Sure, they’re great in their own way, but I think having some meat occasionally would be nice and good for us too; and since there are a lot of small birds in the trees, some of which are probably pretty tasty, I think it would be a smart idea to make bows and arrows so we can easily hunt them.”
“First-rate!” cried Peterkin. “You will make the bows, Jack, and I’ll try my hand at the arrows. The fact is, I’m quite tired of throwing stones at the birds. I began the very day we landed, I think, and have persevered up to the present time, but I’ve never hit anything yet.”
“Awesome!” shouted Peterkin. “You can make the bows, Jack, and I’ll give the arrows a shot. Honestly, I’m pretty tired of throwing stones at the birds. I think I started that on the very day we arrived and have kept at it ever since, but I’ve never managed to hit anything yet.”
“You forget,” said I, “you hit me one day on the shin.”
“You forget,” I said, “you kicked me on the shin one day.”
“Ah, true!” replied Peterkin; “and a precious shindy you kicked up in consequence. But you were at least four yards away from the impudent paroquet I aimed at, so you see what a horribly bad shot I am.”
“Ah, true!” replied Peterkin; “and you caused quite a fuss because of it. But you were at least four yards away from the cheeky parrot I was aiming at, so you can see how terrible my aim is.”
“But, Jack,” said I, “you cannot make three bows and arrows before to-morrow; and would it not be a pity to waste time, now that we have made up our minds to go on this expedition?—Suppose that you make one bow and arrow for yourself, and we can take our clubs?”
“But, Jack,” I said, “you can’t make three bows and arrows before tomorrow; and wouldn’t it be a shame to waste time now that we’ve decided to go on this expedition?—How about you make one bow and arrow for yourself, and we can bring our clubs?”
“That’s true, Ralph. The day is pretty far advanced, and I doubt if I can make even one bow before dark. To be sure, I might work by firelight after the sun goes down.”
"That's right, Ralph. It's getting pretty late in the day, and I don't think I can make even one bow before it gets dark. I could work by firelight after the sun sets, though."
We had, up to this time, been in the habit of going to bed with the sun, as we had no pressing call to work o’ nights; and, indeed, our work during the day was usually hard enough—what between fishing, and improving our bower, and diving in the Water Garden, and rambling in the woods—so that when night came we were usually very glad to retire to our beds. But now that we had a desire to work at night, we felt a wish for candles.
We had, until now, been in the habit of going to bed with the sun since we had no urgent reason to work at night; and honestly, our work during the day was usually tough—what with fishing, improving our shelter, diving in the Water Garden, and wandering in the woods—so by nighttime, we were usually very ready to crawl into bed. But now that we wanted to work at night, we found ourselves wanting candles.
“Won’t a good blazing fire give you light enough?” inquired Peterkin.
“Won’t a good fire give you enough light?” Peterkin asked.
“Yes,” replied Jack, “quite enough; but then it will give us a great deal more than enough of heat in this warm climate of ours.”
“Yeah,” Jack replied, “that’s definitely enough; but it will give us way more heat than we need in this warm climate of ours.”
“True,” said Peterkin; “I forgot that. It would roast us.”
“True,” said Peterkin; “I totally forgot about that. It would cook us.”
“Well, as you’re always doing that at any rate,” remarked Jack, “we could scarcely call it a change. But the fact is, I’ve been thinking over this subject before. There is a certain nut growing in these islands which is called the candle-nut, because the natives use it instead of candles; and I know all about it, and how to prepare it for burning—”
“Well, since you always do that anyway,” Jack said, “we can hardly call it a change. But the truth is, I’ve been thinking about this before. There’s a certain nut found in these islands called the candle-nut, because the locals use it like candles; and I know all about it and how to get it ready for burning—”
“Then why don’t you do it?” interrupted Peterkin. “Why have you kept us in the dark so long, you vile philosopher?”
“Then why don’t you just do it?” interrupted Peterkin. “Why have you kept us in the dark for so long, you vile philosopher?”
“Because,” said Jack, “I have not seen the tree yet, and I’m not sure that I should know either the tree or the nuts if I did see them. You see, I forget the description.”
“Because,” said Jack, “I haven’t seen the tree yet, and I’m not sure I would recognize either the tree or the nuts even if I did see them. You see, I forgot the description.”
“Ah! that’s just the way with me,” said Peterkin with a deep sigh. “I never could keep in my mind for half-an-hour the few descriptions I ever attempted to remember. The very first voyage I ever made was caused by my mistaking a description—or forgetting it, which is the same thing. And a horrible voyage it was. I had to fight with the captain the whole way out, and made the homeward voyage by swimming!”
“Ah! that's just how I am,” Peterkin said with a deep sigh. “I could never keep in my head for even half an hour the few descriptions I ever tried to remember. The very first trip I took happened because I got a description mixed up—or forgot it, which is pretty much the same. And it was a terrible journey. I had to argue with the captain the whole way out and swam back home!”
“Come, Peterkin,” said I, “you can’t get even me to believe that.”
“Come on, Peterkin,” I said, “you can’t even get me to believe that.”
“Perhaps not, but it’s true notwithstanding,” returned Peterkin, pretending to be hurt at my doubting his word.
“Maybe not, but it’s still true regardless,” Peterkin replied, pretending to be offended that I doubted him.
“Let us hear how it happened,” said Jack, while a good-natured smile overspread his face.
“Let’s hear how it happened,” said Jack, his face breaking into a friendly smile.
“Well, you must know,” began Peterkin, “that the very day before I went to sea I was greatly taken up with a game at hockey, which I was playing with my old school-fellows for the last time before leaving them.—You see I was young then, Ralph.” Peterkin gazed, in an abstracted and melancholy manner, out to sea.—“Well, in the midst of the game, my uncle, who had taken all the bother and trouble of getting me bound ’prentice and rigged out, came and took me aside, and told me that he was called suddenly away from home, and would not be able to see me aboard, as he had intended. ‘However,’ said he, ‘the captain knows you are coming, so that’s not of much consequence; but as you’ll have to find the ship yourself, you must remember her name and description. D’ye hear, boy?’ I certainly did hear, but I’m afraid I did not understand; for my mind was so taken up with the game, which I saw my side was losing, that I began to grow impatient, and the moment my uncle finished his description of the ship and bade me good-bye I bolted back to my game, with only a confused idea of three masts, and a green-painted taffrail, and a gilt figurehead of Hercules with his club at the bow. Next day I was so much cast down with everybody saying good-bye, and a lot o’ my female friends cryin’ horribly over me, that I did not start for the harbour, where the ship was lying among a thousand others, till it was almost too late. So I had to run the whole way. When I reached the pier, there were so many masts, and so much confusion, that I felt quite humble-bumbled in my faculties. ‘Now,’ said I to myself, ‘Peterkin, you’re in a fix.’ Then I fancied I saw a gilt figurehead and three masts belonging to a ship just about to start; so I darted on board, but speedily jumped on shore again when I found that two of the masts belonged to another vessel and the figurehead to a third! At last I caught sight of what I made sure was it—a fine large vessel just casting off her moorings. The taffrail was green. Three masts—yes, that must be it—and the gilt figurehead of Hercules. To be sure, it had a three-pronged pitchfork in its hand instead of a club; but that might be my uncle’s mistake, or perhaps Hercules sometimes varied his weapons. ‘Cast off!’ roared a voice from the quarter-deck. ‘Hold on!’ cried I, rushing frantically through the crowd. ‘Hold on! hold on!’ repeated some of the bystanders, while the men at the ropes delayed for a minute. This threw the captain into a frightful rage; for some of his friends had come down to see him off, and having his orders contradicted so flatly was too much for him. However, the delay was sufficient. I took a race and a good leap; the ropes were cast off; the steam-tug gave a puff, and we started. Suddenly the captain walks up to me: ‘Where did you come from, you scamp, and what do you want here?’
“Well, you should know,” Peterkin began, “that the very day before I went to sea, I was really into a game of hockey, which I was playing with my old school friends for the last time before leaving them. You see, I was young back then, Ralph.” Peterkin gazed, in a distracted and sad way, out to sea. “Well, in the middle of the game, my uncle, who had done all the work of getting me apprenticed and outfitted, pulled me aside and told me that he had to leave home suddenly and wouldn’t be able to see me off like he had planned. ‘But,’ he said, ‘the captain knows you’re coming, so that’s not a big deal; but since you’ll need to find the ship on your own, remember her name and description. Do you hear me, boy?’ I did hear him, but I’m afraid I didn’t fully comprehend because my mind was so focused on the game, which I noticed my side was losing, that I started to feel impatient. The moment my uncle finished describing the ship and said goodbye, I dashed back to my game with only a hazy image of three masts, a green-painted taffrail, and a gilded figurehead of Hercules with his club at the bow. The next day, I felt so down with everyone saying their goodbyes and a bunch of my female friends crying terribly over me that I didn’t leave for the harbor, where the ship was among a thousand others, until it was almost too late. So, I had to run all the way there. When I reached the pier, there were so many masts and so much chaos that I felt completely overwhelmed. ‘Now,’ I thought to myself, ‘Peterkin, you’re in a tough spot.’ Then I imagined I saw a gilded figurehead and three masts belonging to a ship ready to depart, so I rushed on board, but quickly jumped back off when I realized that two of the masts belonged to another ship and the figurehead to yet another! Finally, I spotted what I was sure was it—a big ship just casting off its moorings. The taffrail was green. Three masts—yes, it had to be it—and the gilded figurehead of Hercules. Sure, it had a three-pronged pitchfork in its hand instead of a club; but maybe that was my uncle’s mistake, or perhaps Hercules changed his weapons sometimes. ‘Cast off!’ shouted a voice from the quarter-deck. ‘Wait!’ I yelled, frantically rushing through the crowd. ‘Wait! wait!’ some of the onlookers repeated, while the men at the ropes hesitated for a moment. This sent the captain into a furious rage because some of his friends had come to see him off, and having his orders contradicted so openly was too much for him. However, the delay was just enough. I took off running and jumped; the ropes were let go; the steam-tug puffed, and we were on our way. Suddenly, the captain approached me: ‘Where did you come from, you scamp, and what do you want here?’”
“‘Please, sir,’ said I, touching my cap, ‘I’m your new ’prentice come aboard.’
“‘Please, sir,’ I said, tipping my cap, ‘I’m your new apprentice who just came on board.’”
“‘New ’prentice!’ said he, stamping; ‘I’ve got no new ’prentice. My boys are all aboard already. This is a trick, you young blackguard! You’ve run away, you have!’ And the captain stamped about the deck and swore dreadfully; for, you see, the thought of having to stop the ship and lower a boat and lose half-an-hour, all for the sake of sending a small boy ashore, seemed to make him very angry. Besides, it was blowin’ fresh outside the harbour, so that to have let the steamer alongside to put me into it was no easy job. Just as we were passing the pier-head, where several boats were rowing into the harbour, the captain came up to me.
“‘New apprentice!’ he shouted, stomping his feet. ‘I don’t have any new apprentice. My crew is all on board already. This is a trick, you little brat! You’ve run away, haven’t you!’ The captain paced the deck and cursed loudly; because, you see, the idea of having to stop the ship, lower a boat, and waste half an hour just to send a small boy ashore was infuriating to him. Plus, it was pretty windy outside the harbor, so letting the steamer come alongside to drop me off was no simple task. Just as we were passing the pier-head, where several boats were rowing into the harbor, the captain approached me.
“‘You’ve run away, you blackguard!’ he said, giving me a box on the ear.
“‘You’ve run away, you scoundrel!’ he said, slapping me on the ear.
“‘No, I haven’t!’ said I angrily, for the box was by no means a light one.
“‘No, I haven’t!’ I said angrily, because the box was definitely not light."
“‘Hark’ee, boy, can you swim?’
"Hey, kid, can you swim?"
“‘Yes,’ said I.
"Yes," I said.
“‘Then do it!’ and seizing me by my trousers and the nape of my neck, he tossed me over the side into the sea. The fellows in the boats at the end of the pier backed their oars on seeing this; but observing that I could swim, they allowed me to make the best of my way to the pier-head.—So you see, Ralph, that I really did swim my first homeward voyage.”
“‘Then do it!’ and grabbing my pants and the back of my neck, he threw me over the side into the sea. The guys in the boats at the end of the pier pulled back their oars when they saw this; but noticing that I could swim, they let me make my way to the pier-head. —So you see, Ralph, I really did swim my first homeward journey.”
Jack laughed, and patted Peterkin on the shoulder.
Jack laughed and patted Peterkin on the shoulder.
“But tell us about the candle-nut tree,” said I. “You were talking about it.”
“But tell us about the candle-nut tree,” I said. “You were just talking about it.”
“Very true,” said Jack; “but I fear I can remember little about it. I believe the nut is about the size of a walnut; and I think that the leaves are white, but I am not sure.”
“That's right,” said Jack; “but I’m afraid I can’t remember much about it. I think the nut is about the size of a walnut; and I believe the leaves are white, but I’m not certain.”
“Eh! ha! hum!” exclaimed Peterkin; “I saw a tree answering to that description this very day.”
“Hey! Ha! Huh!” Peterkin exclaimed; “I saw a tree that fits that description just today.”
“Did you?” cried Jack. “Is it far from this?”
“Did you?” Jack shouted. “Is it far from here?”
“No, not half-a-mile.”
"No, not half a mile."
“Then lead me to it,” said Jack, seizing his axe.
“Then take me to it,” Jack said, grabbing his axe.
In a few minutes we were all three pushing through the underwood of the forest, headed by Peterkin.
In a few minutes, the three of us were making our way through the bushes in the forest, with Peterkin leading the way.
We soon came to the tree in question, which, after Jack had closely examined it, we concluded must be the candle-nut tree. Its leaves were of a beautiful silvery white, and formed a fine contrast to the dark-green foliage of the surrounding trees. We immediately filled our pockets with the nuts, after which Jack said:
We soon reached the tree we were talking about, which, after Jack took a closer look, we agreed had to be the candle-nut tree. Its leaves were a stunning silvery white, creating a nice contrast with the dark green foliage of the nearby trees. We quickly filled our pockets with the nuts, and then Jack said:
“Now, Peterkin, climb that cocoa-nut tree and cut me one of the long branches.”
“Now, Peterkin, climb that coconut tree and cut me one of the long branches.”
This was soon done; but it cost some trouble, for the stem was very high, and as Peterkin usually pulled nuts from the younger trees, he was not much accustomed to climbing the high ones. The leaf or branch was a very large one, and we were surprised at its size and strength. Viewed from a little distance, the cocoa-nut tree seems to be a tall, straight stem, without a single branch except at the top, where there is a tuft of feathery-looking leaves that seem to wave like soft plumes in the wind. But when we saw one of these leaves or branches at our feet, we found it to be a strong stalk, about fifteen feet long, with a number of narrow, pointed leaflets ranged alternately on each side. But what seemed to us the most wonderful thing about it was a curious substance resembling cloth, which was wrapped round the thick end of the stalk where it had been cut from the tree. Peterkin told us that he had the greatest difficulty in separating the branch from the stem on account of this substance, as it was wrapped quite round the tree, and, he observed, round all the other branches, thus forming a strong support to the large leaves while exposed to high winds. When I call this substance cloth I do not exaggerate. Indeed, with regard to all the things I saw during my eventful career in the South Seas, I have been exceedingly careful not to exaggerate, or in any way to mislead or deceive my readers. This cloth, I say, was remarkably like to coarse brown cotton cloth. It had a seam or fibre down the centre of it, from which diverged other fibres, about the size of a bristle. There were two layers of these fibres, very long and tough, the one layer crossing the other obliquely, and the whole was cemented together with a still finer fibrous and adhesive substance. When we regarded it attentively, we could with difficulty believe that it had not been woven by human hands. This remarkable piece of cloth we stripped carefully off, and found it to be above two feet long by a foot broad, and we carried it home with us as a great prize.
This was done quickly, but it took some effort because the stem was very tall, and since Peterkin usually picked nuts from younger trees, he wasn't used to climbing the high ones. The leaf or branch was quite large, and we were amazed by its size and strength. From a distance, the cocoa-nut tree looks like a tall, straight stem with no branches except at the top, where there's a bunch of feathery leaves that seem to sway like soft plumes in the wind. But when we looked at one of these leaves or branches up close, we saw it was a strong stalk about fifteen feet long, with several narrow, pointed leaflets arranged alternately on each side. What struck us as most amazing was a strange material that looked like cloth, wrapped around the thick end of the stalk where it had been cut from the tree. Peterkin mentioned that he had a hard time separating the branch from the stem because of this material, as it was wrapped tightly around the tree and, he noted, around all the other branches, providing strong support for the large leaves in high winds. When I refer to this substance as cloth, I'm not exaggerating. Throughout all my experiences in the South Seas, I've been very careful not to exaggerate or mislead my readers in any way. This cloth, I tell you, was remarkably similar to coarse brown cotton fabric. It had a seam or fiber running down the center, with other fibers branching out, about the size of a bristle. There were two layers of these strong, tough fibers, one crossing the other at an angle, and the whole was held together by a finer, fibrous, adhesive material. When we looked at it closely, we could hardly believe it hadn’t been woven by human hands. We carefully stripped this remarkable piece of cloth off and found it to be over two feet long and a foot wide, which we carried home with us as a great treasure.
Jack now took one of the leaflets, and cutting out the central spine or stalk, hurried back with it to our camp. Having made a small fire, he baked the nuts slightly and then peeled off the husks. After this he wished to bore a hole in them, which, not having anything better at hand at the time, he did with the point of our useless pencil-case. Then he strung them on the cocoa-nut spine, and on putting a light to the topmost nut we found, to our joy, that it burned with a clear, beautiful flame, upon seeing which Peterkin sprang up and danced round the fire for at least five minutes in the excess of his satisfaction.
Jack took one of the leaflets, cut out the central stalk, and rushed back to our camp with it. After making a small fire, he baked the nuts a bit and then peeled off the husks. Next, he wanted to poke a hole in them, so using the point of our useless pencil case, he did just that. Then he strung them on the coconut spine, and when he lit the top nut, we were delighted to see it burn with a clear, beautiful flame. At this, Peterkin jumped up and danced around the fire for at least five minutes in pure joy.
“Now, lads,” said Jack, extinguishing our candle, “the sun will set in an hour, so we have no time to lose. I shall go and cut a young tree to make my bow out of, and you had better each of you go and select good strong sticks for clubs, and we’ll set to work at them after dark.”
“Alright, guys,” said Jack, blowing out our candle, “the sun will set in an hour, so we can't waste any time. I'm going to cut down a young tree to make my bow, and each of you should find some sturdy sticks for clubs, and we’ll get started on them after dark.”
So saying, he shouldered his axe and went off; followed by Peterkin; while I took up the piece of newly discovered cloth, and fell to examining its structure. So engrossed was I in this that I was still sitting in the same attitude and occupation when my companions returned.
So saying, he shouldered his axe and left, followed by Peterkin, while I picked up the newly discovered piece of cloth and started examining its structure. I was so absorbed in this that I was still sitting in the same position and doing the same thing when my companions returned.
“I told you so!” cried Peterkin with a loud laugh.—“Oh Ralph, you’re incorrigible! See, there’s a club for you. I was sure, when we left you looking at that bit of stuff, that we would find you poring over it when we came back, so I just cut a club for you as well as for myself.”
“I told you so!” laughed Peterkin loudly. “Oh Ralph, you can’t help yourself! Look, I made you a club. I knew that when we left you looking at that piece of stuff, we’d find you studying it when we returned, so I just made a club for you as well as for me.”
“Thank you, Peterkin,” said I. “It was kind of you to do that instead of scolding me for a lazy fellow, as I confess I deserve.”
“Thanks, Peterkin,” I said. “It was nice of you to do that instead of lecturing me for being lazy, which I admit I deserve.”
“Oh, as to that,” returned Peterkin, “I’ll blow you up yet if you wish it; only it would be of no use if I did, for you’re a perfect mule!”
“Oh, about that,” Peterkin replied, “I’ll definitely blow you up if you want; but it wouldn’t help at all because you’re just being stubborn!”
As it was now getting dark we lighted our candle, and placing it in a holder made of two crossing branches inside of our bower, we seated ourselves on our leafy beds and began to work.
As it was getting dark, we lit our candle and put it in a holder made of two crossed branches inside our shelter. We sat down on our leafy beds and started to work.
“I intend to appropriate the bow for my own use,” said Jack, chipping the piece of wood he had brought with his axe. “I used to be a pretty fair shot once.—But what’s that you’re doing?” he added, looking at Peterkin, who had drawn the end of a long pole into the tent, and was endeavouring to fit a small piece of the hoop-iron to the end of it.
“I plan to use the bow for myself,” said Jack, carving the piece of wood he had brought with his axe. “I used to be a decent shot back in the day.—But what are you doing?” he added, looking at Peterkin, who had pulled a long pole into the tent and was trying to attach a small piece of hoop-iron to the end of it.
“I’m going to enlist into the Lancers,” answered Peterkin. “You see, Jack, I find the club rather an unwieldy instrument for my delicately formed muscles, and I flatter myself I shall do more execution with a spear.”
“I’m going to join the Lancers,” replied Peterkin. “You see, Jack, I think the club is a bit too clumsy for my finely shaped muscles, and I believe I will perform better with a spear.”
“Well, if length constitutes power,” said Jack, “you’ll certainly be invincible.”
“Well, if being long means you have power,” Jack said, “then you’re definitely unstoppable.”
The pole which Peterkin had cut was full twelve feet long, being a very strong but light and tough young tree, which merely required thinning at the butt to be a serviceable weapon.
The pole that Peterkin cut was a full twelve feet long, made from a strong yet lightweight young tree that just needed to be trimmed at the bottom to be a useful tool.
“That’s a very good idea,” said I.
"That's a really good idea," I said.
“Which—this?” inquired Peterkin, pointing to the spear.
“Which—this?” Peterkin asked, pointing to the spear.
“Yes,” I replied.
“Yes,” I said.
“Humph!” said he; “you’d find it a pretty tough and matter-of-fact idea if you had it stuck through your gizzard, old boy!”
“Humph!” he said. “You’d find it a pretty tough and straightforward idea if it was stuck right in your stomach, buddy!”
“I mean the idea of making it is a good one,” said I, laughing. “And, now I think of it, I’ll change my plan too. I don’t think much of a club, so I’ll make me a sling out of this piece of cloth. I used to be very fond of slinging, ever since I read of David slaying Goliath the Philistine, and I was once thought to be expert at it.”
“I mean the idea of doing it is a good one,” I said, laughing. “And now that I think about it, I’ll change my plan too. I don’t think much of a club, so I’ll make a sling out of this piece of cloth. I used to really enjoy slinging ever since I read about David defeating Goliath the Philistine, and I was once considered pretty good at it.”
So I set to work to manufacture a sling. For a long time we all worked very busily without speaking. At length Peterkin looked up. “I say, Jack, I’m sorry to say I must apply to you for another strip of your handkerchief to tie on this rascally head with. It’s pretty well torn at any rate, so you won’t miss it.”
So I started working on making a sling. For a long time, we all busily worked without saying a word. Finally, Peterkin looked up. “Hey, Jack, I’m afraid I need to ask you for another piece of your handkerchief to tie on this troublesome head. It's pretty much ripped anyway, so you won’t miss it.”
Jack proceeded to comply with this request, when Peterkin suddenly laid his hand on his arm and arrested him.
Jack started to fulfill this request when Peterkin suddenly grabbed his arm and stopped him.
“Hist, man!” said he; “be tender! You should never be needlessly cruel if you can help it. Do try to shave past Lord Nelson’s mouth without tearing it, if possible! Thanks. There are plenty more handkerchiefs on the cocoa-nut trees.”
“Listen, man!” he said; “be gentle! You shouldn’t be unnecessarily cruel if you can avoid it. Try to shave around Lord Nelson’s mouth without cutting it, if you can! Thanks. There are plenty more handkerchiefs on the coconut trees.”
Poor Peterkin! with what pleasant feelings I recall and record his jests and humorous sayings now!
Poor Peterkin! I happily remember and write down his jokes and funny remarks now!
While we were thus engaged we were startled by a distant, but most strange and horrible, cry. It seemed to come from the sea, but was so far away that we could not clearly distinguish its precise direction. Rushing out of our bower, we hastened down to the beach and stayed to listen. Again it came, quite loud and distinct on the night air—a prolonged, hideous cry, something like the braying of an ass. The moon had risen, and we could see the islands in and beyond the lagoon quite plainly; but there was no object visible to account for such a cry. A strong gust of wind was blowing from the point whence the sound came, but this died away while we were gazing out to sea.
While we were busy with our activities, we were suddenly startled by a distant, yet very strange and horrifying, scream. It seemed to come from the sea, but it was so far away that we couldn't clearly tell where it was coming from. We rushed out of our shelter and hurried down to the beach to listen. Again it came, loud and clear in the night air—a long, awful cry, something like the braying of a donkey. The moon had risen, and we could see the islands in and beyond the lagoon quite clearly; but there was nothing visible to explain such a cry. A strong gust of wind was blowing from the direction where the sound came from, but it died down while we were staring out at the sea.
“What can it be?” said Peterkin in a low whisper, while we all involuntarily crept closer to each other.
“What could it be?” Peterkin said in a quiet whisper, as we all instinctively huddled closer together.
“Do you know,” said Jack, “I have heard that mysterious sound twice before, but never so loud as to-night. Indeed, it was so faint that I thought I must have merely fancied it; so, as I did not wish to alarm you, I said nothing about it.”
“Do you know,” said Jack, “I've heard that strange sound twice before, but never as loudly as tonight. Honestly, it was so faint that I thought I might have just imagined it; so, since I didn’t want to worry you, I kept quiet about it.”
We listened for a long time for the sound again; but as it did not come, we returned to the bower and resumed our work.
We listened for a long time to hear the sound again, but since it never came, we went back to the bower and went back to our work.
“Very strange!” said Peterkin quite gravely.—“Do you believe in ghosts, Ralph?”
“Really weird!” said Peterkin quite seriously. — “Do you believe in ghosts, Ralph?”
“No,” I answered, “I do not. Nevertheless, I must confess that strange, unaccountable sounds, such as we have just heard, make me feel a little uneasy.”
“No,” I replied, “I don’t. Still, I have to admit that strange, unexplainable noises, like the ones we just heard, make me feel a bit uneasy.”
“What say you to it, Jack?”
“What do you think about it, Jack?”
“I neither believe in ghosts nor feel uneasy,” he replied. “I never saw a ghost myself, and I never met with any one who had; and I have generally found that strange and unaccountable things have almost always been accounted for, and found to be quite simple, on close examination. I certainly can’t imagine what that sound is; but I’m quite sure I shall find out before long, and if it’s a ghost I’ll—I’ll—”
“I don’t believe in ghosts, and I’m not worried,” he said. “I’ve never seen a ghost myself, and I’ve never met anyone who has; and I’ve usually found that weird and unexplainable things can almost always be explained and turn out to be pretty simple upon closer look. I honestly can’t imagine what that sound is; but I’m sure I’ll figure it out soon, and if it is a ghost, I’ll—I’ll—”
“Eat it!” cried Peterkin.
“Just eat it!” shouted Peterkin.
“Yes, I’ll eat it!—Now, then, my bow and two arrows are finished; so, if you’re ready, we had better turn in.”
“Yes, I’ll eat it!—Now, my bow and two arrows are done; so, if you’re ready, we should get some sleep.”
By this time Peterkin had thinned down his spear, and tied an iron point very cleverly to the end of it; I had formed a sling, the lines of which were composed of thin strips of the cocoa-nut cloth, plaited; and Jack had made a stout bow, nearly five feet long, with two arrows, feathered with two or three large plumes which some bird had dropped. They had no barbs; but Jack said that if arrows were well feathered they did not require iron points, but would fly quite well if merely sharpened at the point, which I did not know before.
By this time, Peterkin had sharpened his spear and cleverly attached an iron tip to the end. I had made a sling from thin strips of coconut cloth that I braided together, and Jack had crafted a sturdy bow, about five feet long, with two arrows that had feathers from some bird’s dropped plumage. They didn’t have barbs, but Jack mentioned that well-feathered arrows didn't need iron tips and would fly just fine if they were sharpened at the tip, something I hadn’t known before.
“A feathered arrow without a barb,” said he, “is a good weapon, but a barbed arrow without feathers is utterly useless.”
“A feathered arrow without a tip,” he said, “is a good weapon, but a tipped arrow without feathers is completely worthless.”
The string of the bow was formed of our piece of whip-cord, part of which, as he did not like to cut it, was rolled round the bow.
The bowstring was made from our piece of whip-cord, part of which he didn’t want to cut, so it was wrapped around the bow.
Although thus prepared for a start on the morrow we thought it wise to exercise ourselves a little in the use of our weapons before starting, so we spent the whole of the next day in practising. And it was well we did so, for we found that our arms were very imperfect, and that we were far from perfect in the use of them. First, Jack found that the bow was much too strong, and he had to thin it. Also the spear was much too heavy, and so had to be reduced in thickness, although nothing would induce Peterkin to have it shortened. My sling answered very well; but I had fallen so much out of practice that my first stone knocked off Peterkin’s hat, and narrowly missed making a second Goliath of him. However, after having spent the whole day in diligent practice, we began to find some of our former expertness returning, at least Jack and I did. As for Peterkin, being naturally a neat-handed boy, he soon handled his spear well, and could run full tilt at a cocoa-nut, and hit it with great precision once out of every five times.
Although we were prepared to set off the next day, we thought it would be smart to practice with our weapons for a bit first, so we spent the entire next day training. It was a good decision because we discovered our weapons were not very effective, and we weren't skilled in using them. First, Jack realized that the bow was far too strong, and he had to thin it out. The spear was also too heavy, so he had to lessen its thickness, although nothing could persuade Peterkin to have it shortened. My sling worked pretty well; however, I had fallen out of practice so much that my first stone knocked off Peterkin’s hat and just barely missed turning him into a second Goliath. Nonetheless, after a whole day of serious practice, Jack and I started to regain some of our former skills. As for Peterkin, being naturally good with his hands, he quickly got the hang of handling his spear and could charge full speed at a coconut and hit it accurately about once out of every five tries.
But I feel satisfied that we owed much of our rapid success to the unflagging energy of Jack, who insisted that since we had made him captain, we should obey him; and he kept us at work from morning till night, perseveringly, at the same thing. Peterkin wished very much to run about and stick his spear into everything he passed; but Jack put up a cocoa-nut, and would not let him leave off running at that for a moment except when he wanted to rest. We laughed at Jack for this, but we were both convinced that it did us much good.
But I’m glad that we owe a lot of our quick success to Jack’s endless energy. He insisted that since we made him captain, we had to follow his lead, and he kept us working non-stop from morning until night on the same task. Peterkin really wanted to run around and poke his spear into everything he saw, but Jack set up a coconut and wouldn’t let him stop chasing that for a second, except when he needed a break. We teased Jack for this, but we both knew it was actually really helpful.
That night we examined and repaired our arms ere we lay down to rest, although we were much fatigued, in order that we might be in readiness to set out on our expedition at daylight on the following morning.
That night we checked and fixed our weapons before we went to sleep, even though we were very tired, so that we would be ready to start our mission at dawn the next morning.
Chapter Nine.
Prepare for a journey round the island—Sagacious reflections—Mysterious appearances and startling occurrences.
Scarcely had the sun shot its first ray across the bosom of the broad Pacific when Jack sprang to his feet, and hallooing in Peterkin’s ear to awaken him, ran down the beach to take his customary dip in the sea. We did not, as was our wont, bathe that morning in our Water Garden, but in order to save time, refreshed ourselves in the shallow water just opposite the bower. Our breakfast was also despatched without loss of time, and in less than an hour afterwards all our preparations for the journey were completed.
Scarcely had the sun sent its first ray across the expanse of the wide Pacific when Jack jumped to his feet, shouting in Peterkin’s ear to wake him up, and ran down the beach to take his usual swim in the sea. Instead of bathing in our Water Garden like we usually did, we decided to save time and refreshed ourselves in the shallow water right in front of the bower. We also finished our breakfast quickly, and in less than an hour, all our preparations for the journey were done.
In addition to his ordinary dress, Jack tied a belt of cocoa-nut cloth round his waist, into which he thrust the axe. I was also advised to put on a belt and carry a short cudgel or bludgeon in it, for, as Jack truly remarked, the sling would be of little use if we should chance to come to close quarters with any wild animal. As for Peterkin, notwithstanding that he carried such a long and, I must add, frightful-looking spear over his shoulder, we could not prevail on him to leave his club behind; “for,” said he, “a spear at close quarters is not worth a button.” I must say that it seemed to me that the club was, to use his own style of language, not worth a button-hole; for it was all knotted over at the head, something like the club which I remember to have observed in picture-books of Jack the Giant-killer, besides being so heavy that he required to grasp it with both hands in order to wield it at all. However, he took it with him, and in this manner we set out upon our travels.
In addition to his regular clothes, Jack tied a belt made of coconut fabric around his waist, into which he slid the axe. I was also advised to wear a belt and carry a short club or bludgeon in it, because, as Jack rightly pointed out, the sling wouldn’t be very useful if we ended up in close quarters with any wild animal. As for Peterkin, even though he had a long and, I must say, scary-looking spear over his shoulder, we couldn’t convince him to leave his club behind; “because,” he said, “a spear at close range isn’t worth anything.” I have to admit that I thought the club was, to use his own words, not worth a buttonhole; it was all knotted at the head, similar to the clubs I remember from picture books of Jack the Giant-killer, and it was so heavy that he had to grip it with both hands just to use it. Nevertheless, he took it with him, and this was how we set out on our journey.
We did not consider it necessary to carry any food with us, as we knew that wherever we went we should be certain to fall in with cocoa-nut trees—having which we were amply supplied, as Peterkin said, with meat and drink and pocket-handkerchiefs! I took the precaution, however, to put the burning-glass into my pocket lest we should want fire.
We didn’t think it was necessary to bring any food with us since we knew that wherever we went, we’d definitely come across coconut trees. As Peterkin mentioned, these provided us with plenty of food and drinks, and even handkerchiefs! Still, I made sure to grab the burning glass just in case we needed to make a fire.
The morning was exceedingly lovely. It was one of that very still and peaceful sort which made the few noises that we heard seem to be quiet noises (I know no other way of expressing this idea)—noises which, so far from interrupting the universal tranquillity of earth, sea, and sky, rather tended to reveal to us how quiet the world round us really was. Such sounds as I refer to were the peculiar, melancholy—yet, it seemed to me, cheerful—plaint of sea-birds floating on the glassy waters or sailing in the sky; also the subdued twittering of little birds among the bushes, the faint ripples on the beach, and the solemn boom of the surf upon the distant coral reef. We felt very glad in our hearts as we walked along the sands, side by side. For my part, I felt so deeply overjoyed that I was surprised at my own sensations, and fell into a reverie upon the causes of happiness. I came to the conclusion that a state of profound peace and repose, both in regard to outward objects and within the soul, is the happiest condition in which man can be placed; for although I had many a time been most joyful and happy when engaged in bustling, energetic, active pursuits or amusements, I never found that such joy or satisfaction was so deep or so pleasant to reflect upon as that which I now experienced. And I was the more confirmed in this opinion when I observed—and, indeed, as told by himself—that Peterkin’s happiness was also very great; yet he did not express this by dancing, as was his wont, nor did he give so much as a single shout, but walked quietly between us with his eye sparkling and a joyful smile upon his countenance. My reader must not suppose that I thought all this in the clear and methodical manner in which I have set it down here. These thoughts did indeed pass through my mind; but they did so in a very confused and indefinite manner, for I was young at that time and not much given to deep reflections. Neither did I consider that the peace whereof I write is not to be found in this world—at least in its perfection—although I have since learned that, by religion, a man may attain to a very great degree of it.
The morning was incredibly beautiful. It was one of those calm and peaceful mornings where the few sounds we heard felt like quiet sounds (I can't think of a better way to put it)—sounds that, instead of disturbing the overall tranquility of the earth, sea, and sky, actually highlighted just how peaceful the world around us was. The sounds I’m talking about were the unique, sad—yet, to me, uplifting—calls of sea-birds floating on the smooth waters or gliding through the sky; as well as the soft chirping of little birds in the bushes, the gentle lapping of waves on the shore, and the deep rumble of the surf crashing against the distant coral reef. We felt very happy in our hearts as we strolled along the beach side by side. Personally, I felt so overwhelmed with joy that I was taken aback by my own feelings, and I drifted into a daydream about the reasons for happiness. I concluded that a state of deep peace and stillness, both in relation to the outside world and within one’s soul, is the happiest condition a person can find themselves in; because even though I had often felt most joyful and happy when engaged in busy, energetic activities or fun, I never found that kind of happiness as profound or as pleasant to think back on as what I was experiencing now. My conviction grew stronger when I noticed—and, in fact, as Peterkin himself said—that he was also very happy; yet he wasn’t dancing, as he normally would, and didn’t let out a single shout, but walked quietly between us with his eyes sparkling and a joyful smile on his face. My reader shouldn’t assume that I considered all of this in the clear and organized way I’ve written it down here. These thoughts did pass through my mind, but they did so in a very muddled and vague way, as I was young at the time and not particularly prone to deep thought. I also didn’t realize that the peace I’m describing isn’t something to be found in this world—at least not in its fullest form—although I’ve since learned that through religion, one can achieve a significant level of it.
I have said that Peterkin walked along the sands between us. We had two ways of walking together about our island. When we travelled through the woods we always did so in single file, as by this method we advanced with greater facility, the one treading in the other’s footsteps. In such cases Jack always took the lead, Peterkin followed, and I brought up the rear. But when we travelled along the sands, which extended almost in an unbroken line of glistening white round the island, we marched abreast, as we found this method more sociable and every way more pleasant. Jack, being the tallest, walked next the sea, and Peterkin marched between us, as by this arrangement either of us could talk to him or he to us, while if Jack and I happened to wish to converse together we could conveniently do so over Peterkin’s head. Peterkin used to say, in reference to this arrangement, that had he been as tall as either of us, our order of march might have been the same; for, as Jack often used to scold him for letting everything we said to him pass in at one ear and out at the other, his head could, of course, form no interruption to our discourse.
I mentioned that Peterkin walked along the beach between us. We had two ways of walking together around our island. When we went through the woods, we always lined up in single file, as this way allowed us to move more easily, with each person stepping in the other's footsteps. In those situations, Jack always led, Peterkin followed, and I brought up the back. But when we walked along the beach, which stretched almost endlessly in a shiny white line around the island, we walked side by side, as we found this more social and enjoyable. Jack, being the tallest, walked closest to the sea, and Peterkin marched between us, so either of us could talk to him, or he could talk to us, while if Jack and I wanted to chat together, we could easily do so over Peterkin’s head. Peterkin used to joke that if he had been as tall as either of us, our walking arrangement would have been the same; because Jack often teased him for letting everything we said go in one ear and out the other, his head obviously didn’t get in the way of our conversation.
We were now fairly started. Half-a-mile’s walk conveyed us round a bend in the land which shut out our bower from view, and for some time we advanced at a brisk pace without speaking, though our eyes were not idle, but noted everything—in the woods, on the shore, or in the sea—that was interesting. After passing the ridge of land that formed one side of our valley—the Valley of the Wreck—we beheld another small vale lying before us in all the luxuriant loveliness of tropical vegetation. We had indeed seen it before from the mountain-top, but we had no idea that it would turn out to be so much more lovely when we were close to it. We were about to commence the exploration of this valley when Peterkin stopped us, and directed our attention to a very remarkable appearance in advance along the shore.
We were now on our way. After a half-mile walk, we rounded a bend that hid our spot from view, and for a while, we moved quickly without talking, though we were observing everything around us—in the woods, on the beach, or in the sea—that caught our attention. After passing the ridge that bordered our valley—the Valley of the Wreck—we saw another small valley ahead, bursting with the rich beauty of tropical plants. We had seen it from the mountaintop before, but we had no idea it would be even more stunning up close. Just as we were about to explore this valley, Peterkin stopped us and pointed out a striking sight along the shore ahead.
“What’s yon, think you?” said he, levelling his spear as if he expected an immediate attack from the object in question, though it was full half-a-mile distant.
“What’s that over there, do you think?” he said, aiming his spear as if he anticipated an immediate threat from the object, even though it was a good half a mile away.
As he spoke, there appeared a white column above the rocks, as if of steam or spray. It rose upwards to a height of several feet, and then disappeared. Had this been near the sea, we would not have been so greatly surprised, as it might in that case have been the surf, for at this part of the coast the coral reef approached so near to the island that in some parts it almost joined it. There was, therefore, no lagoon between, and the heavy surf of the ocean beat almost up to the rocks. But this white column appeared about fifty yards inland. The rocks at the place were rugged, and they stretched across the sandy beach into the sea. Scarce had we ceased expressing our surprise at this sight when another column flew upwards for a few seconds, not far from the spot where the first had been seen, and disappeared; and so, at long, irregular intervals, these strange sights recurred. We were now quite sure that the columns were watery, or composed of spray; but what caused them we could not guess, so we determined to go and see.
As he spoke, a white column appeared above the rocks, almost like steam or spray. It rose several feet into the air and then vanished. If we had been near the ocean, we wouldn't have been as surprised, since it could have been the surf; at this part of the coast, the coral reef was so close to the island that in some areas it nearly connected. There was no lagoon in between, and the heavy surf from the ocean crashed almost right up to the rocks. However, this white column appeared about fifty yards inland. The rocks at this spot were rugged, stretching across the sandy beach into the sea. Just as we finished expressing our surprise, another column shot upwards for a few seconds, not far from where the first one had appeared, and then disappeared; and so, at long, irregular intervals, these strange sights continued. We were now quite sure that the columns were made of water or spray, but we couldn't figure out what was causing them, so we decided to go check it out.
In a few minutes we gained the spot, which was very rugged and precipitous, and, moreover, quite damp with the falling of the spray. We had much ado to pass over dry-shod. The ground, also, was full of holes here and there. Now, while we stood anxiously waiting for the reappearance of these waterspouts, we heard a low, rumbling sound near us, which quickly increased to a gurgling and hissing noise, and a moment afterwards a thick spout of water burst upwards from a hole in the rock and spouted into the air with much violence, and so close to where Jack and I were standing that it nearly touched us. We sprang aside, but not before a cloud of spray descended and drenched us both to the skin.
In a few minutes, we reached the spot, which was very rugged and steep, and also quite damp from the spray coming down. We had a hard time crossing without getting wet. The ground was also full of holes here and there. Just as we stood there anxiously waiting for the waterspouts to reappear, we heard a low, rumbling sound nearby, which quickly turned into a gurgling and hissing noise. Moments later, a thick jet of water shot up from a hole in the rock and sprayed into the air with great force, so close to where Jack and I were standing that it almost hit us. We jumped aside, but not before a spray cloud descended and soaked us both completely.
Peterkin, who was standing farther off; escaped with a few drops, and burst into an uncontrollable fit of laughter on beholding our miserable plight.
Peterkin, who was standing further away, got away with just a few drops and erupted into an uncontrollable fit of laughter when he saw our miserable situation.
“Mind your eye!” he shouted eagerly; “there goes another!” The words were scarcely out of his mouth when there came up a spout from another hole, which served us exactly in the same manner as before.
“Watch out!” he shouted excitedly; “there goes another one!” The words had hardly left his lips when another spout erupted from a different hole, providing us with the same experience as before.
Peterkin now shrieked with laughter; but his merriment was abruptly put a stop to by the gurgling noise occurring close to where he stood.
Peterkin now burst out laughing; but his amusement was suddenly interrupted by a gurgling sound coming from near where he stood.
“Where’ll it spout this time, I wonder?” he said, looking about with some anxiety and preparing to run. Suddenly there came a loud hiss or snort; a fierce spout of water burst up between Peterkin’s legs, blew him off his feet, enveloped him in its spray, and hurled him to the ground. He fell with so much violence that we feared he must have broken some of his bones, and ran anxiously to his assistance; but fortunately he had fallen on a clump of tangled herbage, in which he lay sprawling in a most deplorable condition.
“Where’s it going to spout this time, I wonder?” he said, looking around anxiously and getting ready to run. Suddenly, there was a loud hiss or snort; a powerful blast of water shot up between Peterkin’s legs, knocked him off his feet, drenched him in its spray, and slammed him to the ground. He fell so hard that we worried he might have broken a bone, and we rushed over to help him; but luckily, he had fallen into a patch of tangled grass, where he lay sprawled in a rather unfortunate state.
It was now our turn to laugh; but as we were not yet quite sure that he was unhurt, and as we knew not when or where the next spout might arise, we assisted him hastily to jump up and hurry from the spot.
It was our turn to laugh, but since we weren't completely sure he was okay, and because we didn't know when or where the next splash might come from, we quickly helped him get up and move away from the area.
I may here add that, although I am quite certain that the spout of water was very strong, and that it blew Peterkin completely off his legs, I am not quite certain of the exact height to which it lifted him, being somewhat startled by the event, and blinded partially by the spray, so that my power of observation was somewhat impaired for the moment.
I should mention that, even though I’m sure the stream of water was really powerful and knocked Peterkin off his feet, I can't say for sure how high it lifted him. I was a bit shocked by what happened and partially blinded by the spray, which made it hard for me to focus for a moment.
“What’s to be done now?” asked Peterkin ruefully.
“What should we do now?” Peterkin asked sadly.
“Make a fire, lad, and dry ourselves,” replied Jack.
“Build a fire, kid, and let's dry off,” replied Jack.
“And here is material ready to our hand,” said I, picking up a dried branch of a tree as we hurried up to the woods.
“And here’s some material we can use,” I said, grabbing a dried branch as we rushed into the woods.
In about an hour after this mishap our clothes were again dried. While they were hanging up before the fire we walked down to the beach, and soon observed that these curious spouts took place immediately after the fall of a huge wave, never before it; and, moreover, that the spouts did not take place excepting when the billow was an extremely large one. From this we concluded that there must be a subterraneous channel in the rock into which the water was driven by the larger waves, and finding no way of escape except through these small holes, was thus forced up violently through them. At any rate, we could not conceive any other reason for these strange waterspouts, and as this seemed a very simple and probable one, we forthwith adopted it.
In about an hour after this incident, our clothes were dry again. While they were hanging by the fire, we walked down to the beach and quickly noticed that these strange spouts appeared right after a huge wave crashed, never before it; and, additionally, the spouts only occurred when the wave was exceptionally large. From this, we figured there must be an underground channel in the rock where the water was pushed by the larger waves, and since there was no other way out except through these small holes, it was forced up violently through them. In any case, we couldn’t think of any other explanation for these unusual waterspouts, and since this seemed like a straightforward and likely one, we decided to go with it.
“I say, Ralph, what’s that in the water? Is it a shark?” said Jack just as we were about to quit the place.
“I say, Ralph, what’s that in the water? Is it a shark?” Jack asked just as we were about to leave.
I immediately ran to the overhanging ledge of rock, from which he was looking down into the sea, and bent over it. There I saw a very faint, pale object of a greenish colour, which seemed to move slightly while I looked at it.
I quickly ran to the overhanging rock ledge where he was looking down at the sea and leaned over it. There, I saw a faint, pale object with a greenish tint that seemed to shift a little while I was watching it.
“It’s like a fish of some sort,” said I.
“It’s like some kind of fish,” I said.
“Hallo, Peterkin!” cried Jack. “Fetch your spear; here’s work for it!”
“Hey, Peterkin!” shouted Jack. “Grab your spear; we’ve got some work to do!”
But when we tried to reach the object, the spear proved to be too short.
But when we tried to grab the object, the spear turned out to be too short.
“There, now,” said Peterkin with a sneer; “you were always telling me it was too long.”
“There, now,” said Peterkin with a smirk; “you were always saying it was too long.”
Jack now drove the spear forcibly towards the object, and let go his hold. But although it seemed to be well aimed, he must have missed, for the handle soon rose again; and when the spear was drawn up, there was the pale-green object in exactly the same spot, slowly moving its tail.
Jack now thrust the spear forcefully at the object and released his grip. But even though it looked like a good shot, he must have missed because the handle quickly lifted again; when the spear was pulled back, the pale-green object was in the exact same spot, slowly moving its tail.
“Very odd!” said Jack.
“Super weird!” said Jack.
But although it was undoubtedly very odd, and although Jack and all of us plunged the spear at it repeatedly, we could neither hit it nor drive it away, so we were compelled to continue our journey without discovering what it was. I was very much perplexed at this strange appearance in the water, and could not get it out of my mind for a long time afterwards. However, I quieted myself by resolving that I would pay a visit to it again at some more convenient season.
But even though it was definitely very strange, and even though Jack and all of us kept thrusting the spear at it over and over, we couldn’t hit it or scare it away, so we had to keep going without figuring out what it was. I was really puzzled by this bizarre sight in the water and couldn’t stop thinking about it for a long time after. However, I calmed myself down by deciding that I would come back to it at a better time.
Chapter Ten.
Make discovery of many excellent roots and fruits—The resources of the coral island gradually unfolded—The banyan tree—Another tree which is supported by natural planks—Water-fowl found—A very remarkable discovery, and a very peculiar murder—We luxuriate on the fat of the land.
Our examination of the little valley proved to be altogether most satisfactory. We found in it not only similar trees to those we had already seen in our own valley, but also one or two others of a different species. We had also the satisfaction of discovering a peculiar vegetable, which, Jack concluded, must certainly be that of which he had read as being very common among the South Sea Islanders, and which was named taro. Also we found a large supply of yams, and another root like a potato in appearance. As these were all quite new to us, we regarded our lot as a most fortunate one, in being thus cast on an island which was so prolific and so well stored with all the necessaries of life. Long afterwards we found out that this island of ours was no better in these respects than thousands of other islands in those seas. Indeed, many of them were much richer and more productive; but that did not render us the less grateful for our present good fortune. We each put one of these roots in our pocket, intending to use them for our supper—of which more hereafter. We also saw many beautiful birds here, and traces of some four-footed animal again. Meanwhile the sun began to descend; so we returned to the shore and pushed on, round the spouting rocks, into the next valley. This was that valley of which I have spoken as running across the entire island. It was by far the largest and most beautiful that we had yet looked upon. Here were trees of every shape and size and hue which it is possible to conceive of, many of which we had not seen in the other valleys; for, the stream in this valley being larger, and the mould much richer than in the Valley of the Wreck, it was clothed with a more luxuriant growth of trees and plants. Some trees were dark, glossy green; others of a rich and warm hue, contrasting well with those of a pale, light green, which were everywhere abundant. Among these we recognised the broad, dark heads of the bread-fruit, with its golden fruit; the pure, silvery foliage of the candle-nut, and several species which bore a strong resemblance to the pine; while here and there, in groups and in single trees, rose the tall forms of the cocoa-nut palms, spreading abroad, and waving their graceful plumes high above all the rest, as if they were a superior race of stately giants keeping guard over these luxuriant forests. Oh, it was a most enchanting scene! and I thanked God for having created such delightful spots for the use of man.
Our exploration of the small valley turned out to be completely satisfying. We found not only the same types of trees we’d seen in our own valley, but also a few others that were different. We were also pleased to discover a unique plant that Jack figured must be the one he read about, which was common among the South Sea Islanders, called taro. Additionally, we found a large supply of yams and another root that looked like a potato. Since all of these were new to us, we felt very lucky to have landed on an island so rich and well-stocked with all the essentials for life. Later on, we learned that our island wasn't necessarily better in these respects than thousands of other islands in those seas. In fact, many of them were much richer and more productive, but that didn’t make us any less grateful for our good fortune. We each tucked one of these roots into our pocket, planning to use them for our dinner—more on that later. We also spotted many beautiful birds and traces of a four-legged animal again. Meanwhile, the sun began to set, so we headed back to the shore and moved around the spouting rocks into the next valley. This was the valley I mentioned that crosses the entire island. It was by far the largest and most beautiful one we had seen yet. Here, there were trees of every shape, size, and color you could imagine, many of which we hadn’t seen in the other valleys. Because the stream in this valley was larger and the soil much richer than in the Valley of the Wreck, it was filled with a more lush growth of trees and plants. Some trees were dark, glossy green; others had warm, rich colors that contrasted nicely with the light green ones that were everywhere. Among these, we recognized the broad, dark heads of the breadfruit with its golden fruit, the pure, silvery leaves of the candle-nut, and several species resembling pine; while scattered throughout were tall coconut palms, spreading their graceful fronds high above everything else, almost like a superior race of stately giants guarding these lush forests. Oh, it was such a beautiful scene! And I thanked God for creating such delightful places for humanity.
Now, while we were gazing around us in silent admiration, Jack uttered an exclamation of surprise, and pointing to an object a little to one side of us, said:
Now, as we were looking around us in quiet amazement, Jack exclaimed in surprise and pointed to something slightly off to the side, saying:
“That’s a banyan tree.”
"That's a banyan tree."
“And what’s a banyan tree?” inquired Peterkin as we walked towards it.
“And what’s a banyan tree?” Peterkin asked as we walked toward it.
“A very curious one, as you shall see presently,” replied Jack. “It is called the aoa here, if I recollect rightly, and has a wonderful peculiarity about it. What an enormous one it is, to be sure!”
“A very curious one, as you’ll see shortly,” replied Jack. “It’s called the aoa here, if I remember correctly, and it has a fascinating feature about it. What a huge one it is, for sure!”
“It!” repeated Peterkin. “Why, there are dozens of banyans here! What do you mean by talking bad grammar? Is your philosophy deserting you, Jack?”
“It!” Peterkin said again. “There are tons of banyans here! What do you mean by using bad grammar? Is your philosophy letting you down, Jack?”
“There is but one tree here of this kind,” returned Jack, “as you will perceive if you will examine it.” And, sure enough, we did find that what we had supposed was a forest of trees was in reality only one. Its bark was of a light colour, and had a shining appearance, the leaves being lance-shaped, small, and of a beautiful pea-green. But the wonderful thing about it was that the branches, which grew out from the stem horizontally, sent down long shoots or fibres to the ground, which, taking root, had themselves become trees, and were covered with bark like the tree itself. Many of these fibres had descended from the branches at various distances, and thus supported them on natural pillars, some of which were so large and strong that it was not easy at first to distinguish the offspring from the parent stem. The fibres were of all sizes and in all states of advancement, from the pillars we have just mentioned to small cords which hung down and were about to take root, and thin brown threads still far from the ground, which swayed about with every motion of wind. In short, it seemed to us that, if there were only space afforded to it, this single tree would at length cover the whole island.
“There’s only one tree like this here,” Jack said, “and you’ll see it if you take a closer look.” And sure enough, we discovered that what we thought was a forest of trees was actually just one. Its bark was a light color with a shiny look, and the leaves were small, lance-shaped, and a lovely pea-green. But what was truly amazing was that the branches spread out horizontally from the trunk and dropped long shoots or fibers to the ground, which took root and turned into trees themselves, also covered in bark like the original tree. Many of these fibers had descended from the branches at different distances, effectively supporting them on natural pillars, some of which were so large and sturdy that it was initially hard to tell the young trees from the parent trunk. The fibers varied in size and stage of growth, ranging from the strong pillars we mentioned to small cords hanging down that were about to take root, and thin brown threads still far from the ground, swaying with every gust of wind. In short, it looked to us like, if given enough space, this single tree would eventually cover the entire island.
Shortly after this we came upon another remarkable tree, which, as its peculiar formation afterwards proved extremely useful to us, merits description. It was a splendid chestnut, but its proper name Jack did not know. However, there were quantities of fine nuts upon it, some of which we put in our pockets. But its stem was the most wonderful part of it. It rose to about twelve feet without a branch, and was not of great thickness; on the contrary, it was remarkably slender for the size of the tree. But to make up for this, there were four or five wonderful projections in this stem, which I cannot better describe than by asking the reader to suppose that five planks of two inches thick and three feet broad had been placed round the trunk of the tree, with their edges closely fixed to it, from the ground up to the branches, and that these planks had been covered over with the bark of the tree and incorporated with it. In short, they were just natural buttresses, without which the stem could not have supported its heavy and umbrageous top. We found these chestnuts to be very numerous. They grew chiefly on the banks of the stream, and were of all sizes.
Shortly after this, we encountered another remarkable tree that proved to be extremely useful to us later on. It was a magnificent chestnut, but Jack didn't know its proper name. Nonetheless, there were plenty of beautiful nuts on it, some of which we pocketed. The most fascinating part was its trunk. It rose about twelve feet without any branches and wasn't very thick; in fact, it was surprisingly slender for a tree of its size. To compensate for this, there were four or five impressive projections on the trunk. The best way to describe them is to imagine five planks, two inches thick and three feet wide, placed around the trunk, with their edges tightly fixed to it from the ground up to the branches, and then covered with bark and blended into the tree. In short, they were natural buttresses, and without them, the trunk couldn't have supported its heavy and leafy top. We found these chestnut trees to be quite numerous. They mainly grew along the stream banks and came in all sizes.
While we were examining a small tree of this kind Jack chipped a piece off a buttress with his axe, and found the wood to be firm and easily cut. He then struck the axe into it with all his force, and very soon split it off close to the tree—first, however, having cut it across transversely above and below. By this means he satisfied himself that we could now obtain short planks, as it were all ready sawn, of any size and thickness that we desired, which was a very great discovery indeed—perhaps the most important we had yet made.
While we were looking at a small tree like this, Jack chopped a piece off a buttress with his axe and found the wood to be solid and easy to cut. He then swung the axe into it with all his strength, and before long, he split it off close to the tree—after cutting it across above and below. This showed us that we could now get short planks, as if they were already cut, in any size and thickness we wanted, which was a huge discovery—possibly the most important one we had made so far.
We now wended our way back to the coast, intending to encamp near the beach, as we found that the mosquitoes were troublesome in the forest. On our way we could not help admiring the birds which flew and chirped around us. Among them we observed a pretty kind of paroquet, with a green body, a blue head, and a red breast; also a few beautiful turtle-doves, and several flocks of wood-pigeons. The hues of many of these birds were extremely vivid—bright green, blue, and scarlet being the prevailing tints. We made several attempts throughout the day to bring down one of these, both with the bow and the sling—not for mere sport, but to ascertain whether they were good for food. But we invariably missed, although once or twice we were very near hitting. As evening drew on however, a flock of pigeons flew past. I slung a stone into the midst of them at a venture, and had the good fortune to kill one. We were startled soon after by a loud whistling noise above our heads, and on looking up, saw a flock of wild ducks making for the coast. We watched these, and observing where they alighted, followed them up until we came upon a most lovely blue lake, not more than two hundred yards long, embosomed in verdant trees. Its placid surface, which reflected every leaf and stem as if in a mirror, was covered with various species of wild ducks, feeding among the sedges and broad-leaved water-plants which floated on it, while numerous birds like water-hens ran to and fro most busily on its margin. These all, with one accord, flew tumultuously away the instant we made our appearance. While walking along the margin we observed fish in the water, but of what sort we could not tell.
We made our way back to the coast, planning to set up camp near the beach since the mosquitoes were a nuisance in the forest. On the way, we couldn't help but admire the birds flying and chirping around us. Among them, we spotted a beautiful type of parakeet with a green body, a blue head, and a red breast; we also saw a few stunning turtle doves and several flocks of wood pigeons. The colors of many of these birds were incredibly vivid—bright green, blue, and scarlet were the dominant shades. Throughout the day, we tried several times to catch one of them, using both a bow and a sling—not just for fun, but to see if they were good to eat. However, we always missed, even though we came close a couple of times. As evening approached, a flock of pigeons flew by. I took a shot at them with a stone and thankfully managed to hit one. Soon after, we were startled by a loud whistling sound above us, and when we looked up, we saw a flock of wild ducks heading for the coast. We followed them to where they landed and discovered a lovely blue lake, about two hundred yards long, nestled among lush trees. Its calm surface reflected every leaf and stem like a mirror and was filled with various species of wild ducks feeding among the sedges and broad-leaved water plants floating on it, while numerous birds similar to water hens busily moved along the shore. They all took off in a chaotic flight as soon as we showed up. While walking along the edge, we noticed fish in the water, but we couldn't tell what kind they were.
Now, as we neared the shore, Jack and I said we would go a little out of our way to see if we could procure one of those ducks; so, directing Peterkin to go straight to the shore and kindle a fire, we separated, promising to rejoin him speedily. But we did not find the ducks, although we made a diligent search for half-an-hour. We were about to retrace our steps when we were arrested by one of the strangest sights that we had yet beheld.
Now, as we got closer to the shore, Jack and I decided to go a bit off course to see if we could catch one of those ducks. We told Peterkin to head straight to the shore and start a fire while we split up, promising to meet him back quickly. However, we couldn’t find the ducks, even after searching hard for half an hour. Just as we were about to head back, we were stopped in our tracks by one of the weirdest sights we had seen so far.
Just in front of us, at the distance of about ten yards, grew a superb tree, which certainly was the largest we had yet seen on the island. Its trunk was at least five feet in diameter, with a smooth, grey bark; above this the spreading branches were clothed with light-green leaves, amid which were clusters of bright-yellow fruit, so numerous as to weigh down the boughs with their great weight. This fruit seemed to be of the plum species, of an oblong form, and a good deal larger than the magnum bonum plum. The ground at the foot of this tree was thickly strewn with the fallen fruit, in the midst of which lay sleeping, in every possible attitude, at least twenty hogs of all ages and sizes, apparently quite surfeited with a recent banquet.
Just ahead of us, about ten yards away, stood a magnificent tree, definitely the biggest one we had seen on the island. Its trunk was at least five feet wide, with smooth, gray bark; above that, the wide branches were covered in light-green leaves, among which clusters of bright-yellow fruit hung so heavily that they weighed down the branches. This fruit looked like plums, elongated in shape, and much larger than the magnum bonum plum. The ground beneath this tree was littered with fallen fruit, and sprawled out in every possible position were at least twenty pigs of various ages and sizes, seemingly stuffed from their recent feast.
Jack and I could scarce restrain our laughter as we gazed at these coarse, fat, ill-looking animals while they lay groaning and snoring heavily amid the remains of their supper.
Jack and I could hardly hold back our laughter as we looked at these rough, overweight, unappealing creatures lying there groaning and snoring loudly among the leftovers of their dinner.
“Now, Ralph,” said Jack in a low whisper, “put a stone in your sling—a good big one—and let fly at that fat fellow with his back toward you. I’ll try to put an arrow into yon little pig.”
“Now, Ralph,” Jack said in a quiet whisper, “grab a stone for your sling—a nice big one—and aim it at that fat guy with his back to you. I’ll see if I can hit that little pig with an arrow.”
“Don’t you think we had better put them up first?” I whispered. “It seems cruel to kill them while asleep.”
“Don’t you think we should deal with them first?” I whispered. “It feels cruel to kill them while they're asleep.”
“If I wanted sport, Ralph, I would certainly set them up; but as we only want pork, we’ll let them lie. Besides, we’re not sure of killing them; so, fire away.”
“If I wanted sport, Ralph, I would definitely go after them; but since we only want pork, we’ll leave them be. Besides, we’re not sure we can actually kill them; so, go ahead.”
Thus admonished, I slung my stone with so good aim that it went bang against the hog’s flank as if against the head of a drum; but it had no other effect than that of causing the animal to start to its feet, with a frightful yell of surprise, and scamper away. At the same instant Jack’s bow twanged, and the arrow pinned the little pig to the ground by the ear.
Thus warned, I threw my stone with such precision that it hit the hog's side like a drumbeat; however, the only result was that the animal jumped up with a terrifying yell of surprise and ran off. At the same moment, Jack’s bow snapped, and the arrow pinned the little pig to the ground by its ear.
“I’ve missed, after all!” cried Jack, darting forward with uplifted axe; while the little pig uttered a loud squeal, tore the arrow from the ground, and ran away with it, along with the whole drove, into the bushes and disappeared, though we heard them screaming long afterwards in the distance.
“I’ve missed after all!” Jack shouted, rushing forward with his axe raised; meanwhile, the little pig let out a loud squeal, grabbed the arrow from the ground, and ran off with the entire herd into the bushes, where they vanished, though we could still hear them screaming in the distance for a long time afterwards.
“That’s very provoking, now,” said Jack, rubbing the point of his nose.
"That's really provoking now," Jack said, rubbing the tip of his nose.
“Very,” I replied, stroking my chin.
“Definitely,” I replied, stroking my chin.
“Well, we must make haste and rejoin Peterkin,” said Jack; “it’s getting late.” And without further remark, we threaded our way quickly through the woods towards the shore.
“Well, we need to hurry and catch up with Peterkin,” said Jack; “it’s getting late.” And without saying anything more, we made our way quickly through the woods toward the shore.
When we reached it we found wood laid out, the fire lighted and beginning to kindle up, with other signs of preparation for our encampment; but Peterkin was nowhere to be found. We wondered very much at this; but Jack suggested that he might have gone to fetch water, so he gave a shout to let him know that we had arrived, and sat down upon a rock, while I threw off my jacket and seized the axe, intending to split up one or two billets of wood. But I had scarce moved from the spot when, in the distance, we heard a most appalling shriek, which was followed up by a chorus of yells from the hogs, and a loud hurrah.
When we got there, we found wood stacked up, the fire lit and starting to blaze, along with other signs of getting ready for our campsite; but Peterkin was nowhere to be seen. We were really puzzled by this; but Jack suggested that he might have gone to get water, so he shouted to let him know we had arrived and sat down on a rock, while I took off my jacket and grabbed the axe, planning to split one or two pieces of wood. But I had barely moved when, in the distance, we heard a horrifying scream, followed by a chorus of yells from the pigs, and a loud cheer.
“I do believe,” said I, “that Peterkin has met with the hogs.”
“I really think,” I said, “that Peterkin has come across the pigs.”
“When Greek meets Greek,” said Jack, soliloquising, “then comes the tug of—”
“When Greek meets Greek,” said Jack, thinking aloud, “then comes the tug of—”
“Hurrah!” shouted Peterkin in the distance.
“Yay!” shouted Peterkin from a distance.
We turned hastily towards the direction whence the sound came, and soon descried Peterkin walking along the beach towards us with a little pig transfixed on the end of his long spear!
We quickly turned in the direction the sound came from and soon spotted Peterkin walking along the beach toward us with a small pig speared on the end of his long spear!
“Well done, my boy!” exclaimed Jack, slapping him on the shoulder when he came up. “You’re the best shot amongst us.”
“Great job, buddy!” Jack said, giving him a pat on the shoulder when he arrived. “You’re the best shooter out of all of us.”
“Look here, Jack!” cried Peterkin as he disengaged the animal from his spear. “Do you recognise that hole?” said he, pointing to the pig’s ear; “and are you familiar with this arrow, eh?”
“Hey, Jack!” shouted Peterkin as he pulled the animal off his spear. “Do you see that hole?” he asked, pointing to the pig’s ear. “And do you recognize this arrow, huh?”
“Well, I declare!” said Jack.
“Well, I swear!” said Jack.
“Of course you do,” interrupted Peterkin; “but, pray, restrain your declarations at this time, and let’s have supper—for I’m uncommonly hungry, I can tell you. And it’s no joke to charge a whole herd of swine with their great-grandmother bristling like a giant porcupine, at the head of them!”
“Of course you do,” interrupted Peterkin; “but please hold off on your speeches for now and let’s have supper—because I’m really hungry, I can tell you. And it’s no joke to have a whole herd of pigs with their great-grandmother, who looks like a giant porcupine, leading them!”
We now set about preparing supper; and, truly, a good display of viands we made when all was laid out on a flat rock in the light of the blazing fire. There was, first of all, the little pig; then there were the taro-root, and the yam, and the potato, and six plums; and lastly, the wood-pigeon. To these Peterkin added a bit of sugar-cane, which he had cut from a little patch of that plant which he had found not long after separating from us; “and,” said he, “the patch was somewhat in a square form, which convinces me it must have been planted by man.”
We got started on making dinner, and honestly, it looked great when we laid everything out on a flat rock in front of the bright fire. First, there was the little pig; then we had the taro root, yam, potato, and six plums; and finally, the wood pigeon. Peterkin added a piece of sugar cane, which he had cut from a small patch he found shortly after parting from us. “And,” he said, “the patch was somewhat square-shaped, which makes me think it must have been planted by someone.”
“Very likely,” replied Jack. “From all we have seen, I’m inclined to think that some of the savages must have dwelt here long ago.”
“Very likely,” replied Jack. “Based on everything we’ve seen, I’m starting to think that some of the natives must have lived here a long time ago.”
We found no small difficulty in making up our minds how we were to cook the pig. None of us had ever cut up one before, and we did not know exactly how to begin; besides, we had nothing but the axe to do it with, our knife having been forgotten. At last Jack started up and said:
We ran into quite a challenge deciding how to cook the pig. None of us had ever butchered one before, and we weren't sure where to start; plus, all we had was the axe since we forgot the knife. Finally, Jack jumped up and said:
“Don’t let us waste more time talking about it, boys.—Hold it up, Peterkin. There, lay the hind leg on this block of wood—so;” and he cut it off; with a large portion of the haunch, at a single blow of the axe. “Now the other—that’s it.” And having thus cut off the two hind legs, he made several deep gashes in them, thrust a sharp-pointed stick through each, and stuck them up before the blaze to roast. The wood-pigeon was then split open, quite flat, washed clean in salt water, and treated in a similar manner. While these were cooking we scraped a hole in the sand and ashes under the fire, into which we put our vegetables and covered them up.
“Let’s not waste any more time talking about it, guys.—Hold it up, Peterkin. There, lay the back leg on this block of wood—like that;” and he chopped it off, taking a big part of the haunch with a single strike of the axe. “Now the other—that’s right.” After cutting off the two hind legs, he made several deep cuts in them, pushed a sharp stick through each, and propped them up in front of the fire to roast. The wood-pigeon was then opened up flat, cleaned in salt water, and prepared in the same way. While these were cooking, we dug a hole in the sand and ashes beneath the fire, where we placed our vegetables and covered them up.
The taro-root was of an oval shape, about ten inches long and four or five thick. It was of a mottled-grey colour, and had a thick rind. We found it somewhat like an Irish potato, and exceedingly good. The yam was roundish, and had a rough brown skin. It was very sweet and well flavoured. The potato, we were surprised to find, was quite sweet and exceedingly palatable, as also were the plums—and, indeed, the pork and pigeon too—when we came to taste them. Altogether, this was decidedly the most luxurious supper we had enjoyed for many a day. Jack said it was out-of-sight better than we ever got on board ship; and Peterkin said he feared that if we should remain long on the island he would infallibly become a glutton or an epicure, whereat Jack remarked that he need not fear that, for he was both already! And so, having eaten our fill, not forgetting to finish off with a plum, we laid ourselves comfortably down to sleep, upon a couch of branches, under the overhanging ledge of a coral rock.
The taro root was oval-shaped, about ten inches long and four or five wide. It had a mottled gray color and a thick skin. We found it somewhat like an Irish potato and really tasty. The yam was roundish with a rough brown skin. It was very sweet and flavorful. To our surprise, the potato was quite sweet and really good, as were the plums—and honestly, the pork and pigeon too—once we tried them. Overall, this was definitely the most luxurious dinner we had enjoyed in a long time. Jack said it was way better than anything we ever had on board the ship; and Peterkin said he was worried that if we stayed on the island too long, he would definitely become a glutton or a foodie, to which Jack replied that he didn’t need to worry because he was already both! And so, having eaten our fill, not forgetting to finish off with a plum, we settled down comfortably to sleep on a couch of branches, under the overhanging ledge of a coral rock.
Chapter Eleven.
Effects of overeating, and reflections thereon—Humble advice regarding cold water—The “horrible cry” accounted for—The curious birds called penguins—Peculiarity of the cocoa-nut palm—Questions on the formation of coral islands—Mysterious footsteps—Strange discoveries and sad sights.
When we awoke on the following morning we found that the sun was already a good way above the horizon, so I came to the conclusion that a heavy supper is not conducive to early rising. Never-the-less, we felt remarkably strong and well, and much disposed to have our breakfast. First, however, we had our customary morning bathe, which refreshed us greatly.
When we woke up the next morning, we saw that the sun was already well above the horizon, so I realized that a big dinner doesn’t help with getting up early. Nevertheless, we felt really strong and good, and we were eager to have our breakfast. But first, we took our usual morning shower, which revitalized us a lot.
I have often wondered very much in after years that the inhabitants of my own dear land did not make more frequent use of this most charming element, water—I mean in the way of cold bathing. Of course, I have perceived that it is not convenient for them to go into the sea or the rivers in winter, as we used to do on the Coral Island; but then I knew from experience that a large washing-tub and a sponge do form a most pleasant substitute. The feelings of freshness, of cleanliness, of vigour, and extreme hilarity that always followed my bathes in the sea—and even, when in England, my ablutions in the wash-tub—were so delightful that I would sooner have gone without my breakfast than without my bathe in cold water. My readers will forgive me for asking whether they are in the habit of bathing thus every morning; and if they answer “No”, they will pardon me for recommending them to begin at once. Of late years, since retiring from the stirring life of adventure which I have led so long in foreign climes, I have heard of a system called the cold-water cure. Now, I do not know much about that system; so I do not mean to uphold it, neither do I intend to run it down. Perhaps, in reference to it, I may just hint that there may be too much of a good thing—I know not. But of this I am quite certain, that there may also be too little of a good thing; and the great delight I have had in cold bathing during the course of my adventurous career inclines me to think that it is better to risk taking too much than to content one’s self with too little. Such is my opinion, derived from much experience; but I put it before my readers with the utmost diffidence and with profound modesty, knowing that it may possibly jar with their feelings of confidence in their own ability to know and judge as to what is best and fittest in reference to their own affairs. But to return from this digression, for which I humbly crave forgiveness.
I have often wondered in later years why the people of my beloved country don't take more advantage of the wonderful element of water—I mean for cold bathing. I understand that it's not easy for them to go into the sea or rivers in winter, like we used to on Coral Island; but from my experience, a large wash tub and a sponge are a great substitute. The feelings of freshness, cleanliness, energy, and sheer joy I always felt after my sea baths—and even, when in England, my wash-tub sessions—were so delightful that I’d rather skip breakfast than miss my cold water bath. I hope my readers won't mind me asking if they usually bathe this way every morning; and if they say “No,” I suggest they start right away. In recent years, since stepping back from the adventurous life I've led abroad, I've heard of something called the cold-water cure. I don't know much about it, so I don’t want to endorse it or criticize it. But I might suggest that there can be too much of a good thing—I’m not sure. However, I am sure that there can also be too little of a good thing; and my enjoyment of cold bathing throughout my adventurous life makes me lean toward feeling that it’s better to risk overdoing it than to settle for too little. This is my opinion based on much experience; I present it to my readers with total humility and modesty, knowing it might conflict with their own beliefs about what’s best for them. But let me return from this tangent, for which I genuinely apologize.
We had not advanced on our journey much above a mile or so, and were just beginning to feel the pleasant glow that usually accompanies vigorous exercise, when, on turning a point that revealed to us a new and beautiful cluster of islands, we were suddenly arrested by the appalling cry which had so alarmed us a few nights before. But this time we were by no means so much alarmed as on the previous occasion, because, whereas at that time it was night, now it was day; and I have always found, though I am unable to account for it, that daylight banishes many of the fears that are apt to assail us in the dark.
We hadn’t traveled much more than a mile, and we were just starting to feel that nice buzz that comes from getting a good workout, when we turned a bend and saw a stunning new group of islands. Suddenly, we were stopped in our tracks by the terrifying cry that had freaked us out a few nights earlier. But this time, we weren’t nearly as scared as we had been before, because back then it was nighttime and now it was daytime. I’ve always noticed, though I can’t explain why, that daylight tends to chase away many of the fears that usually hit us in the dark.
On hearing the sound, Peterkin instantly threw forward his spear.
On hearing the noise, Peterkin quickly thrust his spear forward.
“Now, what can it be?” said he, looking round at Jack. “I tell you what it is: if we are to go on being pulled up in a constant state of horror and astonishment, as we have been for the last week, the sooner we’re out o’ this island the better, notwithstanding the yams and lemonade, and pork and plums!”
“Now, what could it be?” he said, looking over at Jack. “I’ll tell you what it is: if we’re going to keep being yanked around in a constant state of fear and surprise, like we have been for the past week, the sooner we get off this island the better, despite the yams and lemonade, and pork and plums!”
Peterkin’s remark was followed by a repetition of the cry, louder than before.
Peterkin’s comment was followed by an even louder echo of the cry.
“It comes from one of these islands,” said Jack.
“It comes from one of these islands,” Jack said.
“It must be the ghost of a jackass, then,” said Peterkin, “for I never heard anything so like.”
“It must be the ghost of a jerk, then,” said Peterkin, “because I’ve never heard anything so similar.”
We all turned our eyes towards the cluster of islands, where, on the largest, we observed curious objects moving on the shore.
We all looked toward the group of islands, where, on the biggest one, we noticed strange objects moving along the shore.
“Soldiers they are—that’s flat!” cried Peterkin, gazing at them in the utmost amazement.
“Soldiers, that's for sure!” Peterkin exclaimed, staring at them in complete astonishment.
And, in truth, Peterkin’s remark seemed to me to be correct; for at the distance from which we saw them, they appeared to be an army of soldiers. There they stood, rank and file, in lines and in squares, marching and counter-marching, with blue coats and white trousers. While we were looking at them the dreadful cry came again over the water, and Peterkin suggested that it must be a regiment sent out to massacre the natives in cold blood. At this remark Jack laughed and said:
And honestly, Peterkin’s comment seemed right to me; from the distance we were at, they looked like an army of soldiers. They stood there in formation, marching back and forth, wearing blue coats and white pants. While we were watching them, a terrifying cry echoed across the water again, and Peterkin suggested it must be a regiment sent out to slaughter the locals in cold blood. Jack laughed at this and said:
“Why, Peterkin, they are penguins!”
“Wow, Peterkin, they’re penguins!”
“Penguins?” repeated Peterkin.
"Penguins?" Peterkin repeated.
“Ay, penguins, Peterkin, penguins—nothing more or less than big sea-birds, as you shall see one of these days when we pay them a visit in our boat, which I mean to set about building the moment we return to our bower.”
“Yeah, penguins, Peterkin, penguins—just big sea-birds, as you’ll see one of these days when we go visit them in our boat, which I plan to start building as soon as we get back to our place.”
“So, then, our dreadful yelling ghosts and our murdering army of soldiers,” remarked Peterkin, “have dwindled down to penguins—big sea-birds! Very good. Then I propose that we continue our journey as fast as possible, lest our island should be converted into a dream before we get completely round it.”
“So, our frightening shouting ghosts and our killer army of soldiers,” Peterkin said, “have turned into penguins—big sea birds! Great. Then I suggest we keep moving quickly, or our island might become just a dream before we finish exploring it.”
Now, as we continued on our way, I pondered much over this new discovery and the singular appearance of these birds, of which Jack could only give us a very slight and vague account; and I began to long to commence our boat, in order that we might go and inspect them more narrowly. But by degrees these thoughts left me, and I began to be much taken up again with the interesting peculiarities of the country which we were passing through.
Now, as we continued on our way, I thought a lot about this new discovery and the unusual look of these birds, which Jack could only describe in a very vague way; and I started to really want to get our boat ready so we could go check them out more closely. But gradually, those thoughts faded, and I became much more focused on the fascinating features of the landscape we were traveling through.
The second night we passed in a manner somewhat similar to the first—at about two-thirds of the way round the island, as we calculated—and we hoped to sleep on the night following at our bower. I will not here note so particularly all that we said and saw during the course of this second day, as we did not make any further discoveries of great importance. The shore along which we travelled, and the various parts of the woods through which we passed, were similar to those which have been already treated of. There were one or two observations that we made, however, and these were as follows:
The second night we spent was pretty similar to the first—around two-thirds of the way around the island, as we figured—and we hoped to sleep at our shelter the following night. I won’t go into detail about everything we said and saw on this second day since we didn’t make any more significant discoveries. The shores we traveled along and the different parts of the woods we went through were like those we had already talked about. However, we did make one or two observations, which were as follows:
We saw that, while many of the large fruit-bearing trees grew only in the valleys, and some of them only near the banks of the streams, where the soil was peculiarly rich, the cocoa-nut palm grew in every place whatsoever—not only on the hillsides, but also on the seashore, and even, as has been already stated, on the coral reef itself, where the soil, if we may use the name, was nothing better than loose sand mingled with broken shells and coral rock. So near to the sea, too, did this useful tree grow, that in many places its roots were washed by the spray from the breakers. Yet we found the trees growing thus on the sands to be quite as luxuriant as those growing in the valleys, and the fruit as good and refreshing also. Besides this, I noticed that on the summit of the high mountain, which we once more ascended at a different point from our first ascent, were found abundance of shells and broken coral formations, which, Jack and I agreed, proved either that this island must have once been under the sea, or that the sea must once have been above the island: in other words, that as shells and coral could not possibly climb to the mountain-top, they must have been washed upon it while the mountain-top was on a level with the sea. We pondered this very much; and we put to ourselves the question, “What raised the island to its present height above the sea?” But to this we could by no means give to ourselves a satisfactory reply. Jack thought it might have been blown up by a volcano; and Peterkin said he thought it must have jumped up of its own accord! We also noticed, what had escaped us before, that the solid rocks of which the island was formed were quite different from the live coral rocks on the shore, where, the wonderful little insects were continually working. They seemed, indeed, to be of the same material—a substance like limestone; but while the coral rocks were quite full of minute cells in which the insects lived, the other rocks inland were hard and solid, without the appearance of cells at all. Our thoughts and conversations on this subject were sometimes so profound that Peterkin said we should certainly get drowned in them at last, even although we were such good divers! Nevertheless, we did not allow his pleasantry on this and similar points to deter us from making our notes and observations as we went along.
We noticed that while many of the large fruit-bearing trees only grew in the valleys, and some were found only by the streambanks where the soil was especially rich, the coconut palm thrived everywhere—not just on the hillsides, but also on the beach, and even, as mentioned earlier, on the coral reef itself, where the soil, if you could call it that, was nothing more than loose sand mixed with broken shells and coral rock. This useful tree grew so close to the sea that in many spots its roots were washed by the spray from the waves. Yet we found the trees growing in the sand to be just as lush as those in the valleys, and their fruit equally delicious and refreshing. Moreover, I noticed that at the top of the high mountain, which we climbed again from a different angle than our first ascent, there were plenty of shells and fragments of coral formations, which Jack and I agreed indicated either that this island must have once been underwater or that the sea must have been above the island at some point—in other words, since shells and coral couldn't possibly have climbed to the mountain's summit, they must have been deposited there when the mountain was level with the sea. We thought about this a lot and asked ourselves, “What caused the island to rise to its current height above the sea?” But we couldn’t come up with a satisfactory answer. Jack speculated it might have been pushed up by a volcano, while Peterkin joked that it must have jumped up on its own! We also observed, which we had missed before, that the solid rocks forming the island were quite different from the live coral rocks on the shore, where the tiny incredible insects were constantly at work. They seemed to be made of the same material—a substance like limestone; but while the coral rocks were full of tiny cells for the insects to live in, the other rocks inland were hard and solid, with no sign of cells at all. Our thoughts and discussions on this topic sometimes got so deep that Peterkin joked we might end up drowning in them, even though we were such good divers! Still, we didn’t let his jokes about it or similar matters keep us from taking notes and making observations as we went along.
We found several more droves of hogs in the woods, but abstained from killing any of them, having more than sufficient for our present necessities. We saw, also, many of their footprints in this neighbourhood. Among these we also observed the footprints of a smaller animal, which we examined with much care, but could form no certain opinion as to them. Peterkin thought they were those of a little dog, but Jack and I thought differently. We became very curious on this matter, the more so that we observed these footprints to lie scattered about in one locality, as if the animal which had made them was wandering round about in a very irregular manner and without any object in view. Early in the forenoon of our third day we observed these footprints to be much more numerous than ever, and in one particular spot they diverged off into the woods in a regular beaten track, which was, however, so closely beset with bushes that we pushed through it with difficulty. We had now become so anxious to find out what animal this was, and where it went to, that we determined to follow the track and, if possible, clear up the mystery. Peterkin said, in a bantering tone, that he was sure it would be cleared up, as usual, in some frightfully simple way, and prove to be no mystery at all!
We found several more groups of pigs in the woods, but we refrained from killing any since we had more than enough for our current needs. We also saw many of their footprints in the area. Among them, we spotted the footprints of a smaller animal, which we examined carefully, but we couldn't be sure what they were. Peterkin thought they belonged to a little dog, but Jack and I disagreed. We became very curious about this, especially since we noticed the footprints scattered in one area, as if the animal that made them was wandering around in a random way without any purpose. Early on the third day, we saw that these footprints were more numerous than before, and in one specific spot, they led off into the woods on a well-trodden path, which was so thick with bushes that we had a hard time making our way through. We were now so eager to find out what kind of animal this was and where it was going that we decided to follow the track and solve the mystery. Peterkin jokingly said he was sure the mystery would turn out, as always, to be something incredibly simple and not a mystery at all!
The beaten track seemed much too large to have been formed by the animal itself, and we concluded that some larger animal had made it, and that the smaller one made use of it. But everywhere the creeping plants and tangled bushes crossed our path, so that we forced our way along with some difficulty. Suddenly, as we came upon an open space, we heard a faint cry, and observed a black animal standing in the track before us.
The worn path looked way too big to have been made by the animal itself, so we figured that a bigger animal had created it, and the smaller one was just using it. But everywhere we went, creeping plants and tangled bushes blocked our way, making it hard for us to get through. Suddenly, as we entered a clear area, we heard a faint cry and saw a black animal standing in the path ahead of us.
“A wild cat!” cried Jack, fitting an arrow to his bow, and discharging it so hastily that he missed the animal, and hit the earth about half-a-foot to one side of it. To our surprise, the wild cat did not fly, but walked slowly towards the arrow and snuffed at it.
“A wild cat!” shouted Jack, quickly nocking an arrow to his bow and firing it so fast that he missed the animal, hitting the ground about six inches to the side of it. To our surprise, the wild cat didn’t run away but slowly approached the arrow and sniffed at it.
“That’s the most comical wild cat I ever saw!” cried Jack.
"That’s the funniest wild cat I’ve ever seen!" exclaimed Jack.
“It’s a tame wild cat, I think,” said Peterkin, levelling his spear to make a charge.
“It's a domesticated wild cat, I think,” said Peterkin, aiming his spear to get ready for a charge.
“Stop!” cried I, laying my hand on his shoulder. “I do believe the poor beast is blind. See, it strikes against the branches as it walks along. It must be a very old one;” and I hastened towards it.
“Stop!” I shouted, placing my hand on his shoulder. “I think the poor animal is blind. Look, it keeps bumping into the branches as it walks. It must be really old.” I quickly moved toward it.
“Only think,” said Peterkin with a suppressed laugh, “of a superannuated wild cat!”
“Just imagine,” said Peterkin with a muffled laugh, “an old wild cat!”
We now found that the poor cat was not only blind, or nearly so, but extremely deaf, as it did not hear our footsteps until we were quite close behind it. Then it sprang round, and, putting up its back and tail, while the black hair stood all on end, uttered a hoarse mew and a fuff.
We now discovered that the poor cat was not just blind—or almost entirely—but also very deaf, as it didn’t hear our footsteps until we were right behind it. Then it whirled around, arching its back and tail, with its black fur all standing on end, and let out a raspy meow and a huff.
Poor thing said Peterkin, gently extending his hand and endeavouring to pat the cat’s head. “Poor pussy! chee, chee, chee! puss, puss, puss! cheetie pussy!”
“Poor thing,” said Peterkin, gently reaching out his hand to pet the cat’s head. “Poor kitty! Come here, come here, come here! Kitty, kitty, kitty! Sweet little kitty!”
No sooner did the cat hear these sounds than all signs of anger fled, and advancing eagerly to Peterkin, it allowed itself to be stroked, and rubbed itself against his legs, purring loudly all the time, and showing every symptom of the most extreme delight.
No sooner did the cat hear these sounds than all signs of anger disappeared, and it eagerly approached Peterkin, allowed him to pet it, and rubbed against his legs, purring loudly the entire time, showing every sign of pure joy.
“It’s no more a wild cat than I am!” cried Peterkin, taking it in his arms; “it’s quite tame.—Poor pussy! cheetie pussy!”
“It’s no more a wild cat than I am!” yelled Peterkin, scooping it up in his arms; “it’s super tame. —Poor kitty! Sweet kitty!”
We now crowded around Peterkin, and were not a little surprised—and, to say truth, a good deal affected—by the sight of the poor animal’s excessive joy. It rubbed its head against Peterkin’s cheek, licked his chin, and thrust its head almost violently into his neck, while it purred more loudly than I ever heard a cat purr before, and appeared to be so much overpowered by its feelings that it occasionally mewed and purred almost in the same breath. Such demonstrations of joy and affection led us at once to conclude that this poor cat must have known man before, and we conjectured that it had been left either accidentally or by design on the island many years ago, and was now evincing its extreme joy at meeting once more with human beings. While we were fondling the cat and talking about it, Jack glanced round the open space in the midst of which we stood.
We crowded around Peterkin and were quite surprised—and honestly, a bit moved—by the sight of the poor animal’s overwhelming joy. It rubbed its head against Peterkin’s cheek, licked his chin, and practically shoved its head into his neck, purring louder than I had ever heard a cat purr before. It seemed so overwhelmed by its emotions that it occasionally meowed and purred almost in the same breath. Such displays of joy and affection made us quickly conclude that this poor cat must have known humans before. We speculated that it had either been accidentally left or intentionally abandoned on the island many years ago and was now showing its extreme happiness at reuniting with people. While we were petting the cat and discussing it, Jack glanced around the open space where we were standing.
“Hallo!” exclaimed he; “this looks something like a clearing. The axe has been at work here. Just look at these tree-stumps.”
“Hello!” he exclaimed. “This looks like a clearing. The axe has been doing work here. Just look at these tree stumps.”
We now turned to examine these, and without doubt we found trees that had been cut down here and there, also stumps and broken branches—all of which, however, were completely covered over with moss, and bore evidence of having been in this condition for some years. No human footprints were to be seen either on the track or among the bushes, but those of the cat were found everywhere. We now determined to follow up the track as far as it went, and Peterkin put the cat down; but it seemed to be so weak, and mewed so very pitifully, that he took it up again and carried it in his arms, where in a few minutes it fell sound asleep.
We turned to check out the area and definitely found trees that had been cut down here and there, along with stumps and broken branches—all of which were completely covered in moss and showed signs of being this way for several years. There were no human footprints on the path or in the bushes, but we found cat tracks everywhere. We decided to follow the track as far as it went, and Peterkin set the cat down; however, it appeared too weak and meowed so sadly that he picked it up again and carried it in his arms, where it quickly fell sound asleep.
About ten yards farther on, the felled trees became more numerous, and the track, diverging to the right, followed for a short space the banks of a stream. Suddenly we came to a spot where once must have been a rude bridge, the stones of which were scattered in the stream, and those on each bank entirely covered over with moss. In silent surprise and expectancy we continued to advance, and a few yards farther on, beheld, under the shelter of some bread-fruit trees, a small hut or cottage. I cannot hope to convey to my readers a very correct idea of the feelings that affected us on witnessing this unexpected sight. We stood for a long time in silent wonder, for there was a deep and most melancholy stillness about the place that quite overpowered us; and when we did at length speak, it was in subdued whispers, as if we were surrounded by some awful or supernatural influence. Even Peterkin’s voice, usually so quick and lively on all occasions, was hushed now; for there was a dreariness about this silent, lonely, uninhabited cottage—so strange in its appearance, so far away from the usual dwellings of man, so old, decayed, and deserted in its aspect that fell upon our spirits like a thick cloud, and blotted out as with a pall the cheerful sunshine that had filled us since the commencement of our tour round the island.
About ten yards farther along, the felled trees became more common, and the trail, veering to the right, briefly followed the banks of a stream. Suddenly, we reached a spot where there must have once been a crude bridge, with stones scattered in the water and those on either bank completely covered in moss. In silent surprise and anticipation, we continued to move forward, and a few yards later, we saw a small hut or cottage nestled under some breadfruit trees. I can’t hope to accurately express the feelings that washed over us upon seeing this unexpected sight. We stood for a long time in silent awe, as there was a deep, melancholic stillness about the place that completely overwhelmed us; and when we finally spoke, it was in muted whispers, as if we were in the presence of something eerie or supernatural. Even Peterkin's voice, usually so quick and lively, was quiet now; for there was a gloominess surrounding this silent, lonely, uninhabited cottage—so strange in appearance, so far removed from typical human dwellings, and so old, worn, and deserted—that it weighed on our spirits like a thick cloud, overshadowing the cheerful sunshine that had uplifted us since the start of our tour around the island.
The hut or cottage was rude and simple in its construction. It was not more than twelve feet long by ten feet broad, and about seven or eight feet high. It had one window, or rather a small frame in which a window might perhaps once have been, but which was now empty. The door was exceedingly low, and formed of rough boards, and the roof was covered with broad cocoa-nut and plantain leaves. But every part of it was in a state of the utmost decay. Moss and green matter grew in spots all over it. The woodwork was quite perforated with holes; the roof had nearly fallen in, and appeared to be prevented from doing so altogether by the thick matting of creeping plants and the interlaced branches which years of neglect had allowed to cover it almost entirely; while the thick, luxuriant branches of the bread-fruit and other trees spread above it, and flung a deep, sombre shadow over the spot, as if to guard it from the heat and the light of day. We conversed long and in whispers about this strange habitation ere we ventured to approach it; and when at length we did so, it was, at least on my part, with feelings of awe.
The hut or cottage was basic and straightforward in its design. It measured about twelve feet long by ten feet wide, and was roughly seven or eight feet tall. It had one window, or actually a small frame where a window might have been at one point, but now it was just empty. The door was very low and made of rough planks, while the roof was covered with broad coconut and plantain leaves. But every part of it was in terrible disrepair. Moss and green growth covered various spots all over it. The wood was full of holes; the roof was nearly collapsed, held up only by the thick mats of climbing plants and intertwined branches that years of neglect had allowed to cover it almost completely. Above, the lush branches of breadfruit and other trees cast a deep, dark shadow over the place, as if to protect it from the heat and light of day. We whispered for a long time about this strange dwelling before we dared to approach it; and when we finally did, I felt a sense of awe.
At first Jack endeavoured to peep in at the window; but from the deep shadow of the trees already mentioned, and the gloom within, he could not clearly discern objects, so we lifted the latch and pushed open the door. We observed that the latch was made of iron, and almost eaten away with rust. In the like condition were also the hinges, which creaked as the door swung back. On entering, we stood still and gazed around us, while we were much impressed with the dreary stillness of the room. But what we saw there surprised and shocked us not a little. There was no furniture in the apartment save a little wooden stool and an iron pot, the latter almost eaten through with rust. In the corner farthest from the door was a low bedstead, on which lay two skeletons, embedded in a little heap of dry dust. With beating hearts we went forward to examine them. One was the skeleton of a man; the other that of a dog, which was extended close beside that of the man, with its head resting on his bosom.
At first, Jack tried to peek through the window, but the deep shadows of the trees and the darkness inside made it hard for him to see clearly, so we lifted the latch and pushed the door open. We noticed that the latch was made of iron and was almost completely rusted away. The hinges were in the same state, creaking as the door swung open. As we stepped inside, we stopped and looked around, struck by the eerie silence of the room. What we found there both surprised and shocked us. There was no furniture in the room except for a small wooden stool and an iron pot, the latter nearly worn through with rust. In the corner farthest from the door was a low bed frame, where two skeletons lay, surrounded by a small pile of dry dust. With our hearts racing, we moved closer to examine them. One was the skeleton of a man; the other belonged to a dog, lying right beside the man with its head resting on his chest.
Now we were very much concerned about this discovery, and could scarce refrain from tears on beholding these sad remains. After some time we began to talk about what we had seen, and to examine in and around the hut, in order to discover some clue to the name or history of this poor man, who had thus died in solitude, with none to mourn his loss save his cat and his faithful dog. But we found nothing—neither a book nor a scrap of paper. We found, however, the decayed remnants of what appeared to have been clothing, and an old axe. But none of these things bore marks of any kind, and indeed they were so much decayed as to convince us that they had lain in the condition in which we found them for many years.
Now we were really worried about this discovery and could hardly hold back our tears as we looked at these sad remains. After a while, we started talking about what we had seen and examining the hut and its surroundings to find some clue about the name or story of this poor man, who had died alone, with only his cat and faithful dog to mourn him. But we found nothing—neither a book nor a scrap of paper. We did find the rotting remains of what seemed to be clothing and an old axe. However, none of these things had any markings, and they were so decayed that it was clear they had been in that state for many years.
This discovery now accounted to us for the tree-stump at the top of the mountain with the initials cut on it; also for the patch of sugar-cane and other traces of man which we had met with in the course of our rambles over the island. And we were much saddened by the reflection that the lot of this poor wanderer might possibly be our own, after many years’ residence on the island, unless we should be rescued by the visit of some vessel or the arrival of natives. Having no clue whatever to account for the presence of this poor human being in such a lonely spot, we fell to conjecturing what could have brought him there. I was inclined to think that he must have been a shipwrecked sailor, whose vessel had been lost here, and all the crew been drowned except himself and his dog and cat. But Jack thought it more likely that he had run away from his vessel, and had taken the dog and cat to keep him company. We were also much occupied in our minds with the wonderful difference between the cat and the dog. For here we saw that while the one perished like a loving friend by its master’s side, with its head resting on his bosom, the other had sought to sustain itself by prowling abroad in the forest, and had lived in solitude to a good old age. However, we did not conclude from this that the cat was destitute of affection, for we could not forget its emotions on first meeting with us; but we saw from this that the dog had a great deal more of generous love in its nature than the cat, because it not only found it impossible to live after the death of its master, but it must needs, when it came to die, crawl to his side and rest its head upon his lifeless breast.
This discovery explained the tree stump at the top of the mountain with the initials carved into it, as well as the patch of sugar cane and other signs of human presence we had encountered during our walks around the island. We felt a deep sadness at the thought that this poor wanderer’s fate might someday be our own after years of living on the island, unless we were rescued by a passing ship or the arrival of locals. With no reason to understand how this lonely person ended up here, we started to speculate about what could have brought him to this place. I thought he might have been a shipwrecked sailor whose ship had sunk here, with all the crew lost except for him, his dog, and his cat. But Jack believed it was more likely he had run away from his ship, taking the dog and cat with him for company. We also found ourselves thinking about the striking differences between the cat and the dog. We noticed that while one had perished like a loyal friend by its owner’s side, resting its head on his chest, the other had managed to survive by roaming the forest, living in solitude to an old age. However, we didn’t conclude that the cat lacked affection, as we couldn’t forget its feelings when it first met us. It was clear to us that the dog had much more generous love in it than the cat, since it couldn’t bear to live after its owner’s death and felt compelled, when it came time to die, to crawl to his side and rest its head on his lifeless body.
While we were thinking on these things, and examining into everything about the room, we were attracted by an exclamation from Peterkin.
While we were thinking about these things and looking around the room, we were drawn in by Peterkin's exclamation.
“I say, Jack,” said he, “here is something that will be of use to us.”
“I’m telling you, Jack,” he said, “here’s something that will help us.”
“What is it?” said Jack, hastening across the room.
“What is it?” Jack said, rushing across the room.
“An old pistol,” replied Peterkin, holding up the weapon, which he had just pulled from under a heap of broken wood and rubbish that lay in a corner.
“An old pistol,” Peterkin replied, holding up the weapon that he had just pulled out from under a pile of broken wood and trash in a corner.
“That, indeed, might have been useful,” said Jack, examining it, “if we had any powder; but I suspect the bow and the sling will prove more serviceable.”
“That might have been useful,” said Jack, looking it over, “if we had any gunpowder; but I think the bow and the sling will be more practical.”
“True, I forgot that,” said Peterkin; “but we may as well take it with us, for the flint will serve to strike fire with when the sun does not shine.”
“Yeah, I forgot about that,” Peterkin said. “But we might as well bring it along since the flint will help us start a fire when the sun isn’t shining.”
After having spent more than an hour at this place without discovering anything of further interest, Peterkin took up the old cat, which had lain very contentedly asleep on the stool whereon he had placed it, and we prepared to take our departure. In leaving the hut, Jack stumbled heavily against the door-post, which was so much decayed as to break across, and the whole fabric of the hut seemed ready to tumble about our ears. This put it into our heads that we might as well pull it down, and so form a mound over the skeleton. Jack, therefore, with his axe, cut down the other door-post, which, when it was done, brought the whole hut in ruins to the ground, and thus formed a grave to the bones of the poor recluse and his dog. Then we left the spot, having brought away the iron pot, the pistol, and the old axe, as they might be of much use to us hereafter.
After spending over an hour in this place without finding anything else interesting, Peterkin picked up the old cat, which had been sleeping contentedly on the stool where he had set it down, and we got ready to leave. As we were exiting the hut, Jack tripped hard against the doorframe, which was so rotted that it broke in half, and the entire structure of the hut seemed about to collapse on us. This made us think that we might as well tear it down, creating a mound over the skeleton. So, Jack took his axe and chopped down the other doorframe, which, once he finished, brought the whole hut crashing down, forming a grave for the bones of the poor hermit and his dog. We then left the area, taking the iron pot, the pistol, and the old axe with us, as they might be useful to us later on.
During the rest of this day we pursued our journey, and examined the other end of the large valley, which we found to be so much alike to the parts already described that I shall not recount the particulars of what we saw in this place. I may, however, remark that we did not quite recover our former cheerful spirits until we arrived at our bower, which we did late in the evening, and found everything just in the same condition as we had left it three days before.
During the rest of the day, we continued our journey and explored the other end of the large valley. It was so similar to the sections we had already described that I won’t go into detail about what we saw there. However, I should mention that we didn’t fully regain our cheerful spirits until we got back to our shelter, which we reached late in the evening, finding everything just as we had left it three days earlier.
Chapter Twelve.
Something wrong with the tank—Jack’s wisdom and Peterkin’s impertinence—Wonderful behaviour of a crab—Good wishes for those who dwell far from the sea—Jack commences to build a little boat.
Rest is sweet, as well for the body as for the mind. During my long experience, amid the vicissitudes of a chequered life, I have found that periods of profound rest at certain intervals, in addition to the ordinary hours of repose, are necessary to the well-being of man. And the nature, as well as the period, of this rest varies according to the different temperaments of individuals and the peculiar circumstances in which they may chance to be placed. To those who work with their minds, bodily labour is rest; to those who labour with the body, deep sleep is rest; to the downcast, the weary, and the sorrowful, joy and peace are rest. Nay, further, I think that to the gay, the frivolous, the reckless, when sated with pleasures that cannot last, even sorrow proves to be rest of a kind, although, perchance, it were better that I should call it relief than rest. There is, indeed, but one class of men to whom rest is denied—there is no rest to the wicked. At this I do but hint, however, as I treat not of that rest which is spiritual, but more particularly of that which applies to the mind and to the body.
Rest is sweet for both the body and the mind. Throughout my long experience with the ups and downs of life, I've found that periods of deep rest at certain intervals, in addition to regular downtime, are essential for a person's well-being. The type and duration of this rest vary based on individual temperaments and the specific circumstances they find themselves in. For those who work mentally, physical labor serves as rest; for those who work physically, deep sleep is restorative; and for the downcast, weary, and sorrowful, joy and peace provide rest. Moreover, I believe that for the cheerful, the careless, and the reckless—once they've become tired of fleeting pleasures—sorrow can also be a form of rest, though it might be more accurate to call it relief instead. In fact, there’s only one group of people who are denied rest: the wicked. However, I only touch on that here, as I’m not discussing spiritual rest but specifically the rest associated with the mind and body.
Of this rest we stood much in need on our return home, and we found it exceedingly sweet when we indulged in it after completing the journey just related. It had not, indeed, been a very long journey; nevertheless, we had pursued it so diligently that our frames were not a little prostrated. Our minds were also very much exhausted in consequence of the many surprises, frequent alarms, and much profound thought to which they had been subjected; so that when we lay down, on the night of our return, under the shelter of the bower, we fell immediately into very deep repose. I can state this with much certainty; for Jack afterwards admitted the fact, and Peterkin, although he stoutly denied it, I heard snoring loudly at least two minutes after lying down. In this condition we remained all night and the whole of the following day without awaking once, or so much as moving our positions. When we did awake it was near sunset, and we were all in such a state of lassitude that we merely rose to swallow a mouthful of food. As Peterkin remarked, in the midst of a yawn, we took breakfast at tea-time, and then went to bed again, where we lay till the following forenoon.
We really needed that rest when we got home, and it felt amazing after finishing our recent journey. It wasn’t a super long trip, but we had worked hard enough that we were totally worn out. Our minds were pretty drained too, from all the surprises, constant scares, and deep thinking we had to do. So, when we settled down that night under the cozy shelter of the bower, we instantly fell into a deep sleep. I can say this for sure because Jack later confirmed it, and Peterkin, though he tried to deny it, was snoring loudly at least two minutes after we lay down. We stayed in that state all night and throughout the next day without waking up or even changing positions. When we finally did wake up, it was near sunset, and we felt so sluggish that we only got up to grab a quick bite to eat. As Peterkin said between yawns, we had breakfast at tea-time and then went back to bed, where we stayed until the next morning.
After this we arose very greatly refreshed, but much alarmed lest we had lost count of a day. I say we were much alarmed on this head; for we had carefully kept count of the days, since we were cast upon our island, in order that we might remember the Sabbath-day, which day we had hitherto, with one accord, kept as a day of rest, and refrained from all work whatsoever. However, on considering the subject, we all three entertained the same opinion as to how long we had slept, and so our minds were put at ease.
After this, we got up feeling really refreshed but also worried that we might have lost track of a day. I mean, we were quite concerned about that because we had been keeping careful track of the days since we ended up on our island, so we could remember the Sabbath, which we had all agreed to observe as a day of rest, avoiding any work at all. However, after thinking about it, the three of us agreed on how long we had actually slept, and that relieved our minds.
We now hastened to our Water Garden to enjoy a bathe, and to see how did the animals which I had placed in the tank. We found the garden more charming, pellucid, and inviting than ever; and Jack and I plunged into its depths and gambolled among its radiant coral groves, while Peterkin wallowed at the surface, and tried occasionally to kick us as we passed below. Having dressed, I then hastened to the tank; but what was my surprise and grief to find nearly all the animals dead, and the water in a putrid condition! I was greatly distressed at this, and wondered what could be the cause of it.
We quickly made our way to the Water Garden to enjoy a swim and check on the animals I had put in the tank. The garden was more beautiful, clear, and inviting than ever; Jack and I dove into the water and played among its stunning coral groves, while Peterkin splashed around on the surface and occasionally tried to kick us as we swam below. After getting dressed, I hurried to the tank; but I was shocked and saddened to find nearly all the animals dead and the water in a disgusting state! I was really upset about this and wondered what could have caused it.
“Why, you precious humbug!” said Peterkin, coming up to me, “how could you expect it to be otherwise? When fishes are accustomed to live in the Pacific Ocean, how can you expect them to exist in a hole like that?”
“Why, you silly fraud!” said Peterkin, walking over to me, “how could you think it would be any different? When fish are used to living in the Pacific Ocean, how can you expect them to survive in a hole like that?”
“Indeed, Peterkin,” I replied, “there seems to be truth in what you say. Nevertheless, now I think of it, there must be some error in your reasoning; for if I put in but a few very small animals, they will bear the same proportion to this pond that the millions of fish bear to the ocean.”
“Yeah, Peterkin,” I replied, “there is definitely some truth in what you’re saying. Still, now that I think about it, there has to be a mistake in your reasoning; because if I only put in a few tiny animals, they’ll have the same ratio to this pond as the millions of fish do to the ocean.”
“I say, Jack!” cried Peterkin, waving his hand; “come here, like a good fellow. Ralph is actually talking philosophy. Do come to our assistance, for he’s out o’ sight beyond me already!”
“I say, Jack!” shouted Peterkin, waving his hand. “Come here, would you? Ralph is actually talking about philosophy. Please help us out, because he’s already way over my head!”
“What’s the matter?” inquired Jack, coming up, while he endeavoured to scrub his long hair dry with a towel of cocoa-nut cloth.
“What’s up?” asked Jack, approaching while he tried to dry his long hair with a towel made of coconut fibers.
I repeated my thoughts to Jack, who, I was happy to find, quite agreed with me. “The best plan,” he said, “will be to put very few animals at first into your tank, and add more as you find it will bear them. And look here,” he added, pointing to the sides of the tank, which, for the space of two inches above the water-level, were encrusted with salt, “you must carry your philosophy a little further, Ralph. That water has evaporated so much that it is too salt for anything to live in. You will require to add fresh water now and then, in order to keep it at the same degree of saltness as the sea.”
I shared my thoughts with Jack, who I was glad to see agreed with me. “The best plan,” he said, “is to start with just a few animals in your tank, and then add more as you see how it holds up. And look here,” he continued, pointing to the sides of the tank, which were covered with salt for about two inches above the waterline, “you need to think this through a bit more, Ralph. That water has evaporated so much that it’s too salty for anything to survive in. You'll need to add fresh water occasionally to keep it at the same level of salinity as the ocean.”
“Very true, Jack; that never struck me before,” said I.
“That's so true, Jack; I never thought about that before,” I said.
“And, now I think of it,” continued Jack, “it seems to me that the surest way of arranging your tank so as to get it to keep pure and in good condition will be to imitate the ocean in it; in fact, make it a miniature Pacific. I don’t see how you can hope to succeed unless you do that.”
“And now that I think about it,” Jack continued, “it seems to me that the best way to set up your tank to keep it clean and in good shape is to mimic the ocean; basically, create a little Pacific. I don’t see how you can expect to succeed without doing that.”
“Most true,” said I, pondering what my companion said. “But I fear that that will be very difficult.”
“That's true,” I said, thinking about what my friend said. “But I worry that it will be really hard.”
“Not at all,” cried Jack, rolling his towel up into a ball and throwing it into the face of Peterkin, who had been grinning and winking at him during the last five minutes—“not at all. Look here. There is water of a certain saltness in the sea; well, fill your tank with sea-water, and keep it at that saltness by marking the height at which the water stands on the sides. When it evaporates a little, pour in fresh water from the brook till it comes up to the mark, and then it will be right, for the salt does not evaporate with the water. Then there’s lots of seaweed in the sea; well, go and get one or two bits of seaweed and put them into your tank. Of course the weed must be alive, and growing to little stones; or you can chip a bit off the rocks with the weed sticking to it. Then, if you like, you can throw a little sand and gravel into your tank, and the thing’s complete.”
“Not at all,” Jack exclaimed, rolling his towel into a ball and tossing it at Peterkin, who had been grinning and winking at him for the last five minutes—“not at all. Look, there’s a certain saltiness to the sea water; so, fill your tank with sea water, and keep it at that salinity by marking the height on the sides. When it evaporates a bit, add some fresh water from the stream until it reaches the mark, and then it’ll be just right, because the salt doesn’t evaporate with the water. And there’s plenty of seaweed in the ocean; just go get a couple of pieces of it and put them in your tank. Of course, the seaweed needs to be alive and attached to small rocks; or you can just chip off a piece of rock with the seaweed still on it. Then, if you want, you can toss in a little sand and gravel, and you’re all set.”
“Nay, not quite,” said Peterkin, who had been gravely attentive to this off-hand advice—“not quite. You must first make three little men to dive in it before it can be said to be perfect; and that would be rather difficult, I fear, for two of them would require to be philosophers. But hallo! what’s this?—I say, Ralph, look here! There’s one o’ your crabs up to something uncommon. It’s performing the most remarkable operation for a crab I ever saw—taking off its coat, I do believe, before going to bed!”
“Not exactly,” said Peterkin, who had been seriously considering this casual advice—“not exactly. You first need to create three little men to dive in it before it can be considered perfect; and that might be a bit tricky, I’m afraid, because two of them would need to be philosophers. But hey! What’s this?—I say, Ralph, take a look! There’s one of your crabs doing something unusual. It’s performing the most astonishing act for a crab I’ve ever seen—taking off its shell, I really believe, before going to bed!”
We hastily stooped over the tank, and certainly were not a little amused at the conduct of one of the crabs which still survived its companions. It was one of the common small crabs, like to those that are found running about everywhere on the coast of England. While we gazed at it we observed its back to split away from the lower part of its body, and out of the gap thus formed came a soft lump which moved and writhed unceasingly. This lump continued to increase in size until it appeared like a bunch of crab’s legs; and, indeed, such it proved in a very few minutes to be, for the points of the toes were at length extricated from the hole in its back, the legs spread out, the body followed, and the crab walked away quite entire, even to the points of its nipper-claws, leaving a perfectly entire shell behind it, so that, when we looked, it seemed as though there were two complete crabs instead of one.
We quickly leaned over the tank and were definitely amused by the behavior of one of the crabs that had survived its companions. It was a common small crab, similar to those you find scurrying around the coast of England. As we watched, we noticed its back start to split from the lower part of its body, and from the opening came a soft mass that moved and squirmed constantly. This mass kept growing until it looked like a bunch of crab legs; and indeed, within a few minutes, it turned out to be just that, as the tips of the toes finally emerged from the hole in its back, the legs spread out, the body followed, and the crab walked away completely intact, even down to its claws, leaving behind a perfect shell. When we looked, it seemed as though there were two complete crabs instead of one.
“Well,” exclaimed Peterkin, drawing a long breath, “I’ve heard of a man jumping out of his skin and sitting down in his skeleton in order to cool himself, but I never expected to see a crab do it!”
“Well,” shouted Peterkin, taking a deep breath, “I’ve heard of a guy jumping out of his skin and sitting down in his skeleton to cool off, but I never thought I’d actually see a crab do it!”
We were, in truth, much amazed at this spectacle, and the more so when we observed that the new crab was larger than the crab that it came out of. It was also quite soft, but by next morning its skin had hardened into a good shell. We came thus to know that crabs grow in this way, and not by the growing of their shells, as we had always thought before we saw this wonderful operation.
We were honestly pretty amazed by this sight, especially when we noticed that the new crab was bigger than the one it had come out of. It was also really soft, but by the next morning, its skin had toughened into a solid shell. This made us realize that crabs grow this way, and not by their shells growing larger, which is what we had always thought before witnessing this incredible process.
Now I considered well the advice which Jack had given me about preparing my tank, and the more I thought of it the more I came to regard it as very sound and worthy of being acted on. So I forthwith put his plan in execution, and found it to answer excellently well—indeed, much beyond my expectation; for I found that after a little experience had taught me the proper proportion of seaweed and animals to put into a certain amount of water, the tank needed no further attendance. And, moreover, I did not require ever afterwards to renew or change the sea-water, but only to add a very little fresh water from the brook, now and then, as the other evaporated. I therefore concluded that if I had been suddenly conveyed, along with my tank, into some region where there was no salt sea at all, my little sea and my sea-fish would have continued to thrive and to prosper notwithstanding. This made me greatly to desire that those people in the world who live far inland might know of my wonderful tank, and by having materials like to those of which it was made conveyed to them, thus be enabled to watch the habits of those most mysterious animals that reside in the sea, and examine with their own eyes the wonders of the great deep.
Now I really thought about the advice Jack gave me on how to set up my tank, and the more I considered it, the more I found it to be really smart and worth following. So I immediately put his plan into action and found it worked incredibly well—way better than I expected. After a bit of practice, I figured out the right mix of seaweed and animals to add to a certain amount of water, and the tank needed no further care. Plus, I didn't have to change the seawater at all, just added a little fresh water from the brook now and then as it evaporated. I concluded that if I had suddenly been taken, along with my tank, to a place with no saltwater, my little sea and my fish would have kept thriving regardless. This made me really want to share my amazing tank with people who live far inland, so they could have materials similar to what I used and be able to observe the habits of those strange creatures that live in the sea and see the wonders of the deep for themselves.
For many days after this, while Peterkin and Jack were busily employed in building a little boat out of the curious natural planks of the chestnut-tree, I spent much of my time in examining with the burning-glass the marvellous operations that were constantly going on in my tank. Here I saw those anemones which cling, like little red, yellow, and green blobs of jelly, to the rocks, put forth, as it were, a multitude of arms and wait till little fish or other small animalcules unwarily touched them, when they would instantly seize them, fold arm after arm round their victims, and so engulf them in their stomachs. Here I saw the ceaseless working of those little coral insects whose efforts have encrusted the islands of the Pacific with vast rocks, and surrounded them with enormous reefs; and I observed that many of these insects, though extremely minute, were very beautiful, coming out of their holes in a circle of fine threads, and having the form of a shuttlecock. Here I saw curious little barnacles opening a hole in their backs and constantly putting out a thin, feathery hand, with which, I doubt not, they dragged their food into their mouths. Here, also, I saw those crabs which have shells only on the front of their bodies, but no shell whatever on their remarkably tender tails, so that, in order to find a protection to them, they thrust them into the empty shells of whelks, or some such fish, and when they grow too big for one, change into another. But, most curious of all, I saw an animal which had the wonderful power, when it became ill, of casting its stomach and its teeth away from it, and getting an entirely new set in the course of a few months! All this I saw, and a great deal more, by means of my tank and my burning-glass; but I refrain from setting down more particulars here, as I have still much to tell of the adventures that befell us while we remained on this island.
For many days after this, while Peterkin and Jack were busy building a small boat out of the unique natural planks from the chestnut tree, I spent a lot of time using the magnifying glass to observe the amazing activities happening in my tank. I saw those anemones that cling, like little red, yellow, and green blobs of jelly, to the rocks, extending a multitude of arms and waiting for little fish or other small creatures to unwittingly touch them; then they would instantly grab them, wrapping arm after arm around their prey and engulfing them in their stomachs. I witnessed the constant work of those tiny coral insects whose efforts have formed vast rocks that encrust the islands of the Pacific and surrounded them with massive reefs; I noticed that many of these insects, though incredibly small, were quite beautiful, emerging from their holes in a circle of fine threads and resembling shuttlecocks. I observed peculiar little barnacles opening a hole in their backs and consistently extending a thin, feathery arm, which I imagine they used to pull their food into their mouths. I also saw those crabs that have shells only on the front of their bodies, with no shell on their remarkably soft tails, so they seek protection by stuffing them into the empty shells of whelks or similar creatures, and when they grow too large for one, they switch to another. But most fascinating of all was an animal that had the incredible ability, when it fell ill, to shed its stomach and teeth, and grow a completely new set within a few months! I observed all this and much more with my tank and magnifying glass; however, I’ll hold back from detailing more here, as I still have much to share about the adventures we experienced while we were on this island.
Chapter Thirteen.
Notable discovery at the spouting cliffs—The mysterious green monster explained—We are thrown into unutterable terror by the idea that Jack is drowned—The diamond cave.
“Come, Jack,” cried Peterkin one morning about three weeks after our return from our long excursion, “let’s be jolly to-day, and do something vigorous. I’m quite tired of hammering and bammering, hewing and screwing, cutting and butting at that little boat of ours, that seems as hard to build as Noah’s ark. Let us go on an excursion to the mountain-top, or have a hunt after the wild ducks, or make a dash at the pigs. I’m quite flat—flat as bad ginger-beer—flat as a pancake; in fact, I want something to rouse me—to toss me up, as it were. Eh! what do you say to it?”
“Come on, Jack,” shouted Peterkin one morning about three weeks after we got back from our long trip, “let’s have some fun today and do something exciting. I’m really tired of messing around, chiseling and screwing, cutting and shaping that little boat of ours, which feels as tough to build as Noah’s ark. Let’s go on an adventure to the mountain top, or go hunting for wild ducks, or chase after the pigs. I’m feeling totally drained—flat as stale soda—flat as a pancake; honestly, I need something to wake me up—to lift my spirits, so to speak. What do you think?”
“Well,” answered Jack, throwing down the axe with which he was just about to proceed towards the boat, “if that’s what you want, I would recommend you to make an excursion to the waterspouts. The last one we had to do with tossed you up a considerable height; perhaps the next will send you higher—who knows?—if you’re at all reasonable or moderate in your expectations!”
“Well,” replied Jack, dropping the axe that he was about to use to head to the boat, “if that’s what you want, I suggest you take a trip to the waterspouts. The last one we dealt with shot you up quite a ways; maybe the next one will throw you even higher—who knows?—if you keep your expectations reasonable!”
“Jack, my dear boy,” said Peterkin gravely, “you are really becoming too fond of jesting. It’s a thing I don’t at all approve of; and if you don’t give it up, I fear that, for our mutual good, we shall have to part.”
“Jack, my dear boy,” said Peterkin seriously, “you’re really getting too into joking around. I don’t approve of it at all; and if you don’t stop, I’m afraid that, for both our sakes, we’ll have to go our separate ways.”
“Well, then, Peterkin,” replied Jack with a smile, “what would you have?”
“Well, then, Peterkin,” Jack said with a smile, “what do you want?”
“Have?” said Peterkin. “I would have nothing. I didn’t say I wanted to have; I said that I wanted to do.”
“Have?” said Peterkin. “I wouldn’t have anything. I didn’t say I wanted to have; I said that I wanted to do.”
“By the bye,” said I, interrupting their conversation, “I am reminded by this that we have not yet discovered the nature of yon curious appearance that we saw near the waterspouts on our journey round the island. Perhaps it would be well to go for that purpose.”
“By the way,” I said, interrupting their conversation, “this reminds me that we still haven't figured out what that strange thing was that we saw near the waterspouts while we were traveling around the island. Maybe it would be good to check it out.”
“Humph!” ejaculated Peterkin, “I know the nature of it well enough.”
“Humph!” exclaimed Peterkin, “I know exactly what it's about.”
“What was it?” said I.
“What was it?” I asked.
“It was of a mysterious nature, to be sure!” said he with a wave of his hand, while he rose from the log on which he had been sitting and buckled on his belt, into which he thrust his enormous club.
“It was definitely mysterious!” he said, waving his hand as he stood up from the log he had been sitting on and buckled his belt, putting his massive club into it.
“Well, then, let us away to the waterspouts,” cried Jack, going up to the bower for his bow and arrows.—“And bring your spear, Peterkin; it may be useful.”
“Well, then, let’s head to the waterspouts,” shouted Jack, walking up to the shelter to grab his bow and arrows. “And bring your spear, Peterkin; it might come in handy.”
We now, having made up our minds to examine into this matter, sallied forth eagerly in the direction of the waterspout rocks, which, as I have before mentioned, were not far from our present place of abode. On arriving there we hastened down to the edge of the rocks and gazed over into the sea, where we observed the pale-green object still distinctly visible, moving its tail slowly to and fro in the water.
We decided to look into this matter and eagerly headed toward the waterspout rocks, which, as I mentioned earlier, were close to where we were staying. Once we got there, we quickly went to the edge of the rocks and looked out over the sea, where we saw the pale-green object still clearly visible, moving its tail slowly back and forth in the water.
“Most remarkable!” said Jack.
"Super impressive!" said Jack.
“Exceedingly curious!” said I.
"Really curious!" I said.
“Beats everything!” said Peterkin.—“Now, Jack,” he added, “you made such a poor figure in your last attempt to stick that object that I would advise you to let me try it. If it has got a heart at all, I’ll engage to send my spear right through the core of it; if it hasn’t got a heart, I’ll send it through the spot where its heart ought to be.”
“Beats everything!” said Peterkin. “Now, Jack,” he continued, “you didn’t do so well in your last attempt to hit that thing, so I suggest you let me try. If it has a heart at all, I’ll make sure to drive my spear right through the center of it; if it doesn’t have a heart, I’ll aim for the spot where its heart should be.”
“Fire away, then, my boy,” replied Jack with a laugh.
“Go ahead, then, my boy,” Jack replied with a laugh.
Peterkin immediately took the spear, poised it for a second or two above his head, then darted it like an arrow into the sea. Down it went straight into the centre of the green object, passed quite through it, and came up immediately afterwards, pure and unsullied, while the mysterious tail moved quietly as before!
Peterkin quickly grabbed the spear, held it above his head for a moment, then launched it like an arrow into the sea. It went straight down into the middle of the green object, went right through it, and emerged moments later, clean and untouched, while the strange tail continued to move gently as before!
“Now,” said Peterkin gravely, “that brute is a heartless monster; I’ll have nothing more to do with it.”
“Now,” Peterkin said seriously, “that beast is a heartless monster; I won’t have anything more to do with it.”
“I’m pretty sure now,” said Jack, “that it is merely a phosphoric light; but I must say I’m puzzled at its staying always in that exact spot.”
“I’m pretty sure now,” said Jack, “that it’s just a phosphoric light; but I have to admit I’m confused about why it always stays in that exact spot.”
I also was much puzzled, and inclined to think with Jack that it must be phosphoric light, of which luminous appearance we had seen much while on our voyage to these seas. “But,” said I, “there is nothing to hinder us from diving down to it, now that we are sure it is not a shark.”
I was also quite confused and leaned towards Jack's idea that it must be phosphorescent light, which we had seen a lot of during our journey to these waters. “But,” I said, “there's nothing stopping us from diving down to it now that we're sure it isn't a shark.”
“True,” returned Jack, stripping off his clothes. “I’ll go down, Ralph, as I’m better at diving than you are.—Now, then, Peterkin, out o’ the road!” Jack stepped forward, joined his hands above his head, bent over the rocks, and plunged into the sea. For a second or two the spray caused by his dive hid him from view; then the water became still, and we saw him swimming far down in the midst of the green object. Suddenly he sank below it, and vanished altogether from our sight! We gazed anxiously down at the spot where he had disappeared for nearly a minute, expecting every moment to see him rise again for breath; but fully a minute passed and still he did not reappear. Two minutes passed! and then a flood of alarm rushed in upon my soul when I considered that, during all my acquaintance with him, Jack had never stayed under water more than a minute at a time—indeed, seldom so long.
“True,” Jack replied, taking off his clothes. “I’ll go down, Ralph, since I’m better at diving than you. Now, Peterkin, get out of the way!” Jack stepped forward, put his hands above his head, bent over the rocks, and jumped into the sea. For a moment, the spray from his dive concealed him; then the water became calm, and we saw him swimming deep in the green water. Suddenly, he disappeared beneath the surface and vanished from our sight! We anxiously stared at the spot where he had gone for nearly a minute, expecting to see him pop up for air; but a full minute went by, and he still didn’t reappear. Two minutes passed! Panic flooded over me as I realized that, in all the time I had known him, Jack had never stayed underwater for more than a minute—often not even that long.
“Oh Peterkin!” I said in a voice that trembled with increasing anxiety, “something has happened. It is more than three minutes now.” But Peterkin did not answer; and I observed that he was gazing down into the water with a look of intense fear mingled with anxiety, while his face was overspread with a deadly paleness. Suddenly he sprang to his feet and rushed about in a frantic state, wringing his hands, and exclaiming, “Oh Jack! Jack! He is gone! It must have been a shark, and he is gone for ever!”
“Oh Peterkin!” I said, my voice shaking with rising anxiety, “something’s wrong. It’s been over three minutes now.” But Peterkin didn’t respond; I noticed he was staring down into the water, his face a mix of intense fear and anxiety, and he looked really pale. Suddenly, he jumped to his feet, running around in a panic, wringing his hands, and shouted, “Oh Jack! Jack! He’s gone! It must have been a shark, and he’s gone forever!”
For the next five minutes I know not what I did; the intensity of my feelings almost bereft me of my senses. But I was recalled to myself by Peterkin seizing me by the shoulders and staring wildly into my face, while he exclaimed, “Ralph! Ralph! perhaps he has only fainted! Dive for him, Ralph!”
For the next five minutes, I couldn’t tell you what I did; my emotions were so intense that I felt like I was losing my mind. But I came back to reality when Peterkin grabbed me by the shoulders and stared at me in panic, yelling, “Ralph! Ralph! Maybe he just fainted! Go after him, Ralph!”
It seemed strange that this did not occur to me sooner. In a moment I rushed to the edge of the rocks, and without waiting to throw off my garments, was on the point to spring into the waves when I observed something black rising up through the green object. In another moment Jack’s head rose to the surface, and he gave a wild shout, flinging back the spray from his locks, as was his wont after a dive. Now we were almost as much amazed at seeing him reappear, well and strong, as we had been at first at his non-appearance; for, to the best of our judgment, he had been nearly ten minutes under water—perhaps longer—and it required no exertion of our reason to convince us that this was utterly impossible for mortal man to do and retain his strength and faculties. It was, therefore, with a feeling akin to superstitious awe that I held down my hand and assisted him to clamber up the steep rocks. But no such feeling affected Peterkin. No sooner did Jack gain the rocks and seat himself on one, panting for breath, than he threw his arms round his neck and burst into a flood of tears. “Oh Jack! Jack!” said he, “where were you? What kept you so long?”
It felt strange that I hadn't thought of this sooner. In a moment, I rushed to the edge of the rocks and, without taking the time to remove my clothes, was about to jump into the waves when I saw something black rising up through the green water. In another moment, Jack's head broke the surface, and he let out a wild shout, tossing back the spray from his hair, just like he always did after a dive. We were almost as shocked to see him emerge, safe and strong, as we had been at his earlier disappearance; because, by our best estimate, he had been nearly ten minutes underwater—maybe longer—and it didn't take much reasoning to understand that it was totally impossible for a person to do that and still have their strength and senses. So, with a feeling close to superstitious awe, I reached down my hand and helped him climb up the steep rocks. But Peterkin didn't feel anything like that. As soon as Jack reached the rocks and sat down on one, gasping for breath, he wrapped his arms around his neck and burst into tears. "Oh Jack! Jack!" he said, "where were you? What took you so long?"
After a few moments Peterkin became composed enough to sit still and listen to Jack’s explanation, although he could not restrain himself from attempting to wink every two minutes at me in order to express his joy at Jack’s safety. I say he attempted to wink, but I am bound to add that he did not succeed; for his eyes were so much swollen with weeping that his frequent attempts only resulted in a series of violent and altogether idiotical contortions of the face, that were very far from expressing what he intended. However, I knew what the poor fellow meant by it; so I smiled to him in return, and endeavoured to make believe that he was winking.
After a few moments, Peterkin managed to calm down enough to sit still and listen to Jack’s explanation, although he couldn’t help but try to wink at me every couple of minutes to show his happiness about Jack’s safety. I say he tried to wink, but I have to mention that he didn’t succeed; his eyes were so swollen from crying that his frequent attempts resulted in a series of wild and totally ridiculous facial contortions that were far from what he intended. Still, I understood what the poor guy meant by it, so I smiled back at him and tried to act like he was actually winking.
“Now, lads,” said Jack when we were composed enough to listen to him, “yon green object is not a shark; it is a stream of light issuing from a cave in the rocks. Just after I made my dive, I observed that this light came from the side of the rock above which we are now sitting; so I struck out for it, and saw an opening into some place or other that appeared to be luminous within. For one instant I paused to think whether I ought to venture. Then I made up my mind and dashed into it; for you see, Peterkin, although I take some time to tell this, it happened in the space of a few seconds, so that I knew I had wind enough in me to serve to bring me out o’ the hole and up to the surface again. Well, I was just on the point of turning—for I began to feel a little uncomfortable in such a place—when it seemed to me as if there was a faint light right above me. I darted upwards, and found my head out of water. This relieved me greatly, for I now felt that I could take in air enough to enable me to return the way I came. Then it all at once occurred to me that I might not be able to find the way out again; but on glancing downwards, my mind was put quite at rest by seeing the green light below me streaming into the cave, just like the light that we had seen streaming out of it, only what I now saw was much brighter.
“Now, guys,” said Jack when we were calm enough to listen to him, “that green thing over there isn’t a shark; it’s a beam of light coming from a cave in the rocks. Just after I dove in, I noticed that this light was coming from the side of the rock we’re sitting on now; so I swam toward it and saw an opening into some bright space. For a moment, I hesitated to decide if I should go in. Then I made up my mind and rushed in; because, Peterkin, even though I’m taking a while to explain this, it all happened in just a few seconds, so I knew I had enough air in me to get out of the hole and back to the surface. Well, I was just about to turn around—since I was starting to feel a bit uneasy in there—when it seemed like there was a faint light right above me. I shot upwards and found my head above water. This was a huge relief, as I felt I could breathe enough to head back the way I came. Then it suddenly hit me that I might not be able to find my way out again; but when I looked down, I relaxed when I saw the green light below me shining into the cave, just like the light we saw coming out of it, only this time it was much brighter.
“At first I could scarcely see anything as I gazed around me, it was so dark; but gradually my eyes became accustomed to it, and I found that I was in a huge cave, part of the walls of which I observed on each side of me. The ceiling just above me was also visible, and I fancied that I could perceive beautiful, glittering objects there; but the farther end of the cave was shrouded in darkness. While I was looking around me in great wonder, it came into my head that you two would think I was drowned; so I plunged down through the passage again in a great hurry, rose to the surface, and—here I am!”
“At first, I could barely see anything because it was so dark; but slowly my eyes adjusted, and I realized I was in a massive cave, with parts of the walls visible on either side. I could also see the ceiling right above me, and I thought I spotted beautiful, glittering objects up there; but the far end of the cave was completely hidden in darkness. As I was looking around in amazement, it occurred to me that you two might think I had drowned; so I hurried back down through the passage, surfaced, and—here I am!”
When Jack concluded his recital of what he had seen in this remarkable cave, I could not rest satisfied till I had dived down to see it; which I did, but found it so dark, as Jack had said, that I could scarcely see anything. When I returned we had a long conversation about, it, during which I observed that Peterkin had a most lugubrious expression on his countenance.
When Jack finished sharing what he saw in that amazing cave, I couldn't relax until I had gone down to check it out myself. I did, but found it was so dark, just as Jack had said, that I could barely see anything. When I got back, we had a long chat about it, during which I noticed that Peterkin had a really gloomy look on his face.
“What’s the matter, Peterkin?” said I.
"What's wrong, Peterkin?" I asked.
“The matter?” he replied. “It’s all very well for you two to be talking away like mermaids about the wonders of this cave; but you know I must be content to hear about it, while you are enjoying yourselves down there like mad dolphins. It’s really too bad!”
“The issue?” he replied. “It’s great for you two to be chatting away like mermaids about the amazing things in this cave; but you know I have to settle for just hearing about it while you’re having fun down there like crazy dolphins. It’s really a shame!”
“I’m very sorry for you, Peterkin—indeed I am,” said Jack; “but we cannot help you. If you would only learn to dive—”
“I really feel for you, Peterkin—honestly, I do,” Jack said; “but there’s nothing we can do to help you. If only you would learn to dive—”
“Learn to fly, you might as well say!” retorted Peterkin in a very sulky tone.
“Learn to fly, why don't you!” Peterkin replied in a really grumpy tone.
“If you would only consent to keep still,” said I, “we would take you down with us in ten seconds.”
“If you could just agree to be quiet,” I said, “we could take you down with us in ten seconds.”
“Hum!” returned Peterkin; “suppose a salamander was to propose to you ‘only to keep still’ and he would carry you through a blazing fire in a few seconds, what would you say?”
“Hum!” replied Peterkin; “imagine a salamander proposed to you ‘just to stay quiet’ and he would take you through a raging fire in a few seconds, what would you say?”
We both laughed and shook our heads, for it was evident that nothing was to be made of Peterkin in the water. But we could not rest satisfied till we had seen more of this cave; so, after further consultation, Jack and I determined to try if we could take down a torch with us, and set fire to it in the cavern. This we found to be an undertaking of no small difficulty, but we accomplished it at last by the following means: First, we made a torch of a very inflammable nature out of the bark of a certain tree, which we cut into strips, and after twisting, cemented together with a kind of resin or gum, which we also obtained from another tree; neither of which trees, however, was known by name to Jack. This, when prepared, we wrapped up in a great number of plies of cocoa-nut cloth, so that we were confident it could not get wet during the short time it should be under water. Then we took a small piece of the tinder, which we had carefully treasured up lest we should require it, as before said, when the sun should fail us; also, we rolled up some dry grass and a few chips, which, with a little bow and drill, like those described before, we made into another bundle and wrapped it up in cocoa-nut cloth. When all was ready we laid aside our garments, with the exception of our trousers, which, as we did not know what rough scraping against the rocks we might be subjected to, we kept on.
We both laughed and shook our heads because it was clear that Peterkin wasn't going to help in the water. But we couldn't be satisfied until we explored more of this cave, so after some discussion, Jack and I decided to see if we could take a torch with us and light it in the cavern. We found this to be quite a challenge, but we eventually managed it using the following methods: First, we made a highly flammable torch from the bark of a certain tree, cutting it into strips and twisting them together, secured with a kind of resin or gum that we also obtained from another tree; neither of which Jack knew by name. Once prepared, we wrapped it in many layers of coconut cloth to ensure it wouldn't get wet while it was briefly submerged. Then we took a small piece of tinder, which we had carefully saved in case we needed it when the sun was unavailable, and we also rolled up some dry grass and a few chips. Using a little bow and drill like the ones we had described earlier, we made another bundle and wrapped it in coconut cloth. When everything was ready, we set aside our clothes except for our trousers, which we kept on since we weren't sure how rough the rocks would be.
Then we advanced to the edge of the rocks—Jack carrying one bundle, with the torch; I the other, with the things for producing fire.
Then we moved to the edge of the rocks—Jack carrying one bundle with the torch; I had the other, with the items for making fire.
“Now don’t weary for us, Peterkin, should we be gone some time,” said Jack. “We’ll be sure to return in half-an-hour at the very latest, however interesting the cave should be, that we may relieve your mind.”
“Now don’t worry about us, Peterkin, if we’re gone for a while,” said Jack. “We’ll definitely be back in half an hour at the latest, no matter how interesting the cave is, so that you can stop worrying.”
“Farewell!” said Peterkin, coming up to us with a look of deep but pretended solemnity, while he shook hands and kissed each of us on the cheek—“farewell! And while you are gone I shall repose my weary limbs under the shelter of this bush, and meditate on the changefulness of all things earthly, with special reference to the forsaken condition of a poor shipwrecked sailor-boy!” So saying, Peterkin waved his hand, turned from us, and cast himself upon the ground with a look of melancholy resignation, which was so well feigned that I would have thought it genuine had he not accompanied it with a gentle wink. We both laughed, and springing from the rocks together, plunged head first into the sea.
“Goodbye!” said Peterkin, coming over to us with a look of deep but fake seriousness, while shaking hands and kissing each of us on the cheek—“goodbye! And while you’re away, I’ll rest my tired limbs under this bush and think about how everything in life changes, especially the sad state of a poor shipwrecked sailor-boy!” With that, Peterkin waved his hand, turned away from us, and dropped down to the ground with a look of sorrowful resignation that was so convincingly acted that I would have believed it was real if he hadn’t followed it up with a little wink. We both laughed and, jumping off the rocks together, dove headfirst into the sea.
We gained the interior of the submarine cave without difficulty, and on emerging from the waves, supported ourselves for some time by treading water, while we held the two bundles above our heads. This we did in order to let our eyes become accustomed to the obscurity. Then, when we could see sufficiently, we swam to a shelving rock, and landed in safety. Having wrung the water from our trousers, and dried ourselves as well as we could under the circumstances, we proceeded to ignite the torch. This we accomplished without difficulty in a few minutes; and no sooner did it flare up than we were struck dumb with the wonderful objects that were revealed to our gaze. The roof of the cavern just above us seemed to be about ten feet high, but grew higher as it receded into the distance until it was lost in darkness. It seemed to be made of coral, and was supported by massive columns of the same material. Immense icicles (as they appeared to us) hung from it in various places. These, however, were formed, not of ice, but of a species of limestone, which seemed to flow in a liquid form towards the point of each, where it became solid. A good many drops fell, however, to the rock below, and these formed little cones, which rose to meet the points above. Some of them had already met, and thus we saw how the pillars were formed, which at first seemed to us as if they had been placed there by some human architect to support the roof. As we advanced farther in we saw that the floor was composed of the same material as the pillars, and it presented the curious appearance of ripples such as are formed on water when gently ruffled by the wind. There were several openings on either hand in the walls that seemed to lead into other caverns, but these we did not explore at this time. We also observed that the ceiling was curiously marked in many places, as if it were the fretwork of a noble cathedral; and the walls, as well as the roof, sparkled in the light of our torch, and threw back gleams and flashes as if they were covered with precious stones. Although we proceeded far into this cavern, we did not come to the end of it; and we were obliged to return more speedily than we would otherwise have done, as our torch was nearly expended. We did not observe any openings in the roof, or any indications of places whereby light might enter; but near the entrance to the cavern stood an immense mass of pure-white coral rock, which caught and threw back the little light that found an entrance through the cave’s mouth, and thus produced, we conjectured, the pale-green object which had first attracted our attention. We concluded, also, that the reflecting power of this rock was that which gave forth the dim light that faintly illumined the first part of the cave.
We easily entered the submarine cave, and as we came up from the waves, we kept ourselves afloat for a while by treading water while holding the two bundles above our heads. We did this to let our eyes adjust to the darkness. Once we could see well enough, we swam to a sloping rock and safely got out. After wringing the water from our pants and drying ourselves as best as we could under the circumstances, we got to work lighting the torch. We managed to do that in just a few minutes, and as soon as it flared up, we were stunned by the amazing sights it revealed. The ceiling of the cave above us looked to be about ten feet high, but it rose higher as it moved back into the distance until it disappeared into darkness. It seemed to be made of coral and was supported by massive columns of the same material. Huge icicles (or at least that's how they appeared to us) hung from it in various spots. However, these weren’t made of ice but of a type of limestone, which seemed to flow in a liquid form toward the tips, where it solidified. Many droplets fell onto the rock below, forming little cones that rose to meet the points above. Some of them had already connected, showing us how the pillars were formed, which at first looked like they were placed there by some human architect to support the ceiling. As we went further in, we saw that the floor was made of the same material as the pillars, presenting a curious ripple effect similar to what happens on water when it’s gently disturbed by the wind. There were several openings on either side in the walls that seemed to lead into other caverns, but we didn’t explore those at this time. We also noticed that the ceiling was intricately marked in many spots, reminiscent of the detailed work found in a grand cathedral; and the walls, as well as the ceiling, sparkled in our torchlight, reflecting glimmers as if they were covered in precious stones. Although we ventured deep into the cave, we didn’t reach its end, and we had to turn back sooner than we would have liked since our torch was nearly burnt out. We didn’t see any openings in the ceiling or any signs of places for light to enter, but near the cave entrance stood a massive chunk of pure white coral rock that reflected the little light coming through the cave’s mouth. This created, we guessed, the pale green object that had initially caught our attention. We also concluded that the reflectiveness of this rock was what provided the dim light faintly illuminating the first part of the cave.
Before diving through the passage again we extinguished the small piece of our torch that remained, and left it in a dry spot—conceiving that we might possibly stand in need of it if, at any future time, we should chance to wet our torch while diving into the cavern. As we stood for a few minutes after it was out, waiting till our eyes became accustomed to the gloom, we could not help remarking the deep, intense stillness and the unutterable gloom of all around us; and as I thought of the stupendous dome above, and the countless gems that had sparkled in the torchlight a few minutes before, it came into my mind to consider how strange it is that God should make such wonderful and exquisitely beautiful works never to be seen at all—except, indeed, by chance visitors such as ourselves.
Before we went through the passage again, we turned off the last bit of our torch and left it in a dry spot, thinking we might need it if we accidentally got our torch wet while diving into the cavern later. As we stood there for a few minutes after it was out, waiting for our eyes to adjust to the darkness, we couldn’t help but notice the deep silence and overwhelming gloom surrounding us. As I thought about the massive dome above and the countless gems that had sparkled in the torchlight just moments earlier, it struck me how strange it is that God creates such amazing and beautiful things only to be seen by chance visitors like us.
I afterwards found that there were many such caverns among the islands of the South Seas, some of them larger and more beautiful than the one I have just described.
I later discovered that there were many of these caves among the islands of the South Seas, some larger and more beautiful than the one I just described.
“Now, Ralph, are you ready?” said Jack in a low voice, that seemed to echo up into the dome above.
“Hey, Ralph, are you ready?” Jack said in a quiet voice that seemed to echo up into the dome above.
“Quite ready.”
"All set."
“Come along, then,” said he; and plunging off the ledge of the rock into the water, we dived through the narrow entrance. In a few seconds we were panting on the rocks above, and receiving the congratulations of our friend Peterkin.
“Come on, then,” he said; and jumping off the edge of the rock into the water, we dove through the narrow entrance. In a few seconds, we were gasping on the rocks above, receiving congratulations from our friend Peterkin.
Chapter Fourteen.
Strange peculiarity of the tides—Also of the twilight—Peterkin’s remarkable conduct in embracing a little pig and killing a big sow—Sage remarks on jesting—Also on love.
It was quite a relief to us to breathe the pure air and to enjoy the glad sunshine after our long ramble in the Diamond Cave, as we named it; for although we did not stay more than half-an-hour away, it seemed to us much longer. While we were dressing, and during our walk home, we did our best to satisfy the curiosity of poor Peterkin, who seemed to regret, with lively sincerity, his inability to dive.
It was a huge relief for us to breathe the fresh air and enjoy the warm sunshine after our long walk in the Diamond Cave, as we called it; even though we hadn’t been gone more than half an hour, it felt much longer to us. While we were getting ready and on our way home, we tried our best to satisfy Peterkin's curiosity, who seemed genuinely upset about not being able to dive.
There was no help for it, however, so we condoled with him as we best could. Had there been any great rise or fall in the tide of these seas, we might perhaps have found it possible to take him down with us at low water; but as the tide never rose or fell more than eighteen inches or two feet, this was impossible.
There was no way around it, so we comforted him as best as we could. If there had been a significant change in the tide of these waters, we might have been able to take him with us at low tide; but since the tide only changed by about eighteen inches to two feet, that wasn’t possible.
This peculiarity of the tide—its slight rise and fall—had not attracted our observation till some time after our residence on the island. Neither had we observed another curious circumstance until we had been some time there. This was the fact that the tide rose and fell with constant regularity, instead of being affected by the changes of the moon as in our own country, and as it is in most other parts of the world—at least, in all those parts with which I am acquainted. Every day and every night, at twelve o’clock precisely, the tide is at the full; and at six o’clock, every morning and evening, it is ebb. I can speak with much confidence on this singular circumstance, as we took particular note of it, and never found it to alter. Of course I must admit we had to guess the hour of twelve midnight, and I think we could do this pretty correctly; but in regard to twelve noon we are quite positive, because we easily found the highest point that the sun reached in the sky by placing ourselves at a certain spot whence we observed the sharp summit of a cliff resting against the sky, just where the sun passed.
This weird thing about the tide—it’s slight rise and fall—hadn't caught our attention until a while after we had settled on the island. We also hadn't noticed another strange occurrence until we had been there for some time. This was the fact that the tide rose and fell with consistent regularity, instead of being influenced by the moon's phases like it is back home and in most other places I know of. Every day and every night, precisely at twelve o’clock, the tide is at its highest; and at six o’clock, every morning and evening, it goes out. I can speak confidently about this oddity, as we paid close attention to it and never saw it change. Of course, I have to admit we had to guess the hour of twelve midnight, and I think we could figure that out pretty accurately; but as for twelve noon, we are completely sure because we easily identified the highest point the sun reached in the sky by positioning ourselves at a spot where we could see the sharp peak of a cliff against the sky, just where the sun was located.
Jack and I were surprised that we had not noticed this the first few days of our residence here, and could only account for it by our being so much taken up with the more obvious wonders of our novel situation. I have since learned, however, that this want of observation is a sad and very common infirmity of human nature, there being hundreds of persons before whose eyes the most wonderful things are passing every day who nevertheless, are totally ignorant of them. I therefore have to record my sympathy with such persons, and to recommend to them a course of conduct which I have now for a long time myself adopted—namely, the habit of forcing my attention upon all things that go on around me, and of taking some degree of interest in them whether I feel it naturally or not. I suggest this the more earnestly, though humbly, because I have very frequently come to know that my indifference to a thing has generally been caused by my ignorance in regard to it.
Jack and I were surprised that we hadn’t noticed this in the first few days of living here, and we could only explain it by how focused we were on the more obvious wonders of our new surroundings. However, I’ve since learned that this lack of observation is a sad and very common flaw in human nature; there are hundreds of people who have amazing things happening right in front of them every day, yet they are completely unaware of it. So, I feel sympathy for those people, and I want to recommend a practice that I’ve adopted for a long time—specifically, the habit of paying attention to everything happening around me and trying to take an interest in it, whether I feel it naturally or not. I suggest this earnestly, though modestly, because I’ve often realized that my indifference toward something has usually been due to my ignorance about it.
We had much serious conversation on this subject of the tides; and Jack told us, in his own quiet, philosophical way, that these tides did great good to the world in many ways, particularly in the way of cleansing the shores of the land, and carrying off the filth that was constantly poured into the sea therefrom—which, Peterkin suggested, was remarkably tidy of it to do. Poor Peterkin could never let slip an opportunity to joke, however inopportune it might be, which at first we found rather a disagreeable propensity, as it often interrupted the flow of very agreeable conversation—and, indeed, I cannot too strongly record my disapprobation of this tendency in general; but we became so used to it at last that we found it no interruption whatever. Indeed, strange to say, we came to feel that it was a necessary part of our enjoyment (such is the force of habit), and found the sudden outbursts of mirth, resulting from his humorous disposition, quite natural and refreshing to us in the midst of our more serious conversations. But I must not misrepresent Peterkin. We often found, to our surprise, that he knew many things which we did not; and I also observed that those things which he learned from experience were never forgotten. From all these things I came at length to understand that things very opposite and dissimilar in themselves, when united, do make an agreeable whole; as, for example, we three on this our island, although most unlike in many things, when united, made a trio so harmonious that I question if there ever met before such an agreeable triumvirate. There was, indeed, no note of discord whatever in the symphony we played together on that sweet Coral Island; and I am now persuaded that this was owing to our having been all tuned to the same key—namely, that of love! Yes, we loved one another with much fervency while we lived on that island; and, for the matter of that, we love each other still.
We had a lot of serious talks about the tides, and Jack shared, in his calm, thoughtful way, that these tides were very beneficial to the world in various ways, especially in cleaning the shores and carrying away the waste that continually flowed into the sea—which Peterkin noted was pretty tidy of them. Poor Peterkin could never pass up a chance to make a joke, no matter how untimely it might be. At first, we found this tendency rather annoying since it often disrupted our enjoyable conversations, and I can't emphasize enough how much I disapproved of this habit in general. However, we eventually got used to it and found that it didn't interrupt us at all. In fact, oddly enough, we started to see it as a necessary part of our enjoyment (such is the power of habit), and the sudden bursts of laughter from his humorous nature felt quite natural and refreshing amid our more serious discussions. But I don't want to misrepresent Peterkin. We often discovered, to our surprise, that he knew a lot of things we didn't, and I noticed that he never forgot the lessons he learned from experience. From all this, I eventually realized that very different and opposing things, when combined, can create a pleasing whole; for instance, the three of us on our island, despite our many differences, formed such a harmonious trio that I doubt any other agreeable triumvirate has ever come together before. There was truly no dissonance in the symphony we created together on that beautiful Coral Island; and I now believe this was because we were all in sync with the same key—namely, that of love! Yes, we loved each other deeply while we lived on that island, and, as a matter of fact, we still love each other.
And while I am on this subject, or rather the subject that just preceded it—namely, the tides—I may here remark on another curious natural phenomenon. We found that there was little or no twilight in this island. We had a distinct remembrance of the charming long twilight at home, which some people think the most delightful part of the day—though, for my part, I have always preferred sunrise; and when we first landed, we used to sit down on some rocky point or eminence, at the close of our day’s work, to enjoy the evening breeze, but no sooner had the sun sunk below the horizon than all became suddenly dark. This rendered it necessary that we should watch the sun when we happened to be out hunting; for to be suddenly left in the dark while in the woods was very perplexing, as, although the stars shone with great beauty and brilliancy, they could not pierce through the thick umbrageous boughs that interlaced above our heads.
And while I'm on this topic, or actually the topic that just came before it—specifically, the tides—I should mention another interesting natural phenomenon. We noticed that there was hardly any twilight on this island. We had a clear memory of the lovely long twilight back home, which some people consider the most delightful time of day—though I’ve always preferred sunrise. When we first arrived, we would sit on some rocky point or higher ground at the end of our day’s work to enjoy the evening breeze, but as soon as the sun dipped below the horizon, it would suddenly get dark. This made it essential for us to keep an eye on the sun while we were out hunting; being unexpectedly stuck in the dark in the woods was quite disorienting because, although the stars shone beautifully and brightly, they couldn't break through the thick, interlaced branches above us.
But to return. After having told all we could to Peterkin about the Diamond Cave under Spouting Cliff, as we named the locality, we were wending our way rapidly homewards when a grunt and a squeal were borne down by the land breeze to our ears.
But to get back on track. After sharing everything we could with Peterkin about the Diamond Cave beneath Spouting Cliff, as we called the place, we were making our way quickly home when a grunt and a squeal drifted down to us on the land breeze.
“That’s the ticket!” was Peterkin’s remarkable exclamation as he started convulsively and levelled his spear.
“That’s it!” was Peterkin’s excited shout as he suddenly jumped and aimed his spear.
“Hist!” cried Jack; “these are your friends, Peterkin. They must have come over expressly to pay you a friendly visit, for it is the first time we have seen them on this side of the island.”
“Shh!” shouted Jack; “these are your friends, Peterkin. They must have come over just to pay you a friendly visit, since it’s the first time we’ve seen them on this side of the island.”
“Come along!” cried Peterkin, hurrying towards the wood; while Jack and I followed, smiling at his impatience.
“Come on!” shouted Peterkin, rushing towards the woods, while Jack and I followed, chuckling at his eagerness.
Another grunt and half-a-dozen squeals, much louder than before, came down the valley. At this time we were just opposite the small vale which lay between the Valley of the Wreck and Spouting Cliff.
Another grunt and half a dozen squeals, much louder than before, echoed down the valley. At this point, we were directly across from the small hollow that sat between the Valley of the Wreck and Spouting Cliff.
“I say, Peterkin!” cried Jack in a hoarse whisper.
“I say, Peterkin!” Jack exclaimed in a raspy whisper.
“Well, what is’t?”
“Well, what is it?”
“Stay a bit, man! These grunters are just up there on the hillside. If you go and stand with Ralph in the lee of yon cliff I’ll cut round behind and drive them through the gorge, so that you’ll have a better chance of picking out a good one. Now, mind you pitch into a fat young pig, Peterkin!” added Jack as he sprang into the bushes.
“Hang on for a sec, man! Those pigs are just up on the hill. If you go and stand with Ralph by that cliff, I’ll sneak around behind and drive them through the gorge, so you’ll have a better shot at picking out a good one. Now, make sure you go after a fat young pig, Peterkin!” added Jack as he jumped into the bushes.
“Won’t I, just!” said Peterkin, licking his lips, as we took our station beside the cliff. “I feel quite a tender affection for young pigs in my heart. Perhaps it would be more correct to say in my tum—”
“Of course I will!” said Peterkin, licking his lips, as we positioned ourselves next to the cliff. “I have a real soft spot for young pigs in my heart. Maybe it’s more accurate to say in my stomach—”
“There they come!” cried I as a terrific yell from Jack sent the whole herd screaming down the hill. Now Peterkin, being unable to hold back, crept a short way up a very steep grassy mound in order to get a better view of the hogs before they came up; and just as he raised his head above its summit, two little pigs, which had outrun their companions, rushed over the top with the utmost precipitation. One of these brushed close past Peterkin’s ear; the other, unable to arrest its headlong flight, went, as Peterkin himself afterwards expressed it, ‘bash’ into his arms with a sudden squeal, which was caused more by the force of the blow than the will of the animal, and both of them rolled violently down to the foot of the mound. No sooner was this reached than the little pig recovered its feet, tossed up its tail, and fled shrieking from the spot. But I slung a large stone after it, which, being fortunately well aimed, hit it behind the ear and felled it to the earth.
“There they come!” I shouted as a huge yell from Jack sent the whole herd screaming down the hill. Peterkin, not able to hold back, climbed a short way up a steep grassy mound to get a better look at the hogs before they arrived; and just as he raised his head over the top, two little pigs that had outrun their friends rushed over the peak at full speed. One of them brushed close past Peterkin’s ear; the other, unable to stop its wild dash, went, as Peterkin later put it, ‘bash’ into his arms with a sudden squeal, which was caused more by the impact than the pig’s intention, and both of them tumbled violently down to the bottom of the mound. As soon as they reached the bottom, the little pig got back on its feet, lifted its tail, and scrambled away screaming from the spot. But I threw a large stone after it, which, fortunately well aimed, hit it behind the ear and knocked it to the ground.
“Capital, Ralph! that’s your sort!” cried Peterkin, who, to my surprise and great relief, had risen to his feet apparently unhurt, though much dishevelled. He rushed frantically towards the gorge, which the yells of the hogs told us they were now approaching. I had made up my mind that I would abstain from killing another, as, if Peterkin should be successful, two were more than sufficient for our wants at the present time. Suddenly they all burst forth—two or three little round ones in advance, and an enormous old sow with a drove of hogs at her heels.
“Capital, Ralph! That’s your thing!” shouted Peterkin, who, to my surprise and great relief, was back on his feet looking fine, though a bit messy. He dashed frantically toward the gorge, where the screams of the hogs indicated they were getting closer. I had decided I wouldn’t kill another one, since if Peterkin succeeded, two would be more than enough for us right now. Suddenly, they all came out—two or three little ones leading the way, followed by a massive old sow with a herd of hogs trailing behind her.
“Now, Peterkin,” said I, “there’s a nice little fat one; just spear it.”
“Now, Peterkin,” I said, “there’s a nice little fatty; just spear it.”
But Peterkin did not move; he allowed it to pass unharmed. I looked at him in surprise, and saw that his lips were compressed and his eyebrows knitted, as if he were about to fight with some awful enemy.
But Peterkin didn’t move; he let it pass without any harm. I looked at him in surprise and saw that his lips were pressed together and his eyebrows were furrowed, as if he was about to confront some terrible foe.
“What is it?” I inquired with some trepidation.
“What is it?” I asked, a bit nervously.
Suddenly he levelled his spear, darted forward, and with a yell that nearly froze the blood in my veins, stabbed the old sow to the heart. Nay, so vigorously was it done that the spear went in at one side and came out at the other!
Suddenly, he aimed his spear, charged forward, and with a shout that nearly chilled my blood, stabbed the old sow in the heart. It was done with such force that the spear went in on one side and came out on the other!
“Oh Peterkin!” said I, going up to him, “what have you done?”
“Oh Peterkin!” I said, walking up to him, “what have you done?”
“Done? I’ve killed their great-great-grandmother, that’s all,” said he, looking with a somewhat awestruck expression at the transfixed animal.
“Done? I’ve killed their great-great-grandmother, that’s all,” he said, looking with a somewhat amazed expression at the stunned animal.
“Hallo! what’s this?” said Jack as he came up. “Why, Peterkin, you must be fond of a tough chop. If you mean to eat this old hog, she’ll try your jaws, I warrant. What possessed you to stick her, Peterkin?”
“Hey! What’s this?” said Jack as he approached. “Wow, Peterkin, you must really like a tough piece of meat. If you plan to eat this old pig, she’ll test your teeth, I bet. What made you decide to kill her, Peterkin?”
“Why, the fact is, I want a pair of shoes.”
“Honestly, I just want a pair of shoes.”
“What have your shoes to do with the old hog?” said I, smiling.
“What do your shoes have to do with the old pig?” I said, smiling.
“My present shoes have certainly nothing to do with her,” replied Peterkin; “nevertheless, she will have a good deal to do with my future shoes. The fact is, when I saw you floor that pig so neatly, Ralph, it struck me that there was little use in killing another. Then I remembered all at once that I had long wanted some leather or tough substance to make shoes of, and this old grandmother seemed so tough that I just made up my mind to stick her—and you see I’ve done it!”
“My current shoes definitely have nothing to do with her,” replied Peterkin; “however, she will play a significant role in my future shoes. The truth is, when I saw you take down that pig so skillfully, Ralph, it occurred to me that there wasn’t much point in killing another. Then it hit me all of a sudden that I had wanted some leather or a strong material to make shoes for a long time, and this old grandmother seemed tough enough that I just decided to use her—and as you can see, I’ve done it!”
“That you certainly have, Peterkin,” said Jack as he was examining the transfixed animal.
“That you definitely have, Peterkin,” said Jack as he looked closely at the frozen animal.
We now considered how we were to carry our game home, for, although the distance was short, the hog was very heavy. At length we hit on the plan of tying its four feet together, and passing the spear-handle between them. Jack took one end on his shoulder, I took the other on mine, and Peterkin carried the small pig.
We now thought about how we were going to carry our catch home, since even though it wasn’t far, the hog was really heavy. Eventually, we decided to tie its four feet together and run the spear handle between them. Jack put one end on his shoulder, I took the other on mine, and Peterkin carried the small pig.
Thus we returned in triumph to our bower, laden, as Peterkin remarked, with the glorious spoils of a noble hunt. As he afterwards spoke in similarly glowing terms in reference to the supper that followed, there is every reason to believe that we retired that night to our leafy beds in a high state of satisfaction.
Thus we returned in triumph to our hideout, loaded up, as Peterkin noted, with the glorious rewards of a great hunt. When he later spoke in the same enthusiastic way about the dinner that followed, it’s clear we went to sleep that night in our leafy beds feeling very satisfied.
Chapter Fifteen.
Boat-building extraordinary—Peterkin tries his hand at cookery, and fails most signally—The boat finished—Curious conversation with the cat, and other matters.
For many days after this, Jack applied himself with unremitting assiduity to the construction of our boat, which at length began to look something like one. But those only who have had the thing to do can entertain a right idea of the difficulty involved in such an undertaking, with no other implements than an axe, a bit of hoop-iron, a sail-needle, and a broken penknife. But Jack did it. He was of that disposition which will not be conquered. When he believed himself to be acting rightly, he overcame all obstacles. I have seen Jack, when doubtful whether what he was about to do were right or wrong, as timid and vacillating as a little girl; and I honour him for it!
For many days after that, Jack worked tirelessly on building our boat, which eventually started to resemble one. But only those who have done it can truly understand the challenges involved in such a project, with nothing but an axe, a piece of hoop-iron, a sail needle, and a broken penknife. But Jack made it happen. He had that kind of spirit that just won’t be defeated. When he thought he was doing the right thing, he pushed through all obstacles. I’ve seen Jack, when unsure whether what he was about to do was right or wrong, be as shy and indecisive as a little girl; and I admire him for that!
As this boat was a curiosity in its way, a few words here relative to the manner of its construction may not be amiss.
As this boat was interesting in its own way, a few words about how it was built might not be out of place.
I have already mentioned the chestnut-tree with its wonderful buttresses or planks. This tree, then, furnished us with the chief part of our material. First of all, Jack sought out a limb of a tree of such a form and size as, while it should form the keel, a bend at either end should form the stem and stern-posts. Such a piece, however, was not easy to obtain; but at last he procured it by rooting up a small tree which had a branch growing at the proper angle about ten feet up its stem, with two strong roots growing in such a form as enabled him to make a flat-sterned boat. This placed, he procured three branching roots of suitable size, which he fitted to the keel at equal distances, thus forming three strong ribs. Now the squaring and shaping of these, and the cutting of the grooves in the keel, was an easy enough matter, as it was all work for the axe, in the use of which Jack was become wonderfully expert; but it was quite a different affair when he came to nailing the ribs to the keel, for we had no instrument capable of boring a large hole, and no nails to fasten them with. We were, indeed, much perplexed here; but Jack at length devised an instrument that served very well. He took the remainder of our hoop-iron and beat it into the form of a pipe or cylinder, about as thick as a man’s finger. This he did by means of our axe and the old rusty axe we had found at the house of the poor man at the other side of the island. This, when made red hot, bored slowly through the timbers; and the better to retain the heat, Jack shut up one end of it and filled it with sand. True, the work was very slowly done; but it mattered not—we had little else to do. Two holes were bored in each timber, about an inch and a half apart, and also down into the keel, but not quite through. Into these were placed stout pegs made of a tree called iron-wood, and when they were hammered well home, the timbers were as firmly fixed as if they had been nailed with iron. The gunwales, which were very stout, were fixed in a similar manner. But besides the wooden nails, they were firmly lashed to the stem and stern-posts and ribs by means of a species of cordage which we had contrived to make out of the fibrous husk of the cocoa-nut. This husk was very tough, and when a number of the threads were joined together they formed excellent cordage. At first we tied the different lengths together; but this was such a clumsy and awkward complication of knots that we contrived, by careful interlacing of the ends together before twisting, to make good cordage of any size or length we chose. Of course it cost us much time and infinite labour; but Jack kept up our spirits when we grew weary, and so all that we required was at last constructed.
I’ve already mentioned the chestnut tree with its amazing buttresses or planks. This tree provided us with most of our materials. First, Jack looked for a limb of a tree that would work for the keel, with bends at both ends to make the stem and stern posts. Finding a suitable piece wasn’t easy, but eventually, he dug up a small tree with a branch growing at the right angle about ten feet up, and two strong roots that allowed him to create a flat-sterned boat. Once that was in place, he found three branching roots of the right size and attached them to the keel at equal distances, making three strong ribs. Squaring and shaping these, along with cutting grooves in the keel, was straightforward since it only required an axe, which Jack had become really skilled at using. However, nailing the ribs to the keel was quite a challenge since we had no tools for boring large holes and no nails to secure them with. We were definitely stuck at this point, but Jack eventually came up with a tool that worked well. He took what was left of our hoop iron and shaped it into a pipe or cylinder about the thickness of a finger. He did this using our axe and an old rusty axe we had found at the house of a poor man on the other side of the island. When he heated it until it was red hot, it slowly bored through the wood; to keep the heat in, Jack closed one end and filled it with sand. Sure, the work was slow going, but it didn’t matter—nothing else to do. Two holes were drilled into each timber, about an inch and a half apart, and also into the keel, but not all the way through. Sturdy pegs made from a tree called ironwood were inserted into these holes, and when pounded in, the timbers were firmly secured as if they had been nailed with iron. The gunwales, which were very strong, were attached in the same way. In addition to the wooden pegs, they were tightly tied to the stem and stern posts and ribs using a kind of cord we made from the fibrous husk of the coconut. This husk was very tough, and when several threads were joined together, they made excellent cord. Initially, we tied the different lengths together, but this resulted in a messy and complicated knot situation, so we learned to carefully intertwine the ends before twisting to create good cord of any size or length we needed. It took a lot of time and effort, but Jack kept our spirits up when we got tired, and eventually we made everything we needed.
Planks were now cut off the chestnut-trees of about an inch thick. These were dressed with the axe—but clumsily, for an axe is ill-adapted for such work. Five of these planks on each side were sufficient; and we formed the boat in a very rounded, barrel-like shape, in order to have as little twisting of the planks as possible, for although we could easily bend them, we could not easily twist them. Having no nails to rivet the planks with, we threw aside the ordinary fashion of boat-building and adopted one of our own. The planks were therefore placed on each other’s edges, and sewed together with the tough cordage already mentioned; they were also thus sewed to the stem, the stern, and the keel. Each stitch or tie was six inches apart, and was formed thus: Three holes were bored in the upper plank and three in the lower, the holes being above each other—that is, in a vertical line. Through these holes the cord was passed, and when tied, formed a powerful stitch of three-ply. Besides this, we placed between the edges of the planks layers of cocoa-nut fibre, which, as it swelled when wetted, would, we hoped, make our little vessel water-tight. But in order further to secure this end, we collected a large quantity of pitch from the bread-fruit tree, with which, when boiled in our old iron pot, we paid the whole of the inside of the boat, and while it was yet hot, placed large pieces of cocoa-nut cloth on it, and then gave it another coat above that. Thus the interior was covered with a tough, water-tight material; while the exterior, being uncovered, and so exposed to the swelling action of the water, was, we hoped, likely to keep the boat quite dry. I may add that our hopes were not disappointed.
Planks were now cut from the chestnut trees, about an inch thick. These were shaped with an axe—but not very well, since an axe isn't great for that kind of work. Five planks on each side were enough, and we built the boat in a rounded, barrel-like shape to minimize twisting of the planks. While we could easily bend them, twisting was much harder. Since we didn't have nails to fasten the planks, we set aside the usual method of boat-building and came up with our own. The planks were stacked on top of each other, and sewn together with the strong cordage mentioned earlier; they were also sewn to the bow, the stern, and the keel. Each stitch was six inches apart and was created like this: Three holes were drilled in the upper plank and three in the lower, aligned vertically. The cord was threaded through these holes, and when tied, it created a strong, three-ply stitch. Additionally, we placed layers of coconut fiber between the edges of the planks, which we hoped would swell when wet and make our little boat water-tight. To further secure this, we collected a large amount of pitch from the breadfruit tree and, after boiling it in our old iron pot, coated the entire inside of the boat. While it was still hot, we added large pieces of coconut cloth on top, then gave it another layer. This way, the interior was covered with a tough, water-tight material; while the outside remained exposed to the water, we hoped it would keep the boat dry. I can add that our hopes were not disappointed.
While Jack was thus engaged, Peterkin and I sometimes assisted him; but as our assistance was not much required, we more frequently went a-hunting on the extensive mud-flats at the entrance of the long valley which lay nearest to our bower. Here we found large flocks of ducks of various kinds, some of them bearing so much resemblance to the wild ducks of our own country that I think they must have been the same. On these occasions we took the bow and the sling, with both of which we were often successful, though I must confess that I was the least so. Our suppers were thus pleasantly varied, and sometimes we had such a profusion spread out before us that we frequently knew not with which of the dainties to begin.
While Jack was busy with his work, Peterkin and I sometimes helped him; but since he didn't need our help much, we often went hunting on the wide mudflats at the entrance of the long valley closest to our shelter. There, we found large flocks of ducks of different types, some of which looked so much like the wild ducks from our own country that I think they must have been the same. On these trips, we brought along the bow and the sling, and we often succeeded, although I have to admit that I was the least successful. Our dinners were happily varied, and sometimes we had such a large spread that we often didn't know which of the treats to start with.
I must also add that the poor old cat which we had brought home had always a liberal share of our good things; and so well was it looked after, especially by Peterkin, that it recovered much of its former strength, and seemed to improve in sight as well as hearing.
I should also mention that the poor old cat we brought home always got its fair share of our treats; and it was cared for so well, especially by Peterkin, that it regained much of its previous strength and even seemed to improve in both sight and hearing.
The large flat stone, or rock of coral, which stood just in front of the entrance to our bower, was our table. On this rock we had spread out the few articles we possessed the day we were shipwrecked; and on the same rock, during many a day afterwards, we spread out the bountiful supply with which we had been blessed on our Coral Island. Sometimes we sat down at this table to a feast consisting of hot rolls—as Peterkin called the newly baked bread-fruit—a roast pig, roast duck, boiled and roasted yams, cocoa-nuts, taro, and sweet potatoes; which we followed up with a dessert of plums, apples, and plantains—the last being a large-sized and delightful fruit, which grew on a large shrub or tree not more than twelve feet high, with light-green leaves of enormous length and breadth. These luxurious feasts were usually washed down with cocoa-nut lemonade.
The large flat stone, or coral rock, that stood right in front of the entrance to our shelter, was our table. On this rock, we laid out the few items we had when we were shipwrecked; and on that same rock, for many days afterward, we displayed the generous supplies we had been blessed with on our Coral Island. Sometimes, we gathered at this table for a feast that included hot rolls—what Peterkin called the freshly baked bread-fruit—a roast pig, roast duck, boiled and roasted yams, coconuts, taro, and sweet potatoes; which we topped off with a dessert of plums, apples, and plantains—the last being a large and delicious fruit that grew on a large shrub or tree no more than twelve feet tall, with long and wide light-green leaves. These indulgent feasts were usually washed down with coconut lemonade.
Occasionally Peterkin tried to devise some new dish—“a conglomerate,” as he used to say; but these generally turned out such atrocious compounds that he was ultimately induced to give up his attempts in extreme disgust—not forgetting, however, to point out to Jack that his failure was a direct contradiction to the proverb which he (Jack) was constantly thrusting down his throat—namely, that “where there’s a will there’s a way.” For he had a great will to become a cook, but could by no means find a way to accomplish that end.
Occasionally, Peterkin tried to come up with some new dish—“a mix,” as he used to say—but these usually ended up being such terrible combinations that he eventually got so disgusted that he gave up trying. However, he made sure to remind Jack that his failure went against the saying that Jack was always insisting on—“where there’s a will, there’s a way.” He had a strong desire to become a cook, but couldn't find a way to make it happen.
One day, while Peterkin and I were seated beside our table, on which dinner was spread, Jack came up from the beach, and flinging down his axe, exclaimed:
One day, while Peterkin and I were sitting by our table, with dinner laid out, Jack came up from the beach and dropped his axe, shouting:
“There, lads, the boat’s finished at last! So we’ve nothing to do now but shape two pair of oars, and then we may put to sea as soon as we like.”
“There, guys, the boat’s finally done! So we just need to make two pairs of oars, and then we can set out to sea whenever we want.”
This piece of news threw us into a state of great joy; for although we were aware that the boat had been gradually getting near its completion, it had taken so long that we did not expect it to be quite ready for at least two or three weeks. But Jack had wrought hard and said nothing, in order to surprise us.
This news filled us with immense joy; even though we knew the boat was getting closer to being finished, it had taken so long that we didn’t expect it to be ready for at least two or three weeks. But Jack had worked hard and kept quiet, just to surprise us.
“My dear fellow,” cried Peterkin, “you’re a perfect trump! But why did you not tell us it was so nearly ready? Won’t we have a jolly sail to-morrow, eh?”
“My dear friend,” shouted Peterkin, “you’re absolutely amazing! But why didn’t you let us know it was almost ready? Aren’t we going to have a great sail tomorrow, huh?”
“Don’t talk so much, Peterkin,” said Jack; “and, pray, hand me a bit of that pig.”
“Stop talking so much, Peterkin,” said Jack; “and, please, pass me a piece of that pig.”
“Certainly, my dear,” cried Peterkin, seizing the axe. “What part will you have? A leg, or a wing, or a piece of the breast—which?”
“Of course, my dear,” exclaimed Peterkin, grabbing the axe. “What part do you want? A leg, a wing, or a piece of the breast—which one?”
“A hind leg, if you please,” answered Jack; “and, pray, be so good as to include the tail.”
“A hind leg, if you don’t mind,” replied Jack; “and please make sure to include the tail.”
“With all my heart,” said Peterkin, exchanging the axe for his hoop-iron knife, with which he cut off the desired portion. “I’m only too glad, my dear boy, to see that your appetite is so wholesale, and there’s no chance whatever of its dwindling down into re-tail again—at least, in so far as this pig is concerned.—Ralph, lad, why don’t you laugh, eh?” he added, turning suddenly to me with a severe look of inquiry.
“With all my heart,” said Peterkin, swapping the axe for his hoop-iron knife, with which he cut off the part he wanted. “I’m really glad, my dear boy, to see your appetite is so huge, and there’s no chance of it shrinking back down—at least not with this pig. Ralph, why aren’t you laughing, huh?” he added, turning suddenly to me with a serious look of curiosity.
“Laugh!” said I. “What at, Peterkin? Why should I laugh?”
“Laugh!” I said. “What should I laugh at, Peterkin? Why would I laugh?”
Both Jack and Peterkin answered this inquiry by themselves laughing so immoderately that I was induced to believe I had missed noticing some good joke, so I begged that it might be explained to me; but as this only produced repeated roars of laughter, I smiled and helped myself to another slice of plantain.
Both Jack and Peterkin responded to this question by laughing so hard that I thought I must have missed some inside joke, so I asked them to explain it to me; but this just led to more bursts of laughter, so I smiled and took another slice of plantain.
“Well, but,” continued Peterkin, “I was talking of a sail to-morrow. Can’t we have one, Jack?”
“Well, but,” Peterkin continued, “I was talking about a sail tomorrow. Can’t we go for one, Jack?”
“No,” replied Jack, “we can’t have a sail; but I hope we shall have a row, as I intend to work hard at the oars this afternoon, and if we can’t get them finished by sunset, we’ll light our candle-nuts, and turn them out of hands before we turn into bed.”
“No,” Jack replied, “we can’t have a sail; but I hope we can row, as I plan to put in a lot of effort at the oars this afternoon, and if we can’t finish them by sunset, we’ll light our candle-nuts and finish up before we go to bed.”
“Very good,” said Peterkin, tossing a lump of pork to the cat, who received it with a mew of satisfaction. “I’ll help you, if I can.”
“Sounds great,” said Peterkin, tossing a piece of pork to the cat, who caught it with a pleased meow. “I’ll help you out if I can.”
“Afterwards,” continued Jack, “we will make a sail out of the cocoa-nut cloth, and rig up a mast; and then we shall be able to sail to some of the other islands, and visit our old friends the penguins.”
“After that,” Jack said, “we’ll make a sail out of the coconut fabric and set up a mast; then we’ll be able to sail to some of the other islands and visit our old friends, the penguins.”
The prospect of being so soon in a position to extend our observations to the other islands, and enjoy a sail over the beautiful sea, afforded us much delight, and after dinner we set about making the oars in good earnest. Jack went into the woods and blocked them roughly out with the axe, and I smoothed them down with the knife, while Peterkin remained in the bower spinning, or rather twisting, some strong, thick cordage with which to fasten them to the boat.
The chance to soon extend our observations to the other islands and enjoy a sail over the beautiful sea brought us a lot of joy. After dinner, we got serious about making the oars. Jack headed into the woods and roughly shaped them with the axe, while I smoothed them down with a knife. Peterkin stayed in the bower, spinning, or rather twisting, some strong, thick rope to secure them to the boat.
We worked hard and rapidly, so that when the sun went down Jack and I returned to the bower with four stout oars, which required little to be done to them save a slight degree of polishing with the knife. As we drew near we were suddenly arrested by the sound of a voice. We were not a little surprised at this—indeed, I may almost say alarmed; for although Peterkin was undoubtedly fond of talking, we had never, up to this time, found him talking to himself. We listened intently, and still heard the sound of a voice as if in conversation. Jack motioned me to be silent, and advancing to the bower on tiptoe, we peeped in.
We worked hard and quickly, so by the time the sun set, Jack and I returned to the shelter with four sturdy oars, which just needed a little polishing with a knife. As we got closer, we were suddenly stopped by the sound of a voice. We were quite surprised by this—actually, I’d almost say alarmed; because while Peterkin definitely enjoyed talking, we had never heard him talking to himself until now. We listened closely and could still hear a voice as if someone was having a conversation. Jack signaled me to be quiet, and carefully moving to the shelter on tiptoe, we peeked inside.
The sight that met our gaze was certainly not a little amusing. On the top of a log which we sometimes used as a table sat the black cat with a very demure expression on its countenance, and in front of it, sitting on the ground with his legs extended on either side of the log, was Peterkin. At the moment we saw him he was gazing intently into the cat’s face, with his nose about four inches from it, his hands being thrust into his breeches pockets.
The sight that greeted us was quite amusing. On top of a log that we sometimes used as a table sat the black cat, looking very prim and proper. In front of it, sitting on the ground with his legs spread on either side of the log, was Peterkin. At that moment, he was staring intently into the cat's face, with his nose just a few inches away, his hands shoved in his pants pockets.
“Cat,” said Peterkin, turning his head a little on one side, “I love you!”
“Cat,” Peterkin said, tilting his head slightly to one side, “I love you!”
There was a pause, as if Peterkin awaited a reply to this affectionate declaration. But the cat said nothing.
There was a pause, as if Peterkin was waiting for a response to this heartfelt statement. But the cat said nothing.
“Do you hear me?” cried Peterkin sharply. “I love you—I do! Don’t you love me?”
“Do you hear me?” Peterkin shouted. “I love you—I really do! Don’t you love me?”
To this touching appeal the cat said “mew” faintly.
To this heartfelt plea, the cat let out a soft "meow."
“Ah, that’s right! You’re a jolly old rascal! Why did you not speak at once, eh?” and Peterkin put forward his mouth and kissed the cat on the nose!
“Ah, that’s right! You’re a cheerful little rascal! Why didn’t you say something right away, huh?” and Peterkin puckered his lips and kissed the cat on the nose!
“Yes,” continued Peterkin after a pause, “I love you. D’you think I’d say so if I didn’t, you black villain? I love you because I’ve got to take care of you, and to look after you, and to think about you, and to see that you don’t die—”
“Yes,” continued Peterkin after a pause, “I love you. Do you think I’d say that if I didn’t, you black villain? I love you because I need to take care of you, look after you, think about you, and make sure you don’t die—”
“Mew, me-a-w!” said the cat.
“Mew, me-a-w!” said the cat.
“Very good,” continued Peterkin; “quite true, I have no doubt. But you’ve no right to interrupt me, sir. Hold your tongue till I have done speaking. Moreover, cat, I love you because you came to me the first time you ever saw me, and didn’t seem to be afraid, and appeared to be fond of me, though you didn’t know that I wasn’t going to kill you. Now that was brave, that was bold, and very jolly, old boy, and I love you for it—I do!”
“Very good,” continued Peterkin; “that's definitely true, no doubt about it. But you have no right to interrupt me, sir. Just wait until I’m finished. Besides, cat, I love you because you came to me the very first time you saw me, and you didn’t seem scared at all, and you acted like you liked me, even though you didn't know I wasn't going to hurt you. That was brave, that was bold, and really awesome, old boy, and I love you for it—I really do!”
Again there was a pause of a few minutes, during which the cat looked placid, and Peterkin dropped his eyes upon its toes as if in contemplation. Suddenly he looked up.
Again there was a pause of a few minutes, during which the cat looked calm, and Peterkin dropped his eyes onto its toes as if he were deep in thought. Suddenly, he looked up.
“Well, cat, what are you thinking about now? Won’t speak, eh? Now tell me: don’t you think it’s a monstrous shame that those two scoundrels, Jack and Ralph, should keep us waiting for our supper so long?”
“Well, cat, what are you thinking about now? Not going to talk, huh? Now tell me: don’t you think it’s a terrible shame that those two jerks, Jack and Ralph, are making us wait so long for our dinner?”
Here the cat arose, put up its back and stretched itself, yawned slightly, and licked the point of Peterkin’s nose!
Here the cat got up, arched its back and stretched, yawned a little, and licked the tip of Peterkin’s nose!
“Just so, old boy; you’re a clever fellow.—I really do believe the brute understands me!” said Peterkin, while a broad grin overspread his face as he drew back and surveyed the cat.
“Exactly, old chap; you’re quite sharp.—I honestly think the creature gets what I’m saying!” said Peterkin, a wide grin spreading across his face as he stepped back and looked at the cat.
At this point Jack burst into a loud fit of laughter. The cat uttered an angry fuff and fled, while Peterkin sprang up and exclaimed:
At this point, Jack burst into a loud laugh. The cat let out an irritated puff and ran off, while Peterkin jumped up and said:
“Bad luck to you, Jack! You’ve nearly made the heart jump out of my body, you have!”
“Bad luck to you, Jack! You almost gave me a heart attack!”
“Perhaps I have,” replied Jack, laughing, as we entered the bower; “but as I don’t intend to keep you or the cat any longer from your supper, I hope that you’ll both forgive me.”
“Maybe I have,” Jack laughed as we walked into the gazebo; “but since I don't want to keep you or the cat from your dinner any longer, I hope you can both forgive me.”
Peterkin endeavoured to turn this affair off with a laugh. But I observed that he blushed very deeply at the time we discovered ourselves, and he did not seem to relish any allusion to the subject afterwards; so we refrained from remarking on it ever after, though it tickled us not a little at the time.
Peterkin tried to brush off the whole thing with a laugh. But I noticed he turned red when we realized what had happened, and he didn't seem to like any mention of it afterward; so we decided not to bring it up again, even though it made us chuckle a bit at the time.
After supper we retired to rest, and to dream of wonderful adventures in our little boat and distant voyages upon the sea.
After dinner, we went to bed, dreaming of amazing adventures in our little boat and far-off journeys across the sea.
Chapter Sixteen.
The boat launched—We visit the coral reef—The great breaker that never goes down—Coral insects—The way in which coral islands are made—The boats sail—We tax our ingenuity to form fish-hooks—Some of the fish we saw—And a monstrous whale—Wonderful shower of little fish—Waterspouts.
It was a bright, clear, beautiful morning when we first launched our little boat and rowed out upon the placid waters of the lagoon. Not a breath of wind ruffled the surface of the deep. Not a cloud spotted the deep-blue sky. Not a sound that was discordant broke the stillness of the morning, although there were many sounds—sweet, tiny, and melodious—that mingled in the universal harmony of nature. The sun was just rising from the Pacific’s ample bosom, and tipping the mountain-tops with a red glow. The sea was shining like a sheet of glass, yet heaving with the long, deep swell that, all the world round, indicates the life of Ocean; and the bright seaweeds and the brilliant corals shone in the depths of that pellucid water, as we rowed over it, like rare and precious gems. Oh, it was a sight fitted to stir the soul of man to its profoundest depths! and if he owned a heart at all, to lift that heart in adoration and gratitude to the great Creator of this magnificent and glorious universe!
It was a bright, clear, beautiful morning when we first launched our little boat and rowed out onto the calm waters of the lagoon. Not a breath of wind disturbed the surface of the deep. Not a cloud marred the deep-blue sky. Not a jarring sound broke the stillness of the morning, although there were many sweet, tiny, and melodic sounds that blended into the universal harmony of nature. The sun was just rising from the vast ocean, casting a red glow on the mountain tops. The sea shimmered like a sheet of glass, yet surged with the long, deep swell that, all over the world, signifies the life of the Ocean; and the bright seaweeds and vibrant corals sparkled in the depths of that clear water as we rowed over them, like rare and precious gems. Oh, it was a sight that could stir a person's soul to its deepest depths! And if anyone had a heart at all, it would lift that heart in adoration and gratitude to the great Creator of this magnificent and glorious universe!
At first, in the strength of our delight, we rowed hither and thither without aim or object. But after the effervescence of our spirits was abated, we began to look about us and to consider what we should do.
At first, filled with joy, we rowed back and forth without any purpose. But as our excitement started to fade, we began to take notice of our surroundings and think about what we should do next.
“I vote that we row to the reef,” cried Peterkin.
“I say we should row to the reef,” shouted Peterkin.
“And I vote that we visit the islands within the lagoon,” said I.
“And I say we should visit the islands in the lagoon,” I said.
“And I vote we do both,” cried Jack; “so pull away, boys!”
“And I say we do both,” shouted Jack; “so let’s go for it, guys!”
As I have already said, we had made four oars; but our boat was so small that only two were necessary. The extra pair were reserved in case any accident should happen to the others. It was therefore only needful that two of us should row, while the third steered by means of an oar—and relieved the rowers occasionally.
As I mentioned before, we had made four oars, but our boat was so small that only two were needed. The extra pair was kept in case anything happened to the others. So, it was only necessary for two of us to row while the third steered with an oar and took turns relieving the rowers.
First we landed on one of the small islands and ran all over it, but saw nothing worthy of particular notice. Then we landed on a larger island, on which were growing a few cocoa-nut trees. Not having eaten anything that morning, we gathered a few of the nuts and breakfasted. After this we pulled straight out to sea, and landed on the coral reef.
First, we landed on one of the small islands and explored it, but didn't find anything noteworthy. Then we landed on a larger island with a few coconut trees. Since we hadn’t eaten anything that morning, we picked some of the nuts and had breakfast. After that, we headed straight out to sea and landed on the coral reef.
This was indeed a novel and interesting sight to us. We had now been so long on shore that we had almost forgotten the appearance of breakers, for there were none within the lagoon. But now, as we stood beside the foam-crested billow of the open sea, all the enthusiasm of the sailor was awakened in our breasts; and as we gazed on the widespread ruin of that single magnificent breaker that burst in thunder at our feet, we forgot the Coral Island behind us, we forgot our bower and the calm repose of the scented woods, we forgot all that had passed during the last few months, and remembered nothing but the storms, the calms, the fresh breezes, and the surging billows of the open sea.
This was definitely a fresh and exciting sight for us. We had been on land for so long that we had almost forgotten what waves looked like since there were none in the lagoon. But now, as we stood next to the foam-topped wave of the open sea, all the excitement of being sailors stirred within us; and as we watched the powerful crash of that single magnificent wave that thundered at our feet, we forgot about the Coral Island behind us, we forgot our shelter and the peaceful calm of the fragrant woods, we forgot everything that had happened over the last few months, and remembered nothing but the storms, the calm, the fresh breezes, and the rolling waves of the open sea.
This huge, ceaseless breaker, to which I have so often alluded, was a much larger and more sublime object than we had at all imagined it to be. It rose many yards above the level of the sea, and could be seen approaching at some distance from the reef. Slowly and majestically it came on, acquiring greater volume and velocity as it advanced, until it assumed the form of a clear watery arch, which sparkled in the bright sun. On it came with resistless and solemn majesty, the upper edge lipped gently over, and it fell with a roar that seemed as though the heart of Ocean were broken in the crash of tumultuous water, while the foam-clad coral reef appeared to tremble beneath the mighty shock!
This massive, relentless wave, which I’ve mentioned multiple times, turned out to be much larger and more impressive than we ever thought. It rose several yards above the sea level, and you could see it coming from a distance near the reef. It approached slowly and grandly, picking up size and speed as it moved forward, until it formed a clear, sparkling water arch under the bright sun. It kept coming with unstoppable, serious beauty, the top gently curling over, and when it crashed down, it roared as if the heart of the Ocean had broken in the tumult of the water, while the foam-covered coral reef seemed to shudder under the powerful impact!
We gazed long and wonderingly at this great sight, and it was with difficulty we could tear ourselves away from it. As I have once before mentioned, this wave broke in many places over the reef and scattered some of its spray into the lagoon; but in most places the reef was sufficiently broad and elevated to receive and check its entire force. In many places the coral rocks were covered with vegetation—the beginning, as it appeared to us, of future islands. Thus, on this reef, we came to perceive how most of the small islands of those seas are formed. On one part we saw the spray of the breaker washing over the rocks, and millions of little, active, busy creatures continuing the work of building up this living rampart. At another place, which was just a little too high for the waves to wash over it, the coral insects were all dead; for we found that they never did their work above water. They had faithfully completed the mighty work which their Creator had given them to do, and they were now all dead. Again, in other spots the ceaseless lashing of the sea had broken the dead coral in pieces, and cast it up in the form of sand. Here sea-birds had alighted, little pieces of seaweed and stray bits of wood had been washed up, seeds of plants had been carried by the wind, and a few lovely blades of bright green had already sprung up, which, when they died, would increase the size and fertility of these emeralds of Ocean. At other places these islets had grown apace, and were shaded by one or two cocoa-nut trees, which grew literally in the sand, and were constantly washed by the ocean spray—yet, as I have before remarked, their fruit was most refreshing and sweet to our taste.
We stared at this amazing sight for a long time, and it was hard to pull ourselves away from it. As I mentioned earlier, this wave broke in many spots over the reef, spraying some of its mist into the lagoon; but in most places, the reef was wide and high enough to absorb its full force. In many areas, the coral was covered with plants—the beginning of what seemed like future islands to us. On this reef, we realized how most small islands in those seas are formed. In one area, we saw the wave's spray washing over the rocks, while millions of tiny, busy creatures continued the work of building this living barrier. In another spot, which was just a bit too high for the waves to reach, the coral insects were all dead; we found that they never worked above water. They had faithfully completed the grand task their Creator set for them, and now they were all gone. In other areas, the relentless crashing of the sea had shattered the dead coral into pieces, turning it into sand. Here, seabirds had landed, little bits of seaweed and wood had washed ashore, plant seeds had arrived carried by the wind, and a few beautiful blades of bright green were already growing, which, when they died, would add to the size and richness of these gems of the ocean. In other places, these tiny islands had quickly grown, shaded by one or two coconut trees that literally grew in the sand and were constantly sprayed by the ocean—yet, as I mentioned before, their fruit was incredibly refreshing and sweet to us.
Again, at this time Jack and I pondered the formation of the large coral islands. We could now understand how the low ones were formed; but the larger islands cost us much consideration, yet we could arrive at no certain conclusion on the subject.
Again, at this time, Jack and I thought about how the large coral islands were created. We could now grasp how the smaller ones formed, but the bigger islands had us stumped; we just couldn't come to any definite conclusion about it.
Having satisfied our curiosity, and enjoyed ourselves during the whole day in our little boat, we returned, somewhat wearied, and withal rather hungry, to our bower.
Having satisfied our curiosity and enjoyed ourselves all day in our little boat, we returned, a bit tired and quite hungry, to our cozy spot.
“Now,” said Jack, “as our boat answers so well we will get a mast and sail made immediately.”
“Now,” Jack said, “since our boat works so well, we’ll get a mast and sail made right away.”
“So we will!” cried Peterkin as we all assisted to drag the boat above high-water mark. “We’ll light our candle and set about it this very night. Hurrah, my boys, pull away!”
“So we will!” shouted Peterkin as we all helped drag the boat above the high-water line. “We’ll light our candle and get started on it tonight. Hurrah, my boys, pull away!”
As we dragged our boat, we observed that she grated heavily on her keel; and as the sands were in this place mingled with broken coral rocks, we saw portions of the wood being scraped off.
As we pulled our boat, we noticed it was scraping hard against its keel; and since the sand in this area was mixed with broken coral rocks, we could see bits of wood getting worn away.
“Hallo!” cried Jack on seeing this, “that won’t do. Our keel will be worn off in no time at this rate.”
“Hey!” shouted Jack when he saw this, “that won’t work. Our keel will get worn down in no time at this pace.”
“So it will,” said I, pondering deeply as to how this might be prevented. But I am not of a mechanical turn naturally, so I could conceive no remedy save that of putting a plate of iron on the keel; but as we had no iron, I knew not what was to be done. “It seems to me, Jack,” I added, “that it is impossible to prevent the keel being worn off thus.”
“So it will,” I said, thinking hard about how to stop this from happening. But I'm not naturally good with mechanics, so the only solution I could think of was putting a plate of iron on the keel; but since we didn’t have any iron, I didn’t know what to do. “It seems to me, Jack,” I added, “that it’s impossible to prevent the keel from being worn down like this.”
“Impossible?” cried Peterkin. “My dear Ralph, you are mistaken; there is nothing so easy.”
“Impossible?” Peterkin exclaimed. “My dear Ralph, you’re wrong; it’s really quite simple.”
“How?” I inquired in some surprise.
“Seriously?” I asked, a bit surprised.
“Why, by not using the boat at all!” replied Peterkin.
“Why not just not use the boat at all!” replied Peterkin.
“Hold your impudent tongue, Peterkin!” said Jack as he shouldered the oars. “Come along with me, and I’ll give you work to do. In the first place, you will go and collect coca-nut fibre, and set to work to make sewing-twine with it—”
“Shut your mouth, Peterkin!” Jack said as he grabbed the oars. “Come with me, and I'll give you something to do. First, you’re going to collect coconut fiber and start making some sewing twine with it—”
“Please, captain,” interrupted Peterkin, “I’ve got lots of it made already—more than enough, as a little friend of mine used to be in the habit of saying every day after dinner.”
“Please, captain,” interrupted Peterkin, “I’ve already made plenty of it—more than enough, like a little friend of mine used to say every day after dinner.”
“Very well,” continued Jack; “then you’ll help Ralph to collect cocoa-nut cloth and cut it into shape, after which we’ll make a sail of it. I’ll see to getting the mast and the gearing; so let’s to work.”
“Alright,” Jack continued; “then you’ll help Ralph gather coconut fibers and shape them, after which we’ll make a sail out of it. I’ll handle getting the mast and the rigging; so let’s get to work.”
And to work we went right busily, so that in three days from that time we had set up a mast and sail, with the necessary rigging, in our little boat. The sail was not, indeed, very handsome to look at, as it was formed of a number of oblong patches of cloth; but we had sewed it well by means of our sail-needle, so that it was strong, which was the chief point.—Jack had also overcome the difficulty about the keel by pinning to it a false keel. This was a piece of tough wood, of the same length and width as the real keel, and about five inches deep. He made it of this depth because the boat would be thereby rendered not only much more safe, but more able to beat against the wind—which, in a sea where the trade-winds blow so long and so steadily in one direction, was a matter of great importance. This piece of wood was pegged very firmly to the keel; and we now launched our boat with the satisfaction of knowing that when the false keel should be scraped off we could easily put on another,—whereas, should the real keel have been scraped away, we could not have renewed it without taking our boat to pieces, which Peterkin said made his “marrow quake to think upon.”
And we got to work right away, so that in three days we had set up a mast and sail, along with the necessary rigging, on our little boat. The sail wasn't exactly beautiful, as it was made of several rectangular patches of cloth, but we had sewn it up well with our sail needle, making it strong, which was the most important thing. Jack had also solved the problem with the keel by attaching a false keel to it. This was a sturdy piece of wood, the same length and width as the real keel, and about five inches deep. He made it this deep because it would make the boat not only safer but also more capable of sailing against the wind—which was really important in an area where the trade winds blow steadily in one direction. This piece of wood was securely fastened to the keel, and we launched our boat knowing that when the false keel wore down, we could easily replace it—unlike the real keel, which if worn away would have required us to take the boat apart, something that made Peterkin feel quite uneasy to think about.
The mast and sail answered excellently; and we now sailed about in the lagoon with great delight, and examined with much interest the appearance of our island from a distance. Also, we gazed into the depths of the water, and watched for hours the gambols of the curious and bright-coloured fish among the corals and seaweed. Peterkin also made a fishing-line; and Jack constructed a number of hooks, some of which were very good, others remarkably bad. Some of these hooks were made of iron-wood—which did pretty well, the wood being extremely hard—and Jack made them very thick and large. Fish there are not particular. Some of the crooked bones in fish-heads also answered for this purpose pretty well. But that which formed our best and most serviceable hook was the brass finger-ring belonging to Jack. It gave him not a little trouble to manufacture it. First he cut it with the axe, then twisted it into the form of a hook. The barb took him several hours to cut. He did it by means of constant sawing with the broken penknife. As for the point, an hour’s rubbing on a piece of sandstone made an excellent one.
The mast and sail worked perfectly, and we happily sailed around the lagoon, taking great interest in how our island looked from afar. We also peered into the depths of the water, watching the playful, colorful fish among the corals and seaweed for hours. Peterkin made a fishing line, while Jack created several hooks, some of which were pretty good and others quite poor. Some of the hooks were made from ironwood, which worked well since the wood is really hard, and Jack made them thick and large. Fish aren’t picky. Some bent bones from fish heads also worked pretty well for this. But our best and most useful hook was Jack's brass finger ring. He had quite a bit of trouble making it. First, he cut it with an axe and then shaped it into a hook. It took him several hours to create the barb by constantly sawing with his broken penknife. As for the point, an hour of rubbing it on a piece of sandstone made it excellent.
It would be a matter of much time and labour to describe the appearance of the multitudes of fish that were day after day drawn into our boat by means of the brass hook. Peterkin always caught them—for we observed that he derived much pleasure from fishing—while Jack and I found ample amusement in looking on, also in gazing down at the coral groves, and in baiting the hook. Among the fish that we saw, but did not catch, were porpoises and swordfish, whales and sharks. The porpoises came frequently into our lagoon in shoals, and amused us not a little by their bold leaps into the air and their playful gambols in the sea. The swordfish were wonderful creatures—some of them apparently ten feet in length, with an ivory spear six or eight feet long projecting from their noses. We often saw them darting after other fish, and no doubt they sometimes killed them with their ivory swords. Jack remembered having heard once of a swordfish attacking a ship, which seemed strange indeed; but as they are often in the habit of attacking whales, perhaps it mistook the ship for one. This swordfish ran against the vessel with such force that it drove its sword quite through the thick planks; and when the ship arrived in harbour, long afterwards, the sword was found still sticking in it!
It would take a lot of time and effort to describe the countless fish that were caught in our boat day after day with the brass hook. Peterkin always caught them—since we noticed he really enjoyed fishing—while Jack and I found plenty of fun just watching, looking down at the coral groves, and baiting the hook. Among the fish we saw but didn’t catch were porpoises and swordfish, whales, and sharks. The porpoises often came into our lagoon in groups, entertaining us with their daring leaps into the air and playful antics in the sea. The swordfish were amazing creatures—some of them appeared to be ten feet long, with an ivory spear six or eight feet long sticking out of their noses. We often saw them darting after other fish, and they likely sometimes killed them with their ivory swords. Jack recalled hearing about a swordfish attacking a ship, which seemed very strange; but since they often attack whales, maybe it mistook the ship for one. This swordfish rammed into the vessel with such force that it drove its sword right through the thick planks; and when the ship finally made it to harbor, the sword was still stuck in it!
Sharks did not often appear; but we took care never again to bathe in deep water without leaving one of our number in the boat, to give us warning if he should see a shark approaching. As for the whales, they never came into our lagoon; but we frequently saw them spouting in the deep water beyond the reef. I shall never forget my surprise the first day I saw one of these huge monsters close to me. We had been rambling about on the reef during the morning, and were about to re-embark in our little boat to return home, when a loud blowing sound caused us to wheel rapidly round. We were just in time to see a shower of spray falling, and the flukes or tail of some monstrous fish disappear in the sea a few hundred yards off. We waited some time to see if he would rise again. As we stood, the sea seemed to open up at our very feet; an immense spout of water was sent with a snort high into the air, and the huge, blunt head of a sperm-whale rose before us. It was so large that it could easily have taken our little boat, along with ourselves, into its mouth! It plunged slowly back into the sea, like a large ship foundering, and struck the water with its tail so forcibly as to cause a sound like a cannon-shot.
Sharks didn't show up often, but we made sure never to swim in deep water again without leaving someone in the boat to warn us if they spotted a shark coming. As for whales, they never entered our lagoon, but we frequently saw them spouting in the deep water beyond the reef. I'll never forget my surprise the first day I saw one of those huge creatures up close. We had been wandering around on the reef in the morning and were about to get back in our little boat to head home when a loud blowing sound made us turn quickly. We barely caught a glimpse of spray falling and the tail of a gigantic fish disappearing into the sea a few hundred yards away. We waited for a while to see if it would surface again. As we stood there, the sea seemed to part right in front of us; an enormous spout of water shot up high into the air with a snort, and the huge, blunt head of a sperm whale appeared before us. It was so big that it could have easily swallowed our little boat and us along with it! It slowly sank back into the sea, like a large ship sinking, and hit the water with its tail so hard that it made a sound like a cannon shot.
We also saw a great number of flying-fish, although we caught none; and we noticed that they never flew out of the water except when followed by their bitter foe the dolphin, from whom they thus endeavoured to escape. But of all the fish that we saw, none surprised us so much as those that we used to find in shallow pools after a shower of rain; and this not on account of their appearance, for they were ordinary-looking and very small, but on account of their having descended in a shower of rain! We could account for them in no other way, because the pools in which we found these fish were quite dry before the shower, and at some distance above high-water mark. Jack, however, suggested a cause which seemed to me very probable. We used often to see waterspouts in the sea. A waterspout is a whirling body of water, which rises from the sea like a sharp-pointed pillar. After rising a good way, it is met by a long tongue, which comes down from the clouds; and when the two have joined, they look something like an hour-glass. The waterspout is then carried by the wind—sometimes gently, sometimes with violence—over the sea, sometimes up into the clouds; and then, bursting asunder, it descends in a deluge. This often happens over the land as well as over the sea; and it sometimes does much damage, but frequently it passes gently away. Now, Jack thought that the little fish might perhaps have been carried up in a waterspout, and so sent down again in a shower of rain. But we could not be certain as to this point, yet we thought it likely.
We also saw a lot of flying fish, although we didn’t catch any; and we noticed that they only jumped out of the water when they were being chased by their main enemy, the dolphin, which is how they tried to escape. But of all the fish we saw, none amazed us more than those we used to find in shallow puddles after a rainstorm; not because of how they looked, since they were ordinary and very small, but because they seemed to have fallen from the sky in the rain! We couldn’t explain it any other way, because the puddles where we found these fish were totally dry before the rain, and quite a bit above high tide. Jack, however, suggested a reason that seemed very plausible to me. We often saw waterspouts at sea. A waterspout is a spinning column of water that rises from the sea like a pointed pillar. After it rises a good distance, it meets a long tendril that comes down from the clouds; and when the two connect, they can look something like an hourglass. The waterspout is then blown by the wind—sometimes gently, sometimes violently—over the sea, sometimes up into the clouds; and then, bursting apart, it falls down in a downpour. This can happen over land as well as over the sea; it can cause a lot of damage, but often it just passes quietly. Now, Jack thought that the little fish might have been sucked up by a waterspout and then dropped back down during the rain. But we couldn’t be completely sure about this, though we thought it was likely.
During these delightful fishing and boating excursions we caught a good many eels, which we found to be very good to eat. We also found turtles among the coral rocks, and made excellent soup in our iron kettle. Moreover, we discovered many shrimps and prawns, so that we had no lack of variety in our food; and, indeed, we never passed a week without making some new and interesting discovery of some sort or other, either on the land or in the sea.
During these enjoyable fishing and boating trips, we caught quite a few eels, which turned out to be really tasty. We also found turtles among the coral rocks and made delicious soup in our iron kettle. Plus, we discovered many shrimp and prawns, so we always had a variety of food. In fact, we never went a week without making some new and interesting discovery of some kind, whether on land or at sea.
Chapter Seventeen.
A monster wave and its consequences—The boat lost and found—Peterkin’s terrible accident—Supplies of food for a voyage in the boat—We visit Penguin Island, and are amazed beyond measure—Account of the penguins.
One day, not long after our little boat was finished, we were sitting on the rocks at Spouting Cliff, and talking of an excursion which we intended to make to Penguin Island the next day.
One day, not long after we finished our little boat, we were sitting on the rocks at Spouting Cliff, talking about our planned trip to Penguin Island the next day.
“You see,” said Peterkin, “it might be all very well for a stupid fellow like me to remain here and leave the penguins alone; but it would be quite inconsistent with your characters as philosophers to remain any longer in ignorance of the habits and customs of these birds, so the sooner we go the better.”
“You see,” said Peterkin, “it might be fine for a clueless guy like me to stay here and leave the penguins alone; but it wouldn’t be right for you as philosophers to stay ignorant of the habits and customs of these birds, so the sooner we go, the better.”
“Very true,” said I. “There is nothing I desire so much as to have a closer inspection of them.”
“Absolutely,” I said. “There’s nothing I want more than to take a closer look at them.”
“And I think,” said Jack, “that you had better remain at home, Peterkin, to take care of the cat; for I’m sure the hogs will be at it in your absence, out of revenge for your killing their great-grandmother so recklessly.”
“And I think,” Jack said, “that you should stay home, Peterkin, to look after the cat; I’m sure the pigs will go after it while you’re gone, just out of spite for you recklessly killing their great-grandmother.”
“Stay at home!” cried Peterkin. “My dear fellow, you would certainly lose your way, or get upset, if I were not there to take care of you.”
“Stay home!” shouted Peterkin. “My friend, you’d definitely get lost or stressed out if I weren’t here to look after you.”
“Ah, true!” said Jack gravely; “that did not occur to me. No doubt you must go. Our boat does require a good deal of ballast; and all that you say, Peterkin, carries so much weight with it that we won’t need stones if you go.”
“Ah, right!” said Jack seriously; “I hadn’t thought of that. You definitely have to go. Our boat needs a lot of weight to balance it, and everything you say, Peterkin, is so important that we won’t need any rocks if you leave.”
Now, while my companions were talking, a notable event occurred, which, as it is not generally known, I shall be particular in recording here.
Now, while my friends were chatting, something significant happened that isn't widely known, so I’ll make sure to note it here.
While we were talking, as I have said, we noticed a dark line, like a low cloud or fog-bank, on the seaward horizon. The day was a fine one, though cloudy, and a gentle breeze was blowing; but the sea was not rougher, or the breaker on the reef higher, than usual. At first we thought that this looked like a thundercloud, and as we had had a good deal of broken weather of late, accompanied by occasional peals of thunder, we supposed that a storm must be approaching. Gradually, however, this line seemed to draw nearer without spreading up over the sky, as would certainly have been the case if it had been a storm-cloud. Still nearer it came, and soon we saw that it was moving swiftly towards the island; but there was no sound till it reached the islands out at sea. As it passed these islands we observed, with no little anxiety, that a cloud of white foam encircled them, and burst in spray into the air; it was accompanied by a loud roar. This led us to conjecture that the approaching object was an enormous wave of the sea; but we had no idea how large it was till it came near to ourselves. When it approached the outer reef, however, we were awestruck with its unusual magnitude; and we sprang to our feet, and clambered hastily up to the highest point of the precipice, under an indefinable feeling of fear.
While we were talking, as I mentioned, we noticed a dark line, like a low cloud or fog, on the horizon over the sea. It was a nice day, though cloudy, with a gentle breeze blowing; but the sea wasn’t rougher, or the waves crashing on the reef higher, than usual. At first, we thought it looked like a thunderstorm, and since we had experienced quite a bit of bad weather recently, with occasional thunder, we assumed a storm was on the way. Gradually, though, this line seemed to come closer without spreading out over the sky, which would have happened if it had been a storm cloud. It kept getting closer, and soon we saw that it was moving quickly toward the island; but there was no sound until it reached the islands far out at sea. As it passed these islands, we noticed with growing concern that a cloud of white foam surrounded them and burst into spray in the air, accompanied by a loud roar. This made us think that the approaching object was an enormous wave; but we had no idea how big it was until it got close to us. When it reached the outer reef, however, we were stunned by its massive size; we jumped to our feet and hurried up to the highest point of the cliff, feeling an indescribable sense of fear.
I have said before that the reef opposite Spouting Cliff was very near to the shore, while just in front of the bower it was at a considerable distance out to sea. Owing to this formation, the wave reached the reef at the latter point before it struck at the foot of Spouting Cliff. The instant it touched the reef we became aware, for the first time, of its awful magnitude. It burst completely over the reef at all points with a roar that seemed louder to me than thunder, and this roar continued for some seconds while the wave rolled gradually along towards the cliff on which we stood. As its crest reared before us we felt that we were in great danger, and turned to flee; but we were too late. With a crash that seemed to shake the solid rock, the gigantic billow fell, and instantly the spouting-holes sent up a gush of waterspouts with such force that they shrieked on issuing from their narrow vents. It seemed to us as if the earth had been blown up with water. We were stunned and confused by the shock, and so drenched and blinded with spray that we knew not for a few moments whither to flee for shelter. At length we all three gained an eminence beyond the reach of the water. But what a scene of devastation met our gaze as we looked along the shore! This enormous wave not only burst over the reef, but continued its way across the lagoon, and fell on the sandy beach of the island with such force that it passed completely over it and dashed into the woods, levelling the smaller trees and bushes in its headlong course.
I’ve mentioned before that the reef in front of Spouting Cliff was really close to the shore, while right in front of the bower, it was a good distance out to sea. Because of this setup, the wave hit the reef at that point before it crashed at the base of Spouting Cliff. The moment it hit the reef, we realized for the first time how enormous it was. It exploded over the reef at all points with a roar that sounded louder to me than thunder, and this roar continued for several seconds as the wave rolled gradually toward the cliff where we stood. When its crest rose up in front of us, we felt we were in serious danger and turned to run; but it was too late. With a crash that shook the solid rock, the massive wave fell, and instantly the spouting holes launched a surge of waterspouts with such force that they screamed as they burst from their narrow openings. It felt like the ground had been blown up with water. We were stunned and disoriented by the impact, and completely drenched and blinded by spray that we had no idea for a few moments where to escape for shelter. Finally, the three of us managed to find a higher spot out of the water's reach. But what a scene of destruction greeted us as we looked along the shore! This massive wave not only crashed over the reef, but it also traveled across the lagoon and hit the sandy beach of the island with such force that it completely washed over it and charged into the woods, flattening the smaller trees and bushes in its reckless path.
On seeing this, Jack said he feared our bower must have been swept away, and that the boat, which was on the beach, must have been utterly destroyed. Our hearts sank within us as we thought of this, and we hastened round through the woods towards our home. On reaching it we found, to our great relief of mind, that the force of the wave had been expended just before reaching the bower; but the entrance to it was almost blocked up by the torn-up bushes and tangled heaps of seaweed. Having satisfied ourselves as to the bower, we hurried to the spot where the boat had been left; but no boat was there. The spot on which it had stood was vacant, and no sign of it could we see on looking around us.
On seeing this, Jack said he was worried our shelter must have been swept away, and that the boat, which was on the beach, must have been completely destroyed. Our hearts sank as we thought about it, and we rushed through the woods towards home. When we reached it, we were greatly relieved to find that the force of the wave had been spent just before it hit the shelter; however, the entrance was nearly blocked by uprooted bushes and tangled piles of seaweed. After checking on the shelter, we hurried to where the boat had been left, but there was no boat in sight. The spot where it had been was empty, and we couldn’t see any sign of it looking around.
“It may have been washed up into the woods,” said Jack, hurrying up the beach as he spoke. Still no boat was to be seen, and we were about to give ourselves over to despair when Peterkin called to Jack and said:
“It might have been washed ashore into the woods,” said Jack, rushing up the beach as he spoke. Still, no boat was in sight, and we were just about to give in to despair when Peterkin shouted to Jack and said:
“Jack, my friend, you were once so exceedingly sagacious and wise as to make me acquainted with the fact that cocoa-nuts grow upon trees. Will you now be so good as to inform me what sort of fruit that is growing on the top of yonder bush? for I confess to being ignorant, or at least doubtful, on the point.”
“Jack, my friend, you were once incredibly smart and wise to let me know that coconuts grow on trees. Could you now be kind enough to tell me what kind of fruit is growing on top of that bush over there? I have to admit I’m not sure, or at least I’m uncertain about it.”
We looked towards the bush indicated, and there, to our surprise, beheld our little boat snugly nestled among the leaves. We were very much overjoyed at this, for we would have suffered any loss rather than the loss of our boat. We found that the wave had actually borne the boat on its crest from the beach into the woods, and there launched it into the heart of this bush, which was extremely fortunate; for had it been tossed against a rock or a tree, it would have been dashed to pieces, whereas it had not received the smallest injury. It was no easy matter, however, to get it out of the bush and down to the sea again. This cost us two days of hard labour to accomplish.
We looked toward the bush pointed out to us, and there, to our surprise, saw our little boat snugly tucked among the leaves. We were thrilled about this because we would have preferred to lose anything else rather than our boat. We discovered that the wave had actually carried the boat on its crest from the beach into the woods and launched it into the middle of this bush, which was incredibly fortunate; if it had been thrown against a rock or a tree, it would have been wrecked, but it wasn’t harmed at all. However, getting it out of the bush and back down to the sea was no easy task. It took us two days of hard work to achieve it.
We had also much ado to clear away the rubbish from before the bower, and spent nearly a week in constant labour ere we got the neighbourhood to look as clean and orderly as before; for the uprooted bushes and seaweed that lay on the beach formed a more dreadfully confused-looking mass than one who had not seen the place after the inundation could conceive.
We also had a lot of trouble clearing away the debris from in front of the bower and spent almost a week working tirelessly to make the area look as clean and organized as it did before. The uprooted bushes and seaweed on the beach created a much more chaotic sight than anyone who hadn’t seen the place after the flood could imagine.
Before leaving the subject I may mention, for the sake of those who interest themselves in the curious natural phenomena of our world, that this gigantic wave occurs regularly on some of the islands of the Pacific once, and sometimes twice, in the year. I heard this stated by the missionaries during my career in those seas. They could not tell me whether it visited all of the islands, but I was certainly assured that it occurred periodically in some of them.
Before I move on, I want to mention for those who are interested in the intriguing natural phenomena of our world that this massive wave happens regularly on some Pacific islands once, and sometimes twice, a year. I heard this from the missionaries during my time in those waters. They couldn’t say if it affected all the islands, but they assured me that it definitely happened periodically on some of them.
After we had got our home put to rights, and cleared of the débris of the inundation, we again turned our thoughts to paying the penguins a visit. The boat was therefore overhauled and a few repairs done. Then we prepared a supply of provisions, for we intended to be absent at least a night or two—perhaps longer. This took us some time to do; for, while Jack was busy with the boat, Peterkin was sent into the woods to spear a hog or two, and had to search long, sometimes, ere he found them. Peterkin was usually sent on this errand when we wanted a pork chop (which was not seldom), because he was so active and could run so wonderfully fast that he found no difficulty in overtaking the hogs; but being dreadfully reckless, he almost invariably tumbled over stumps and stones in the course of his wild chase, and seldom returned home without having knocked the skin off his shins. Once, indeed, a more serious accident happened to him. He had been out all the morning alone, and did not return at the usual time to dinner. We wondered at this, for Peterkin was always very punctual at the dinner-hour. As supper-time drew near we began to be anxious about him, and at length sallied forth to search the woods. For a long time we sought in vain; but a little before dark we came upon the tracks of the hogs, which we followed up until we came to the brow of a rather steep bank or precipice. Looking over this, we beheld Peterkin lying in a state of insensibility at the foot, with his cheek resting on the snout of a little pig, which was pinned to the earth by the spear. We were dreadfully alarmed, but hastened to bathe his forehead with water, and had soon the satisfaction of seeing him revive. After we had carried him home, he related to us how the thing had happened.
After we got our home back in order and cleaned up the mess from the flood, we shifted our focus to visiting the penguins. So, we checked the boat and made a few repairs. Then we packed some supplies because we planned to be away for at least a night or two—maybe longer. This took us some time; while Jack was busy with the boat, Peterkin was sent into the woods to hunt a hog or two, which sometimes took him a while to find. Peterkin usually went on this mission when we wanted pork chops (which was often) because he was so quick and could easily catch up to the hogs. But he was incredibly reckless, often tripping over stumps and stones during his wild chase, and he rarely came back without scraped shins. Once, he even had a more serious accident. He had been out all morning by himself and didn’t return at the usual time for dinner. We were puzzled by this since Peterkin was always on time. As supper approached, we started to worry about him, and finally went out to look for him in the woods. We searched for a long time without success, but just before dark, we found some hog tracks and followed them to the edge of a steep bank. Looking over, we saw Peterkin lying unconscious at the bottom, with his cheek resting on the snout of a little pig, which was pinned to the ground by his spear. We were really worried but quickly rushed to splash water on his face, and soon we were relieved to see him wake up. After we took him home, he told us how it all happened.
“You must know,” said he, “I walked about all the forenoon, till I was as tired as an old donkey, without seeing a single grunter—not so much as a track of one; but as I was determined not to return empty-handed, I resolved to go without my dinner, and—”
“You should know,” he said, “I walked around all morning until I was as exhausted as an old donkey, without seeing a single pig—not even a footprint; but since I was determined not to come back empty-handed, I decided to skip lunch, and—”
“What!” exclaimed Jack, “did you really resolve to do that?”
“What!” shouted Jack, “did you actually decide to do that?”
“Now, Jack, hold your tongue,” returned Peterkin. “I say that I resolved to forego my dinner and to push to the head of the small valley, where I felt pretty sure of discovering the hogs. I soon found that I was on the right scent, for I had scarcely walked half-a-mile in the direction of the small plum-tree we found there the other day when a squeak fell on my ear. ‘Ho, ho,’ said I, ‘there you go, my boys;’ and I hurried up the glen. I soon started them, and singling out a fat pig, ran tilt at him. In a few seconds I was up with him, and stuck my spear right through his dumpy body. Just as I did so, I saw that we were on the edge of a precipice—whether high or low, I knew not; but I had been running at such a pace that I could not stop, so the pig and I gave a howl in concert and went plunging over together. I remembered nothing more after that till I came to my senses, and found you bathing my temples, and Ralph wringing his hands over me.”
“Now, Jack, be quiet,” Peterkin replied. “I decided to skip dinner and head to the top of the small valley, where I was pretty sure I’d find the pigs. I quickly realized I was on the right track because I hadn’t even walked half a mile toward that little plum tree we discovered the other day when I heard a squeak. ‘Ho, ho,’ I said, ‘there you are, guys;’ and I hurried up the glen. I soon spotted them, and zeroing in on a fat pig, I chased after him. Within seconds, I caught up and drove my spear straight through his chubby body. Just as I did that, I noticed we were on the edge of a cliff—whether it was high or low, I had no idea; but I was running so fast that I couldn’t stop, so the pig and I both screamed and went tumbling over together. I didn’t remember anything after that until I came to and found you cooling my forehead, while Ralph was wringing his hands over me.”
But although Peterkin was often unfortunate in the way of getting tumbles, he was successful on the present occasion in hunting, and returned before evening with three very nice little hogs. I also was successful in my visit to the mud-flats, where I killed several ducks. So that when we launched and loaded our boat at sunrise the following morning, we found our store of provisions to be more than sufficient. Part had been cooked the night before, and on taking note of the different items, we found the account to stand thus:
But even though Peterkin often had bad luck and would trip over things, he did really well this time while hunting and came back before evening with three nice little pigs. I was also successful on my trip to the mud-flats, where I shot several ducks. So when we launched and loaded our boat at sunrise the next morning, we discovered that we had more than enough supplies. Some of it had been cooked the night before, and when we listed what we had, it looked like this:
10 Bread-fruits (two baked, eight unbaked).
20 Yams (six roasted, the rest raw).
6 Taro-roots.
50 Fine large plums.
6 Cocoa-nuts, ripe.
6 Ditto, green (for drinking).
4 Large ducks and two small ones, raw.
3 Cold roast pigs, with stuffing.
10 breadfruits (two baked, eight raw).
20 yams (six roasted, the rest uncooked).
6 taro roots.
50 large, quality plums.
6 ripe coconuts.
6 young coconuts (for drinking).
4 large ducks and two small ones, raw.
3 cold roast pigs, with stuffing.
I may here remark that the stuffing had been devised by Peterkin specially for the occasion. He kept the manner of its compounding a profound secret, so I cannot tell what it was; but I can say, with much confidence, that we found it to be atrociously bad, and after the first tasting, scraped it carefully out and threw it overboard. We calculated that this supply would last us for several days; but we afterwards found that it was much more than we required, especially in regard to the cocoa-nuts, of which we found large supplies wherever we went. However, as Peterkin remarked, it was better to have too much than too little, as we knew not to what straits we might be put during our voyage.
I should mention that Peterkin specially created the stuffing for this occasion. He kept the ingredients a complete secret, so I can't say what it was; but I can confidently say that it was absolutely terrible, and after the first taste, we carefully scraped it out and tossed it overboard. We thought this supply would last us for several days, but we later discovered that we had way more than we needed, especially with the coconuts, which we found in large quantities wherever we went. However, as Peterkin pointed out, it’s better to have too much than too little since we didn’t know what difficulties we might face during our journey.
It was a very calm, sunny morning when we launched forth and rowed over the lagoon towards the outlet in the reef, and passed between the two green islets that guarded the entrance. We experienced some difficulty and no little danger in passing the surf of the breaker, and shipped a good deal of water in the attempt; but once past the billow, we found ourselves floating placidly on the long, oily swell that rose and fell slowly as it rolled over the wide ocean.
It was a really calm, sunny morning when we set off and rowed across the lagoon toward the opening in the reef, passing between the two green islets that protected the entrance. We faced some challenges and quite a bit of danger navigating the surf of the breaker, and we took on a lot of water during the attempt. But once we got past the wave, we found ourselves peacefully floating on the long, smooth swell that rose and fell slowly as it rolled over the vast ocean.
Penguin Island lay on the other side of our own island, at about a mile beyond the outer reef, and we calculated that it must be at least twenty miles distant by the way we should have to go. We might, indeed, have shortened the way by coasting round our island inside of the lagoon, and going out at the passage in the reef nearly opposite to Penguin Island; but we preferred to go by the open sea—first, because it was more adventurous, and secondly, because we should have the pleasure of again feeling the motion of the deep, which we all loved very much, not being liable to sea-sickness.
Penguin Island was on the other side of our island, about a mile past the outer reef, and we figured it must be at least twenty miles away based on the route we would take. We could have made the trip shorter by staying inside the lagoon and going out through the passage in the reef that was nearly opposite Penguin Island; however, we chose to take the open sea route—first, because it was more adventurous, and second, because we wanted to enjoy the feeling of the deep water again, which we all loved since we weren't prone to seasickness.
“I wish we had a breeze,” said Jack.
“I wish we had a breeze,” said Jack.
“So do I,” cried Peterkin, resting on his oar and wiping his heated brow; “pulling is hard work. Oh dear, if we could only catch a hundred or two of these gulls, tie them to the boat with long strings, and make them fly as we want them, how capital it would be!”
“Same here,” shouted Peterkin, stopping to rest on his oar and wiping his sweating forehead. “Rowing is tough. Oh man, if we could just catch a hundred or so of these seagulls, tie them to the boat with long strings, and make them fly the way we want, that would be amazing!”
“Or bore a hole through a shark’s tail and reeve a rope through it, eh?” remarked Jack. “But, I say, it seems that my wish is going to be granted, for here comes a breeze. Ship your oar, Peterkin.—Up with the mast, Ralph; I’ll see to the sail. Mind your helm; look out for squalls!”
“Or punch a hole through a shark’s tail and thread a rope through it, right?” Jack said. “But hey, it looks like my wish is about to come true because here comes a breeze. Stow your oar, Peterkin.—Raise the mast, Ralph; I’ll take care of the sail. Keep an eye on the helm; watch out for squalls!”
This last speech was caused by the sudden appearance of a dark-blue line on the horizon, which, in an incredibly short space of time, swept down on us, lashing up the sea in white foam as it went. We presented the stern of the boat to its first violence, and in a few seconds it moderated into a steady breeze, to which we spread our sail and flew merrily over the waves. Although the breeze died away soon afterwards, it had been so stiff while it lasted that we were carried over the greater part of our way before it fell calm again; so that when the flapping of the sail against the mast told us that it was time to resume the oars, we were not much more than a mile from Penguin Island.
This last speech was triggered by the sudden appearance of a dark-blue line on the horizon, which quickly approached us, whipping up the sea into white foam as it came. We turned the back of the boat to face its initial force, and in just a few seconds, it settled into a steady breeze, allowing us to spread our sail and glide joyfully over the waves. Although the breeze faded soon after, it had been strong enough while it lasted that we had covered most of our distance before it fell calm again; so by the time the sail started flapping against the mast, signaling it was time to switch back to the oars, we were only about a mile away from Penguin Island.
“There go the soldiers!” cried Peterkin as we came in sight of it. “How spruce their white trousers look this morning! I wonder if they will receive us kindly?—D’you think they are hospitable, Jack?”
“There go the soldiers!” shouted Peterkin as we spotted them. “Their white trousers look so sharp this morning! I wonder if they’ll welcome us nicely? Do you think they’re friendly, Jack?”
“Don’t talk, Peterkin, but pull away, and you shall see shortly.”
“Don’t say anything, Peterkin, just pull away, and you’ll see soon.”
As we drew near to the island, we were much amused by the manoeuvres and appearance of these strange birds. They seemed to be of different species: for some had crests on their heads, while others had none; and while some were about the size of a goose, others appeared nearly as large as a swan. We also saw a huge albatross soaring above the heads of the penguins. It was followed and surrounded by numerous flocks of sea-gulls. Having approached to within a few yards of the island, which was a low rock, with no other vegetation on it than a few bushes, we lay on our oars and gazed at the birds with surprise and pleasure, they returning our gaze with interest. We now saw that their soldierlike appearance was owing to the stiff erect manner in which they sat on their short legs—“bolt-upright,” as Peterkin expressed it. They had black heads, long, sharp beaks, white breasts, and bluish backs. Their wings were so short that they looked more like the fins of a fish, and indeed we soon saw that they used them for the purpose of swimming under water. There were no quills on these wings, but a sort of scaly feathers, which also thickly covered their bodies. Their legs were short, and placed so far back that the birds, while on land, were obliged to stand quite upright in order to keep their balance; but in the water they floated like other water-fowl. At first we were so stunned with the clamour which they and other sea-birds kept up around us that we knew not which way to look, for they covered the rocks in thousands; but as we continued to gaze, we observed several quadrupeds (as we thought) walking in the midst of the penguins.
As we got closer to the island, we were really entertained by the movements and appearance of these unusual birds. They seemed to be different species: some had crests on their heads, while others did not; some were about the size of a goose, while others were nearly as large as a swan. We also spotted a large albatross soaring above the penguins, surrounded by flocks of seagulls. After getting just a few yards from the island, which was a low rock with only a few bushes on it, we stopped rowing and watched the birds with amazement and delight, and they seemed to look back at us with curiosity. We then noticed that their soldier-like appearance was due to the stiff, upright way they sat on their short legs—“bolt-upright,” as Peterkin put it. They had black heads, long, sharp beaks, white chests, and bluish backs. Their wings were so short that they looked more like fish fins, and we soon realized they used them for swimming underwater. There were no quills on their wings, just a kind of scaly feathers that also covered their bodies. Their legs were short and positioned so far back that the birds had to stand quite upright on land to keep their balance, but in the water, they floated like other waterfowl. At first, we were overwhelmed by the noise from them and other seabirds all around us, not knowing where to look since they covered the rocks in the thousands; but as we continued to watch, we noticed several creatures (or so we thought) walking among the penguins.
“Pull in a bit,” cried Peterkin, “and let’s see what these are. They must be fond of noisy company to consort with such creatures.”
“Pull in a little,” shouted Peterkin, “and let’s check these out. They must enjoy loud company to hang out with such creatures.”
To our surprise, we found that these were no other than penguins which had gone down on all fours, and were crawling among the bushes on their feet and wings, just like quadrupeds. Suddenly one big old bird, that had been sitting on a point very near to us, gazing in mute astonishment, became alarmed, and scuttling down the rocks, plumped or fell, rather than ran, into the sea. It dived in a moment, and, a few seconds afterwards, came out of the water far ahead with such a spring, and such a dive back into the sea again, that we could scarcely believe it was not a fish that had leaped in sport.
To our surprise, we discovered that these were no other than penguins that had gone down on all fours, crawling through the bushes on their feet and wings, just like mammals. Suddenly, one large old bird, which had been sitting on a nearby ledge, staring in silent amazement, got scared and scampered down the rocks, plopping, or rather falling, into the sea instead of running. It dove in immediately, and a few seconds later, it jumped out of the water far ahead with such a spring and such a dive back into the sea again that we could hardly believe it wasn’t a fish that had jumped in play.
“That beats everything!” said Peterkin, rubbing his nose, and screwing up his face with an expression of exasperated amazement. “I’ve heard of a thing being neither fish, flesh, nor fowl; but I never did expect to live to see a brute that was all three together—at once—in one! But look there!” he continued, pointing with a look of resignation to the shore—“look there! there’s no end to it. What has that brute got under its tail?”
“That beats everything!” said Peterkin, rubbing his nose and scrunching up his face in exasperated disbelief. “I’ve heard of things being neither fish, meat, nor fowl; but I never thought I’d see a creature that’s all three at once! But look there!” he continued, pointing with a resigned expression to the shore—“look there! It just goes on and on. What does that creature have under its tail?”
We turned to look in the direction pointed out, and there saw a penguin walking slowly and very sedately along the shore with an egg under its tail. There were several others, we observed, burdened in the same way; and we found afterwards that these were a species of penguin that always carried their eggs so. Indeed, they had a most convenient cavity for the purpose, just between the tail and the legs. We were very much impressed with the regularity and order of this colony. The island seemed to be apportioned out into squares, of which each penguin possessed one, and sat in stiff solemnity in the middle of it, or took a slow march up and down the spaces between. Some were hatching their eggs, but others were feeding their young ones in a manner that caused us to laugh not a little. The mother stood on a mound or raised rock, while the young one stood patiently below her on the ground. Suddenly the mother raised her head and uttered a series of the most discordant cackling sounds.
We turned to look where we were directed, and there we saw a penguin walking slowly and calmly along the shore with an egg tucked under its tail. There were several others, we noticed, carrying their eggs the same way; and we later learned that these were a species of penguin that always did it this way. In fact, they had a handy spot for it, right between their tail and legs. We were really impressed by the neatness and order of this colony. The island seemed divided into squares, with each penguin claiming one, sitting solemnly in the middle or taking a slow walk back and forth between them. Some were hatching their eggs, while others were feeding their chicks in a way that made us laugh quite a bit. The mother penguin stood on a mound or raised rock, while the chick stood patiently below her on the ground. Suddenly, the mother lifted her head and let out a series of the most jarring cackling sounds.
“She’s going to choke,” cried Peterkin.
"She's going to choke," shouted Peterkin.
But this was not the case, although, I confess, she looked like it. In a few seconds she put down her head and opened her mouth, into which the young one thrust its beak and seemed to suck something from her throat. Then the cackling was renewed, the sucking continued, and so the operation of feeding was carried on till the young one was satisfied; but what she fed her little one with we could not tell.
But that wasn't the case, though I have to admit, she looked like it. Within moments, she lowered her head and opened her mouth, into which the young one inserted its beak and appeared to draw something from her throat. Then the cackling started up again, the sucking went on, and this feeding process continued until the young one was satisfied; but we couldn’t figure out what she was feeding her little one with.
“Now, just look yonder!” said Peterkin in an excited tone. “If that isn’t the most abominable piece of maternal deception I ever saw! That rascally old lady penguin has just pitched her young one into the sea, and there’s another about to follow her example.”
“Now, just look over there!” said Peterkin in an excited tone. “If that isn’t the most outrageous act of maternal deception I’ve ever seen! That sneaky old lady penguin just tossed her chick into the sea, and there’s another one about to do the same.”
This indeed seemed to be the case, for on the top of a steep rock close to the edge of the sea we observed an old penguin endeavouring to entice her young one into the water; but the young one seemed very unwilling to go, and notwithstanding the enticements of its mother, moved very slowly towards her. At last she went gently behind the young bird and pushed it a little towards the water, but with great tenderness, as much as to say, “Don’t be afraid, darling; I won’t hurt you, my pet!” But no sooner did she get it to the edge of the rock, where it stood looking pensively down at the sea, than she gave it a sudden and violent push, sending it headlong down the slope into the water, where its mother left it to scramble ashore as it best could. We observed many of them employed in doing this, and we came to the conclusion that this is the way in which old penguins teach their children to swim.
This really seemed to be the case, because at the top of a steep rock near the edge of the sea, we saw an old penguin trying to coax her chick into the water. The chick, however, seemed pretty hesitant and, despite its mother’s attempts to encourage it, moved very slowly towards her. Eventually, she gently nudged the young bird from behind, pushing it a bit closer to the water, doing it with great care, as if to say, “Don’t worry, sweetie; I won’t hurt you, my dear!” But as soon as she got it to the edge of the rock, where it stood staring thoughtfully down at the sea, she suddenly gave it a strong push, sending it tumbling down the slope into the water, where she left it to find its way back to shore as best as it could. We saw many penguins doing this, and we concluded that this is how older penguins teach their chicks to swim.
Scarcely had we finished making our remarks on this, when we were startled by about a dozen of the old birds hopping in the most clumsy and ludicrous manner towards the sea. The beach here was a sloping rock, and when they came to it some of them succeeded in hopping down in safety, but others lost their balance and rolled and scrambled down the slope in the most helpless manner. The instant they reached the water, however, they seemed to be in their proper element. They dived, and bounded out of it and into it again with the utmost agility; and so, diving and bounding and sputtering—for they could not fly—they went rapidly out to sea.
As soon as we finished our comments on this, we were surprised by about a dozen of the old birds awkwardly hopping toward the sea. The beach was a sloping rock, and when they reached it, some managed to hop down safely, while others lost their balance and tumbled down the slope in a clumsy way. But the moment they hit the water, they seemed right at home. They dove in and jumped out with impressive agility; and so, diving, jumping, and splashing—since they couldn’t fly—they quickly moved out to sea.
On seeing this, Peterkin turned with a grave face to us and said, “It’s my opinion that these birds are all stark, staring mad, and that this is an enchanted island. I therefore propose that we should either put about ship and fly in terror from the spot, or land valorously on the island and sell our lives as dearly as we can.”
On seeing this, Peterkin turned to us with a serious expression and said, “I think these birds are completely crazy, and that this is a magical island. So, I suggest we either turn the ship around and escape in fear, or bravely land on the island and fight for our lives.”
“I vote for landing; so pull in, lads!” said Jack, giving a stroke with his oar that made the boat spin. In a few seconds we ran the boat into a little creek, where we made her fast to a projecting piece of coral, and running up the beach, entered the ranks of the penguins, armed with our cudgels and our spear. We were greatly surprised to find that instead of attacking us, or showing signs of fear at our approach, these curious birds did not move from their places until we laid hands on them, and merely turned their eyes on us in solemn, stupid wonder as we passed. There was one old penguin, however, that began to walk slowly towards the sea; and Peterkin took it into his head that he would try to interrupt its progress, so he ran between it and the sea and brandished his cudgel in its face. But this proved to be a resolute old bird. It would not retreat; nay, more, it would not cease to advance, but battled with Peterkin bravely, and drove him before it until it reached the sea. Had Peterkin used his club he could easily have felled it, no doubt; but as he had no wish to do so cruel an act merely out of sport, he let the bird escape.
“I vote we land; so pull in, guys!” said Jack, giving a stroke with his oar that made the boat spin. In a few seconds, we steered the boat into a little creek, where we secured it to a projecting piece of coral. Running up the beach, we joined the ranks of the penguins, armed with our clubs and our spear. We were really surprised to find that instead of attacking us or showing any fear, these curious birds didn’t move from their spots until we grabbed them. They just turned their eyes on us in solemn, dumb wonder as we passed. However, there was one old penguin that started walking slowly toward the sea, and Peterkin decided to try to block its path, so he ran between it and the ocean, waving his club in its face. But this proved to be a determined old bird. It wouldn’t back down; in fact, it kept advancing, bravely pushing Peterkin back until it reached the sea. If Peterkin had used his club, he probably could have taken it down easily, but since he didn’t want to commit such a cruel act just for fun, he let the bird go.
We spent fully three hours on this island in watching the habit of these curious birds; but when we finally left them, we all three concluded, after much consultation, that they were the most wonderful creatures we had ever seen, and further, we thought it probable that they were the most wonderful creatures in the world!
We spent a full three hours on this island observing the behavior of these fascinating birds; when we finally left, the three of us agreed, after a lot of discussion, that they were the most amazing creatures we had ever seen, and furthermore, we believed it was likely that they were the most incredible creatures in the world!
Chapter Eighteen.
An awful storm and its consequences—Narrow escape—A rock proves a sure foundation—A fearful night and a bright morning—Deliverance from danger.
It was evening before we left the island of the penguins. As we had made up our minds to encamp for the night on a small island whereon grew a few cocoa-nut trees, which was about two miles off, we lay-to our oars with some energy. But a danger was in store for us which we had not anticipated. The wind, which had carried us so quickly to Penguin Island, freshened as evening drew on to a stiff breeze, and before we had made half the distance to the small island, it became a regular gale. Although it was not so directly against us as to prevent our rowing in the course we wished to go, yet it checked us very much; and although the force of the sea was somewhat broken by the island, the waves soon began to rise and to roll their broken crests against our small craft, so that she began to take in water, and we had much ado to keep ourselves afloat. At last the wind and sea together became so violent that we found it impossible to make the island; so Jack suddenly put the head of the boat round, and ordered Peterkin and me to hoist a corner of the sail, intending to run back to Penguin Island.
It was evening by the time we left the penguin island. We had decided to set up camp for the night on a small island about two miles away, where a few coconut trees grew, so we rowed with determination. But trouble was ahead that we hadn’t seen coming. As evening approached, the wind that had brought us swiftly to Penguin Island picked up into a strong breeze, and before we had covered half the distance to the small island, it turned into a full-blown gale. Although it wasn’t directly against us, making it impossible to row where we wanted to go, it slowed us down significantly. Even though the island somewhat softened the force of the sea, the waves soon started to rise and crash against our small boat, causing it to take on water, and we struggled to stay afloat. Eventually, the wind and sea became so fierce that we realized we couldn’t reach the island, so Jack suddenly turned the boat around and ordered Peterkin and me to raise a corner of the sail, planning to head back to Penguin Island.
“We shall at least have the shelter of the bushes,” he said as the boat flew before the wind, “and the penguins will keep us company.”
“We'll at least have the shelter of the bushes,” he said as the boat sped along with the wind, “and the penguins will keep us company.”
As Jack spoke, the wind suddenly shifted and blew so much against us that we were forced to hoist more of the sail in order to beat up for the island, being by this change thrown much to leeward of it. What made matters worse was that the gale came in squalls, so that we were more than once nearly upset.
As Jack spoke, the wind suddenly changed direction and blew so hard against us that we had to raise more of the sail to make our way toward the island, having been pushed significantly off course by this change. To make things worse, the storm came in bursts, and we were almost tipped over more than once.
“Stand by, both of you!” cried Jack in a quick, earnest tone. “Be ready to deuce the sail. I very much fear we won’t make the island after all.”
“Hold on, both of you!” Jack shouted quickly and earnestly. “Get ready to drop the sail. I’m really worried we won’t reach the island after all.”
Peterkin and I were so much in the habit of trusting everything to Jack that we had fallen into the way of not considering things, especially such things as were under Jack’s care. We had, therefore, never doubted for a moment that all was going well, so that it was with no little anxiety that we heard him make the above remark. However, we had no time for question or surmise, for at the moment he spoke a heavy squall was bearing down upon us, and as we were then flying with our lee gunwale dipping occasionally under the waves, it was evident that we should have to lower our sail altogether. In a few seconds the squall struck the boat; but Peterkin and I had the sail down in a moment, so that it did not upset us. But when it was past we were more than half-full of water. This I soon bailed out, while Peterkin again hoisted a corner of the sail. But the evil which Jack had feared came upon us. We found it quite impossible to make Penguin Island. The gale carried us quickly past it towards the open sea, and the terrible truth flashed upon us that we should be swept out and left to perish miserably in a small boat in the midst of the wide ocean.
Peterkin and I were so used to relying on Jack for everything that we stopped considering things, especially those that were in his control. So, we never doubted for a second that everything was fine, which is why we felt anxious when we heard him say that. However, we didn’t have time to question or think about it because a heavy squall was coming our way. At that moment, we were going fast with our leeward side occasionally dipping under the waves, so it was clear we needed to take down the sail completely. In a few seconds, the squall hit the boat, but Peterkin and I managed to get the sail down quickly enough that we didn't capsize. However, once the storm passed, we found ourselves more than half-full of water. I quickly bailed that out while Peterkin raised a corner of the sail again. But the disaster that Jack had worried about became reality. We realized it was impossible to reach Penguin Island. The gale blew us rapidly past it and out into the open sea, and the awful truth hit us that we would get swept away and left to suffer in a small boat in the vast ocean.
This idea was forced very strongly upon us, because we saw nothing in the direction whither the wind was blowing us save the raging billows of the sea; and indeed we trembled as we gazed around us, for we were now beyond the shelter of the islands, and it seemed as though any of the huge billows, which curled over in masses of foam, might swallow us up in a moment. The water also began to wash in over our sides, and I had to keep constantly bailing; for Jack could not quit the helm, nor Peterkin the sail, for an instant, without endangering our lives. In the midst of this distress Jack uttered an exclamation of hope, and pointed towards a low island or rock which lay directly ahead. It had been hitherto unobserved, owing to the dark clouds that obscured the sky and the blinding spray that seemed to fill the whole atmosphere.
This idea was strongly impressed upon us because we saw nothing in the direction the wind was taking us except for the crashing waves of the sea; and we were indeed scared as we looked around, since we were now beyond the safety of the islands. It felt like any of the massive waves, which rolled over in heaps of foam, could swallow us up at any moment. The water was also starting to wash over the sides, and I had to keep bailing constantly; Jack couldn’t leave the helm, and Peterkin couldn’t take a break from the sail for a second without putting our lives in danger. In the middle of this distress, Jack shouted out an exclamation of hope and pointed towards a low island or rock that lay straight ahead. We hadn’t noticed it before because of the dark clouds that covered the sky and the blinding spray that seemed to fill the air.
As we neared this rock we observed that it was quite destitute of trees and verdure, and so low that the sea broke completely over it. In fact, it was nothing more than the summit of one of the coral formations, which rose only a few feet above the level of the water, and was, in stormy weather, all but invisible. Over this island the waves were breaking in the utmost fury, and our hearts sank within us as we saw that there was not a spot where we could thrust our little boat without its being dashed to pieces.
As we got closer to this rock, we noticed it was completely bare of trees and greenery, and so low that the sea crashed right over it. In fact, it was just the top of one of the coral formations, which only stood a few feet above the water level and was almost invisible in stormy weather. The waves were crashing down on this island with incredible force, and we felt a sense of dread as we realized there was no place we could put our little boat without it getting destroyed.
“Show a little bit more sail!” cried Jack as we swept past the weather side of the rock with fearful speed.
“Show a little more sail!” shouted Jack as we raced past the windward side of the rock at a terrifying speed.
“Ay, ay!” answered Peterkin, hoisting about a foot more of our sail.
“Ay, ay!” Peterkin replied, lifting another foot of our sail.
Little though the addition was, it caused the boat to lie over and creak so loudly, as we cleft the foaming waves, that I expected to be upset every instant; and I blamed Jack in my heart for his rashness. But I did him injustice; for although during two seconds the water rushed inboard in a torrent, he succeeded in steering us sharply round to the leeward side of the rock, where the water was comparatively calm and the force of the breeze broken.
Little as the addition was, it made the boat lean over and creak so loudly as we sliced through the choppy waves that I thought we would capsize any moment; I silently blamed Jack for being reckless. But I was being unfair to him; for although for a couple of seconds water surged inboard like a flood, he managed to steer us sharply around to the leeward side of the rock, where the water was relatively calm and the force of the wind was less intense.
“Out your oars now, lads! That’s well done! Give way!” We obeyed instantly. The oars splashed into the waves together. One good, hearty pull, and we were floating in a comparatively calm creek that was so narrow as to be barely able to admit our boat. Here we were in perfect safety, and as we leaped on shore and fastened our cable to the rocks, I thanked God in my heart for our deliverance from so great danger. But although I have said we were now in safety, I suspect that few of my readers would have envied our position. It is true we had no lack of food; but we were drenched to the skin; the sea was foaming round us, and the spray flying over our heads, so that we were completely enveloped, as it were, in water; the spot on which we had landed was not more than twelve yards in diameter, and from this spot we could not move without the risk of being swept away by the storm. At the upper end of the creek was a small hollow or cave in the rock, which sheltered us from the fury of the winds and waves; and as the rock extended in a sort of ledge over our heads, it prevented the spray from falling upon us.
“Get your oars out now, guys! That’s great! Let’s go!” We followed the command without hesitation. The oars hit the water together. With one strong pull, we found ourselves in a relatively calm creek that was so narrow it barely fit our boat. Here we were perfectly safe, and as we jumped ashore and secured our cable to the rocks, I thanked God in my heart for saving us from such great danger. But even though I said we were safe now, I doubt many of my readers would have envied our situation. It’s true we had plenty of food, but we were soaked to the skin; the sea was churning around us, and the spray was flying over our heads, completely engulfing us in water; the spot where we landed was no more than twelve yards wide, and we couldn’t move from it without risking being swept away by the storm. At the far end of the creek was a small hollow or cave in the rock that shielded us from the force of the winds and waves; and since the rock extended like a ledge above us, it kept the spray from hitting us.
“Why,” said Peterkin, beginning to feel cheery again, “it seems to me that we have got into a mermaid’s cave, for there is nothing but water all round us; and as for earth and sky, they are things of the past.”
“Why,” said Peterkin, starting to feel cheerful again, “it feels like we’ve entered a mermaid’s cave, because there’s nothing but water all around us; and as for land and sky, they’re just memories now.”
Peterkin’s idea was not inappropriate, for what with the sea roaring in white foam up to our very feet, and the spray flying in white sheets continually over our heads, and the water dripping heavily from the ledge above like a curtain in front of our cave, it did seem to us very much more like being below than above water.
Peterkin’s idea wasn’t out of place, because with the sea crashing in white foam right at our feet, the spray constantly flying over our heads in white sheets, and the water dripping heavily from the ledge above like a curtain in front of our cave, it really did feel much more like being underwater than on top of it.
“Now, boys,” cried Jack, “bestir yourselves, and let’s make ourselves comfortable.—Toss out our provisions, Peterkin; and here, Ralph, lend a hand to haul up the boat. Look sharp!”
“Alright, guys,” shouted Jack, “get moving, and let’s get settled in.—Throw out our supplies, Peterkin; and hey, Ralph, help pull up the boat. Hurry up!”
“Ay, ay, captain!” we cried as we hastened to obey, much cheered by the hearty manner of our comrade.
“Sure thing, captain!” we shouted as we rushed to comply, feeling boosted by the friendly way our teammate spoke.
Fortunately the cave, although not very deep, was quite dry, so that we succeeded in making ourselves much more comfortable than could have been expected. We landed our provisions, wrung the water out of our garments, spread our sail below us for a carpet, and after having eaten a hearty meal, began to feel quite cheerful. But as night drew on our spirits sank again, for with the daylight all evidence of our security vanished away. We could no longer see the firm rock on which we lay, while we were stunned with the violence of the tempest that raged around us. The night grew pitchy dark as it advanced, so that we could not see our hands when we held them up before our eyes, and were obliged to feel each other occasionally to make sure that we were safe, for the storm at last became so terrible that it was difficult to make our voices audible. A slight variation of the wind, as we supposed, caused a few drops of spray ever and anon to blow into our faces; and the eddy of the sea, in its mad boiling, washed up into our little creek until it reached our feet and threatened to tear away our boat. In order to prevent this latter calamity, we hauled the boat farther up and held the cable in our hands. Occasional flashes of lightning shone with a ghastly glare through the watery curtains around us, and lent additional horror to the scene. Yet we longed for those dismal flashes, for they were less appalling than the thick blackness that succeeded them. Crashing peals of thunder seemed to tear the skies in twain, and fell upon our ears through the wild yelling of the hurricane as if it had been but a gentle summer breeze; while the billows burst upon the weather side of the island until we fancied that the solid rock was giving way, and in our agony we clung to the bare ground, expecting every moment to be whirled away and whelmed in the black, howling sea. Oh, it was a night of terrible anxiety! and no one can conceive the feelings of intense gratitude and relief with which we at last saw the dawn of day break through the vapoury mists around us.
Fortunately, the cave, while not very deep, was pretty dry, so we managed to make ourselves a lot more comfortable than we expected. We brought in our supplies, wrung the water out of our clothes, spread our sail underneath us as a sort of carpet, and after a hearty meal, we started to feel quite cheerful. But as night fell, our spirits dropped again, because with the daylight, all signs of our safety disappeared. We could no longer see the solid rock we were lying on, and we were shaken by the intensity of the storm raging around us. The night grew pitch dark as it went on, to the point where we couldn’t see our hands when we held them up in front of our faces, and we had to feel around occasionally to make sure we were safe, as the storm became so fierce that it was hard to hear each other. A slight shift in the wind occasionally sent a few drops of spray into our faces, and the chaotic waves washed into our little creek until it reached our feet, threatening to sweep our boat away. To prevent that disaster, we pulled the boat further up and held onto the rope. Occasional flashes of lightning lit up the scene with a ghastly glow through the watery curtains around us, adding to the horror. Yet we craved those gloomy flashes, as they were less frightening than the thick darkness that followed. The crashing thunder sounded like it was tearing the sky apart, barely audible over the wild wind of the hurricane, while the waves crashed against the weather side of the island until we feared the solid rock was giving way. In our panic, we clung to the ground, expecting to be swept away into the turbulent, dark sea at any moment. Oh, it was a night of extreme anxiety! No one can imagine the feelings of deep gratitude and relief we had when we finally saw the dawn breaking through the misty fog around us.
For three days and three nights we remained on this rock, while the storm continued to rage with unabated fury. On the morning of the fourth day it suddenly ceased, and the wind fell altogether; but the waves still ran so high that we did not dare to put off in our boat. During the greater part of this period we scarcely slept above a few minutes at a time; but on the third night we slept soundly, and awoke early on the fourth morning to find the sea very much down, and the sun shining brightly again in the clear blue sky.
For three days and three nights, we stayed on this rock while the storm kept raging without letting up. On the morning of the fourth day, it suddenly stopped, and the wind died down completely; however, the waves were still so high that we didn’t dare to take our boat out. For most of this time, we barely slept for more than a few minutes at a time; but on the third night, we slept soundly and woke up early on the fourth morning to find the sea calmed down a lot, with the sun shining brightly in the clear blue sky.
It was with light hearts that we launched forth once more in our little boat and steered away for our island home, which, we were overjoyed to find, was quite visible on the horizon, for we had feared that we had been blown out of sight of it altogether. As it was a dead calm, we had to row during the greater part of the day; but towards the afternoon a fair breeze sprang up, which enabled us to hoist our sail. We soon passed Penguin Island and the other island which we had failed to reach on the day the storm commenced; but as we had still enough of provisions, and were anxious to get home, we did not land—to the great disappointment of Peterkin, who seemed to entertain quite an affection for the penguins.
It was with light hearts that we set off once again in our little boat and headed toward our island home, which, to our delight, was clearly visible on the horizon. We had been worried that we might have been blown far away from it. Since it was completely calm, we had to row for most of the day; but by the afternoon, a nice breeze picked up, allowing us to put up our sail. We quickly passed Penguin Island and the other island we hadn’t reached the day the storm started; however, since we still had enough supplies and were eager to get home, we didn’t stop—much to Peterkin’s disappointment, as he seemed to have a real fondness for the penguins.
Although the breeze was pretty fresh for several hours, we did not reach the outer reef of our island till nightfall; and before we had sailed more than a hundred yards into the lagoon, the wind died away altogether, so that we had to take to our oars again. It was late, and the moon and stars were shining brightly when we arrived opposite the bower and leaped upon the strand. So glad were we to be safe back again on our beloved island that we scarcely took time to drag the boat a short way up the beach, and then ran up to see that all was right at the bower. I must confess, however, that my joy was mingled with a vague sort of fear lest our home had been visited and destroyed during our absence; but on reaching it we found everything just as it had been left, and the poor black cat curled up, sound asleep, on the coral table in front of our humble dwelling.
Although the breeze was pretty fresh for a few hours, we didn't reach the outer reef of our island until nightfall; and before we had sailed more than a hundred yards into the lagoon, the wind completely died down, so we had to use our oars again. It was late, and the moon and stars were shining brightly when we arrived at the bower and jumped onto the shore. We were so happy to be safely back on our beloved island that we barely took the time to pull the boat a short way up the beach before running up to check that everything was okay at the bower. I must admit, though, that my happiness was mixed with a vague fear that our home might have been visited and damaged while we were gone; but when we got there, we found everything just as we had left it, and the poor black cat curled up, sound asleep, on the coral table in front of our simple dwelling.
Chapter Nineteen.
Shoemaking—The even tenor of our way suddenly interrupted—An unexpected visit and an appalling battle—We all become warriors, and Jack proves himself to be a hero.
For many months after this we continued to live on our island in uninterrupted harmony and happiness. Sometimes we went out a-fishing in the lagoon, and sometimes went a-hunting in the woods, or ascended to the mountain-top by way of variety, although Peterkin always asserted that we went for the purpose of hailing any ship that might chance to heave in sight. But I am certain that none of us wished to be delivered from our captivity, for we were extremely happy; and Peterkin used to say that as we were very young, we should not feel the loss of a year or two. Peterkin, as I have said before, was thirteen years of age, Jack eighteen, and I fifteen. But Jack was very tall, strong, and manly for his age, and might easily have been mistaken for twenty.
For many months after this, we continued to live on our island in uninterrupted harmony and happiness. Sometimes we went fishing in the lagoon, and sometimes we went hunting in the woods, or we climbed to the mountain top for a change of scenery, although Peterkin always insisted that we went to look out for any ships that might happen to come into view. But I’m sure none of us wanted to escape from our situation because we were incredibly happy; Peterkin used to say that since we were so young, we wouldn’t really notice the loss of a year or two. As I mentioned before, Peterkin was thirteen, Jack was eighteen, and I was fifteen. But Jack was very tall, strong, and mature for his age, and could easily have been mistaken for twenty.
The climate was so beautiful that it seemed to be a perpetual summer, and as many of the fruit-trees continued to bear fruit and blossom all the year round, we never wanted for a plentiful supply of food. The hogs, too, seemed rather to increase than diminish, although Peterkin was very frequent in his attacks on them with his spear. If at any time we failed in finding a drove, we had only to pay a visit to the plum-tree before mentioned, where we always found a large family of them asleep under its branches.
The weather was so nice that it felt like it was always summer, and since many of the fruit trees kept producing fruit and blooming year-round, we never ran out of food. The pigs also seemed to be multiplying instead of decreasing, even though Peterkin often tried to spear them. Whenever we couldn't find a group of pigs, we just had to check out the previously mentioned plum tree, where we always discovered a whole bunch of them sleeping under its branches.
We employed ourselves very busily during this time in making various garments of cocoa-nut cloth, as those with which we had landed were beginning to be very ragged. Peterkin also succeeded in making excellent shoes out of the skin of the old hog in the following manner: He first cut a piece of the hide, of an oblong form, a few inches longer than his foot. This he soaked in water, and while it was wet he sewed up one end of it so as to form a rough imitation of that part of the heel of a shoe where the seam is. This done, he bored a row of holes all round the edge of the piece of skin, through which a tough line was passed. Into the sewed-up part of this shoe he thrust his heel; then, drawing the string tight, the edges rose up and overlapped his foot all round. It is true there were a great many ill-looking puckers in these shoes; but we found them very serviceable notwithstanding, and Jack came at last to prefer them to his long boots. We also made various other useful articles, which added to our comfort, and once or twice spoke of building us a house; but we had so great an affection for the bower, and withal found it so serviceable, that we determined not to leave it, nor to attempt the building of a house, which in such a climate might turn out to be rather disagreeable than useful.
We kept ourselves really busy during this time making different clothes from coconut fabric, since the ones we had arrived in were getting pretty worn out. Peterkin also figured out how to make great shoes from the skin of the old pig like this: He first cut a piece of hide that was a few inches longer than his foot. He soaked it in water, and while it was wet, he sewed up one end to create a rough version of the heel seam of a shoe. After that, he punched a row of holes around the edge of the piece of skin and threaded a tough line through them. He then slid his heel into the sewn-up part, and by pulling the string tight, the edges came up and wrapped around his foot. Sure, there were a lot of bumpy pulls in these shoes, but we found them really useful, and Jack eventually preferred them to his long boots. We also created various other handy items that made our lives more comfortable, and a couple of times we talked about building a house; however, we loved our bower so much and found it so practical that we decided against leaving it or trying to build a house, which might end up being more uncomfortable than helpful in such a climate.
We often examined the pistol that we had found in the house on the other side of the island, and Peterkin wished much that we had powder and shot, as it would render pig-killing much easier; but, after all, we had become so expert in the use of our sling and bow and spear that we were independent of more deadly weapons.
We often looked at the pistol we found in the house on the other side of the island, and Peterkin really wished we had some gunpowder and bullets because it would make hunting pigs a lot easier. However, we had become so skilled with our sling, bow, and spear that we didn’t really need any more dangerous weapons.
Diving in the Water Garden also continued to afford us as much pleasure as ever, and Peterkin began to be a little more expert in the water from constant practice. As for Jack and me, we began to feel as if water were our native element, and revelled in it with so much confidence and comfort that Peterkin said he feared we would turn into fish some day and swim off and leave him, adding that he had been for a long time observing that Jack was becoming more and more like a shark every day. Whereupon Jack remarked that if he (Peterkin) were changed into a fish, he would certainly turn into nothing better or bigger than a shrimp. Poor Peterkin did not envy us our delightful excursions under water—except, indeed, when Jack would dive down to the bottom of the Water Garden, sit down on a rock, and look up and make faces at him. Peterkin did feel envious then, and often said he would give anything to be able to do that. I was much amused when Peterkin said this; for if he could only have seen his own face when he happened to take a short dive, he would have seen that Jack’s was far surpassed by it—the great difference being, however, that Jack made faces on purpose, Peterkin couldn’t help it!
Diving in the Water Garden still gave us as much joy as ever, and Peterkin started to get a bit better in the water from all the practice. As for Jack and me, we began to feel like water was our natural environment, enjoying it with so much confidence and ease that Peterkin joked he was worried we’d turn into fish one day and swim off and leave him. He added that he had noticed Jack was becoming more and more like a shark every day. Jack shot back that if Peterkin were to turn into a fish, he’d definitely end up being nothing better or bigger than a shrimp. Poor Peterkin didn’t really envy us our amazing underwater adventures—except, of course, when Jack would dive to the bottom of the Water Garden, sit on a rock, and make faces at him. That’s when Peterkin felt envious and often said he would give anything to be able to do that. I found it pretty funny when Peterkin said this; if he could only have seen his own face during a quick dive, he would have realized that Jack’s expressions were nothing compared to his—though the big difference was that Jack made faces on purpose, while Peterkin just couldn’t help it!
Now, while we were engaged with these occupations and amusements, an event occurred one day which was as unexpected as it was exceedingly alarming and very horrible.
Now, while we were busy with these activities and distractions, an event happened one day that was as surprising as it was incredibly frightening and quite terrible.
Jack and I were sitting, as we were often wont to do, on the rocks at Spouting Cliff, and Peterkin was wringing the water from his garments, having recently fallen by accident into the sea—a thing he was constantly doing—when our attention was suddenly arrested by two objects which appeared on the horizon.
Jack and I were sitting, as we often did, on the rocks at Spouting Cliff, and Peterkin was wringing out his clothes, having just accidentally fallen into the sea—a frequent occurrence for him—when something caught our attention on the horizon.
“What are yon, think you?” I said, addressing Jack.
“What do you think those are?” I said, talking to Jack.
“I can’t imagine,” answered he. “I’ve noticed them for some time, and fancied they were black sea-gulls; but the more I look at them, the more I feel convinced they are much larger than gulls.”
“I can’t imagine,” he replied. “I’ve seen them for a while, and thought they were black sea-gulls; but the more I look at them, the more I’m convinced they’re much bigger than gulls.”
“They seem to be coming towards us,” said I.
“They look like they’re coming towards us,” I said.
“Hallo! what’s wrong?” inquired Peterkin, coming up.
“Hey! What’s wrong?” Peterkin asked as he approached.
“Look there,” said Jack.
“Check that out,” said Jack.
“Whales!” cried Peterkin, shading his eyes with his hand. “No—eh—can they be boats, Jack?”
“Whales!” shouted Peterkin, shielding his eyes with his hand. “No—wait—could they be boats, Jack?”
Our hearts beat with excitement at the very thought of seeing human faces again.
Our hearts race with excitement just thinking about seeing human faces again.
“I think you are about right, Peterkin. But they seem to me to move strangely for boats,” said Jack in a low tone, as if he were talking to himself.
“I think you're probably right, Peterkin. But they look like they're moving strangely for boats,” Jack said quietly, almost as if he were talking to himself.
I noticed that a shade of anxiety crossed Jack’s countenance as he gazed long and intently at the two objects, which were now nearing us fast. At last he sprang to his feet. “They are canoes, Ralph! whether war-canoes or not, I cannot tell; but this I know—that all the natives of the South Sea Islands are fierce cannibals, and they have little respect for strangers. We must hide if they land here, which I earnestly hope they will not do.”
I saw a look of anxiety cross Jack’s face as he stared hard at the two objects that were quickly approaching us. Finally, he jumped to his feet. “They’re canoes, Ralph! I can’t tell if they’re war canoes or not, but I do know this—all the natives of the South Sea Islands are fierce cannibals, and they don’t have much respect for strangers. We need to hide if they come ashore here, which I really hope they won’t.”
I was greatly alarmed at Jack’s speech; but I confess I thought less of what he said than of the earnest, anxious manner in which he said it, and it was with very uncomfortable feelings that Peterkin and I followed him quickly into the woods.
I was really worried by Jack’s speech; but I have to admit I focused more on his serious, anxious tone than on the actual words he used, and with a lot of unease, Peterkin and I hurried after him into the woods.
“How unfortunate,” said I as we gained the shelter of the bushes, “that we have forgotten our arms!”
“How unfortunate,” I said as we reached the shelter of the bushes, “that we forgot our weapons!”
“It matters not,” said Jack; “here are clubs enough and to spare.” As he spoke, he laid his hand on a bundle of stout poles of various sizes, which Peterkin’s ever-busy hands had formed, during our frequent visits to the cliff, for no other purpose, apparently, than that of having something to do.
“It doesn’t matter,” said Jack; “we have plenty of clubs.” As he spoke, he placed his hand on a collection of sturdy poles of different sizes that Peterkin’s always-busy hands had made during our frequent trips to the cliff, seemingly just to have something to do.
We each selected a stout club according to our several tastes and lay down behind a rock, whence we could see the canoes approach without ourselves being seen. At first we made an occasional remark on their appearance; but after they entered the lagoon and drew near the beach, we ceased to speak, and gazed with intense interest at the scene before us.
We each picked a sturdy club based on our individual preferences and lay down behind a rock, where we could see the canoes coming without being noticed. At first, we made some comments about how they looked; but once they entered the lagoon and got closer to the beach, we stopped talking and watched the scene in front of us with great interest.
We now observed that the foremost canoe was being chased by the other, and that it contained a few women and children as well as men—perhaps forty souls altogether—while the canoe which pursued it contained only men. They seemed to be about the same in number, but were better armed, and had the appearance of being a war-party. Both crews were paddling with all their might, and it seemed as if the pursuers exerted themselves to overtake the fugitives ere they could land. In this, however, they failed. The foremost canoe made for the beach close beneath the rocks behind which we were concealed. Their short paddles flashed like meteors in the water, and sent up a constant shower of spray. The foam curled from the prow, and the eyes of the rowers glistened in their black faces as they strained every muscle of their naked bodies. Nor did they relax their efforts till the canoe struck the beach with a violent shock; then, with a shout of defiance, the whole party sprang, as if by magic, from the canoe to the shore. Three women, two of whom carried infants in their arms, rushed into the woods; and the men crowded to the water’s edge, with stones in their hands, spears levelled, and clubs brandished, to resist the landing of their enemies.
We saw that the leading canoe was being chased by another one, and it held a few women and children along with men—maybe about forty people in total—while the chasing canoe had only men in it. They seemed to be about the same number, but they were better armed and looked like a war party. Both crews were paddling as hard as they could, and it seemed like the pursuers were trying to catch up to the ones fleeing before they could reach the shore. However, they didn’t succeed. The leading canoe headed for the beach right below the rocks where we were hiding. Their short paddles flashed like meteors in the water, sending up a constant spray. Foam curled off the front, and the rowers' eyes gleamed in their dark faces as they pushed their bodies to the limit. They didn’t stop paddling until the canoe hit the beach with a hard crash; then, with a shout of defiance, the whole group jumped out of the canoe onto the shore as if by magic. Three women, two of them holding infants, sprinted into the woods; while the men rushed to the water's edge, armed with stones, readying their spears and swinging their clubs to fend off their enemies.
The distance between the two canoes had been about half-a-mile, and at the great speed they were going, this was soon passed. As the pursuers neared the shore, no sign of fear or hesitation was noticeable. On they came, like a wild charger—received, but recked not of, a shower of stones. The canoe struck, and with a yell that seemed to issue from the throats of incarnate fiends, they leaped into the water and drove their enemies up the beach.
The distance between the two canoes was about half a mile, and at the speed they were moving, they quickly closed the gap. As the pursuers got closer to the shore, there was no sign of fear or hesitation. They charged forward like a wild horse—taking hits from a shower of stones but not caring about it. The canoe hit the shore, and with a yell that sounded like it came from demons, they jumped into the water and forced their enemies up the beach.
The battle that immediately ensued was frightful to behold. Most of the men wielded clubs of enormous size and curious shapes, with which they dashed out each other’s brains. As they were almost entirely naked, and had to bound, stoop, leap, and run in their terrible hand-to-hand encounters, they looked more like demons than human beings. I felt my heart grow sick at the sight of this bloody battle, and would fain have turned away; but a species of fascination seemed to hold me down and glue my eyes upon the combatants. I observed that the attacking party was led by a most extraordinary being, who, from his size and peculiarity, I concluded was a chief. His hair was frizzed out to an enormous extent, so that it resembled a large turban. It was of a light-yellow hue, which surprised me much, for the man’s body was as black as coal, and I felt convinced that the hair must have been dyed. He was tattooed from head to foot; and his face, besides being tattooed, was besmeared with red paint and streaked with white. Altogether, with his yellow turban-like hair, his Herculean black frame, his glittering eyes, and white teeth, he seemed the most terrible monster I ever beheld. He was very active in the fight, and had already killed four men.
The battle that followed was horrifying to watch. Most of the men swung huge clubs of weird shapes, smashing each other's heads. Since they were nearly naked and had to jump, bend, leap, and run in their brutal close fights, they looked more like demons than people. I felt my stomach turn at the sight of this bloody conflict, and I wanted to look away; but something about it held me in place, forcing my eyes on the fighters. I noticed that the attacking group was led by a very unusual figure, who, due to his size and uniqueness, I guessed was a chief. His hair was frizzed out so much that it looked like a giant turban. It was a light yellow color, which surprised me since his body was as black as coal, making me think his hair must have been dyed. He was covered in tattoos from head to toe; his face, aside from the tattoos, was smeared with red paint and streaked with white. All together, with his yellow turban-like hair, massive black body, sparkling eyes, and white teeth, he looked like the most terrifying creature I had ever seen. He was very quick in the fight and had already killed four men.
Suddenly the yellow-haired chief was attacked by a man quite as strong and large as himself. He flourished a heavy club, something like an eagle’s beak at the point. For a second or two these giants eyed each other warily, moving round and round, as if to catch each other at a disadvantage; but seeing that nothing was to be gained by this caution, and that the loss of time might effectually turn the tide of battle either way, they apparently made up their minds to attack at the same instant, for, with a wild shout and simultaneous spring, they swung their heavy clubs, which met with a loud report. Suddenly the yellow-haired savage tripped, his enemy sprang forward, the ponderous club was swung; but it did not descend, for at that moment the savage was felled to the ground by a stone from the hand of one who had witnessed his chief’s danger. This was the turning-point in the battle. The savages who landed first turned and fled towards the bush on seeing the fall of their chief. But not one escaped; they were all overtaken and felled to the earth. I saw, however, that they were not all killed. Indeed, their enemies, now that they were conquered, seemed anxious to take them alive; and they succeeded in securing fifteen, whom they bound hand and foot with cords, and carrying them up into the woods, laid them down among the bushes. Here they left them, for what purpose I knew not, and returned to the scene of the late battle, where the remnant of the party were bathing their wounds.
Suddenly, the yellow-haired chief was attacked by a man just as strong and large as he was. He swung a heavy club, resembling an eagle's beak at the end. For a second or two, these giants eyed each other cautiously, circling around, trying to find an opening; but realizing that this hesitation wouldn’t give them any advantage and that wasting time could change the outcome of the battle, they decided to strike at the same time. With a wild shout and simultaneous leap, they swung their heavy clubs, which clashed with a loud bang. Suddenly, the yellow-haired warrior stumbled; his opponent lunged forward, the massive club was raised, but it didn’t come down, because at that moment, the warrior was knocked to the ground by a stone thrown by someone who had seen his chief in danger. This was the turning point of the battle. The savages who landed first turned and fled into the bushes when they saw their chief fall. But no one escaped; they were all caught and brought down. I noticed that not all of them were killed. In fact, their enemies, now that they had won, seemed eager to capture them alive; they managed to secure fifteen, tying their hands and feet with ropes, and taking them into the woods, where they laid them down among the bushes. They left them there, for reasons I didn’t know, and returned to the site of the recent battle, where the remaining members of their group were tending to their wounds.
Out of the forty blacks that composed the attacking party only twenty-eight remained alive, two of whom were sent into the bush to hunt for the women and children. Of the other party, as I have said, only fifteen survived, and these were lying bound and helpless on the grass.
Out of the forty Black members of the attacking party, only twenty-eight were still alive, two of whom were sent into the woods to search for the women and children. From the other group, as I mentioned before, only fifteen survived, and they were lying tied up and defenseless on the grass.
Jack and Peterkin and I now looked at each other, and whispered our fears that the savages might clamber up the rocks to search for fresh water, and so discover our place of concealment; but we were so much interested in watching their movements that we agreed to remain where we were—and indeed we could not easily have risen without exposing ourselves to detection. One of the savages now went up to the woods and soon returned with a bundle of firewood, and we were not a little surprised to see him set fire to it by the very same means used by Jack the time we made our first fire—namely, with the bow and drill. When the fire was kindled, two of the party went again to the woods and returned with one of the bound men. A dreadful feeling of horror crept over my heart as the thought flashed upon me that they were going to burn their enemies. As they bore him to the fire my feelings almost overpowered me. I gasped for breath, and seizing my club, endeavoured to spring to my feet; but Jack’s powerful arm pinned me to the earth. Next moment one of the savages raised his club and fractured the wretched creature’s skull. He must have died instantly; and, strange though it may seem, I confess to a feeling of relief when the deed was done, because I now knew that the poor savage could not be burned alive. Scarcely had his limbs ceased to quiver when the monsters cut slices of flesh from his body, and after roasting them slightly over the fire, devoured them.
Jack, Peterkin, and I looked at each other and whispered our fears that the savages might climb up the rocks to search for fresh water and discover where we were hiding. However, we were so captivated by their movements that we decided to stay put—and honestly, we couldn't have easily gotten up without being seen. One of the savages went into the woods and soon came back with a bundle of firewood, and we were quite surprised to see him light it using the same method Jack had used when we made our first fire—specifically, with the bow and drill. Once the fire was going, two of the group returned from the woods with one of the bound men. A wave of horror washed over me as I realized they were going to burn their enemies. As they carried him to the fire, my emotions almost overwhelmed me. I gasped for breath and grabbed my club, trying to get to my feet, but Jack's strong arm held me down. The next moment, one of the savages raised his club and smashed the poor man's skull. He must have died instantly; and, strangely enough, I felt a sense of relief when it was over because I knew the poor savage wouldn't be burned alive. Almost as soon as his body stopped twitching, the monsters sliced pieces of flesh from him and, after roasting them slightly over the fire, began to eat.
Suddenly there arose a cry from the woods, and in a few seconds the two savages hastened towards the fire, dragging the three women and their two infants along with them. One of these women was much younger than her companions, and we were struck with the modesty of her demeanour and the gentle expression of her face, which, although she had the flattish nose and thick lips of the others, was of a light-brown colour, and we conjectured that she must be of a different race. She and her companions wore short petticoats, and a kind of tippet on their shoulders. Their hair was jet black, but instead of being long, was short and curly—though not woolly—somewhat like the hair of a young boy. While we gazed with interest and some anxiety at these poor creatures, the big chief advanced to one of the elder females and laid his hand upon the child. But the mother shrank from him, and clasping the little one to her bosom, uttered a wail of fear. With a savage laugh, the chief tore the child from her arms and tossed it into the sea. A low groan burst from Jack’s lips as he witnessed this atrocious act and heard the mother’s shriek as she fell insensible on the sand. The rippling waves rolled the child on the beach, as if they refused to be a party in such a foul murder, and we could observe that the little one still lived.
Suddenly, a shout came from the woods, and within seconds, the two savages rushed towards the fire, dragging the three women and their two infants behind them. One of these women was much younger than the others, and we were struck by her modest demeanor and the gentle expression on her face. Even though she had the flat nose and thick lips of the others, her skin was a light brown, leading us to guess that she belonged to a different race. She and her companions wore short skirts and a type of shawl draped over their shoulders. Their hair was jet black, but instead of being long, it was short and curly—though not woolly—similar to a young boy's hair. As we looked at these unfortunate women with both interest and anxiety, the big chief approached one of the older women and laid his hand on her child. But the mother recoiled, clutching her baby to her chest and letting out a wail of fear. With a savage laugh, the chief ripped the child from her arms and threw it into the sea. A low groan escaped Jack's lips as he witnessed this horrific act and heard the mother’s scream as she collapsed, unconscious on the sand. The gentle waves rolled the child onto the beach, as if they refused to be complicit in such a crime, and we could see that the little one was still alive.
The young girl was now brought forward, and the chief addressed her; but although we heard his voice and even the words distinctly, of course we could not understand what he said. The girl made no answer to his fierce questions, and we saw by the way in which he pointed to the fire that he threatened her life.
The young girl was brought forward, and the chief spoke to her; but even though we could hear his voice and the words clearly, we couldn't understand what he was saying. The girl didn't respond to his harsh questions, and we noticed by how he pointed to the fire that he was threatening her life.
“Peterkin,” said Jack in a hoarse whisper, “have you got your knife?”
“Peterkin,” Jack said in a rough whisper, “do you have your knife?”
“Yes,” replied Peterkin, whose face was pale as death.
“Yes,” replied Peterkin, his face as pale as death.
“That will do. Listen to me, and do my bidding quick.—Here is the small knife, Ralph. Fly, both of you, through the bush, cut the cords that bind the prisoners, and set them free! There! quick, ere it be too late!” Jack sprang up and seized a heavy but short bludgeon, while his strong frame trembled with emotion, and large drops rolled down his forehead.
“That's enough. Listen to me and do what I say quickly. —Here’s the small knife, Ralph. Hurry, both of you, through the bushes, cut the ropes that tie up the prisoners, and set them free! Come on! Do it fast, before it’s too late!” Jack jumped up and grabbed a heavy but short club, his strong body shaking with emotion, and big drops streamed down his forehead.
At this moment the man who had butchered the savage a few minutes before advanced towards the girl with his heavy club. Jack uttered a yell that rang like a death-shriek among the rocks. With one bound he leaped over a precipice full fifteen feet high, and before the savages had recovered from their surprise, was in the midst of them, while Peterkin and I dashed through the bushes towards the prisoners. With one blow of his staff Jack felled the man with the club; then turning round with a look of fury he rushed upon the big chief with the yellow hair. Had the blow which Jack aimed at his head taken effect, the huge savage would have needed no second stroke; but he was agile as a cat, and avoided it by springing to one side, while at the same time he swung his ponderous club at the head of his foe. It was now Jack’s turn to leap aside; and well was it for him that the first outburst of his blind fury was over, else he had become an easy prey to his gigantic antagonist. But Jack was cool now. He darted his blows rapidly and well, and the superiority of his light weapon was strikingly proved in this combat; for while he could easily evade the blows of the chief’s heavy club, the chief could not so easily evade those of his light one. Nevertheless, so quick was he, and so frightfully did he fling about the mighty weapon, that although Jack struck him almost every blow, the strokes had to be delivered so quickly that they wanted force to be very effectual.
At that moment, the man who had killed the savage just minutes before approached the girl with his heavy club. Jack let out a yell that echoed like a death scream among the rocks. With one leap, he jumped over a ledge that was about fifteen feet high, and before the savages could recover from their surprise, he was right in the middle of them, while Peterkin and I rushed through the bushes toward the prisoners. With one swing of his staff, Jack knocked the man with the club to the ground; then, turning with a furious look, he charged at the big chief with yellow hair. If Jack's strike aimed at the chief's head had connected, the massive savage wouldn't have needed a second hit; but he was as quick as a cat and dodged it by springing to the side, while simultaneously swinging his heavy club at Jack's head. Now it was Jack's turn to leap aside; and he was fortunate that the initial surge of his blind fury had passed, or he would have easily fallen prey to his gigantic opponent. But Jack was calm now. He delivered his blows quickly and accurately, and the advantage of his lighter weapon became clear in this fight; while he could easily dodge the strikes from the chief’s heavy club, the chief couldn’t evade Jack’s lighter attacks as easily. Nonetheless, the chief was so quick, and he swung his massive weapon so ferociously that even though Jack hit him almost every time, each strike had to be delivered so quickly that they lacked enough force to be truly effective.
It was lucky for Jack that the other savages considered the success of their chief in this encounter to be so certain that they refrained from interfering. Had they doubted it, they would have probably ended the matter at once by felling him. But they contented themselves with awaiting the issue.
It was fortunate for Jack that the other savages were so sure of their chief's success in this encounter that they decided not to get involved. If they had any doubts, they probably would have resolved the situation right away by taking him down. Instead, they chose to sit back and see what happened.
The force which the chief expended in wielding his club now began to be apparent. His movements became slower, his breath hissed through his clenched teeth, and the surprised savages drew nearer in order to render assistance. Jack observed this movement. He felt that his fate was sealed, and resolved to cast his life upon the next blow. The chief’s club was again about to descend on his head. He might have evaded it easily, but instead of doing so, he suddenly shortened his grasp of his own club, rushed in under the blow, struck his adversary right between the eyes with all his force, and fell to the earth, crushed beneath the senseless body of the chief. A dozen clubs flew high in air, ready to descend on the head of Jack; but they hesitated a moment, for the massive body of the chief completely covered him. That moment saved his life. Ere the savages could tear the chief’s body away, seven of their number fell prostrate beneath the clubs of the prisoners whom Peterkin and I had set free, and two others fell under our own hand. We could never have accomplished this had not our enemies been so engrossed with the fight between Jack and their chief that they had failed to observe us until we were upon them. They still outnumbered our party by three; but we were flushed with victory, while they were taken by surprise and dispirited by the fall of their chief. Moreover, they were awestruck by the sweeping fury of Jack, who seemed to have lost his senses altogether, and had no sooner shaken himself free of the chief’s body than he rushed into the midst of them, and in three blows equalised our numbers. Peterkin and I flew to the rescue, the savages followed us, and in less than ten minutes the whole of our opponents were knocked down or made prisoners, bound hand and foot, and extended side by side upon the seashore.
The strength the chief used to swing his club was now becoming clear. His movements slowed down, and his breath came out in hisses through his clenched teeth, while the surprised natives moved closer to help. Jack noticed this happening. He realized his fate was sealed and decided to put everything on the line with the next blow. The chief’s club was about to come down on him again. He could have easily dodged it, but instead of evading, he suddenly shortened his grip on his own club, rushed in under the swing, and struck his opponent squarely between the eyes with all his might, then fell to the ground, crushed under the chief’s lifeless body. A dozen clubs were raised high, ready to strike Jack’s head, but they hesitated for a moment because the chief’s hefty body completely covered him. That moment saved his life. Before the natives could pull the chief’s body off him, seven of them fell flat from the clubs of the prisoners Peterkin and I had freed, and two more fell to our own hands. We would never have achieved this if the enemies hadn’t been so focused on the fight between Jack and their chief that they hadn’t noticed us until it was too late. They still outnumbered us three to one, but we were pumped with victory, while they were caught off guard and dispirited by their chief's defeat. Additionally, they were taken aback by Jack’s furious attack, who seemed completely out of control. As soon as he managed to shake off the chief’s body, he charged right into their midst, and with three powerful blows, he evened our numbers. Peterkin and I rushed to help, the natives followed us, and in less than ten minutes, all our opponents were either knocked out or captured, tied hand and foot, and laid out side by side on the seashore.
Chapter Twenty.
Intercourse with the savages—Cannibalism prevented—The slain are buried and the survivors depart, leaving us again alone on our Coral Island.
After the battle was over, the savages crowded round us and gazed at us in surprise, while they continued to pour upon us a flood of questions, which, being wholly unintelligible, of course we could not answer. However, by way of putting an end to it, Jack took the chief (who had recovered from the effects of his wound) by the hand and shook it warmly. No sooner did the blacks see that this was meant to express good-will than they shook hands with us all round. After this ceremony was gone through Jack went up to the girl, who had never once moved from the rock where she had been left, but had continued an eager spectator of all that had passed. He made signs to her to follow him, and then, taking the chief by the hand, was about to conduct him to the bower when his eye fell on the poor infant which had been thrown into the sea and was still lying on the shore. Dropping the chief’s hand he hastened towards it, and, to his great joy, found it to be still alive. We also found that the mother was beginning to recover slowly.
After the battle was over, the tribespeople gathered around us and looked at us in surprise, bombarding us with questions we couldn't understand. To put an end to it, Jack took the chief (who had recovered from his injuries) by the hand and shook it warmly. As soon as the locals saw this gesture of goodwill, they shook hands with all of us. Once this was done, Jack approached the girl, who hadn't moved from the rock where she was left but had eagerly watched everything unfold. He gestured for her to follow him, and then, taking the chief's hand, was about to lead him to the bower when he noticed the poor infant that had been thrown into the sea and was still lying on the shore. Letting go of the chief's hand, he rushed toward it and, to his great relief, found it was still alive. We also discovered that the mother was starting to recover slowly.
“Here, get out o’ the way,” said Jack, pushing us aside as we stooped over the poor woman and endeavoured to restore her; “I’ll soon bring her round.” So saying, he placed the infant on her bosom and laid its warm cheek on hers. The effect was wonderful. The woman opened her eyes, felt the child, looked at it, and with a cry of joy, clasped it in her arms, at the same time endeavouring to rise—for the purpose, apparently, of rushing into the woods.
“Here, move out of the way,” said Jack, pushing us aside as we bent over the poor woman and tried to help her; “I’ll bring her back.” With that, he placed the baby on her chest and pressed its warm cheek against hers. The effect was incredible. The woman opened her eyes, felt the child, looked at it, and with a cry of joy, pulled it into her arms, simultaneously trying to get up—seemingly to run into the woods.
“There, that’s all right,” said Jack, once more taking the chief by the hand.—“Now, Ralph and Peterkin, make the women and these fellows follow me to the bower. We’ll entertain them as hospitably as we can.”
“There, that’s all good,” said Jack, once again shaking hands with the chief. “Now, Ralph and Peterkin, get the women and these guys to follow me to the bower. We’ll host them as warmly as we can.”
In a few minutes the savages were all seated on the ground in front of the bower, making a hearty meal off a cold roast pig, several ducks, and a variety of cold fish, together with an unlimited supply of cocoa-nuts, bread-fruits, yams, taro, and plums—with all of which they seemed to be quite familiar and perfectly satisfied.
In a few minutes, the natives were all sitting on the ground in front of the shelter, enjoying a hearty meal of cold roast pig, several ducks, and a variety of cold fish, along with an endless supply of coconuts, breadfruit, yams, taro, and plums—of which they seemed well acquainted and perfectly content.
Meanwhile we three, being thoroughly knocked up with our day’s work, took a good draught of cocoa-nut lemonade, and throwing ourselves on our beds, fell fast asleep. The savages, it seems, followed our example, and in half-an-hour the whole camp was buried in repose.
Meanwhile, the three of us, completely exhausted from our day's work, enjoyed a refreshing glass of coconut lemonade and then collapsed onto our beds, falling fast asleep. Apparently, the savages followed our lead, and within half an hour, the entire camp was deep in slumber.
How long we slept I cannot tell; but this I know—that when we lay down the sun was setting, and when we awoke it was high in the heavens. I awoke Jack, who started up in surprise, being unable at first to comprehend our situation. “Now, then,” said he, springing up, “let’s see after breakfast.—Hallo, Peterkin, lazy fellow! how long do you mean to lie there?”
How long we slept, I can’t say; but I know this: when we went to sleep, the sun was setting, and when we woke up it was high in the sky. I shook Jack awake, and he jumped up in surprise, unable to immediately grasp what was going on. “Alright, then,” he said, standing up, “let’s see about breakfast. Hey, Peterkin, you lazy guy! How long are you going to lie there?”
Peterkin yawned heavily. “Well,” said he, opening his eyes and looking up after some trouble, “if it isn’t to-morrow morning, and me thinking it was to-day all this time—Hallo, Venus! where did you come from? You seem tolerably at home, anyhow. Bah! might as well speak to the cat as to you—better, in fact, for it understands me, and you don’t.”
Peterkin yawned widely. “Well,” he said, opening his eyes and looking up with some effort, “if it isn’t tomorrow morning, and I thought it was today all along—Hey, Venus! Where did you come from? You look pretty comfortable here, anyway. Ugh! Might as well talk to the cat as to you—actually better, because it understands me, and you don’t.”
This remark was called forth by the sight of one of the elderly females, who had seated herself on the rock in front of the bower, and having placed her child at her feet, was busily engaged in devouring the remains of a roast pig.
This comment was prompted by the sight of an older woman, who had sat down on the rock in front of the shelter, and had placed her child at her feet while she was happily eating the leftovers of a roast pig.
By this time the natives outside were all astir, and breakfast in an advanced state of preparation. During the course of it we made sundry attempts to converse with the natives by signs, but without effect. At last we hit upon a plan of discovering their names. Jack pointed to his breast and said “Jack” very distinctly; then he pointed to Peterkin and to me, repeating our names at the same time. Then he pointed to himself again and said “Jack,” and laying his finger on the breast of the chief, looked inquiringly into his face. The chief instantly understood him, and said “Tararo” twice distinctly. Jack repeated it after him, and the chief, nodding his head approvingly, said “Chuck,” on hearing which Peterkin exploded with laughter. But Jack turned, and with a frown rebuked him, saying, “I must look even more indignantly at you than I feel, Peterkin, you rascal, for these fellows don’t like to be laughed at.” Then turning towards the youngest of the women, who was seated at the door of the bower, he pointed to her; whereupon the chief said “Avatea,” and pointing towards the sun, raised his finger slowly towards the zenith, where it remained steadily for a minute or two.
By this time, the locals outside were bustling around, and breakfast was well underway. Throughout the meal, we made several attempts to communicate with the natives using gestures, but it didn’t work. Finally, we came up with a way to figure out their names. Jack pointed to his chest and said “Jack” clearly; then he pointed to Peterkin and to me, saying our names at the same time. He pointed to himself again and repeated “Jack,” then placed his finger on the chief’s chest and looked questioningly at him. The chief immediately understood and said “Tararo” clearly twice. Jack repeated it back to him, and the chief nodded in approval and said “Chuck,” which made Peterkin burst out laughing. But Jack turned to him with a frown and scolded, “I have to look even more angry at you than I actually am, Peterkin, you troublemaker, because these people don’t like being laughed at.” Then, turning to the youngest woman sitting at the entrance of the bower, he pointed at her. The chief replied with “Avatea,” then pointed toward the sun and raised his finger slowly up to the highest point in the sky, holding it there for a minute or two.
“What can that mean, I wonder?” said Jack, looking puzzled.
“What could that mean, I wonder?” Jack said, looking confused.
“Perhaps,” said Peterkin, “the chief means she is an angel come down to stay here for a while. If so, she’s an uncommonly black one!”
“Maybe,” said Peterkin, “the chief means she’s an angel sent down to stay here for a bit. If that’s the case, she’s an unusually dark one!”
We did not feel quite satisfied with this explanation, so Jack went up to her and said “Avatea.” The woman smiled sadly and nodded her head, at the same time pointing to her breast and then to the sun in the same manner as the chief had done. We were much puzzled to know what this could signify; but as there was no way of solving our difficulty, we were obliged to rest content.
We weren’t completely satisfied with this explanation, so Jack approached her and said, “Avatea.” The woman smiled sadly and nodded, while pointing to her chest and then to the sun, just like the chief had. We were really confused about what this could mean; but since there was no way to figure it out, we had to just accept it.
Jack now made signs to the natives to follow him, and taking up his axe, he led them to the place where the battle had been fought. Here we found the prisoners, who had passed the night on the beach, having been totally forgotten by us, as our minds had been full of our guests, and were ultimately overcome by sleep. They did not seem the worse for their exposure, however, as we judged by the hearty appetite with which they devoured the breakfast that was soon after given to them. Jack then began to dig a hole in the sand, and after working a few seconds, he pointed to it and to the dead bodies that lay exposed on the beach. The natives immediately perceived what he wanted, and running for their paddles, dug a hole in the course of half-an-hour that was quite large enough to contain all the bodies of the slain. When it was finished, they tossed their dead enemies into it with so much indifference that we felt assured they would not have put themselves to this trouble had we not asked them to do so. The body of the yellow-haired chief was the last thrown in. This wretched man would have recovered from the blow with which Jack felled him, and indeed he did endeavour to rise during the mêlée that followed his fall; but one of his enemies, happening to notice the action, dealt him a blow with his club that killed him on the spot.
Jack now signaled to the locals to follow him, and grabbing his axe, he led them to the site of the battle. There, we found the prisoners who had spent the night on the beach, completely forgotten by us as we were focused on our guests and eventually fell asleep. They didn't seem worse for their exposure, as evidenced by the hearty way they devoured the breakfast we soon provided. Jack then started to dig a hole in the sand, and after a few moments of work, he pointed to it and to the dead bodies lying exposed on the beach. The locals immediately understood what he wanted, and after fetching their paddles, they dug a hole in about half an hour that was large enough to hold all the bodies of the slain. Once it was done, they tossed their dead enemies in with such indifference that we were sure they wouldn't have bothered if we hadn't asked them to. The body of the yellow-haired chief was the last one thrown in. This unfortunate man could have survived the blow from Jack, and in fact, he did try to get up during the chaos that followed his fall; but one of his enemies, noticing this, struck him with a club and killed him instantly.
While they were about to throw the sand over this chief, one of the savages stooped over him, and with a knife, made apparently of stone, cut a large slice of flesh from his thigh. We knew at once that he intended to make use of this for food, and could not repress a cry of horror and disgust.
While they were about to throw sand over this chief, one of the savages bent down and, with a knife that looked like it was made of stone, cut a large piece of flesh from his thigh. We immediately realized that he planned to use this for food, and we couldn't help but let out a scream of horror and disgust.
“Come, come, you blackguard!” cried Jack, starting up and seizing the man by the arm, “pitch that into the hole. Do you hear?”
“Come on, you scoundrel!” yelled Jack, jumping up and grabbing the man by the arm, “throw that into the hole. Do you hear me?”
The savage, of course, did not understand the command; but he perfectly understood the look of disgust with which Jack regarded the flesh, and his fierce gaze as he pointed towards the hole. Nevertheless, he did not obey. Jack instantly turned to Tararo and made signs to him to enforce obedience. The chief seemed to understand the appeal; for he stepped forward, raised his club, and was on the point of dashing out the brains of his offending subject when Jack sprang forward and caught his uplifted arm.
The savage, of course, didn’t understand the command; but he completely grasped the look of disgust with which Jack stared at the flesh, along with his fierce gaze as he pointed toward the hole. Still, he didn’t comply. Jack quickly turned to Tararo and gestured for him to enforce obedience. The chief seemed to get the hint; he stepped forward, raised his club, and was about to smash his offending subject’s head when Jack rushed forward and grabbed his raised arm.
“Stop, you blockhead!” he shouted. “I don’t want you to kill the man!” He then pointed again to the flesh and to the hole. The chief uttered a few words, which had the desired effect; for the man threw the flesh into the hole, which was immediately filled up. This man was of a morose, sulky disposition, and during all the time he remained on the island, regarded us—especially Jack—with a scowling visage. His name, we found, was Mahine.
“Stop, you idiot!” he shouted. “I don’t want you to kill the man!” He then pointed again at the meat and the hole. The chief said a few words, which worked, because the man threw the meat into the hole, which was then immediately filled in. This man had a gloomy, sullen demeanor, and throughout his time on the island, he looked at us—especially Jack—with a frown. We learned that his name was Mahine.
The next three or four days were spent by the savages in mending their canoe, which had been damaged by the violent shock it had sustained on striking the shore. This canoe was a very curious structure. It was about thirty feet long, and had a high, towering stern. The timbers of which it was partly composed were fastened much in the same way as those of our little boat were put together; but the part that seemed most curious to us was a sort of outrigger, or long plank, which was attached to the body of the canoe by means of two stout cross-beams. These beams kept the plank parallel with the canoe, but not in contact with it, for it floated in the water with an open space between—thus forming a sort of double canoe. This, we found, was intended to prevent the upsetting of the canoe, which was so narrow that it could not have maintained an upright position without the outrigger. We could not help wondering both at the ingenuity and the clumsiness of this contrivance.
The next three or four days were spent by the natives fixing their canoe, which had been damaged by the hard impact when it hit the shore. This canoe was quite an interesting design. It was about thirty feet long and had a high, towering back end. The timbers that made it up were attached in a similar way to how our small boat was constructed; however, what caught our attention most was a sort of outrigger, or long plank, which was connected to the canoe's body by two strong cross-beams. These beams kept the plank parallel to the canoe, but not touching it, as it floated in the water with a gap in between—creating a sort of double canoe. We discovered that this was meant to stop the canoe from tipping over since it was so narrow that it couldn't stay upright without the outrigger. We couldn't help but admire both the cleverness and the awkwardness of this design.
When the canoe was ready, we assisted the natives to carry the prisoners into it, and helped them to load it with provisions and fruit. Peterkin also went to the plum-tree for the purpose of making a special onslaught upon the hogs, and killed no less than six of them. These we baked and presented to our friends, on the day of their departure. On that day Tararo made a great many energetic signs to us, which, after much consideration, we came to understand were proposals that we should go away with him to his island; but having no desire to do so, we shook our heads very decidedly. However, we consoled him by presenting him with our rusty axe, which we thought we could spare, having the excellent one which had been so providentially washed ashore to us the day we were wrecked. We also gave him a piece of wood with our names carved on it, and a piece of string to hang it round his neck as an ornament.
When the canoe was ready, we helped the natives carry the prisoners into it and loaded it with supplies and fruit. Peterkin also went to the plum tree to specifically target the hogs and managed to kill six of them. We baked these and served them to our friends on the day of their departure. On that day, Tararo made a lot of enthusiastic gestures towards us, which after some thought, we realized were invitations for us to join him on his island; but since we didn’t want to go, we shook our heads firmly. However, we cheered him up by giving him our old axe, which we thought we could spare since we had the excellent one that had miraculously washed ashore the day we were wrecked. We also gave him a carved piece of wood with our names on it and a piece of string so he could wear it around his neck as a decoration.
In a few minutes more we were all assembled on the beach. Being unable to speak to the savages, we went through the ceremony of shaking hands, and expected they would depart; but before doing so, Tararo went up to Jack and rubbed noses with him, after which he did the same with Peterkin and me! Seeing that this was their mode of salutation, we determined to conform to their custom; so we rubbed noses heartily with the whole party, women and all! The only disagreeable part of the process was when we came to rub noses with Mahine; and Peterkin afterwards said that when he saw his wolfish eyes glaring so close to his face, he felt much more inclined to bang than to rub his nose. Avatea was the last to take leave of us, and we experienced a feeling of real sorrow when she approached to bid us farewell. Besides her modest air and gentle manners, she was the only one of the party who exhibited the smallest sign of regret at parting from us. Going up to Jack, she put out her flat little nose to be rubbed, and thereafter paid the same compliment to Peterkin and me.
In just a few minutes, we were all gathered on the beach. Since we couldn’t speak to the natives, we went through the ritual of shaking hands, expecting them to leave afterward. However, before they did, Tararo approached Jack and rubbed noses with him, then did the same with Peterkin and me! Realizing this was their way of greeting, we decided to follow their example; so we rubbed noses enthusiastically with the whole group, women included! The only unpleasant part was when it came to rubbing noses with Mahine; Peterkin later said that when he saw Mahine’s wolfish eyes so close to his face, he felt much more like hitting than rubbing noses. Avatea was the last to say goodbye, and we genuinely felt sad when she came to bid us farewell. Besides her modest demeanor and gentle manners, she was the only one in the group who showed any real sign of sadness at leaving us. She walked up to Jack, extended her flat little nose for a rub, and then did the same for Peterkin and me.
An hour later the canoe was out of sight; and we, with an indefinable feeling of sadness creeping round our hearts, were seated in silence beneath the shadow of our bower, meditating on the wonderful events of the last few days.
An hour later, the canoe disappeared from view, and we, with a vague sense of sadness settling in our hearts, sat in silence under the shade of our shelter, reflecting on the amazing events of the past few days.
Chapter Twenty One.
Sagacious and moral remarks in regard to life—A sail!—An unexpected salute—The end of the black cat—A terrible dive—An incautious proceeding and a frightful catastrophe.
Life is a strange compound. Peterkin used to say of it that it beat a druggist’s shop all to sticks; for whereas the first is a compound of good and bad, the other is a horrible compound of all that is utterly detestable. And indeed the more I consider it, the more I am struck with the strange mixture of good and evil that exists, not only in the material earth, but in our own natures. In our own Coral Island we had experienced every variety of good that a bountiful Creator could heap on us. Yet on the night of the storm we had seen how almost, in our case—and altogether, no doubt, in the case of others less fortunate—all this good might be swept away for ever. We had seen the rich fruit-trees waving in the soft air, the tender herbs shooting upwards under the benign influence of the bright sun; and the next day we had seen these good and beautiful trees and plants uprooted by the hurricane, crushed and hurled to the ground in destructive devastation. We had lived for many months in a clime, for the most part, so beautiful that we had often wondered whether Adam and Eve had found Eden more sweet; and we had seen the quiet solitudes of our paradise suddenly broken in upon by ferocious savages, and the white sands stained with blood and strewed with lifeless forms, yet among these cannibals we had seen many symptoms of a kindly nature. I pondered these things much, and while I considered them there recurred to my memory those words which I had read in my Bible: “The works of God are wonderful, and His ways past finding out.”
Life is a strange mix. Peterkin used to say it was crazier than a druggist’s shop; because while life is a blend of good and bad, the shop is just full of things that are truly awful. The more I think about it, the more I notice the odd combination of good and evil that exists, not just in the physical world, but within ourselves. In our own Coral Island, we had experienced every kind of good that a generous Creator could provide. Yet on the night of the storm, we realized how quickly all of that good could be lost forever—almost for us, and certainly for others who were less fortunate. We had watched the lush fruit trees swaying in the gentle breeze, the tender herbs growing strong under the warm sun; then the next day, we saw those beautiful trees and plants ripped from the ground by the hurricane, destroyed and scattered everywhere. We had enjoyed many months in a place so stunning that we often wondered if Adam and Eve found Eden even sweeter; then we saw the peaceful solitude of our paradise shattered by savage attackers, with the white sands soaked in blood and covered in lifeless bodies, and yet among those cannibals, we noticed many signs of kindness. I thought about these things a lot, and while reflecting, I remembered those words I read in the Bible: “The works of God are wonderful, and His ways past finding out.”
After these poor savages had left us we used to hold long and frequent conversations about them, and I noticed that Peterkin’s manner was now much altered. He did not, indeed, jest less heartily than before, but he did so less frequently; and often there was a tone of deep seriousness in his manner, if not in his words, which made him seem to Jack and me as if he had grown two years older within a few days. But indeed I was not surprised at this when I reflected on the awful realities which we had witnessed so lately. We could by no means shake off a tendency to gloom for several weeks afterwards; but as time wore away, our usual good spirits returned somewhat, and we began to think of the visit of the savages with feelings akin to those with which we recall a terrible dream.
After those poor savages left us, we would have long and frequent talks about them, and I noticed that Peterkin had changed quite a bit. He didn’t joke as much as before, but when he did, there was often a serious tone in his demeanor, if not in his words, that made Jack and me feel like he had aged two years in just a few days. I wasn’t really surprised by this when I thought about the awful things we had just seen. We couldn’t shake off our gloomy feelings for several weeks, but as time passed, our usual good spirits gradually returned, and we started to think about the savages' visit with feelings similar to those we have when recalling a terrifying dream.
One day we were all enjoying ourselves in the Water Garden preparatory to going on a fishing excursion, for Peterkin had kept us in such constant supply of hogs that we had become quite tired of pork and desired a change. Peterkin was sunning himself on the ledge of rock, while we were creeping among the rocks below. Happening to look up, I observed Peterkin cutting the most extraordinary capers and making violent gesticulations for us to come up; so I gave Jack a push and rose immediately.
One day, we were all having a great time in the Water Garden getting ready for a fishing trip since Peterkin had kept us so stocked with pork that we were pretty tired of it and wanted something different. Peterkin was lounging on a rock ledge, while we were exploring the rocks below. When I looked up, I saw Peterkin doing the most ridiculous dances and waving his arms wildly for us to come up, so I nudged Jack and got up right away.
“A sail! a sail—Ralph, look—Jack, away on the horizon there, just over the entrance to the lagoon!” cried Peterkin as we scrambled up the rocks.
“A sail! A sail—Ralph, look—Jack, out on the horizon there, just over the entrance to the lagoon!” cried Peterkin as we hurried up the rocks.
“So it is—and a schooner, too!” said Jack as he proceeded hastily to dress.
“So it is—and a schooner, too!” Jack said as he hurried to get dressed.
Our hearts were thrown into a terrible flutter by this discovery, for if it should touch at our island, we had no doubt the captain would be happy to give us a passage to some of the civilised islands, where we could find a ship sailing for England or some other part of Europe. Home, with all its associations, rushed in upon my heart like a flood; and much though I loved the Coral Island and the bower which had now been our home so long, I felt that I could have quitted all at that moment without a sigh. With joyful anticipations we hastened to the highest point of rock near our dwelling and awaited the arrival of the vessel, for we now perceived that she was making straight for the island under a steady breeze.
Our hearts raced with excitement at this discovery because if it reached our island, we were sure the captain would gladly give us a ride to some civilized islands where we could catch a ship to England or somewhere else in Europe. Thoughts of home, with all its memories, flooded my heart; and even though I loved Coral Island and the shelter that had been our home for so long, I felt I could leave it all behind in that moment without a second thought. With joyful hopes, we hurried to the highest rock near our home and waited for the ship's arrival, as we now saw that it was headed straight for the island with a steady breeze.
In less than an hour she was close to the reef, where she rounded-to and backed her topsails in order to survey the coast. Seeing this, and fearing that they might not perceive us, we all three waved pieces of cocoa-nut cloth in the air, and soon had the satisfaction of seeing them beginning to lower a boat and bustle about the decks as if they meant to land. Suddenly a flag was run up to the peak, a little cloud of white smoke rose from the schooner’s side, and before we could guess their intentions, a cannon-shot came crashing through the bushes, carried away several cocoa-nut trees in its passage, and burst in atoms against the cliff a few yards below the spot on which we stood.
In less than an hour, she was near the reef, where she turned around and adjusted her sails to get a better look at the coast. Noticing this, and worried that they might not see us, the three of us waved pieces of coconut cloth in the air. Soon, we were pleased to see them start lowering a boat and moving around the deck as if they were getting ready to land. Suddenly, a flag was raised at the peak, a small puff of white smoke appeared from the side of the schooner, and before we could figure out what they were up to, a cannon shot blasted through the bushes, took down several coconut trees on its way, and exploded against the cliff just a few yards below where we were standing.
With feelings of terror we now observed that the flag at the schooner’s peak was black, with a Death’s-head and cross-bones upon it. As we gazed at each other in blank amazement, the word “pirate” escaped our lips simultaneously.
With a sense of dread, we now noticed that the flag at the top of the schooner was black, featuring a skull and crossbones. As we looked at each other in stunned disbelief, we all simultaneously whispered the word "pirate."
“What is to be done?” cried Peterkin as we observed a boat shoot from the vessel’s side and make for the entrance of the reef. “If they take us off the island, it will either be to throw us overboard for sport or to make pirates of us.”
“What are we going to do?” cried Peterkin as we watched a boat leave the ship and head toward the entrance of the reef. “If they take us off the island, it will either be to toss us overboard for fun or to make us into pirates.”
I did not reply, but looked at Jack, as being our only resource in this emergency. He stood with folded arms, and his eyes fixed with a grave, anxious expression on the ground. “There is but one hope,” said he, turning with a sad expression of countenance to Peterkin. “Perhaps, after all, we may not have to resort to it. If these villains are anxious to take us, they will soon overrun the whole island. But come, follow me.”
I didn’t respond, but looked at Jack, our only option in this situation. He stood with his arms crossed, his eyes focused on the ground with a serious, worried look. “There’s only one hope,” he said, turning to Peterkin with a sad expression. “Maybe we won’t have to use it after all. If these guys are eager to catch us, they’ll quickly take over the entire island. But come on, follow me.”
Stopping abruptly in his speech, Jack bounded into the woods, and led us by a circuitous route to Spouting Cliff. Here he halted, and advancing cautiously to the rocks, glanced over their edge. We were soon by his side, and saw the boat, which was crowded with armed men, just touching the shore. In an instant the crew landed, formed line, and rushed up to our bower.
Stopping suddenly in his speech, Jack jumped into the woods and took us on a winding path to Spouting Cliff. Once there, he stopped and carefully approached the rocks to look over the edge. We quickly joined him and saw a boat, packed with armed men, just reaching the shore. In a flash, the crew disembarked, lined up, and charged towards our shelter.
In a few seconds we saw them hurrying back to the boat, one of them swinging the poor cat round his head by the tail. On reaching the water’s edge he tossed it far into the sea, and joined his companions, who appeared to be holding a hasty council.
In a few seconds, we saw them rushing back to the boat, one of them swinging the poor cat around his head by the tail. When he got to the water’s edge, he threw it far into the sea and joined his friends, who seemed to be having a quick meeting.
“You see what we may expect,” said Jack bitterly. “The man who will wantonly kill a poor brute for sport will think little of murdering a fellow-creature. Now, boys, we have but one chance left—the Diamond Cave.”
“You see what we can expect,” Jack said bitterly. “A man who will casually kill a poor animal for fun won’t think twice about taking a human life. Now, guys, we have only one chance left—the Diamond Cave.”
“The Diamond Cave!” cried Peterkin. “Then my chance is a poor one, for I could not dive into it if all the pirates on the Pacific were at my heels.”
“The Diamond Cave!” shouted Peterkin. “Then my chances are slim, because I couldn't dive into it even if all the pirates in the Pacific were right behind me.”
“Nay, but,” said I, “we will take you down, Peterkin, if you will only trust us.”
“Nah, but,” I said, “we’ll help you down, Peterkin, if you'll just trust us.”
As I spoke, we observed the pirates scatter over the beach, and radiate, as if from a centre, towards the woods and along shore.
As I talked, we watched the pirates spread out across the beach and move away from a central point, heading into the woods and along the shore.
“Now, Peterkin,” said Jack in a solemn tone, “you must make up your mind to do it, or we must make up our minds to die in your company.”
“Now, Peterkin,” Jack said seriously, “you need to decide to do it, or we have to decide to die with you.”
“Oh Jack, my dear friend!” cried Peterkin, turning pale, “leave me; I don’t believe they’ll think it worth while to kill me. Go, you and Ralph, and dive into the cave.”
“Oh Jack, my dear friend!” cried Peterkin, turning pale, “leave me; I don’t think they’ll bother to kill me. Go, you and Ralph, and dive into the cave.”
“That will not I,” answered Jack quietly, while he picked up a stout cudgel from the ground.—“So now, Ralph, we must prepare to meet these fellows. Their motto is ‘No quarter.’ If we can manage to floor those coming in this direction, we may escape into the woods for a while.”
“That won’t be me,” Jack replied quietly as he picked up a heavy stick from the ground. “So now, Ralph, we need to get ready to face these guys. Their motto is ‘No mercy.’ If we can take down those coming this way, we might be able to escape into the woods for a bit.”
“There are five of them,” said I; “we have no chance.”
“There are five of them,” I said; “we don’t stand a chance.”
“Come, then!” cried Peterkin, starting up and grasping Jack convulsively by the arm; “let us dive. I will go.”
“Come on!” shouted Peterkin, jumping up and gripping Jack tightly by the arm; “let’s dive. I’m going.”
Those who are not naturally expert in the water know well the feelings of horror that overwhelm them, when in it, at the bare idea of being held down even for a few seconds—that spasmodic, involuntary recoil from compulsory immersion which has no connection whatever with cowardice; and they will understand the amount of resolution that it required in Peterkin to allow himself to be dragged down to a depth of ten feet, and then, through a narrow tunnel, into an almost pitch-dark cavern. But there was no alternative. The pirates had already caught sight of us, and were now within a short distance of the rocks.
Those who aren't naturally good in the water know the intense fear that hits them when they're submerged, even just the thought of being held underwater for a few seconds—it's that sudden, instinctive urge to resist being forced to dive, and it has nothing to do with being a coward. They will appreciate the courage it took for Peterkin to let himself be pulled down to a depth of ten feet, and then through a narrow tunnel into a nearly pitch-black cave. But there was no choice. The pirates had already spotted us and were now close to the rocks.
Jack and I seized Peterkin by the arms.
Jack and I grabbed Peterkin by the arms.
“Now, keep quite still—no struggling,” said Jack, “or we are lost!”
“Now, stay very still—no moving around,” said Jack, “or we’re done for!”
Peterkin made no reply; but the stern gravity of his marble features, and the tension of his muscles, satisfied us that he had fully made up his mind to go through with it. Just as the pirates gained the foot of the rocks, which hid us for a moment from their view, we bent over the sea and plunged down together, head foremost. Peterkin behaved like a hero. He floated passively between us like a log of wood, and we passed the tunnel and rose into the cave in a shorter space of time than I had ever done it before.
Peterkin didn't say anything, but the serious look on his face and the tightness in his muscles showed us that he was completely decided to go through with it. Just as the pirates reached the base of the rocks that briefly blocked them from seeing us, we leaned over the sea and dove down together, headfirst. Peterkin acted like a hero. He floated between us like a piece of driftwood, and we went through the tunnel and emerged into the cave faster than I had ever done before.
Peterkin drew a long, deep breath on reaching the surface, and in a few seconds we were all standing on the ledge of rock in safety. Jack now searched for the tinder and torch which always lay in the cave. He soon found them, and lighting the torch, revealed to Peterkin’s wondering gaze the marvels of the place. But we were too wet to waste much time in looking about us. Our first care was to take off our clothes and wring them as dry as we could. This done, we proceeded to examine into the state of our larder, for, as Jack truly remarked, there was no knowing how long the pirates might remain on the island.
Peterkin took a deep breath when he reached the surface, and in a few seconds, we were all safely standing on the rock ledge. Jack started looking for the tinder and torch that were always in the cave. He quickly found them, and lighting the torch, showed Peterkin the amazing things around us. But we were too wet to spend much time looking around. Our first priority was to take off our clothes and wring them out as best as we could. Once we did that, we checked on our food supplies, because as Jack rightly pointed out, we had no idea how long the pirates might stay on the island.
“Perhaps,” said Peterkin, “they may take it into their heads to stop here altogether, and so we shall be buried alive in this place.”
“Maybe,” said Peterkin, “they might decide to just stay here completely, and then we’ll be buried alive in this spot.”
“Don’t you think, Peterkin, that it’s the nearest thing to being drowned alive that you ever felt?” said Jack with a smile. “But I have no fear of that. These villains never stay long on shore. The sea is their home, so you may depend upon it that they won’t stay more than a day or two at the furthest.”
“Don’t you think, Peterkin, that it’s the closest thing to being drowned alive that you’ve ever experienced?” said Jack with a grin. “But I'm not worried about that. These crooks never stick around on land. The sea is their real home, so you can count on them not hanging around for more than a day or two at most.”
We now began to make arrangements for spending the night in the cavern. At various periods Jack and I had conveyed cocoa-nuts and other fruits, besides rolls of cocoa-nut cloth, to this submarine cave, partly for amusement, and partly from a feeling that we might possibly be driven one day to take shelter here from the savages. Little did we imagine that the first savages who would drive us into it would be white savages—perhaps our own countrymen! We found the cocoa-nuts in good condition, and the cooked yams; but the bread-fruits were spoiled. We also found the cloth where we had left it, and on opening it out, there proved to be sufficient to make a bed—which was important, as the rock was damp. Having collected it all together, we spread out our bed, placed our torch in the midst of us, and ate our supper. It was indeed a strange chamber to feast in; and we could not help remarking on the cold, ghastly appearance of the walls, and the black water at our side with the thick darkness beyond, and the sullen sound of the drops that fell at long intervals from the roof of the cavern into the still water, and the strong contrast between all this and our bed and supper, which, with our faces, were lit up with the deep-red flame of the torch.
We started getting ready to spend the night in the cave. Over time, Jack and I had brought cocoa nuts and other fruits, along with rolls of coconut fabric, to this underwater cave, partly for fun and partly because we thought we might someday need to hide from savages. Little did we know that the first savages to push us there would be white savages—maybe even our own countrymen! We found the cocoa nuts in good condition, as well as the cooked yams, but the breadfruits were spoiled. We also found the fabric where we left it, and when we opened it up, there was enough to make a bed—which was important since the rock was damp. Once we gathered everything together, we spread out our bed, placed our torch in the center, and had our supper. It was definitely a strange place to eat; we couldn’t help but notice the cold, eerie look of the walls, the black water beside us with thick darkness beyond it, and the dull sound of drops falling from the cave ceiling into the still water, contrasting sharply with our bed and supper, which, along with our faces, were lit up by the deep-red flames of the torch.
We sat long over our meal, talking together in subdued voices, for we did not like the dismal echoes that rang through the vault above when we happened to raise them. At last the faint light that came through the opening died away, warning us that it was night and time for rest. We therefore put out our torch and lay down to sleep.
We lingered over our meal, speaking in low voices, as we disliked the gloomy echoes that filled the space above whenever we spoke too loudly. Eventually, the dim light coming from the opening faded, signaling that it was night and time to rest. So, we extinguished our torch and lay down to sleep.
On awaking, it was some time ere we could collect our faculties so as to remember where we were, and we were in much uncertainty as to whether it was early or late. We saw by the faint light that it was day, but could not guess at the hour; so Jack proposed that he should dive out and reconnoitre.
On waking up, it took us a while to gather our thoughts and remember where we were, and we were unsure whether it was early or late. We could see from the dim light that it was daytime, but we couldn’t figure out what time it was; so Jack suggested that he should jump out and check.
“No, Jack,” said I; “do you rest here. You’ve had enough to do during the last few days. Rest yourself now, and take care of Peterkin, while I go out to see what the pirates are about. I’ll be very careful not to expose myself, and I’ll bring you word again in a short time.”
“No, Jack,” I said; “you stay here. You’ve done enough over the past few days. Take a break now, and look after Peterkin while I go out to see what the pirates are up to. I’ll be very careful not to put myself in danger, and I’ll let you know what I find out soon.”
“Very well, Ralph,” answered Jack; “please yourself. But don’t be long. And if you’ll take my advice, you’ll go in your clothes; for I would like to have some fresh cocoa-nuts, and climbing trees without clothes is uncomfortable—to say the least of it.”
“Alright, Ralph,” Jack replied; “do what you want. But don’t take too long. And if I were you, I’d wear your clothes; because I’d really like some fresh coconuts, and climbing trees without clothes is uncomfortable—at the very least.”
“The pirates will be sure to keep a sharp lookout,” said Peterkin; “so, pray, be careful.”
“The pirates will be sure to keep a close eye out,” said Peterkin; “so, please, be careful.”
“No fear,” said I. “Good-bye.”
“No fear,” I said. “Goodbye.”
“Good-bye,” answered my comrades.
“Goodbye,” replied my friends.
And while the words were yet sounding in my ears, I plunged into the water, and in a few seconds found myself in the open air. On rising, I was careful to come up gently and to breathe softly, while I kept close in beside the rocks; but as I observed no one near me, I crept slowly out and ascended the cliff, a step at a time, till I obtained a full view of the shore. No pirates were to be seen—even their boat was gone; but as it was possible they might have hidden themselves, I did not venture too boldly forward. Then it occurred to me to look out to sea, when, to my surprise, I saw the pirate schooner sailing away almost hull down on the horizon! On seeing this I uttered a shout of joy. Then my first impulse was to dive back to tell my companions the good news; but I checked myself, and ran to the top of the cliff in order to make sure that the vessel I saw was indeed the pirate schooner. I looked long and anxiously at her, and giving vent to a deep sigh of relief, said aloud, “Yes, there she goes; the villains have been balked of their prey this time at least!”
And while the words were still ringing in my ears, I jumped into the water, and in a few seconds found myself in the open air. When I surfaced, I made sure to come up slowly and breathe gently, staying close to the rocks. But when I saw no one around, I carefully crawled out and climbed up the cliff, taking it one step at a time, until I could see the entire shore. There were no pirates in sight—not even their boat was there; but since they could be hiding, I didn’t move too recklessly. Then it occurred to me to look out to sea, and to my surprise, I saw the pirate schooner sailing away, almost sunk low on the horizon! When I saw this, I let out a shout of joy. My first instinct was to dive back to tell my friends the good news, but I stopped myself and ran to the top of the cliff to make sure that the ship I saw was really the pirate schooner. I stared at it for a long time, feeling a deep sigh of relief, and said aloud, “Yes, there she goes; those villains have been thwarted this time at least!”
“Not so sure of that!” said a deep voice at my side, while at the same moment a heavy hand grasped my shoulder and held it as if in a vice.
“Not so sure about that!” said a deep voice next to me, and at the same time, a heavy hand landed on my shoulder and squeezed it tightly.
Chapter Twenty Two.
I fall into the hands of pirates—How they treated me, and what I said to them—The result of the whole ending in a melancholy separation and in a most unexpected gift.
My heart seemed to leap into my throat at the words; and turning round, I beheld a man of immense stature and fierce aspect regarding me with a smile of contempt. He was a white man—that is to say, he was a man of European blood, though his face, from long exposure to the weather, was deeply bronzed. His dress was that of a common seaman, except that he had on a Greek skull-cap, and wore a broad shawl of the richest silk round his waist. In this shawl were placed two pairs of pistols and a heavy cutlass. He wore a beard and moustache, which, like the locks on his head, were short, curly, and sprinkled with grey hairs.
My heart felt like it was jumping into my throat when I heard those words; and when I turned around, I saw a very tall man with a fierce look, looking at me with a smirk of disdain. He was a white man—that is, of European descent—but his face was deeply tanned from long exposure to the elements. He dressed like a regular sailor, except he had on a Greek skull-cap and a wide silk shawl wrapped around his waist. In that shawl, he had two pairs of pistols and a heavy cutlass. He had a beard and mustache, which, like the hair on his head, were short, curly, and sprinkled with gray hairs.
“So, youngster,” he said with a sardonic smile, while I felt his grasp tighten on my shoulder, “the villains have been balked of their prey, have they? We shall see—we shall see. Now, you whelp, look yonder!” As he spoke, the pirate uttered a shrill whistle. In a second or two it was answered, and the pirate boat rowed round the point at the Water Garden and came rapidly towards us. “Now, go make a fire on that point; and hark’ee, youngster, if you try to run away I’ll send a quick and sure messenger after you,” and he pointed significantly at his pistols.
“So, kid,” he said with a sarcastic smile, while I felt his grip tighten on my shoulder, “the bad guys have lost their target, huh? We’ll see about that. Now, you little brat, look over there!” As he spoke, the pirate let out a sharp whistle. A moment later, it was answered, and the pirate boat rounded the point at the Water Garden, quickly heading our way. “Now, go start a fire on that point; and listen up, kid, if you try to run, I’ll send someone after you in no time,” and he pointed meaningfully at his pistols.
I obeyed in silence; and as I happened to have the burning-glass in my pocket, a fire was speedily kindled, and a thick smoke ascended into the air. It had scarcely appeared for two minutes when the boom of a gun rolled over the sea, and looking up, I saw that the schooner was making for the island again. It now flashed across me that this was a ruse on the part of the pirates, and that they had sent their vessel away, knowing that it would lead us to suppose that they had left altogether. But there was no use of regret now. I was completely in their power; so I stood helplessly beside the pirate, watching the crew of the boat as they landed on the beach. For an instant I contemplated rushing over the cliff into the sea; but this, I saw, I could not now accomplish, as some of the men were already between me and the water.
I stayed quiet and, since I had the magnifying glass in my pocket, I quickly started a fire, and thick smoke began to rise into the air. It had barely been two minutes when I heard the boom of a gun echoing over the sea, and when I looked up, I saw that the schooner was heading back to the island. Suddenly, it hit me that this was a trick by the pirates; they must have sent their ship away, knowing it would make us think they'd left completely. But there was no point in regretting it now. I was totally at their mercy, so I stood helplessly by the pirate, watching the crew of the boat as they came ashore. For a moment, I thought about jumping off the cliff into the sea; but I quickly realized I couldn't do that since some of the men were already between me and the water.
There was a good deal of jesting at the success of their scheme, as the crew ascended the rocks and addressed the man who had captured me by the title of “Captain”. They were a ferocious set of men, with shaggy beards and scowling brows. All of them were armed with cutlasses and pistols, and their costumes were, with trifling variations, similar to that of the captain. As I looked from one to the other, and observed the low, scowling brows that never unbent even when the men laughed, and the mean, rascally expression that sat on each face, I felt that my life hung by a hair.
There was a lot of joking about the success of their plan as the crew climbed the rocks and called the man who had captured me “Captain.” They were a tough group, with unkempt beards and grim faces. Each of them was armed with cutlasses and pistols, and their outfits were, with slight variations, similar to the captain's. As I looked from one to another and noticed their low, furrowed brows that never relaxed even when the men laughed, and the petty, sneaky expression on each face, I felt like my life was hanging by a thread.
“But where are the other cubs?” cried one of the men with an oath that made me shudder. “I’ll swear to it there were three at least, if not more.”
“But where are the other cubs?” one of the men shouted, cursing in a way that made me shiver. “I swear there were at least three, if not more.”
“You hear what he says, whelp: where are the other dogs?” said the captain.
“You hear what he's saying, pup: where are the other dogs?” said the captain.
“If you mean my companions,” said I in a low voice, “I won’t tell you.”
“If you’re talking about my friends,” I said quietly, “I won’t tell you.”
A loud laugh burst from the crew at this answer.
A loud laugh erupted from the crew at this answer.
The pirate captain looked at me in surprise. Then drawing a pistol from his belt, he cocked it and said, “Now, youngster, listen to me. I’ve no time to waste here. If you don’t tell me all you know, I’ll blow your brains out! Where are your comrades?”
The pirate captain stared at me, surprised. Then he pulled a pistol from his belt, cocked it, and said, “Now, kid, listen up. I don’t have time to mess around. If you don’t tell me everything you know, I’ll blow your brains out! Where are your friends?”
For an instant I hesitated, not knowing what to do in this extremity. Suddenly a thought occurred to me.
For a moment, I hesitated, unsure of what to do in this situation. Then a thought suddenly popped into my mind.
“Villain,” said I, shaking my clenched fist in his face, “to blow my brains out would make short work of me, and be soon over; death by drowning is as sure, and the agony prolonged. Yet I tell you to your face, if you were to toss me over yonder cliff into the sea, I would not tell you where my companions are; and I dare you to try me!”
“Villain,” I said, shaking my fist in his face, “blowing my brains out would be quick and easy, but drowning would definitely kill me and take much longer. Still, I’m telling you to your face, if you were to throw me over that cliff into the sea, I wouldn’t tell you where my friends are; I dare you to try!”
The pirate captain grew white with rage as I spoke. “Say you so?” cried he, uttering a fierce oath.—“Here, lads, take him by the legs and heave him in—quick!”
The pirate captain turned pale with anger as I spoke. “Is that so?” he shouted, swearing fiercely. “Hey, guys, grab him by the legs and throw him in—hurry up!”
The men, who were utterly silenced with surprise at my audacity, advanced and seized me; and as they carried me towards the cliff, I congratulated myself not a little on the success of my scheme, for I knew that once in the water I should be safe, and could rejoin Jack and Peterkin in the cave. But my hopes were suddenly blasted by the captain crying out, “Hold on, lads, hold on! We’ll give him a taste of the thumb-screws before throwing him to the sharks. Away with him into the boat. Look alive! the breeze is freshening.”
The men, who were completely shocked by my boldness, moved forward and grabbed me; as they carried me toward the cliff, I felt pretty pleased with how my plan was going, because I knew that once I hit the water, I’d be safe and could reunite with Jack and Peterkin in the cave. But my hopes were shattered when the captain shouted, “Hold on, guys, hold on! We’ll give him a taste of the thumb-screws before tossing him to the sharks. Get him into the boat. Hurry up! The breeze is picking up.”
The men instantly raised me shoulder-high, and hurrying down the rocks, tossed me into the bottom of the boat, where I lay for some time stunned with the violence of my fall.
The men quickly lifted me up to shoulder height and rushed down the rocks, throwing me into the bottom of the boat, where I lay for a while, dazed from the force of my fall.
On recovering sufficiently to raise myself on my elbow, I perceived that we were already outside the coral reef and close alongside the schooner, which was of small size and clipper-built. I had only time to observe this much when I received a severe kick on the side from one of the men, who ordered me, in a rough voice, to jump aboard. Rising hastily, I clambered up the side. In a few minutes the boat was hoisted on deck, the vessel’s head put close to the wind, and the Coral Island dropped slowly astern as we beat up against a head sea.
On recovering enough to prop myself up on my elbow, I noticed that we were already outside the coral reef and right next to the schooner, which was small and had a sleek clipper design. I barely had time to take this in before one of the men kicked me hard in the side and shouted at me to jump on board. Quickly getting to my feet, I scrambled up the side. In a few minutes, the boat was pulled up onto the deck, the vessel's bow turned into the wind, and the Coral Island slowly fell behind as we fought against the incoming waves.
Immediately after coming aboard, the crew were too busily engaged in working the ship and getting in the boat to attend to me; so I remained leaning against the bulwarks close to the gangway, watching their operations. I was surprised to find that there were no guns or carronades of any kind in the vessel, which had more the appearance of a fast-sailing trader than a pirate. But I was struck with the neatness of everything. The brass-work of the binnacle and about the tiller, as well as the copper belaying-pins, were as brightly polished as if they had just come from the foundry. The decks were pure white and smooth. The masts were clean-scraped and varnished, except at the cross-trees and truck, which were painted black. The standing and running rigging was in the most perfect order, and the sails white as snow. In short, everything, from the single narrow red stripe on her low, black hull to the trucks on her tapering masts, evinced an amount of care and strict discipline that would have done credit to a ship of the Royal Navy. There was nothing lumbering or unseemly about the vessel, excepting, perhaps, a boat, which lay on the deck with its keel up between the fore and main masts. It seemed disproportionately large for the schooner; but when I saw that the crew amounted to between thirty and forty men, I concluded that this boat was held in reserve in case of any accident compelling the crew to desert the vessel.
As soon as I got on board, the crew was busy working the ship and preparing the boat, so they didn’t have time for me. I leaned against the bulwarks near the gangway, watching what they were doing. I was surprised to see that there were no guns or cannons on the ship, which looked more like a fast trader than a pirate vessel. But I was impressed by how tidy everything was. The brass work on the binnacle and around the tiller, as well as the copper belaying pins, were polished to a shine, as if they had just come from the factory. The decks were spotless and smooth. The masts were cleaned and varnished, except for the cross-trees and truck, which were painted black. The standing and running rigging was in perfect condition, and the sails were as white as snow. In short, everything, from the single narrow red stripe on her sleek black hull to the trucks on her tapering masts, showed a level of care and discipline that would make any Royal Navy ship proud. There was nothing clumsy or out of place about the vessel, except maybe a boat resting on the deck with its keel up between the fore and main masts. It seemed a bit too big for the schooner, but when I saw that the crew had between thirty and forty men, I figured the boat was a backup in case they had to abandon the ship.
As I have before said, the costumes of the men were similar to that of the captain. But in head-gear they differed, not only from him, but from each other—some wearing the ordinary straw hat of the merchant service, while others wore cloth caps and red worsted nightcaps. I observed that all their arms were sent below, the captain only retaining his cutlass and a single pistol in the folds of his shawl. Although the captain was the tallest and most powerful man in the ship, he did not strikingly excel many of his men in this respect; and the only difference that an ordinary observer would have noticed was a certain degree of open candour, straightforward daring, in the bold, ferocious expression of his face, which rendered him less repulsive than his low-browed associates, but did not by any means induce the belief that he was a hero. This look was, however, the indication of that spirit which gave him the pre-eminence among the crew of desperadoes who called him captain. He was a lion-like villain, totally devoid of personal fear, and utterly reckless of consequences, and therefore a terror to his men, who individually hated him, but unitedly felt it to be to their advantage to have him at their head.
As I mentioned before, the men's costumes were similar to the captain's. But they differed in headgear, not just from him, but from one another—some wore the standard straw hats of the merchant service, while others had cloth caps and red wool nightcaps. I noticed that all their weapons were put away, with the captain keeping only his cutlass and a single pistol tucked in his shawl. Although the captain was the tallest and strongest man on the ship, he wasn't significantly more imposing than many of his crew; the only difference an ordinary observer would notice was a certain openness and bravery reflected in his fierce expression, making him seem less intimidating than his more brooding associates, though it certainly didn’t make anyone think he was a hero. This expression was a sign of the spirit that set him apart among the gang of outlaws who called him captain. He was a lion-like villain, completely unafraid and totally reckless, making him a terror to his men, who each hated him individually but collectively found it beneficial to have him leading them.
But my thoughts soon reverted to the dear companions whom I had left on shore; and as I turned towards the Coral Island, which was now far away to leeward, I sighed deeply, and the tears rolled slowly down my cheeks as I thought that I might never see them more.
But my thoughts quickly went back to the dear friends I had left on shore; and as I turned towards the Coral Island, which was now far away behind me, I sighed deeply, and tears slowly rolled down my cheeks as I realized I might never see them again.
“So you’re blubbering, are you, you obstinate whelp?” said the deep voice of the captain as he came up and gave me a box on the ear that nearly felled me to the deck. “I don’t allow any such weakness aboard o’ this ship. So clap a stopper on your eyes, or I’ll give you something to cry for.”
“So you’re crying, are you, you stubborn kid?” said the captain in a deep voice as he approached and slapped me on the ear, almost knocking me down to the deck. “I don’t allow any weakness on this ship. So stop your whining, or I’ll give you something to really cry about.”
I flushed with indignation at this rough and cruel treatment, but felt that giving way to anger would only make matters worse; so I made no reply, but took out my handkerchief and dried my eyes.
I was upset by this harsh and unfair treatment, but I knew that giving in to my anger would only make things worse; so I didn’t say anything, but pulled out my handkerchief and dried my eyes.
“I thought you were made of better stuff,” continued the captain angrily. “I’d rather have a mad bulldog aboard than a water-eyed puppy. But I’ll cure you, lad, or introduce you to the sharks before long. Now go below, and stay there till I call you.”
“I thought you were made of stronger stuff,” the captain continued angrily. “I’d rather have a mad bulldog on board than a weepy puppy. But I’ll toughen you up, kid, or you’ll meet the sharks soon enough. Now go below deck and stay there until I call for you.”
As I walked forward to obey, my eye fell on a small keg standing by the side of the mainmast, on which the word gunpowder was written in pencil. It immediately flashed across me that as we were beating up against the wind, anything floating in the sea would be driven on the reef encircling the Coral Island. I also recollected—for thought is more rapid than the lightning—that my old companions had a pistol. Without a moment’s hesitation, therefore, I lifted the keg from the deck and tossed it into the sea! An exclamation of surprise burst from the captain and some of the men who witnessed this act of mine.
As I moved forward to comply, I noticed a small keg next to the mainmast, with the word gunpowder written in pencil on it. It hit me right then that since we were sailing against the wind, anything floating in the water would be pushed toward the reef surrounding Coral Island. I also remembered—because thoughts move faster than lightning—that my old friends had a pistol. So, without a second thought, I grabbed the keg from the deck and threw it into the sea! The captain and some of the crew exclaimed in surprise at my action.
Striding up to me, and uttering fearful imprecations, the captain raised his hand to strike me, while he shouted, “Boy! whelp! what mean you by that?”
Striding up to me and yelling angry threats, the captain raised his hand to hit me and shouted, “Boy! Whelp! What do you think you’re doing?”
“If you lower your hand,” said I in a loud voice, while I felt the blood rush to my temples, “I’ll tell you. Until you do so, I’m dumb.”
“If you put your hand down,” I said loudly, feeling the blood rush to my temples, “I’ll tell you. Until then, I’m silent.”
The captain stepped back and regarded me with a look of amazement.
The captain stepped back and looked at me in astonishment.
“Now,” continued I, “I threw that keg into the sea because the wind and waves will carry it to my friends on the Coral Island, who happen to have a pistol but no powder. I hope that it will reach them soon; and my only regret is that the keg was not a bigger one. Moreover, pirate, you said just now that you thought I was made of better stuff. I don’t know what stuff I am made of—I never thought much about that subject; but I’m quite certain of this—that I am made of such stuff as the like of you shall never tame, though you should do your worst!”
“Now,” I went on, “I tossed that keg into the sea because the wind and waves will take it to my friends on Coral Island, who have a pistol but no gunpowder. I hope it gets to them soon; my only regret is that the keg wasn’t bigger. Also, pirate, you just said that you thought I was made of better stuff. I don’t know what I’m made of—I’ve never thought much about it—but I’m sure of this: I’m made of stuff that someone like you will never tame, no matter how hard you try!”
To my surprise, the captain, instead of flying into a rage, smiled, and thrusting his hand into the voluminous shawl that encircled his waist, turned on his heel and walked aft, while I went below.
To my surprise, the captain, instead of getting really angry, smiled, and reaching into the large shawl wrapped around his waist, turned around and walked to the back, while I went downstairs.
Here, instead of being rudely handled, as I had expected, the men received me with a shout of laughter; and one of them, patting me on the back, said, “Well done, lad! You’re a brick, and I have no doubt will turn out a rare cove. Bloody Bill there was just such a fellow as you are, and he’s now the biggest cut-throat of us all.”
Here, instead of being treated roughly like I expected, the guys welcomed me with a laugh; and one of them, giving me a pat on the back, said, “Well done, kid! You’re a champ, and I have no doubt you’ll turn out to be something special. Bloody Bill over there was just like you, and now he’s the biggest thug among us.”
“Take a can of beer, lad,” cried another, “and wet your whistle after that speech o’ your’n to the captain. If any one o’ us had made it, youngster, he would have had no whistle to wet by this time.”
“Grab a can of beer, kid,” shouted another, “and quench your thirst after that speech of yours to the captain. If any of us had given it, you’d be out of luck by now.”
“Stop your clapper, Jack!” vociferated a third. “Give the boy a junk o’ meat. Don’t you see he’s a’most goin’ to kick the bucket?”
“Shut your mouth, Jack!” shouted a third. “Give the kid a chunk of meat. Can’t you see he’s about to pass out?”
“And no wonder,” said the first speaker with an oath, “after the tumble you gave him into the boat! I guess it would have broke your neck if you had got it.”
“And no wonder,” said the first speaker with a curse, “after the way you tossed him into the boat! I bet it would have broken your neck if you had landed that way.”
I did indeed feel somewhat faint, which was owing, doubtless, to the combined effects of ill-usage and hunger; for it will be recollected that I had dived out of the cave that morning before breakfast, and it was now near midday. I therefore gladly accepted a plate of boiled pork and a yam, which were handed to me by one of the men from the locker on which some of the crew were seated eating their dinner. But I must add that the zest with which I ate my meal was much abated in consequence of the frightful oaths and the terrible language that flowed from the lips of these godless men, even in the midst of their hilarity and good-humour. The man who had been alluded to as Bloody Bill was seated near me, and I could not help wondering at the moody silence he maintained among his comrades. He did indeed reply to their questions in a careless, off-hand tone, but he never volunteered a remark. The only difference between him and the others was his taciturnity and his size, for he was nearly, if not quite, as large a man as the captain.
I did feel a bit faint, probably because of a mix of mistreatment and hunger. Remember, I had left the cave that morning before breakfast, and it was now close to midday. So I gladly accepted a plate of boiled pork and a yam from one of the men sitting on a locker while some of the crew were having their dinner. However, I have to say that my enjoyment of the meal was greatly diminished by the awful swearing and terrible language coming from these godless men, even while they were laughing and in a good mood. The man known as Bloody Bill was sitting near me, and I couldn’t help but notice his sullen silence compared to his shipmates. He did respond to their questions in a casual way, but he never joined in the conversation. The only real difference between him and the others was his quietness and his size since he was nearly, if not completely, as big as the captain.
During the remainder of the afternoon I was left to my own reflections, which were anything but agreeable; for I could not banish from my mind the threat about the thumbscrews, of the nature and use of which I had a vague but terrible conception. I was still meditating on my unhappy fate when, just after nightfall, one of the watch on deck called down the hatchway:
During the rest of the afternoon, I was left to my own thoughts, which were anything but pleasant; I couldn’t shake off the terrifying idea of the thumbscrews, which I had a vague but horrifying understanding of. I was still thinking about my unfortunate situation when, just after nightfall, one of the guards on deck called down the hatchway:
“Hallo, there! One o’ you tumble up and light the cabin lamp, and send that boy aft to the captain—sharp!”
“Hey there! One of you get up and turn on the cabin lamp, and send that kid back to the captain—quick!”
“Now, then, do you hear, youngster? the captain wants you. Look alive!” said Bloody Bill, raising his huge frame from the locker on which he had been asleep for the last two hours. He sprang up the ladder, and I instantly followed him, and going aft, was shown into the cabin by one of the men, who closed the door after me.
“Hey, kid, do you hear that? The captain wants to see you. Get moving!” said Bloody Bill, lifting his large body off the locker where he had been napping for the past two hours. He jumped up the ladder, and I immediately followed him. Once we reached the back, one of the crew members showed me into the cabin and closed the door behind me.
A small silver lamp which hung from a beam threw a dim, soft light over the cabin, which was a small apartment, and comfortably but plainly furnished. Seated on a camp-stool at the table, and busily engaged in examining a chart of the Pacific, was the captain, who looked up as I entered, and in a quiet voice bade me be seated, while he threw down his pencil, and rising from the table, stretched himself on a sofa at the upper end of the cabin.
A small silver lamp hanging from a beam cast a dim, soft light over the cabin, which was a small apartment, simply but comfortably furnished. The captain was seated at the table on a camp-stool, intently studying a chart of the Pacific. He looked up as I walked in and calmly invited me to take a seat while he dropped his pencil and got up from the table, stretching out on a sofa at the end of the cabin.
“Boy,” said he, looking me full in the face, “what is your name?”
“Boy,” he said, looking me straight in the eye, “what’s your name?”
“Ralph Rover,” I replied.
“Ralph Rover,” I said.
“Where did you come from, and how came you to be on that island? How many companions had you on it? Answer me, now, and mind you tell no lies.”
“Where did you come from, and how did you end up on that island? How many companions did you have with you? Answer me now, and make sure you're telling the truth.”
“I never tell lies,” said I firmly.
“I never lie,” I said firmly.
The captain received this reply with a cold, sarcastic smile, and bade me answer his questions.
The captain responded to this reply with a cold, sarcastic smile and told me to answer his questions.
I then told him the history of myself and my companions from the time we sailed till the day of his visit to the island—taking care, however, to make no mention of the Diamond Cave. After I had concluded, he was silent for a few minutes; then looking up, he said, “Boy, I believe you.”
I then shared the story of my journey and my friends from the moment we set sail until the day he came to the island—being careful not to mention the Diamond Cave. After I finished, he was quiet for a few minutes; then he looked up and said, “Boy, I believe you.”
I was surprised at this remark, for I could not imagine why he should not believe me. However, I made no reply.
I was taken aback by this comment because I couldn't understand why he wouldn't believe me. Still, I didn't say anything.
“And what,” continued the captain, “makes you think that this schooner is a pirate?”
“And what,” the captain continued, “makes you think that this schooner is a pirate?”
“The black flag,” said I, “showed me what you are; and if any further proof were wanting, I have had it in the brutal treatment I have received at your hands.”
“The black flag,” I said, “showed me who you really are; and if I needed any more proof, I’ve seen it in the harsh way you’ve treated me.”
The captain frowned as I spoke; but, subduing his anger, he continued, “Boy, you are too bold. I admit that we treated you roughly, but that was because you made us lose time and gave us a good deal of trouble. As to the black flag, that is merely a joke that my fellows play off upon people sometimes in order to frighten them. It is their humour, and does no harm. I am no pirate, boy, but a lawful trader—a rough one, I grant you; but one can’t help that in these seas, where there are so many pirates on the water and such murderous blackguards on the land. I carry on a trade in sandal-wood with the Feejee Islands; and if you choose, Ralph, to behave yourself and be a good boy, I’ll take you along with me and give you a good share of the profits. You see, I’m in want of an honest boy like you to look after the cabin, and keep the log, and superintend the traffic on shore sometimes. What say you, Ralph: would you like to become a sandal-wood trader?”
The captain frowned as I spoke; but, controlling his anger, he continued, “Kid, you’re too bold. I admit we were rough with you, but that’s because you made us waste time and caused us a lot of trouble. As for the black flag, it’s just a joke my crew plays on people to scare them. It's their sense of humor and doesn't really hurt anyone. I'm not a pirate, kid, but a legitimate trader—a rough one, I’ll concede; but that’s just how it is in these waters, with so many pirates at sea and dangerous thugs on land. I trade in sandalwood with the Fiji Islands, and if you behave and act like a good kid, I’ll take you with me and give you a fair share of the profits. You see, I need an honest kid like you to look after the cabin, keep the log, and sometimes manage things on shore. What do you say, Ralph: would you like to become a sandalwood trader?”
I was much surprised by this explanation, and a good deal relieved to find that the vessel, after all, was not a pirate; but instead of replying, I said, “If it be as you state, then why did you take me from my island, and why do you not now take me back?”
I was really surprised by this explanation and quite relieved to find out that the ship wasn't a pirate after all; but instead of replying, I said, “If that’s true, then why did you take me from my island, and why aren’t you taking me back now?”
The captain smiled as he replied, “I took you off in anger, boy, and I’m sorry for it. I would even now take you back, but we are too far away from it. See, there it is,” he added, laying his finger on the chart; “and we are now here—fifty miles, at least. It would not be fair to my men to put about now, for they have all an interest in the trade.”
The captain smiled as he responded, “I pulled you off in anger, kid, and I’m sorry about that. I’d even take you back now, but we’re too far away from it. Look, there it is,” he said, pointing at the chart; “and we’re over here—at least fifty miles away. It wouldn’t be fair to my crew to turn back now since they all have a stake in the trade.”
I could make no reply to this; so, after a little more conversation, I agreed to become one of the crew—at least, until we could reach some civilised island where I might be put ashore. The captain assented to this proposition; and after thanking him for the promise, I left the cabin and went on deck with feelings that ought to have been lighter, but which were, I could not tell why, marvellously heavy and uncomfortable still.
I couldn’t respond to that, so after chatting a bit more, I agreed to join the crew—at least until we got to some civilized island where I could be dropped off. The captain agreed to this plan, and after thanking him for the promise, I left the cabin and went up on deck with feelings that should have been lighter, but for some reason felt strangely heavy and uncomfortable.
Chapter Twenty Three.
Bloody Bill—Dark surmises—A strange sail, and a strange crew, and a still stranger cargo—New reasons for favouring missionaries—A murderous massacre, and thoughts thereon.
Three weeks after the conversation narrated in the last chapter I was standing on the quarter-deck of the schooner, watching the gambols of a shoal of porpoises that swam round us. It was a dead calm—one of those still, hot, sweltering days so common in the Pacific, when nature seems to have gone to sleep, and the only thing in water or in air that proves her still alive is her long, deep breathing in the swell of the mighty sea. No cloud floated in the deep blue above, no ripple broke the reflected blue below. The sun shone fiercely in the sky, and a ball of fire blazed with almost equal power from out the bosom of the water. So intensely still was it, and so perfectly transparent was the surface of the deep, that had it not been for the long swell already alluded to, we might have believed the surrounding universe to be a huge, blue, liquid ball, and our little ship the one solitary material speck in all creation floating in the midst of it.
Three weeks after the conversation described in the last chapter, I was standing on the quarter-deck of the schooner, watching a group of porpoises swimming around us. It was perfectly calm—one of those still, hot, sweltering days that are common in the Pacific, when nature seems to have fallen asleep, and the only indication that it’s still alive is the long, deep breathing of the ocean’s swell. No clouds floated in the deep blue sky above, and no ripples broke the reflected blue below. The sun blazed fiercely in the sky, and a ball of fire shone with almost equal intensity from the surface of the water. It was so intensely still, and the surface of the deep was so transparent, that if it hadn't been for the long swell I mentioned before, we might have thought the surrounding universe was a giant, blue, liquid sphere, with our little ship being the only solid speck in all of creation floating in the middle of it.
No sound broke on our ears save the soft puff now and then of a porpoise, the slow creak of the masts as we swayed gently on the swell, the patter of the reef-points, and the occasional flap of the hanging sails. An awning covered the fore and after parts of the schooner, under which the men composing the watch on deck lolled in sleepy indolence, overcome with excessive heat. Bloody Bill, as the men invariably called him, was standing at the tiller; but his post for the present was a sinecure, and he whiled away the time by alternately gazing in dreamy abstraction at the compass in the binnacle and by walking to the taffrail in order to spit into the sea. In one of these turns he came near to where I was standing, and leaning over the side, looked long and earnestly down into the blue wave.
No sound reached our ears except for the soft puff of a porpoise every now and then, the slow creak of the masts as we gently swayed with the waves, the patter of the reef-points, and the occasional flap of the hanging sails. An awning covered the front and back parts of the schooner, where the crew on deck lounged in sleepy laziness, overwhelmed by the heat. Bloody Bill, as the men always called him, was at the tiller; but for now, his job was an easy one, and he passed the time by alternately staring dreamily at the compass in the binnacle and walking to the back of the boat to spit into the sea. During one of these walks, he came close to where I was standing and leaned over the side, looking intently down into the blue water.
This man, although he was always taciturn and often surly, was the only human being on board with whom I had the slightest desire to become better acquainted. The other men, seeing that I did not relish their company, and knowing that I was a protégé of the captain, treated me with total indifference. Bloody Bill, it is true, did the same; but as this was his conduct to every one else, it was not peculiar in reference to me. Once or twice I tried to draw him into conversation, but he always turned away after a few cold monosyllables. As he now leaned over the taffrail, close beside me, I said to him:
This guy, even though he was always quiet and often grumpy, was the only person on board I actually wanted to get to know better. The other guys noticed that I wasn't into hanging out with them, and since I was the captain's protégé, they completely ignored me. Bloody Bill acted the same way, but that was just how he treated everyone, so it wasn't anything personal. I tried a couple of times to get him to talk, but he always just gave me a few cold one-word replies and turned away. Now, as he leaned over the rail next to me, I said to him:
“Bill, why is it that you are so gloomy? Why do you never speak to any one?”
“Bill, why are you so down? Why don’t you ever talk to anyone?”
Bill smiled slightly as he replied, “Why, I s’pose it’s because I hain’t got nothin’ to say!”
Bill smiled a little as he replied, “I guess it’s because I don’t have anything to say!”
“That’s strange,” said I musingly. “You look like a man that could think, and such men can usually speak.”
“That’s odd,” I said thoughtfully. “You look like someone who can think, and people like that usually know how to speak.”
“So they can, youngster,” rejoined Bill somewhat sternly; “and I could speak too if I had a mind to, but what’s the use o’ speakin’ here? The men only open their mouths to curse and swear, and they seem to find it entertainin’; but I don’t, so I hold my tongue.”
“So they can, kid,” Bill replied a bit sternly; “and I could chime in too if I wanted to, but what’s the point of talking here? The guys only open their mouths to curse and swear, and they seem to think it’s entertaining; but I don’t, so I keep quiet.”
“Well, Bill, that’s true, and I would rather not hear you speak at all than hear you speak like the other men. But I don’t swear, Bill; so you might talk to me sometimes, I think. Besides, I’m weary of spending day after day in this way, without a single soul to say a pleasant word to. I’ve been used to friendly conversation, Bill, and I really would take it kind if you would talk with me a little now and then.”
“Well, Bill, that’s true, and I’d rather not hear you talk at all than hear you talk like the other guys. But I don’t swear, Bill; so I think you could chat with me sometimes. Besides, I’m tired of spending day after day like this, without a single person to say a kind word to. I’m used to friendly conversations, Bill, and I would really appreciate it if you could talk with me a little now and then.”
Bill looked at me in surprise, and I thought I observed a sad expression pass across his sunburned face.
Bill looked at me in surprise, and I thought I saw a sad look cross his sunburned face.
“An’ where have you been used to friendly conversation?” said Bill, looking down again into the sea. “Not on that Coral Island, I take it?”
“And where have you been having friendly conversations?” Bill asked, looking back down at the sea. “Not on that Coral Island, I guess?”
“Yes, indeed,” said I energetically. “I have spent many of the happiest months in my life on that Coral Island;” and without waiting to be further questioned, I launched out into a glowing account of the happy life that Jack and Peterkin and I had spent together, and related minutely every circumstance that befell us while on the island.
“Yes, definitely,” I said excitedly. “I’ve spent some of the happiest months of my life on that Coral Island;” and without waiting for more questions, I dove into a vibrant recounting of the joyful times Jack, Peterkin, and I had together, sharing every detail of what happened to us while we were on the island.
“Boy, boy,” said Bill in a voice so deep that it startled me, “this is no place for you!”
“Hey, kid,” Bill said in a deep voice that surprised me, “this isn’t a good place for you!”
“That’s true,” said I. “I am of little use on board, and I don’t like my comrades; but I can’t help it, and at any rate I hope to be free again soon.”
"That's true," I said. "I'm not much help on the ship, and I don't really like my teammates; but I can't change it, and anyway, I hope to be free again soon."
“Free?” said Bill, looking at me in surprise.
“Free?” Bill said, looking at me in surprise.
“Yes, free,” returned I. “The captain said he would put me ashore after this trip was over.”
"Yes, free," I replied. "The captain said he would drop me off after this trip is done."
“This trip! Hark’ee, boy,” said Bill, lowering his voice, “what said the captain to you the day you came aboard?”
“This trip! Listen, kid,” said Bill, lowering his voice, “what did the captain tell you the day you came on board?”
“He said that he was a trader in sandal-wood, and no pirate, and told me that if I would join him for this trip he would give me a good share of the profits, or put me on shore in some civilised island if I chose.”
“He said he was a sandalwood trader, not a pirate, and told me that if I joined him for this trip, he would give me a good share of the profits or drop me off on a civilized island if I wanted.”
Bill’s brows lowered savagely as he muttered, “Ay, he said truth when he told you he was a sandal-wood trader, but he lied when—”
Bill’s eyebrows furrowed fiercely as he muttered, “Yeah, he spoke the truth when he told you he was a sandalwood trader, but he lied when—”
“Sail ho!” shouted the lookout at the masthead.
“Sail ahead!” shouted the lookout at the top of the mast.
“Where away?” cried Bill, springing to the tiller; while the men, startled by the sudden cry, jumped up and gazed round the horizon.
“Where to?” yelled Bill, jumping to the tiller; while the men, surprised by the sudden shout, got up and looked around the horizon.
“On the starboard quarter, hull down, sir,” answered the lookout.
“On the starboard side, hull down, sir,” replied the lookout.
At this moment the captain came on deck, and mounting into the rigging, surveyed the sail through the glass. Then sweeping his eye round the horizon, he gazed steadily at the particular point.
At that moment, the captain came on deck and climbed up into the rigging to check the sail through the binoculars. Then, scanning the horizon, he focused intently on a specific point.
“Take in topsails!” shouted the captain, swinging himself down on the deck by the main-back stay.
“Trim the topsails!” shouted the captain, swinging himself down onto the deck by the main backstay.
“Take in topsails!” roared the first mate.
“Pull in the topsails!” shouted the first mate.
“Ay, ay, sir–r–r!” answered the men as they sprang into the rigging and went aloft like cats.
“Ay, ay, sir!” answered the men as they rushed into the rigging and climbed up like cats.
Instantly all was bustle on board the hitherto quiet schooner. The topsails were taken in and stowed, the men stood by the sheets and halyards, and the captain gazed anxiously at the breeze, which was now rushing towards us like a sheet of dark blue. In a few seconds it struck us. The schooner trembled, as if in surprise at the sudden onset, while she fell away; then, bending gracefully to the wind, as though in acknowledgment of her subjection, she cut through the waves with her sharp prow like a dolphin, while Bill directed her course towards the strange sail.
Instantly, the previously calm schooner was filled with activity. The topsails were quickly taken in and stored away, the crew got ready at the sheets and halyards, and the captain watched nervously as the wind approached us like a dark blue sheet. In just a few seconds, it hit us. The schooner shook, seemingly surprised by the sudden change, then leaned elegantly into the wind as if submitting to it, slicing through the waves with her sharp bow like a dolphin, while Bill steered her towards the unfamiliar sail.
In half-an-hour we neared her sufficiently to make out that she was a schooner, and from the clumsy appearance of her masts and sails we judged her to be a trader. She evidently did not like our appearance, for the instant the breeze reached her she crowded all sail and showed us her stern. As the breeze had moderated a little, our topsails were again shaken out; and it soon became evident—despite the proverb, “A stern chase is a long one”—that we doubled her speed, and would overhaul her speedily. When within a mile we hoisted British colours, but receiving no acknowledgment, the captain ordered a shot to be fired across her bows. In a moment, to my surprise, a large portion of the bottom of the boat amidships was removed, and in the hole thus exposed appeared an immense brass gun. It worked on a swivel, and was elevated by means of machinery. It was quickly loaded and fired. The heavy ball struck the water a few yards ahead of the chase, and ricochetting into the air, plunged into the sea a mile beyond it.
In half an hour, we got close enough to see that she was a schooner, and from the awkward look of her masts and sails, we figured she was a trader. She clearly wasn’t happy to see us, because as soon as the breeze hit her, she set all her sails and showed us her back. Since the wind had eased a bit, we rehoisted our topsails, and it quickly became clear—despite the saying, “A stern chase is a long one”—that we were moving twice as fast as her, and we'd catch up soon. When we were within a mile, we raised our British colors, but when we didn’t get a response, the captain ordered a shot to be fired across her bow. To my surprise, a large section of the boat’s bottom in the middle was removed, and an enormous brass gun appeared in the opening. It was mounted on a swivel and was raised with machinery. It was loaded quickly and fired. The heavy ball hit the water just a few yards in front of the chase, skipping into the air and landing a mile beyond it.
This produced the desired effect. The strange vessel backed her topsails and hove-to, while we ranged up and lay-to about a hundred yards off.
This created the intended result. The odd ship lowered her sails and came to a stop, while we positioned ourselves and floated about a hundred yards away.
“Lower the boat!” cried the captain.
“Lower the boat!” shouted the captain.
In a second the boat was lowered and manned by a part of the crew, who were all armed with cutlasses and pistols. As the captain passed me to get into it he said, “Jump into the stern-sheets, Ralph; I may want you.” I obeyed, and in ten minutes more we were standing on the stranger’s deck. We were all much surprised at the sight that met our eyes. Instead of a crew of such sailors as we were accustomed to see, there were only fifteen blacks, standing on the quarter-deck, and regarding us with looks of undisguised alarm. They were totally unarmed, and most of them unclothed. One or two, however, wore portions of European attire. One had on a pair of duck trousers, which were much too large for him, and stuck out in a most ungainly manner; another wore nothing but the common, scanty, native garment round the loins and a black beaver hat; but the most ludicrous personage of all, and one who seemed to be chief, was a tall, middle-aged man, of a mild, simple expression of countenance, who wore a white cotton shirt, a swallow-tailed coat, and a straw hat, while his black, brawny legs were totally uncovered below the knees.
In a moment, the boat was lowered and crewed by some of the sailors, all armed with cutlasses and pistols. As the captain passed me to get in, he said, “Jump into the back, Ralph; I might need you.” I complied, and in another ten minutes, we were on the deck of the stranger's ship. We were all quite surprised by what we saw. Instead of a crew of sailors we were used to, there were only fifteen Black men standing on the quarter-deck, looking at us with clear fear. They were completely unarmed and most of them were barely dressed. One or two wore parts of European clothing. One had on oversized duck trousers that looked awkward; another wore just a basic, short local garment around his waist and a black beaver hat; but the most amusing was a tall, middle-aged man with a gentle, simple face, dressed in a white cotton shirt, a swallow-tailed coat, and a straw hat, while his strong black legs were fully exposed below the knees.
“Where’s the commander of this ship?” inquired our captain, stepping up to this individual.
“Where’s the captain of this ship?” asked our captain, approaching this person.
“I is cap’in,” he answered, taking off his straw hat and making a low bow.
“I’m the captain,” he replied, removing his straw hat and bowing slightly.
“You!” said our captain in surprise. “Where do you come from, and where are you bound? What cargo have you aboard?”
“You!” said our captain in surprise. “Where are you coming from, and where are you headed? What cargo do you have on board?”
“We is come,” answered the man with the swallow-tail, “from Aitutaki; we was go for Rarotonga. We is native miss’nary ship; our name is de Olive Branch; an’ our cargo is two tons cocoa-nuts, seventy pigs, twenty cats, and de Gosp’l.”
“We've come,” answered the man in the swallow-tail coat, “from Aitutaki; we were heading to Rarotonga. We're a native missionary ship; our name is the Olive Branch; and our cargo includes two tons of coconuts, seventy pigs, twenty cats, and the Gospel.”
This announcement was received by the crew of our vessel with a shout of laughter, which, however, was peremptorily checked by the captain, whose expression instantly changed from one of severity to that of frank urbanity as he advanced towards the missionary and shook him warmly by the hand.
This announcement was met by our crew with laughter, which was quickly silenced by the captain. His expression shifted immediately from stern to friendly as he approached the missionary and shook his hand warmly.
“I am very glad to have fallen in with you,” said he, “and I wish you much success in your missionary labours. Pray take me to your cabin, as I wish to converse with you privately.”
“I’m really glad to have met you,” he said, “and I wish you lots of success in your missionary work. Please take me to your cabin; I’d like to talk to you privately.”
The missionary immediately took him by the hand, and as he led him away I heard him saying, “me most glad to find you trader; we t’ought you be pirate. You very like one ’bout the masts.”
The missionary quickly grabbed his hand, and as he pulled him away, I heard him say, “I’m so happy to find you, trader; we thought you were a pirate. You look a lot like one near the masts.”
What conversation the captain had with this man I never heard; but he came on deck again in a quarter of an hour, and shaking hands cordially with the missionary, ordered us into our boat and returned to the schooner, which was immediately put before the wind. In a few minutes the Olive Branch was left far behind us.
What the captain talked about with this man, I never found out; but he came back on deck after about fifteen minutes, shook hands warmly with the missionary, told us to get into our boat, and then went back to the schooner, which was quickly set in front of the wind. In a few minutes, the Olive Branch was a long way behind us.
That afternoon, as I was down below at dinner, I heard the men talking about this curious ship.
That afternoon, while I was having dinner downstairs, I heard the guys talking about this strange ship.
“I wonder,” said one, “why our captain looked so sweet on yon swallow-tailed supercargo o’ pigs and Gospels? If it had been an ordinary trader, now, he would have taken as many o’ the pigs as he required and sent the ship with all on board to the bottom.”
“I wonder,” said one, “why our captain seemed so fond of that fancy supercargo of pigs and Gospels? If it had been just a regular trader, he would have taken as many pigs as he needed and sent the ship and everyone on it to the bottom.”
“Why, Dick, you must be new to these seas if you don’t know that!” cried another. “The captain cares as much for the Gospel as you do (an’ that’s precious little); but he knows, and everybody knows, that the only place among the southern islands where a ship can put in and get what she wants in comfort is where the Gospel has been sent to. There are hundreds o’ islands, at this blessed moment, where you might as well jump straight into a shark’s maw as land without a band o’ thirty comrades armed to the teeth to back you.”
“Why, Dick, you must be new to these waters if you don’t know that!” shouted another. “The captain cares about the Gospel as much as you do (which isn’t much); but he knows, and everyone knows, that the only place among the southern islands where a ship can dock and get what it needs comfortably is where the Gospel has been brought. There are hundreds of islands, right now, where you might as well jump straight into a shark’s mouth as land without a group of thirty friends armed to the teeth to support you.”
“Ay,” said a man with a deep scar over his right eye. “Dick’s new to the work. But if the captain takes us for a cargo o’ sandal-wood to the Feejees, he’ll get a taste o’ these black gentry in their native condition. For my part, I don’t know, and I don’t care, what the Gospel does to them; but I know that when any o’ the islands chance to get it, trade goes all smooth and easy. But where they ha’n’t got it, Beelzebub himself could hardly desire better company.”
“Ay,” said a man with a deep scar over his right eye. “Dick’s new to the job. But if the captain takes us for a load of sandalwood to the Fijis, he’ll get a firsthand experience of these black folks in their natural state. As for me, I don’t know, and I don’t care, what the Gospel does for them; but I do know that when any of the islands get it, trade goes all smooth and easy. But where they haven’t got it, Beelzebub himself couldn’t ask for better company.”
“Well, you ought to be a good judge,” cried another, laughing, “for you’ve never kept any company but the worst all your life!”
“Well, you must be a great judge,” shouted another, laughing, “because you've only hung out with the worst people your whole life!”
“Ralph Rover!” shouted a voice down the hatchway; “captain wants you, aft.”
“Ralph Rover!” shouted a voice from the hatch; “the captain wants you at the back.”
Springing up the ladder, I hastened to the cabin, pondering as I went the strange testimony borne by these men to the effect of the Gospel on savage natures—testimony which, as it was perfectly disinterested, I had no doubt whatever was strictly true.
Rushing up the ladder, I hurried to the cabin, thinking along the way about the strange evidence these men provided regarding the impact of the Gospel on wild natures—evidence that, because it was completely selfless, I had no doubt was absolutely true.
On coming again on deck I found Bloody Bill at the helm, and as we were alone together, I tried to draw him into conversation. After repeating to him the conversation in the forecastle about the missionaries, I said:
On coming back on deck, I found Bloody Bill at the helm. Since we were alone, I tried to get him to talk. After I repeated the conversation from the forecastle about the missionaries, I said:
“Tell me, Bill: is this schooner really a trader in sandal-wood?”
“Tell me, Bill: is this schooner really a sandalwood trader?”
“Yes, Ralph, she is; but she’s just as really a pirate. The black flag you saw flying at the peak was no deception.”
“Yes, Ralph, she is; but she’s just as much a pirate. The black flag you saw flying at the top was no trick.”
“Then how can you say she’s a trader?” asked I.
“Then how can you say she’s a traitor?” I asked.
“Why, as to that, she trades when she can’t take by force; but she takes by force when she can, in preference. Ralph,” he added, lowering his voice, “if you had seen the bloody deeds that I have witnessed done on these decks, you would not need to ask if we were pirates. But you’ll find it out soon enough. As for the missionaries, the captain favours them because they are useful to him. The South Sea Islanders are such incarnate fiends that they are the better of being tamed, and the missionaries are the only men who can do it.”
“Why, in that case, she makes deals when she can’t get things by force; but she takes things by force whenever she can, that’s her preference. Ralph,” he said, lowering his voice, “if you had seen the brutal acts I’ve witnessed on these decks, you wouldn’t even need to ask if we’re pirates. But you’ll figure it out soon enough. As for the missionaries, the captain supports them because they’re useful to him. The South Sea Islanders are such wicked creatures that it’s better for them to be tamed, and the missionaries are the only ones who can do that.”
Our track after this lay through several clusters of small islets, among which we were becalmed more than once. During this part of our voyage the watch on deck and the lookout at the masthead were more than usually vigilant, as we were not only in danger of being attacked by the natives (who, I learned from the captain’s remarks, were a bloody and deceitful tribe at this group), but we were also exposed to much risk from the multitudes of coral reefs that rose up in the channels between the islands—some of them just above the surface, others a few feet below it. Our precautions against the savages, I found, were indeed necessary.
Our route after this took us through several clusters of small islands, where we were stuck without wind more than once. During this part of our journey, the crew on deck and the lookout at the masthead were especially alert, as we faced the risk of being attacked by the locals (who, as I gathered from the captain’s comments, were a violent and treacherous tribe in this area). Additionally, we were at significant risk from the numerous coral reefs that stood in the channels between the islands—some barely above the water's surface and others a few feet below. I realized that our precautions against the natives were truly necessary.
One day we were becalmed among a group of small islands, most of which appeared to be uninhabited. As we were in want of fresh water, the captain sent the boat ashore to bring off a cask or two. But we were mistaken in thinking there were no natives; for scarcely had we drawn near to the shore when a band of naked blacks rushed out of the bush and assembled on the beach, brandishing their clubs and spears in a threatening manner. Our men were well armed, but refrained from showing any signs of hostility, and rowed nearer in order to converse with the natives; and I now found that more than one of the crew could imperfectly speak dialects of the language peculiar to the South Sea Islanders. When within forty yards of the shore we ceased rowing, and the first mate stood up to address the multitude; but instead of answering us, they replied with a shower of stones, some of which cut the men severely. Instantly our muskets were levelled, and a volley was about to be fired when the captain hailed us in a loud voice from the schooner, which lay not more than five or six hundred yards off the shore.
One day we were stranded among a group of small islands, most of which seemed to be uninhabited. Since we needed fresh water, the captain sent a boat to the shore to bring back a cask or two. But we were wrong to think there were no inhabitants; as soon as we got close to the shore, a group of naked locals rushed out of the bushes and gathered on the beach, waving their clubs and spears in a threatening way. Our crew was well-armed but chose not to show any aggression and rowed closer to communicate with the locals. I soon discovered that more than one crew member could somewhat speak the dialects of the South Sea Islanders. When we were about forty yards from the shore, we stopped rowing, and the first mate stood up to speak to the crowd; but instead of responding, they answered with a volley of stones, some of which hit the men hard. Immediately, our muskets were aimed, and we were about to fire when the captain shouted at us from the schooner, which was only five or six hundred yards away from the shore.
“Don’t fire!” he shouted angrily. “Pull off to the point ahead of you!”
“Don’t shoot!” he yelled furiously. “Move to the point in front of you!”
The men looked surprised at this order, and uttered deep curses as they prepared to obey; for their wrath was roused, and they burned for revenge. Three or four of them hesitated, and seemed disposed to mutiny.
The men looked shocked at this order and muttered furious curses as they got ready to comply; their anger was ignited, and they craved revenge. Three or four of them hesitated and seemed ready to rebel.
“Don’t distress yourselves, lads,” said the mate, while a bitter smile curled his lip. “Obey orders. The captain’s not the man to take an insult tamely. If Long Tom does not speak presently, I’ll give myself to the sharks.”
“Don’t worry, guys,” said the mate, a bitter smile on his face. “Just follow orders. The captain isn’t the type to take an insult lightly. If Long Tom doesn’t speak soon, I’ll throw myself to the sharks.”
The men smiled significantly as they pulled from the shore, which was now crowded with a dense mass of savages, amounting probably to five or six hundred. We had not rowed off above a couple of hundred yards when a loud roar thundered over the sea, and the big brass gun sent a withering shower of grape point-blank into the midst of the living mass, through which a wide lane was cut; while a yell, the like of which I could not have imagined, burst from the miserable survivors as they fled to the woods. Amongst the heaps of dead that lay on the sand just where they had fallen, I could distinguish mutilated forms writhing in agony; while ever and anon one and another rose convulsively from out the mass, endeavoured to stagger towards the wood, and ere they had taken a few steps, fell and wallowed on the bloody sand. My blood curdled within me as I witnessed this frightful and wanton slaughter; but I had little time to think, for the captain’s deep voice came again over the water towards us: “Pull ashore, lads, and fill your water-casks!” The men obeyed in silence, and it seemed to me as if even their hard hearts were shocked by the ruthless deed. On gaining the mouth of the rivulet at which we intended to take in water, we found it flowing with blood; for the greater part of those who were slain had been standing on the banks of the stream, a short way above its mouth. Many of the wretched creatures had fallen into it; and we found one body, which had been carried down, jammed between two rocks, with the staring eyeballs turned towards us, and his black hair waving in the ripples of the blood-red stream. No one dared to oppose our landing now, so we carried our casks to a pool above the murdered group, and having filled them, returned on board. Fortunately a breeze sprang up soon afterwards, and carried us away from the dreadful spot; but it could not waft me away from the memory of what I had seen.
The men smiled knowingly as they pushed away from the shore, which was now packed with a dense crowd of natives, probably numbering five or six hundred. We hadn't rowed more than a couple hundred yards when a loud roar echoed over the sea, and the big brass cannon fired a devastating shower of grapeshot right into the crowd, creating a wide gap; a scream erupted from the wretched survivors as they fled into the woods. Among the piles of dead lying on the sand where they had fallen, I could see mutilated bodies writhing in pain; occasionally, one would convulsively rise from the mass, try to stagger toward the trees, and before taking more than a few steps, collapse and thrash on the bloody sand. My blood ran cold as I witnessed this horrific and senseless slaughter; but I had little time to think, for the captain's booming voice called to us across the water: "Pull ashore, guys, and fill your water casks!" The men complied in silence, and it seemed even their hardened hearts were disturbed by the brutal act. When we reached the mouth of the stream where we planned to take on water, we found it flowing with blood; most of those killed had been standing on the banks a short distance upstream. Many of the poor souls had fallen into it; we found one body that had been carried downstream, wedged between two rocks, its wide-open eyes staring at us, and black hair floating in the blood-red current. No one dared to stop us from landing now, so we took our casks to a pool above the slain group, filled them, and returned to the ship. Fortunately, a breeze picked up soon after, carrying us away from that horrific place; but it couldn't erase the memory of what I had witnessed.
“And this,” thought I, gazing in horror at the captain, who, with a quiet look of indifference, leaned upon the taffrail, smoking a cigar and contemplating the fertile green islets as they passed like a lovely picture before our eyes—“this is the man who favours the missionaries because they are useful to him and can tame the savages better than any one else can do it!” Then I wondered in my mind whether it were possible for any missionary to tame him!
“And this,” I thought, staring in shock at the captain, who, with an indifferent expression, leaned on the railing, smoking a cigar and admiring the lush green islands as they drifted by like a beautiful painting in front of us—“this is the guy who supports the missionaries because they’re useful to him and can handle the locals better than anyone else can!” Then I wondered to myself if it was even possible for any missionary to tame him!
Chapter Twenty Four.
Bloody Bill is communicative and sagacious—Unpleasant prospects—Retrospective meditations interrupted by volcanic agency—The pirates negotiate with a Feejee chief—Various etceteras that are calculated to surprise and horrify.
It was many days after the events just narrated ere I recovered a little of my wonted spirits. I could not shake off the feeling for a long time that I was in a frightful dream, and the sight of our captain filled me with so much horror that I kept out of his way as much as my duties about the cabin would permit. Fortunately he took so little notice of me that he did not observe my changed feelings towards him, otherwise it might have been worse for me.
It was many days after the events I just described before I regained a bit of my usual spirits. For a long time, I couldn't shake the feeling that I was in a terrifying dream, and seeing our captain filled me with so much dread that I tried to avoid him as much as my responsibilities in the cabin allowed. Luckily, he paid so little attention to me that he didn't notice my changed feelings towards him; otherwise, it might have been worse for me.
But I was now resolved that I would run away the very first island we should land at, and commit myself to the hospitality of the natives rather than remain an hour longer than I could help in the pirate schooner. I pondered this subject a good deal, and at last made up my mind to communicate my intention to Bloody Bill; for during several talks I had had with him of late, I felt assured that he too would willingly escape if possible. When I told him of my design he shook his head. “No, no, Ralph,” said he; “you must not think of running away here. Among some of the groups of islands you might do so with safety; but if you tried it here, you would find that you had jumped out of the fryin’-pan into the fire.”
But I was now determined to run away the very first island we landed on and rely on the hospitality of the locals instead of staying on the pirate schooner for even one more hour than necessary. I thought about this for a while and finally decided to share my plan with Bloody Bill; after several conversations with him lately, I felt confident that he too would want to escape if he could. When I told him my idea, he shook his head. “No, no, Ralph,” he said; “you shouldn’t think about running away here. In some of the island groups, you might be safe doing that; but if you tried it here, you’d find you jumped from the frying pan into the fire.”
“How so, Bill?” said I. “Would the natives not receive me?”
“How so, Bill?” I asked. “Wouldn’t the locals accept me?”
“That they would, lad; but they would eat you too.”
"Sure they would, kid; but they would eat you up, too."
“Eat me!” said I in surprise. “I thought the South Sea Islanders never ate anybody except their enemies.”
“Eat me!” I said in surprise. “I thought the South Sea Islanders only ate their enemies.”
“Humph!” ejaculated Bill. “I ’spose ’twas yer tender-hearted friends in England that put that notion into your head. There’s a set o’ soft-hearted folk at home that I knows on who don’t like to have their feelin’s ruffled; and when you tell them anything they don’t like—that shocks them, as they call it—no matter how true it be, they stop their ears and cry out, ‘Oh, that is too horrible! We can’t believe that!’ An’ they say truth. They can’t believe it, ’cause they won’t believe it. Now, I believe there’s thousands o’ the people in England who are sich born drivellin’ won’t believers that they think the black fellows hereaways, at the worst, eat an enemy only now an’ then out o’ spite; whereas I know for certain, and many captains of the British and American navies know as well as me, that the Feejee Islanders eat not only their enemies but one another—and they do it not for spite, but for pleasure. It’s a fact that they prefer human flesh to any other. But they don’t like white men’s flesh so well as black; they say it makes them sick.”
“Humph!” Bill exclaimed. “I guess it was your soft-hearted friends in England who put that idea in your head. There’s a group of tender-hearted folks back home that I know who don’t like to have their feelings hurt; and when you tell them something they don’t want to hear—that shocks them, as they put it—no matter how true it is, they cover their ears and shout, ‘Oh, that is too horrible! We can’t believe that!’ And they’re right. They can’t believe it because they won’t believe it. Now, I believe there are thousands of people in England who are such born “won’t believers” that they think the black people here only eat an enemy now and then out of spite; whereas I know for sure, and many captains of the British and American navies know it just as well, that the Feejee Islanders eat not only their enemies but each other—and they do it not out of spite but for pleasure. It’s a fact that they prefer human flesh to any other. But they don’t like white men’s flesh as much as black; they say it makes them sick.”
“Why, Bill,” said I, “you told me just now that they would eat me if they caught me!”
“Why, Bill,” I said, “you just told me that they’d eat me if they caught me!”
“So I did, and so I think they would. I’ve only heard some o’ them say they don’t like white men so well as black; but if they was hungry they wouldn’t be particular. Anyhow, I’m sure they would kill you. You see, Ralph, I’ve been a good while in them parts, and I’ve visited the different groups of islands oftentimes as a trader. And thorough-goin’ blackguards some o’ them traders are—no better than pirates, I can tell you. One captain that I sailed with was not a chip better than the one we’re with now. He was trading with a friendly chief one day aboard his vessel. The chief had swam off to us with the things for trade tied atop of his head, for them chaps are like otters in the water. Well, the chief was hard on the captain, and would not part with some o’ his things. When their bargainin’ was over they shook hands, and the chief jumped overboard to swim ashore; but before he got forty yards from the ship, the captain seized a musket and shot him dead. He then hove up anchor and put to sea, and as we sailed along the shore he dropped six black fellows with his rifle, remarkin’ that ‘that would spoil the trade for the next-comers.’ But, as I was sayin’, I’m up to the ways o’ these fellows. One o’ the laws o’ the country is that every shipwrecked person who happens to be cast ashore, be he dead or alive, is doomed to be roasted and eaten. There was a small tradin’ schooner wrecked off one of these islands when we were lyin’ there in harbour during a storm. The crew was lost—all but three men, who swam ashore. The moment they landed, they were seized by the natives and carried up into the woods. We knew pretty well what their fate would be; but we could not help them, for our crew was small, and if we had gone ashore they would likely have killed us all. We never saw the three men again. But we heard frightful yelling and dancing and merrymaking that night; and one of the natives, who came aboard to trade with us next day, told us that the long pigs, as he called the men, had been roasted and eaten, and their bones were to be converted into sail-needles. He also said that white men were bad to eat, and that most o’ the people on shore were sick.”
“So I did, and I think they would too. I've only heard a few of them say they don't like white men as much as black; but if they were hungry, they wouldn't be picky. Either way, I'm sure they would kill you. You see, Ralph, I’ve spent quite some time in those areas, and I’ve visited the different islands many times as a trader. And some of those traders are downright scoundrels—no better than pirates, I can tell you. One captain I sailed with was no better than the one we’re with now. He was trading with a friendly chief one day on his ship. The chief had swum out to us with the goods for trade balanced on his head, since those guys are like otters in the water. Well, the chief was tough on the captain and wouldn't part with some of his items. When their bargaining was done, they shook hands, and the chief jumped overboard to swim ashore; but before he got forty yards from the ship, the captain grabbed a musket and shot him dead. He then weighed anchor and set sail, and as we sailed along the shore, he shot six natives with his rifle, remarking that ‘that would ruin the trade for the next ones.’ But, as I was saying, I know the ways of these folks. One of the laws of the land is that any shipwrecked person who washes ashore, dead or alive, is destined to be roasted and eaten. There was a small trading schooner wrecked off one of these islands while we were anchored there during a storm. The crew was lost—all but three men, who swam ashore. The moment they landed, they were seized by the natives and taken up into the woods. We knew pretty well what their fate would be; but we couldn’t help them, as our crew was small, and if we had gone ashore, they probably would have killed us all. We never saw the three men again. But we heard terrifying yelling, dancing, and celebration that night; and one of the natives who came aboard to trade with us the next day told us that the long pigs, as he called the men, had been roasted and eaten, and their bones were to be turned into sail needles. He also mentioned that white men were bad to eat, and that most of the people on shore were sick.”
I was very much shocked and cast down in my mind at this terrible account of the natives, and asked Bill what he would advise me to do. Looking round the deck to make sure that we were not overheard, he lowered his voice and said, “There are two or three ways that we might escape, Ralph, but none o’ them’s easy. If the captain would only sail for some o’ the islands near Tahiti we might run away there well enough, because the natives are all Christians; an’ we find that wherever the savages take up with Christianity they always give over their bloody ways, and are safe to be trusted. I never cared for Christianity myself,” he continued in a soliloquising voice, “and I don’t well know what it means; but a man with half-an-eye can see what it does for these black critters. However, the captain always keeps a sharp lookout after us when we get to these islands, for he half-suspects that one or two o’ us are tired of his company. Then we might manage to cut the boat adrift some fine night when it’s our watch on deck, and clear off before they discovered that we were gone. But we would run the risk o’ bein’ caught by the blacks. I wouldn’t like to try that plan. But you and I will think over it, Ralph, and see what’s to be done. In the meantime it’s our watch below, so I’ll go and turn in.”
I was really shocked and upset by this awful news about the locals, so I asked Bill what he thought I should do. He looked around the deck to make sure no one was listening, then lowered his voice and said, “We have a couple of options for escaping, Ralph, but none of them will be easy. If the captain would just head to some of the islands near Tahiti, we could get away there without too much trouble since the locals are all Christians. We’ve noticed that wherever the natives adopt Christianity, they tend to give up their violent ways and can be trusted. I’ve never cared for Christianity myself,” he continued, almost thinking out loud, “and I don’t really understand what it means; but anyone with half a brain can see what it does for these people. Still, the captain always keeps a close eye on us when we reach these islands because he half-suspects that a few of us are fed up with his company. Another plan could be to cut the boat loose some night when it's our shift on deck and slip away before they notice we’re gone. But that would put us at risk of getting caught by the locals. I wouldn’t want to try that. But you and I can think about it, Ralph, and figure out what to do. For now, it’s our turn to rest, so I’ll go get some sleep.”
Bill then bade me good-night and went below, while a comrade took his place at the helm; but feeling no desire to enter into conversation with him, I walked aft, and leaning over the stern, looked down into the phosphorescent waves that gurgled around the rudder, and streamed out like a flame of blue light in the vessel’s wake. My thoughts were very sad, and I could scarce refrain from tears as I contrasted my present wretched position with the happy, peaceful time I had spent on the Coral Island with my dear companions. As I thought upon Jack and Peterkin, anxious forebodings crossed my mind, and I pictured to myself the grief and dismay with which they would search every nook and corner of the island in a vain attempt to discover my dead body; for I felt assured that if they did not see any sign of the pirate schooner or boat when they came out of the cave to look for me, they would never imagine that I had been carried away. I wondered, too, how Jack would succeed in getting Peterkin out of the cave without my assistance; and I trembled when I thought that he might lose presence of mind, and begin to kick when he was in the tunnel! These thoughts were suddenly interrupted and put to flight by a bright-red blaze, which lighted up the horizon to the southward and cast a crimson glow far over the sea. This appearance was accompanied by a low growling sound, as of distant thunder, and at the same time the sky above us became black, while a hot, stifling wind blew around us in fitful gusts.
Bill then said goodnight and went below deck, while another crew member took over at the helm. Not feeling like chatting with him, I walked to the back of the boat and leaned over the stern, watching the glowing waves swirl around the rudder, streaming out like a blue flame in the ship’s wake. My thoughts were very heavy, and I could barely hold back tears as I compared my current miserable situation to the happy, peaceful time I had spent on the Coral Island with my dear friends. As I thought about Jack and Peterkin, anxious thoughts crossed my mind, and I imagined the sadness and panic they would feel as they searched every nook and cranny of the island, desperately trying to find my dead body. I was sure that if they didn’t see any sign of the pirate schooner or boat when they came out of the cave to look for me, they would never think I had been taken away. I also wondered how Jack would manage to get Peterkin out of the cave without my help, and I trembled at the thought that he might lose his cool and start kicking while they were in the tunnel! My thoughts were suddenly interrupted by a bright red blaze lighting up the horizon to the south and casting a crimson glow far across the sea. This sight was accompanied by a low rumbling sound, like distant thunder, and at the same time, the sky above us turned black, while a hot, suffocating wind blew in fitful gusts around us.
The crew assembled hastily on deck, and most of them were under the belief that a frightful hurricane was pending; but the captain, coming on deck, soon explained the phenomena.
The crew hurriedly gathered on deck, many of them thinking that a terrible hurricane was on its way; however, the captain came up on deck and quickly clarified what was happening.
“It’s only a volcano,” said he. “I knew there was one hereabouts, but thought it was extinct.—Up, there, and furl topgallant sails! We’ll likely have a breeze, and it’s well to be ready.”
“It’s just a volcano,” he said. “I knew there was one around here, but I thought it was inactive. —Up there, and take in the topgallant sails! We’ll probably get a breeze, so it’s good to be prepared.”
As he spoke, a shower began to fall, which, we quickly observed, was not rain, but fine ashes. As we were many miles distant from the volcano, these must have been carried to us from it by the wind. As the captain had predicted, a stiff breeze soon afterwards sprang up, under the influence of which we speedily left the volcano far behind us; but during the greater part of the night we could see its lurid glare and hear its distant thunder. The shower did not cease to fall for several hours, and we must have sailed under it for nearly forty miles—perhaps farther. When we emerged from the cloud, our decks and every part of the rigging were completely covered with a thick coat of ashes. I was much interested in this, and recollected that Jack had often spoken of many of the islands of the Pacific as being volcanoes, either active or extinct, and had said that the whole region was more or less volcanic, and that some scientific men were of opinion that the islands of the Pacific were nothing more or less than the mountain-tops of a huge continent which had sunk under the influence of volcanic agency.
As he spoke, a shower started to fall, which we quickly realized wasn’t rain, but fine ashes. Since we were many miles away from the volcano, these must have been carried to us by the wind. Just as the captain had predicted, a strong breeze soon picked up, and we quickly left the volcano far behind; but for most of the night, we could still see its ominous glow and hear its distant rumbling. The shower continued for several hours, and we must have sailed through it for almost forty miles—maybe even farther. When we finally came out from under the cloud, our decks and every part of the rigging were completely coated with a thick layer of ashes. I found this fascinating and remembered that Jack had often talked about many of the islands in the Pacific being volcanoes, either active or dormant, and had said that the entire region was more or less volcanic. Some scientists believed that the islands of the Pacific were just the mountain tops of a massive continent that had sunk due to volcanic activity.
Three days after passing the volcano, we found ourselves a few miles to windward of an island of considerable size and luxuriant aspect. It consisted of two mountains, which seemed to be nearly four thousand feet high. They were separated from each other by a broad valley, whose thick-growing trees ascended a considerable distance up the mountain-sides; and rich, level plains or meadow-land spread round the base of the mountains, except at the point immediately opposite the large valley, where a river seemed to carry the trees, as it were, along with it down to the white, sandy shore. The mountain-tops, unlike those of our Coral Island, were sharp, needle-shaped, and bare, while their sides were more rugged and grand in outline than anything I had yet seen in those seas. Bloody Bill was beside me when the island first hove in sight.
Three days after we passed the volcano, we found ourselves a few miles to the windward of a large, lush island. It had two mountains, each nearly four thousand feet high. They were separated by a wide valley filled with thick trees that climbed a good way up the mountainsides, while rich, flat plains or meadows spread around the base of the mountains, except directly opposite the large valley, where a river seemed to carry the trees along with it down to the white sandy shore. Unlike the mountains on our Coral Island, these peaks were sharp, needle-like, and bare, while their sides were more rugged and impressive than anything I had seen in those seas. Bloody Bill was next to me when the island first came into view.
“Ah!” he exclaimed, “I know that island well. They call it Emo.”
“Ah!” he exclaimed, “I know that island well. They call it Emo.”
“Have you been there before, then?” I inquired.
“Have you been there before?” I asked.
“Ay, that I have, often, and so has this schooner. ’Tis a famous island for sandal-wood. We have taken many cargoes of it already—and have paid for them, too, for the savages are so numerous that we dared not try to take it by force. But our captain has tried to cheat them so often that they’re beginnin’ not to like us overmuch now. Besides, the men behaved ill the last time we were here, and I wonder the captain is not afraid to venture. But he’s afraid o’ nothin’ earthly, I believe.”
“Yeah, I have, often, and so has this schooner. It’s a famous island for sandalwood. We’ve already taken many loads of it—and we’ve paid for them too, because there are so many locals that we didn’t dare try to take it by force. But our captain has tried to swindle them so many times that they’re starting not to like us much now. Plus, the crew acted badly the last time we were here, and I’m surprised the captain isn’t worried about going back. But I think he’s not scared of anything on this earth.”
We soon ran inside the barrier coral reef, and let go our anchor in six fathoms water, just opposite the mouth of a small creek, whose shores were densely covered with mangroves and tall umbrageous trees. The principal village of the natives lay about half-a-mile from this point. Ordering the boat out, the captain jumped into it, and ordered me to follow him. The men, fifteen in number, were well armed; and the mate was directed to have Long Tom ready for emergencies.
We quickly entered the barrier coral reef and dropped our anchor in six fathoms of water, right across from the mouth of a small creek, which was lined with thick mangroves and tall shady trees. The main village of the locals was about half a mile from this spot. After sending the boat out, the captain hopped in and told me to follow him. The crew, fifteen in total, were well-armed, and the mate was instructed to have Long Tom ready for any emergencies.
“Give way, lads!” cried the captain.
“Make way, guys!” shouted the captain.
The oars fell into the water at the word, the boat shot from the schooner’s side, and in a few minutes reached the shore. Here, contrary to our expectation, we were met with the utmost cordiality by Romata, the principal chief of the island, who conducted us to his house and gave us mats to sit upon. I observed in passing that the natives, of whom there were two or three thousand, were totally unarmed.
The oars plunged into the water at the signal, and the boat quickly raced away from the schooner. In just a few minutes, we arrived at the shore. To our surprise, we were warmly greeted by Romata, the main chief of the island, who took us to his house and offered us mats to sit on. I noticed as we walked by that the locals, numbering two or three thousand, were completely unarmed.
After a short preliminary palaver, a feast of baked pigs and various roots was spread before us, of which we partook sparingly, and then proceeded to business. The captain stated his object in visiting the island, regretted that there had been a slight misunderstanding during the last visit, and hoped that no ill-will was borne by either party, and that a satisfactory trade would be accomplished.
After a brief discussion, a feast of roasted pigs and different root vegetables was laid out for us, which we sampled modestly before getting down to business. The captain explained the purpose of his visit to the island, expressed regret over a small misunderstanding during the last visit, and hoped that neither side held any grudges and that a successful trade could be achieved.
Romata answered that he had forgotten there had been any differences between them, protested that he was delighted to see his friends again, and assured them they should have every assistance in cutting and embarking the wood. The terms were afterwards agreed on, and we rose to depart. All this conversation was afterwards explained to me by Bill, who understood the language pretty well.
Romata said he forgot there were any issues between them, claimed he was glad to see his friends again, and promised they would get all the help they needed with cutting and loading the wood. They later worked out the details, and we got up to leave. Bill, who understood the language pretty well, later explained all this conversation to me.
Romata accompanied us on board, and explained that a great chief from another island was then on a visit to him, and that he was to be ceremoniously entertained on the following day. After begging to be allowed to introduce him to us, and receiving permission, he sent his canoe ashore to bring him off. At the same time he gave orders to bring on board his two favourites, a cock and a paroquet. While the canoe was gone on this errand, I had time to regard the savage chief attentively. He was a man of immense size, with massive but beautifully moulded limbs and figure, only parts of which—the broad chest and muscular arms—were uncovered; for although the lower orders generally wore no other clothing than a strip of cloth called maro round their loins, the chief, on particular occasions, wrapped his person in voluminous folds of a species of native cloth made from the bark of the Chinese paper-mulberry. Romata wore a magnificent black beard and moustache, and his hair was frizzed out to such an extent that it resembled a large turban, in which was stuck a long wooden pin! I afterwards found that this pin served for scratching the head, for which purpose the fingers were too short without disarranging the hair. But Romata put himself to much greater inconvenience on account of his hair; for we found that he slept with his head resting on a wooden pillow, in which was cut a hollow for the neck, so that the hair of the sleeper might not be disarranged.
Romata came on board and explained that a powerful chief from another island was visiting him and that he would be formally entertained the next day. After asking if he could introduce us, and getting the go-ahead, he sent his canoe to the shore to bring him over. At the same time, he instructed that his two favorites—a rooster and a parakeet—be brought on board. While the canoe was away, I had a chance to take a good look at the savage chief. He was a huge man, with strong but well-shaped limbs and a body, only some parts of which—the broad chest and muscular arms—were exposed. Although the common people usually wore only a strip of cloth called maro around their waists, the chief wrapped himself in large folds of a type of native cloth made from the bark of the Chinese paper-mulberry on special occasions. Romata had a magnificent black beard and mustache, and his hair was frizzed out so much that it looked like a big turban, with a long wooden pin stuck in it! I later found out that this pin was used for scratching his head, since his fingers were too short to do so without messing up his hair. But Romata faced even more trouble because of his hair; we discovered that he slept with his head on a wooden pillow, which was hollowed out for the neck, so the sleeper's hair wouldn't get messed up.
In ten minutes the canoe returned, bringing the other chief, who certainly presented a most extraordinary appearance, having painted one half of his face red and the other half yellow, besides ornamenting it with various designs in black! Otherwise he was much the same in appearance as Romata, though not so powerfully built. As this chief had never seen a ship before—except, perchance, some of the petty traders that at long intervals visit these remote islands—he was much taken up with the neatness and beauty of all the fittings of the schooner. He was particularly struck with a musket which was shown to him, and asked where the white men got hatchets hard enough to cut the tree of which the barrel was made! While he was thus engaged, his brother-chief stood aloof, talking with the captain, and fondling a superb cock and a little blue-headed paroquet—the favourites of which I have before spoken. I observed that all the other natives walked in a crouching posture while in the presence of Romata. Before our guests left us, the captain ordered the brass gun to be uncovered and fired for their gratification; and I have every reason to believe he did so for the purpose of showing our superior power, in case the natives should harbour any evil designs against us. Romata had never seen this gun before, as it had not been uncovered on previous visits, and the astonishment with which he viewed it was very amusing. Being desirous of knowing its power, he begged that the captain would fire it; so a shot was put into it. The chiefs were then directed to look at a rock about two miles out at sea, and the gun was fired. In a second the top of the rock was seen to burst asunder, and to fall in fragments into the sea.
In ten minutes, the canoe came back, bringing the other chief, who had a striking appearance, with one half of his face painted red and the other half yellow, along with various black designs! Otherwise, he looked a lot like Romata, though he wasn't as muscular. Since this chief had never seen a ship before—other than possibly some of the small traders that visit these remote islands every once in a while—he was really impressed by the neatness and beauty of all the schooner's features. He was especially fascinated by a musket that was shown to him and asked where the white men got axes strong enough to cut down the tree that made the barrel! While this was happening, his brother-chief stayed back, chatting with the captain and petting a magnificent rooster and a small blue-headed parrot, which I’ve mentioned before. I noticed that all the other natives walked in a crouched position when they were around Romata. Before our guests left, the captain ordered the brass cannon to be uncovered and fired for their entertainment; I believe he did this to demonstrate our superior power in case the natives had any harmful intentions toward us. Romata had never seen this gun before since it hadn’t been uncovered on past visits, and his astonishment at seeing it was quite entertaining. Curious about its power, he asked the captain to fire it, so a shot was loaded. The chiefs were then told to look at a rock about two miles out to sea, and the gun was fired. In an instant, the top of the rock exploded and shattered into pieces that fell into the sea.
Romata was so delighted with the success of this shot that he pointed to a man who was walking on the shore, and begged the captain to fire at him, evidently supposing that his permission was quite sufficient to justify the captain in such an act. He was therefore surprised, and not a little annoyed, when the captain refused to fire at the native and ordered the gun to be housed.
Romata was so thrilled with the success of this shot that he pointed to a man walking on the shore and begged the captain to shoot at him, clearly thinking that his permission was enough to justify the captain’s action. He was therefore surprised and quite annoyed when the captain refused to fire at the native and ordered the gun to be put away.
Of all the things, however, that afforded matter of amusement to these savages, that which pleased Romata’s visitor most was the ship’s pump. He never tired of examining it and pumping up the water. Indeed, so much was he taken up with this pump that he could not be prevailed on to return on shore, but sent a canoe to fetch his favourite stool, on which he seated himself, and spent the remainder of the day in pumping the bilge-water out of the ship!
Of all the things that amused these natives, Romata’s visitor was most fascinated by the ship’s pump. He never got tired of checking it out and pumping up the water. In fact, he was so engrossed with this pump that he wouldn’t be convinced to go back ashore; instead, he sent a canoe to bring his favorite stool, which he sat on, and spent the rest of the day pumping the bilge water out of the ship!
Next day the crew went ashore to cut sandal-wood, while the captain, with one or two men, remained on board, in order to be ready, if need be, with the brass gun, which was unhoused and conspicuously elevated, with its capacious muzzle directed point-blank at the chief’s house. The men were fully armed, as usual; and the captain ordered me to go with them, to assist in the work. I was much pleased with this order, for it freed me from the captain’s company, which I could not now endure, and it gave me an opportunity of seeing the natives.
The next day, the crew went ashore to cut sandalwood while the captain, along with a couple of men, stayed on the ship to be ready with the brass gun, which was set up and aimed directly at the chief’s house. The men were fully armed as usual, and the captain told me to go with them to help with the work. I was really pleased with this order because it got me away from the captain, whose company I could no longer stand, and it gave me a chance to see the locals.
As we wound along in single file through the rich, fragrant groves of banana, cocoa-nut, bread-fruit, and other trees, I observed that there were many of the plum and banyan trees, with which I had become familiar on the Coral Island. I noticed, also, large quantities of taro—roots, yams, and sweet potatoes growing in enclosures. On turning into an open glade of the woods, we came abruptly upon a cluster of native houses. They were built chiefly of bamboos, and were thatched with the large, thick leaves of the pandanus; but many of them had little more than a sloping roof and three sides with an open front, being the most simple shelter from the weather that could well be imagined. Within these and around them were groups of natives—men, women, and children—who all stood up to gaze at us as we marched along, followed by the party of men whom the chief had sent to escort us. About half-a-mile inland we arrived at the spot where the sandal-wood grew, and while the men set to work I clambered up an adjoining hill to observe the country.
As we made our way in a single file through the lush, fragrant groves of banana, coconut, breadfruit, and other trees, I noticed that there were plenty of plum and banyan trees, which I had gotten to know on Coral Island. I also saw a lot of taro, roots, yams, and sweet potatoes growing in enclosures. When we turned into a clearing in the woods, we unexpectedly came across a group of native houses. They were mostly made of bamboo and had roofs made from the large, thick leaves of the pandanus; however, many of them consisted of little more than a sloping roof and three walls with an open front, providing the simplest shelter from the elements that you could imagine. Inside and around these houses were groups of natives—men, women, and children—who all stood up to watch us as we passed by, followed by the group of men the chief had sent to escort us. About half a mile inland, we reached the area where sandalwood grew, and while the men began their work, I climbed up a nearby hill to take in the view of the countryside.
About midday the chief arrived with several followers, one of whom carried a baked pig on a wooden platter, with yams and potatoes on several plantain leaves, which he presented to the men, who sat down under the shade of a tree to dine. The chief sat down to dine also; but, to my surprise, instead of feeding himself, one of his wives performed that office for him! I was seated beside Bill, and asked him the reason of this.
About noon, the chief showed up with a few followers, one of whom was carrying a roasted pig on a wooden platter, along with yams and potatoes on several plantain leaves. He offered this to the men, who sat down under the shade of a tree to eat. The chief joined them for the meal too; but, to my surprise, instead of eating by himself, one of his wives served him! I was sitting next to Bill and asked him why that was.
“It is beneath his dignity, I believe, to feed himself,” answered Bill; “but I dare say he’s not particular, except on great occasions. They’ve a strange custom among them, Ralph, which is called tabu, and they carry it to great lengths. If a man chooses a particular tree for his god, the fruit o’ that tree is tabued to him; and if he eats it, he is sure to be killed by his people—and eaten, of course, for killing means eating hereaway. Then, you see that great mop o’ hair on the chief’s head? Well, he has a lot o’ barbers to keep it in order; and it’s a law that whoever touches the head of a living chief or the body of a dead one, his hands are tabued. So in that way the barbers’ hands are always tabued, and they daren’t use them for their lives, but have to be fed like big babies—as they are, sure enough!”
“It's beneath his dignity, I think, to feed himself,” replied Bill; “but I guess he doesn’t mind too much, except on special occasions. They have a strange practice among them, Ralph, called tabu, and they take it very seriously. If a man selects a specific tree as his god, the fruit from that tree is off-limits to him; if he eats it, he’ll definitely be killed by his people—and eaten, of course, because killing means being eaten in this part of the world. Now, see that big mop of hair on the chief’s head? He has a lot of barbers to maintain it; and there’s a rule that whoever touches the head of a living chief or the body of a dead one, their hands are off-limits. So, in that way, the barbers’ hands are always off-limits, and they can’t use them for anything, but have to be fed like big babies—as they are, for sure!”
“That’s odd, Bill. But look there,” said I, pointing to a man whose skin was of a much lighter colour than the generality of the natives. “I’ve seen a few of these light-skinned fellows among the Feejeeans. They seem to me to be of quite a different race.”
“That's strange, Bill. But look over there,” I said, pointing to a man whose skin was much lighter than most of the locals. “I've seen a few of these light-skinned guys among the Fijians. They seem to me to belong to a completely different race.”
“So they are,” answered Bill. “These fellows come from the Tongan Islands, which lie a long way to the eastward. They come here to build their big war-canoes; and as these take two, and sometimes four, years to build, there’s always some o’ the brown-skins among the black sarpents o’ these islands.”
“So they are,” replied Bill. “These guys come from the Tongan Islands, which are quite a distance to the east. They come here to build their large war canoes, and since these take two, and sometimes four, years to make, there are always some of the brown-skinned people among the black serpents of these islands.”
“By the way, Bill,” said I, “your mentioning serpents reminds me that I have not seen a reptile of any kind since I came to this part of the world.”
“By the way, Bill,” I said, “your mention of snakes makes me realize that I haven’t seen any reptiles at all since I arrived in this part of the world.”
“No more there are any,” said Bill, “if ye except the niggers themselves. There’s none on the islands but a lizard or two, and some sich harmless things; but I never seed any myself. If there’s none on the land, however, there’s more than enough in the water; and that reminds me of a wonderful brute they have here. But come, I’ll show it to you.” So saying, Bill arose, and leaving the men still busy with the baked pig, led me into the forest. After proceeding a short distance we came upon a small pond of stagnant water. A native lad had followed us, to whom we called and beckoned him to come to us. On Bill saying a few words to him, which I did not understand, the boy advanced to the edge of the pond and gave a low, peculiar whistle. Immediately the water became agitated, and an enormous eel thrust its head above the surface and allowed the youth to touch it. It was about twelve feet long, and as thick round the body as a man’s thigh.
“There's nothing left,” Bill said, “except for the locals themselves. There are no creatures on the islands except for a lizard or two and some harmless animals; but I’ve never seen any myself. If there’s nothing on land, though, there’s more than enough in the water; and that reminds me of an amazing creature they have here. Come on, I'll show you.” With that, Bill got up and, leaving the men busy with the roasted pig, led me into the forest. After walking for a short while, we found a small pond of stagnant water. A native boy had followed us, and we called him over. After Bill said a few words to him, which I didn’t understand, the boy stepped to the edge of the pond and made a low, strange whistle. Instantly, the water stirred, and a massive eel lifted its head above the surface, allowing the boy to touch it. It was about twelve feet long and as thick as a man's thigh.
“There!” said Bill, his lip curling with contempt; “what do you think of that for a god, Ralph? This is one o’ their gods, and it has been fed with dozens o’ livin’ babies already. How many more it’ll get afore it dies is hard to say.”
“There!” said Bill, his lip curling with disdain; “what do you think of that for a god, Ralph? This is one of their gods, and it has already been fed with dozens of living babies. How many more it will get before it dies is hard to say.”
“Babies!” said I with an incredulous look.
“Babies!” I said, staring in disbelief.
“Ay, babies,” returned Bill. “Your soft-hearted folk at home would say, ‘Oh, horrible! Impossible!’ to that, and then go away as comfortable and unconcerned as if their sayin’ ‘Horrible! impossible!’ had made it a lie. But I tell you, Ralph, it’s a fact. I’ve seed it with my own eyes the last time I was here; an’ mayhap, if you stop awhile at this accursed place and keep a sharp lookout, you’ll see it too. They don’t feed it regularly with livin’ babies, but they give it one now and then as a treat.—Bah, you brute!” cried Bill in disgust, giving the reptile a kick on the snout with his heavy boot that sent it sweltering back in agony into its loathsome pool. I thought it lucky for Bill—indeed for all of us—that the native youth’s back happened to be turned at the time, for I am certain that if the poor savages had come to know that we had so rudely handled their god we should have had to fight our way back to the ship. As we retraced our steps I questioned my companion further on this subject.
“Ay, babies,” Bill replied. “Your kind-hearted folks back home would say, ‘Oh, how awful! No way!’ to that, and then walk away all comfortable and unconcerned as if their words made it untrue. But I tell you, Ralph, it’s a fact. I’ve seen it with my own eyes the last time I was here; and maybe, if you hang around this cursed place and keep a close watch, you’ll see it too. They don’t feed it regularly with living babies, but they give it one now and then as a treat.—Bah, you beast!” Bill yelled in disgust, kicking the reptile on the snout with his heavy boot, sending it writhing back in pain to its disgusting pool. I thought it was lucky for Bill—really for all of us—that the native youth’s back happened to be turned at the time, because I’m certain that if the poor savages had seen us treat their god so rudely, we would have had to fight our way back to the ship. As we retraced our steps, I asked my companion more about this topic.
“How comes it, Bill, that the mothers allow such a dreadful thing to be done?”
“How is it, Bill, that the mothers let such a terrible thing happen?”
“Allow it? the mothers do it! It seems to me that there’s nothing too fiendish or diabolical for these people to do. Why, in some of the islands they have an institution called the Areoi, and the persons connected with that body are ready for any wickedness that mortal man can devise. In fact, they stick at nothing; and one o’ their customs is to murder their infants the moment they are born. The mothers agree to it, and the fathers do it. And the mildest ways they have of murdering them is by sticking them through the body with sharp splinters of bamboo, strangling them with their thumbs, or burying them alive and stamping them to death while under the sod.”
“Allow it? The mothers do it! It seems to me that there’s nothing too evil or wicked for these people to do. In some of the islands, they have a group called the Areoi, and the people involved are ready for any cruelty that humans can come up with. In fact, they stop at nothing; one of their customs is to kill their babies right after they're born. The mothers agree to it, and the fathers carry it out. The mildest methods they use for killing them are piercing them with sharp bamboo shards, strangling them with their fingers, or burying them alive and stamping them to death while they’re under the ground.”
I felt sick at heart while my companion recited these horrors.
I felt a heavy sadness while my friend talked about these dreadful things.
“But it’s a curious fact,” he continued after a pause, during which we walked in silence towards the spot where we had left our comrades—“it’s a curious fact that wherever the missionaries get a footin’ all these things come to an end at once, an’ the savages take to doin’ each other good and singin’ psalms, just like Methodists.”
“But it’s an interesting thing,” he continued after a pause, during which we walked in silence toward the place where we had left our friends—“it’s an interesting thing that wherever the missionaries make their mark, all these issues come to an end immediately, and the locals start doing good for one another and singing hymns, just like Methodists.”
“God bless the missionaries,” said I, while a feeling of enthusiasm filled my heart so that I could speak with difficulty. “God bless and prosper the missionaries till they get a footing in every island of the sea!”
“God bless the missionaries,” I said, as a wave of enthusiasm filled my heart, making it hard for me to speak. “God bless and support the missionaries until they establish a presence on every island in the sea!”
“I would say Amen to that prayer, Ralph, if I could,” said Bill, in a deep, sad voice; “but it would be a mere mockery for a man to ask a blessing for others who dare not ask one for himself. But, Ralph,” he continued, “I’ve not told you half o’ the abominations I have seen durin’ my life in these seas. If we pull long together, lad, I’ll tell you more; and if times have not changed very much since I was here last, it’s like that you’ll have a chance o’ seeing a little for yourself before long.”
“I’d say Amen to that prayer, Ralph, if I could,” Bill said in a deep, sad voice. “But it would be a total joke for someone to ask for a blessing for others when they can’t even ask for one for themselves. But, Ralph,” he continued, “I haven’t even told you half of the terrible things I’ve seen during my life at sea. If we stick together long enough, kid, I’ll tell you more; and if things haven’t changed much since I was here last, you’ll probably get a chance to see a bit of it for yourself soon.”
Chapter Twenty Five.
The sandal-wood party—Native children’s games somewhat surprising—Desperate amusements suddenly and fatally brought to a close—An old friend recognised—News—Romata’s mad conduct.
Next day the wood-cutting party went ashore again, and I accompanied them as before. During the dinner-hour I wandered into the woods alone, being disinclined for food that day. I had not rambled far when I found myself unexpectedly on the seashore, having crossed a narrow neck of land which separated the native village from a large bay. Here I found a party of the islanders busy with one of their war-canoes, which was almost ready for launching. I stood for a long time watching this party with great interest, and observed that they fastened the timbers and planks to each other very much in the same way in which I had seen Jack fasten those of our little boat. But what surprised me most was its immense length, which I measured carefully, and found to be a hundred feet long; and it was so capacious that it could have held three hundred men. It had the unwieldy outrigger and enormously high stern-posts which I had remarked on the canoe that came to us while I was on the Coral Island. Observing some boys playing at games a short way along the beach, I resolved to go and watch them; but as I turned from the natives who were engaged so busily and cheerfully at their work, I little thought of the terrible event that hung on the completion of that war-canoe.
The next day, the wood-cutting party went ashore again, and I joined them as before. During lunch, I wandered into the woods alone, not feeling like eating that day. I hadn’t gone far when I unexpectedly found myself on the seashore, having crossed a narrow strip of land that separated the native village from a large bay. Here, I saw a group of islanders working on one of their war canoes, which was almost ready to launch. I stood there for a long time, watching them with great interest, and noticed that they fastened the timbers and planks together in a way similar to how I had seen Jack secure those of our little boat. But what surprised me the most was its incredible length, which I measured carefully to be a hundred feet long. It was so roomy that it could hold three hundred men. It had the bulky outrigger and the extremely high stern posts that I had noted on the canoe that came to us while I was on the Coral Island. Seeing some boys playing games a bit further down the beach, I decided to go watch them; however, as I turned away from the natives who were so busily and happily working, I had no idea of the tragic event that was tied to the completion of that war canoe.
Advancing towards the children, who were so numerous that I began to think this must be the general playground of the village, I sat down on a grassy bank under the shade of a plantain-tree to watch them. And a happier or more noisy crew I have never seen. There were at least two hundred of them, both boys and girls, all of whom were clad in no other garments than their own glossy little black skins, except the maro, or strip of cloth, round the loins of the boys, and a very short petticoat or kilt on the girls. They did not all play at the same game, but amused themselves in different groups.
Heading towards the kids, who were so many that I started to think this must be the main playground of the village, I sat down on a grassy bank under the shade of a banana tree to watch them. And I've never seen a happier or noisier bunch. There were at least two hundred of them, boys and girls alike, all dressed in nothing but their own shiny little black skin, except for the maro, or strip of cloth, around the boys' waists, and a very short skirt or kilt on the girls. They weren't all playing the same game but were having fun in different groups.
One band was busily engaged in a game exactly similar to our blind man’s buff. Another set were walking on stilts, which raised the children three feet from the ground. They were very expert at this amusement, and seldom tumbled. In another place I observed a group of girls standing together, and apparently enjoying themselves very much; so I went up to see what they were doing, and found that they were opening their eyelids with their fingers till their eyes appeared of an enormous size, and then thrusting pieces of straw between the upper and lower lids, across the eyeball, to keep them in that position! This seemed to me, I must confess, a very foolish as well as dangerous amusement. Nevertheless, the children seemed to be greatly delighted with the hideous faces they made. I pondered this subject a good deal, and thought that if little children knew how silly they seemed to grown-up people when, they make faces, they would not be so fond of doing it. In another place were a number of boys engaged in flying kites; and I could not help wondering that some of the games of those little savages should be so like to our own, although they had never seen us at play. But the kites were different from ours in many respects, being of every variety of shape. They were made of very thin cloth, and the boys raised them to a wonderful height in the air by means of twine made from the cocoa-nut husk. Other games there were, some of which showed the natural depravity of the hearts of these poor savages, and made me wish fervently that missionaries might be sent out to them. But the amusement which the greatest number of the children of both sexes seemed to take chief delight in was swimming and diving in the sea, and the expertness which they exhibited was truly amazing. They seemed to have two principal games in the water, one of which was to dive off a sort of stage which had been erected near a deep part of the sea, and chase each other in the water. Some of them went down to an extraordinary depth; others skimmed along the surface, or rolled over and over like porpoises, or diving under each other, came up unexpectedly and pulled each other down by a leg or an arm. They never seemed to tire of this sport, and from the great heat of the water in the South Seas, they could remain in it nearly all day without feeling chilled. Many of these children were almost infants, scarce able to walk; yet they staggered down the beach, flung their round, fat little black bodies fearlessly into deep water, and struck out to sea with as much confidence as ducklings.
One group was busy playing a game similar to our version of blind man’s bluff. Another set was walking on stilts, which lifted the kids three feet above the ground. They were really good at this game and rarely fell over. Nearby, I saw a group of girls standing together, clearly having a great time. I approached to see what they were up to and found they were using their fingers to open their eyelids wide so their eyes looked huge, then sticking pieces of straw between their upper and lower lids, across their eyeballs, to keep them that way! I have to admit, I thought this was a pretty silly and dangerous activity. Still, the kids seemed to really enjoy the strange faces they made. I thought about this for a while, and figured that if little kids knew how ridiculous they looked to adults when they made faces, they might not enjoy it as much. In another spot, a group of boys was flying kites, and I couldn't help but wonder how much their games resembled our own, even though they had never seen us play. However, their kites were different from ours in many ways, coming in every shape imaginable. They were made from very thin fabric, and the boys managed to get them to an incredible height using twine made from coconut husk. There were other games, some showing the natural mischief of these kids, making me wish that missionaries could come to help them. But the game that seemed to bring the most joy to both boys and girls was swimming and diving in the sea, and their skills were truly impressive. They had two main games in the water: one involved diving off a sort of platform built near a deep part of the ocean and chasing each other around. Some would go to remarkable depths, while others skimmed the surface, rolling like porpoises, or diving under each other, popping up unexpectedly to pull a leg or arm. They never seemed to tire of this fun, and because the water in the South Seas was so warm, they could stay in it nearly all day without feeling cold. Many of these kids were practically infants, barely able to walk, yet they would stagger down the beach, throw their chubby little bodies fearlessly into the deep water, and swim out to sea with as much confidence as ducklings.
The other game to which I have referred was swimming in the surf. But as this is an amusement in which all engage, from children of ten to grey-headed men of sixty, and as I had an opportunity of witnessing it in perfection the day following, I shall describe it more minutely.
The other activity I mentioned was swimming in the waves. Since this is something everyone participates in, from kids around ten to older men in their sixties, and since I had the chance to see it done perfectly the next day, I’ll describe it in more detail.
I suppose it was in honour of their guest that this grand swimming-match was got up, for Romata came and told the captain that they were going to engage in it, and begged him to “come and see.”
I guess this big swimming match was organized in honor of their guest, since Romata came and told the captain that they were going to participate in it and asked him to “come and see.”
“What sort of amusement is this surf-swimming?” I inquired of Bill as we walked together to a part of the shore on which several thousands of the natives were assembled.
“What kind of fun is this surf-swimming?” I asked Bill as we strolled to a spot on the beach where several thousand locals had gathered.
“It’s a very favourite lark with these ’xtr’or’nary critters,” replied Bill, giving a turn to the quid of tobacco that invariably bulged out of his left cheek. “Ye see, Ralph, them fellows take to the water as soon a’most as they can walk, an’ long before they can do that anything respectably, so that they are as much at home in the sea as on the land. Well, ye see, I ’spose they found swimmin’ for miles out to sea, and divin’ fathoms deep, wasn’t excitin’ enough, so they invented this game o’ swimmin’ on the surf. Each man and boy, as you see, has got a short board or plank, with which he swims out for a mile or more to sea, and then, gettin’ on the top o’ yon thunderin’ breaker, they come to shore on the top of it, yellin’ and screechin’ like fiends. It’s a marvel to me that they’re not dashed to shivers on the coral reef, for sure an’ sart’in am I that if any o’ us tried it, we wouldn’t be worth the fluke of a broken anchor after the wave fell. But there they go!”
“It’s a real favorite activity for these extraordinary creatures,” replied Bill, shifting the chew of tobacco that always bulged out of his left cheek. “You see, Ralph, those guys take to the water almost as soon as they can walk, and long before they can do that properly, so they’re just as comfortable in the sea as they are on the land. Well, I guess they found swimming for miles out at sea and diving deep down wasn’t thrilling enough, so they came up with this game of surfing. Each man and boy, as you can see, has a short board or plank, with which they swim out for a mile or more into the sea, and then, getting on top of that thundering wave, they ride it back to shore, yelling and screaming like crazy. It amazes me that they don’t get smashed to pieces on the coral reef, because I’m sure that if any of us tried it, we wouldn’t be worth a broken anchor once the wave crashed down. But there they go!”
As he spoke, several hundreds of the natives, amongst whom we were now standing, uttered a loud yell, rushed down the beach, plunged into the surf, and were carried off by the seething foam of the retreating wave.
As he was speaking, several hundred of the locals, among whom we were now standing, let out a loud shout, ran down the beach, jumped into the water, and were swept away by the churning foam of the receding wave.
At the point where we stood, the encircling coral reef joined the shore, so that the magnificent breakers, which a recent stiff breeze had rendered larger than usual, fell in thunder at the feet of the multitudes who lined the beach. For some time the swimmers continued to strike out to sea, breasting over the swell like hundreds of black seals. Then they all turned, and watching an approaching billow, mounted its white crest, and each laying his breast on the short, flat board, came rolling towards the shore, careering on the summit of the mighty wave, while they and the onlookers shouted and yelled with excitement. Just as the monster wave curled in solemn majesty to fling its bulky length upon the beach, most of the swimmers slid back into the trough behind; others, slipping off their boards, seized them in their hands, and plunging through the watery waste, swam out to repeat the amusement; but a few, who seemed to me the most reckless, continued their career until they were launched upon the beach and enveloped in the churning foam and spray. One of these last came in on the crest of the wave most manfully, and landed with a violent bound almost on the spot where Bill and I stood. I saw by his peculiar head-dress that he was the chief whom the tribe entertained as their guest. The sea-water had removed nearly all the paint with which his face had been covered, and as he rose panting to his feet, I recognised, to my surprise, the features of Tararo, my old friend of the Coral Island!
At the spot where we stood, the surrounding coral reef met the shore, so the impressive waves, which a recent strong breeze had made bigger than usual, crashed thunderously at the feet of the crowds lined up on the beach. For a while, the swimmers kept heading out to sea, moving through the swells like hundreds of black seals. Then they all turned, and as they watched a big wave approaching, they climbed onto its white crest. Each one laid on their stomach on a short, flat board and came rushing towards the shore, riding the top of the massive wave while they and the spectators shouted with excitement. Just as the huge wave curled majestically to crash down on the beach, most of the swimmers slipped back into the trough behind it; others, falling off their boards, grabbed them in their hands and dove through the churning water to swim out and have fun again. But a few, who seemed the boldest, kept going until they reached the beach, getting caught in the swirling foam and spray. One of these last ones rode in on the crest of the wave with great determination, landing almost right at the spot where Bill and I stood. I recognized him by his unusual headpiece; he was the chief whom the tribe had as their guest. The seawater had washed away nearly all the paint from his face, and as he rose, panting, to his feet, I was surprised to recognize the features of Tararo, my old friend from the Coral Island!
Tararo at the same moment recognised me, and advancing quickly, took me round the neck and rubbed noses, which had the effect of transferring a good deal of the moist paint from his nose to mine. Then, recollecting that this was not the white man’s mode of salutation, he grasped me by the hand and shook it violently.
Tararo instantly recognized me, and quickly coming forward, he wrapped his arms around my neck and rubbed our noses together, which ended up smudging a lot of his wet paint onto my face. Then, realizing this wasn't how white people greeted each other, he grabbed my hand and shook it vigorously.
“Hallo, Ralph!” cried Bill in surprise, “that chap seems to have taken a sudden fancy to you, or he must be an old acquaintance.”
“Hey, Ralph!” shouted Bill in surprise, “that guy seems to have suddenly taken a liking to you, or he must be an old friend.”
“Right, Bill,” I replied; “he is indeed an old acquaintance.” And I explained, in a few words, that he was the chief whose party Jack and Peterkin and I had helped to save.
“Right, Bill,” I replied; “he is definitely an old acquaintance.” And I briefly explained that he was the chief whose group Jack, Peterkin, and I had helped to save.
Tararo having thrown away his surf-board, entered into an animated conversation with Bill, pointing frequently during the course of it to me, whereby I concluded he must be telling him about the memorable battle and the part we had taken in it. When he paused I begged of Bill to ask him about the woman Avatea, for I had some hope that she might have come with Tararo on this visit. “And ask him,” said I, “who she is, for I am persuaded she is of a different race from the Feejeeans.” On the mention of her name the chief frowned darkly, and seemed to speak with much anger.
Tararo, having tossed aside his surfboard, jumped into a lively conversation with Bill, often pointing at me during the chat, which made me think he was telling him about the unforgettable battle and our involvement in it. When he took a break, I asked Bill to find out about the woman Avatea because I hoped she might have come with Tararo on this trip. “Also, ask him,” I said, “who she is, because I’m sure she’s from a different background than the Fijians.” When her name was mentioned, the chief frowned deeply and appeared to speak with a lot of anger.
“You’re right, Ralph,” said Bill when the chief had ceased to talk; “she’s not a Feejee girl, but a Samoan. How she ever came to this place the chief does not very clearly explain; but he says she was taken in war, and that he got her three years ago, an’ kept her as his daughter ever since. Lucky for her, poor girl, else she’d have been roasted and eaten like the rest.”
“You’re right, Ralph,” Bill said after the chief stopped talking. “She’s not a Feejee girl, but a Samoan. He doesn’t explain very clearly how she ended up here, but he says she was captured in war and that he got her three years ago and has kept her as his daughter ever since. Lucky for her, poor girl, or she would have been roasted and eaten like the others.”
“But why does Tararo frown and look so angry?” said I.
“But why does Tararo look so upset and angry?” I asked.
“Because the girl’s somewhat obstinate, like most o’ the sex, an’ won’t marry the man he wants her to. It seems that a chief of some other island came on a visit to Tararo and took a fancy to her; but she wouldn’t have him on no account, bein’ already in love, and engaged to a young chief whom Tararo hates, and she kicked up a desperate shindy. So, as he was goin’ on a war-expedition in his canoe, he left her to think about it, sayin’ he’d be back in six months or so, when he hoped she wouldn’t be so obstropolous. This happened just a week ago; an’ Tararo says that if she’s not ready to go, when the chief returns, as his bride, she’ll be sent to him as a long pig.”
“Because the girl’s a bit stubborn, like most women, and won’t marry the man he wants her to. It seems a chief from another island visited Tararo and took a liking to her; but she wouldn’t have him at all, since she’s already in love and engaged to a young chief whom Tararo hates, and she made a huge scene. So, as he was heading out on a war expedition in his canoe, he left her to think about it, saying he’d be back in six months or so, hoping she wouldn’t be so difficult. This happened just a week ago; and Tararo says that if she’s not ready to go with the chief when he returns as his bride, she’ll be sent to him as a long pig.”
“As a long pig!” I exclaimed in surprise. “Why, what does he mean by that?”
“As a long pig!” I exclaimed in surprise. “What does he mean by that?”
“He means somethin’ very unpleasant,” answered Bill with a frown. “You see, these blackguards eat men an’ women just as readily as they eat pigs; and as baked pigs and baked men are very like each other in appearance, they call men long pigs. If Avatea goes to this fellow as a long pig, it’s all up with her, poor thing!”
“He means something really unpleasant,” Bill replied with a frown. “You see, these scoundrels eat men and women just as easily as they eat pigs; and since baked pigs and baked men look pretty similar, they call men long pigs. If Avatea goes to this guy as a long pig, she’s done for, poor thing!”
“Is she on the island now?” I asked eagerly.
“Is she on the island right now?” I asked eagerly.
“No; she’s at Tararo’s island.”
“No; she’s at Tararo's Island.”
“And where does it lie?”
“And where is it located?”
“About fifty or sixty miles to the south’ard o’ this,” returned Bill; “but I—”
“About fifty or sixty miles to the south of this,” replied Bill; “but I—”
At this moment we were startled by the cry of “mao! mao—a shark! a shark!” which was immediately followed by a shriek that rang clear and fearfully loud above the tumult of cries that arose from the savages in the water and on the land. We turned hastily towards the direction whence the cry came, and had just time to observe the glaring eyeballs of one of the swimmers as he tossed his arms in the air. Next instant he was pulled under the waves. A canoe was instantly launched, and the hand of the drowning man was caught; but only half of his body was dragged from the maw of the monster, which followed the canoe until the water became so shallow that it could scarcely swim. The crest of the next billow was tinged with red as it rolled towards the shore.
At that moment, we were shocked by the shout of “Mao! Mao—a shark! A shark!” which was quickly followed by a scream that pierced through the chaos of cries coming from the people in the water and on the land. We quickly turned towards the source of the shout and had just enough time to see the frightened eyes of one of the swimmers as he flailed his arms. In the next instant, he was pulled under the water. A canoe was quickly launched, and they grabbed the hand of the drowning man; but only half of his body was pulled from the jaws of the beast, which chased the canoe until the water became so shallow that it could barely swim. The top of the next wave was stained red as it rolled toward the shore.
In most countries of the world this would have made a deep impression on the spectators; but the only effect it had upon these islanders was to make them hurry with all speed out of the sea, lest a similar fate should befall some of the others. But so utterly reckless were they of human life that it did not for a moment suspend the progress of their amusements. It is true the surf-swimming ended for that time somewhat abruptly, but they immediately proceeded with other games. Bill told me that sharks do not often attack the surf-swimmers, being frightened away by the immense numbers of men and boys in the water, and by the shouting and splashing that they make. “But,” said he, “such a thing as you have seen just now don’t frighten them much. They’ll be at it again to-morrow or next day, just as if there wasn’t a single shark between Feejee and Nova Zembla.”
In most countries around the world, this would have deeply affected the spectators; however, all it did for these islanders was make them rush out of the water quickly, so they wouldn’t share the same fate. But they were so indifferent to human life that it didn’t even momentarily disrupt their fun. It’s true that surf-swimming ended somewhat abruptly for that time, but they quickly moved on to other games. Bill told me that sharks rarely attack surfers, scared away by the huge number of men and boys in the water, along with all the shouting and splashing. “But,” he said, “what you just saw doesn’t scare them much. They’ll be back out there tomorrow or the next day, as if there isn’t a single shark between Fiji and Nova Zembla.”
After this the natives had a series of wrestling and boxing matches; and being men of immense size and muscle, they did a good deal of injury to each other, especially in boxing, in which not only the lower orders but several of the chiefs and priests engaged. Each bout was very quickly terminated; for they did not pretend to a scientific knowledge of the art, and wasted, no time in sparring, but hit straight out at each other’s heads, and their blows were delivered with great force. Frequently one of the combatants was knocked down with a single blow, and one gigantic fellow hit his adversary so severely that he drove the skin entirely off his forehead. This feat was hailed with immense applause by the spectators.
After this, the locals had a bunch of wrestling and boxing matches. Being really big and muscular guys, they ended up hurting each other quite a bit, especially in boxing, which included not just the common folks but also several chiefs and priests. Each match ended pretty quickly because they didn't pretend to have any real knowledge of the sport and wasted no time sparring; they just went straight for each other's heads, hitting hard. Often, one of the fighters would get knocked down with a single hit, and one huge guy struck his opponent so hard that he completely removed the skin from his forehead. This impressive feat earned huge applause from the spectators.
During these exhibitions, which were very painful to me, though I confess I could not refrain from beholding them, I was struck with the beauty of many of the figures and designs that were tattooed on the persons of the chiefs and principal men. One figure, that seemed to me very elegant, was that of a palm-tree tattooed on the back of a man’s leg, the roots rising, as it were, from under his heel, the stem ascending the tendon of the ankle, and the graceful head branching out upon the calf. I afterwards learned that this process of tattooing is very painful, and takes long to do, commencing at the age of ten, and being continued at intervals up to the age of thirty. It is done by means of an instrument made of bone, with a number of sharp teeth, with which the skin is punctured. Into these punctures a preparation made from the kernel of the candle-nut, mixed with cocoa-nut oil, is rubbed, and the mark thus made is indelible. The operation is performed by a class of men whose profession it is, and they tattoo as much at a time as the person on whom they are operating can bear, which is not much, the pain and inflammation caused by tattooing being very great—sometimes causing death. Some of the chiefs were tattooed with an ornamental stripe down the legs, which gave them the appearance of being clad in tights; others had marks round the ankles and insteps, which looked like tight-fitting and elegant boots. Their faces were also tattooed, and their breasts were very profusely marked with every imaginable species of device—muskets, dogs, birds, pigs, clubs, and canoes, intermingled with lozenges, squares, circles, and other arbitrary figures.
During these exhibitions, which were very painful for me, though I admit I couldn't help but watch, I was struck by the beauty of many of the tattoos on the chiefs and important men. One design that I found particularly elegant was a palm tree tattooed on a man's leg, with the roots seemingly rising from his heel, the trunk running up his ankle, and the branches gracefully spreading across his calf. I later learned that the tattooing process is very painful and takes a long time, starting at age ten and continuing at intervals until age thirty. It's done using a bone instrument with sharp teeth to puncture the skin. A mixture made from the candle-nut kernel and coconut oil is rubbed into these punctures, making the marks permanent. The procedure is performed by a specialized group of men who tattoo as much as the person can handle at once, which isn't much, as the pain and inflammation can be intense—sometimes even leading to death. Some of the chiefs had decorative stripes down their legs, making them look like they were wearing tights; others had markings around their ankles and insteps that resembled fitted, stylish boots. Their faces were also tattooed, and their chests were covered in all sorts of designs—muskets, dogs, birds, pigs, clubs, and canoes mixed with diamonds, squares, circles, and other random shapes.
The women were not tattooed so much as the men, having only a few marks on their feet and arms. But I must say, however objectionable this strange practice may be, it nevertheless had this good effect—that it took away very much from their appearance of nakedness.
The women had fewer tattoos than the men, with just a few marks on their feet and arms. But I have to say, no matter how questionable this unusual practice might be, it did have one positive effect—it significantly reduced the impression of their nudity.
Next day, while we were returning from the woods to our schooner, we observed Romata rushing about in the neighbourhood of his house, apparently mad with passion.
Next day, as we were heading back from the woods to our schooner, we noticed Romata running around near his house, seemingly crazy with anger.
“Ah!” said Bill to me, “there he’s at his old tricks again. That’s his way when he gets drink. The natives make a sort of drink o’ their own, and it makes him bad enough; but when he gets brandy he’s like a wild tiger. The captain, I suppose, has given him a bottle, as usual, to keep him in good-humour. After drinkin’ he usually goes to sleep, and the people know it well, and keep out of his way for fear they should waken him. Even the babies are taken out of earshot; for when he’s waked up he rushes out, just as you see him now, and spears or clubs the first person he meets.”
“Ah!” Bill said to me, “he’s up to his old tricks again. That’s how he gets when he drinks. The locals make their own version of alcohol, and it makes him pretty bad; but when he gets brandy, he acts like a wild tiger. The captain, I guess, has given him a bottle, as usual, to keep him in a good mood. After drinking, he usually falls asleep, and the people know it well, so they stay out of his way to avoid waking him up. Even the babies are taken out of earshot; because when he wakes up, he rushes out, just like you see him now, and stabs or hits the first person he comes across.”
It seemed at the present time, however, that no deadly weapon had been in his way, for the infuriated chief was raging about without one. Suddenly he caught sight of an unfortunate man who was trying to conceal himself behind a tree. Rushing towards him, Romata struck him a terrible blow on the head, which knocked out the poor man’s eye and also dislocated the chief’s finger. The wretched creature offered no resistance; he did not even attempt to parry the blow. Indeed, from what Bill said, I found that he might consider himself lucky in having escaped with his life, which would certainly have been forfeited had the chief been possessed of a club at the time.
It seemed at that moment, though, that no dangerous weapon was in his way, as the enraged chief was storming around empty-handed. Suddenly, he spotted an unfortunate man trying to hide behind a tree. Charging toward him, Romata delivered a brutal blow to the man's head, knocking out his eye and also injuring the chief’s finger. The poor man offered no resistance; he didn’t even try to defend himself. In fact, from what Bill said, he should consider himself lucky to have escaped with his life, which he surely would have lost if the chief had had a club in his hands.
“Have these wretched creatures no law among themselves,” said I, “which can restrain such wickedness?”
“Don’t these miserable creatures have any rules among themselves,” I said, “that can control such evil?”
“None,” replied Bill. “The chief’s word is law. He might kill and eat a dozen of his own subjects any day for nothing more than his own pleasure, and nobody would take the least notice of it.”
“None,” replied Bill. “The chief’s word is law. He could kill and eat a dozen of his own people just because he felt like it, and no one would bat an eye.”
This ferocious deed took place within sight of our party as we wended our way to the beach, but I could not observe any other expression on the faces of the men than that of total indifference or contempt. It seemed to me a very awful thing that it should be possible for men to come to such hardness of heart and callousness to the sight of bloodshed and violence; but, indeed, I began to find that such constant exposure to scenes of blood was having a slight effect upon myself, and I shuddered when I came to think that I too was becoming callous.
This brutal act happened right in front of us as we made our way to the beach, but I couldn’t see any expression on the men’s faces other than complete indifference or disdain. It struck me as truly terrible that people could become so hard-hearted and insensitive to bloodshed and violence; however, I realized that this ongoing exposure to scenes of blood was starting to affect me too, and I felt a shiver when I thought about how I was becoming desensitized as well.
I thought upon this subject much that night while I walked up and down the deck during my hours of watch, and I came to the conclusion that if I, who hated, abhorred, and detested such bloody deeds as I had witnessed within the last few weeks, could so soon come to be less sensitive about them, how little wonder that these poor, ignorant savages, who were born and bred in familiarity therewith, should think nothing of them at all, and should hold human life in so very slight esteem!
I thought a lot about this that night while I paced the deck during my watch, and I concluded that if I, who hated and loathed the bloody acts I’d seen in the past few weeks, could become less sensitive to them so quickly, it’s no surprise that these poor, ignorant savages, who grew up around such violence, wouldn’t think twice about it and would consider human life so insignificant!
Chapter Twenty Six.
Mischief brewing—My blood is made to run cold—Evil consultations and wicked resolves—Bloody Bill attempts to do good, and fails—The attack—Wholesale murder—The flight—The escape.
Next morning I awoke with a feverish brow and a feeling of deep depression at my heart; and the more I thought on my unhappy fate, the more wretched and miserable did I feel.
Next morning, I woke up with a feverish forehead and a heavy feeling of depression in my chest; and the more I reflected on my unfortunate situation, the more wretched and miserable I felt.
I was surrounded on all sides by human beings of the most dreadful character, to whom the shedding of blood was mere pastime. On shore were the natives, whose practices were so horrible that I could not think of them without shuddering. On board were none but pirates of the blackest dye, who, although not cannibals, were foul murderers, and more blameworthy even than the savages, inasmuch as they knew better. Even Bill, with whom I had, under the strange circumstances of my lot, formed a kind of intimacy, was so fierce in his nature as to have acquired the title of “Bloody” from his vile companions. I felt very much cast down the more I considered the subject and the impossibility of delivery, as it seemed to me—at least, for a long time to come. At last, in my feeling of utter helplessness, I prayed fervently to the Almighty that He would deliver me out of my miserable condition; and when I had done so I felt some degree of comfort.
I was surrounded on all sides by the most terrible people, for whom killing was just a fun activity. On the shore were the locals, whose customs were so horrifying that I couldn't think about them without feeling sick. On the ship were nothing but pirates of the worst kind, who, although they weren't cannibals, were brutal murderers and even worse than the savages because they knew better. Even Bill, with whom I had formed a strange sort of bond given my circumstances, was so savage that his horrible friends had dubbed him “Bloody.” The more I thought about my situation and the seeming impossibility of escape, the more discouraged I felt. Finally, in my total despair, I prayed earnestly to God, asking Him to rescue me from my wretched state; and after I did, I felt a little bit better.
When the captain came on deck, before the hour at which the men usually started for the woods, I begged of him to permit me to remain aboard that day, as I did not feel well; but he looked at me angrily, and ordered me, in a surly tone, to get ready to go on shore as usual. The fact was that the captain had been out of humour for some time past. Romata and he had had some differences, and high words had passed between them, during which the chief had threatened to send a fleet of his war-canoes, with a thousand men, to break up and burn the schooner; whereupon the captain smiled sarcastically, and going up to the chief, gazed sternly in his face while he said, “I have only to raise my little finger just now, and my big gun will blow your whole village to atoms in five minutes!” Although the chief was a bold man, he quailed before the pirate’s glance and threat, and made no reply; but a bad feeling had been raised, and old sores had been opened.
When the captain came on deck, earlier than when the crew usually headed for the woods, I asked him if I could stay on board that day since I wasn’t feeling well. He glared at me angrily and ordered me, in a grumpy tone, to get ready to go ashore as usual. The truth was that the captain had been in a bad mood for a while. He and Romata had had some disagreements, and they exchanged some heated words, during which the chief threatened to send a fleet of his war canoes, with a thousand men, to destroy and burn the schooner. The captain responded with a sarcastic smile, walked up to the chief, looked him squarely in the eyes, and said, “I just have to raise my little finger right now, and my big gun will obliterate your entire village in five minutes!” Even though the chief was a courageous man, he shrank back under the pirate’s fierce gaze and threat, saying nothing; however, a bad feeling had been stirred up, reopening old wounds.
I had, therefore, to go with the woodcutters that day. Before starting, however, the captain called me into the cabin and said:
I had to go with the woodcutters that day. But before we started, the captain called me into the cabin and said:
“Here, Ralph; I’ve got a mission for you, lad. That blackguard Romata is in the dumps, and nothing will mollify him but a gift; so do you go up to his house and give him these whale’s teeth, with my compliments. Take with you one of the men who can speak the language.”
“Here, Ralph; I have a mission for you, kid. That scoundrel Romata is feeling down, and nothing will cheer him up but a gift; so you should go to his house and give him these whale’s teeth, with my regards. Take one of the men who can speak the language with you.”
I looked at the gift in some surprise, for it consisted of six white whale’s teeth, and two of the same dyed bright red, which seemed to me very paltry things. However, I did not dare to hesitate, or to ask any questions; so gathering them up, I left the cabin, and was soon on my way to the chief’s house, accompanied by Bill. On expressing my surprise at the gift, he said:
I looked at the gift in surprise because it was made up of six white whale teeth and two that were dyed bright red, which seemed like pretty insignificant items to me. However, I didn't want to hesitate or ask any questions, so I gathered them up, left the cabin, and quickly headed to the chief's house with Bill. When I expressed my surprise at the gift, he said:
“They’re paltry enough to you or me, Ralph, but they’re considered of great value by them chaps. They’re a sort o’ cash among them. The red ones are the most prized, one of them bein’ equal to twenty o’ the white ones. I suppose the only reason for their bein’ valuable is that there ain’t many of them, and they’re hard to be got.”
“They're pretty worthless to you or me, Ralph, but those guys think they're really valuable. They're like cash to them. The red ones are the most sought after, with one of them being worth twenty of the white ones. I guess the only reason they're valuable is that there aren't many of them, and they're hard to get."
On arriving at the house we found Romata sitting on a mat, in the midst of a number of large bales of native cloth and other articles, which had been brought to him as presents from time to time by inferior chiefs. He received us rather haughtily; but on Bill explaining the nature of our errand, he became very condescending, and his eyes glistened with satisfaction when he received the whale’s teeth, although he laid them aside with an assumption of kingly indifference.
On arriving at the house, we found Romata sitting on a mat, surrounded by several large bales of traditional cloth and other items that had been brought to him as gifts from lesser chiefs over time. He welcomed us with a bit of arrogance, but when Bill explained why we were there, he became much more agreeable, and his eyes sparkled with satisfaction when he received the whale’s teeth, although he dismissed them with a show of royal indifference.
“Go,” said he with a wave of the hand— “go tell your captain that he may cut wood to-day, but not to-morrow. He must come ashore; I want to have a palaver with him.”
“Go,” he said, waving his hand. “Go tell your captain he can cut wood today, but not tomorrow. He needs to come ashore; I want to talk to him.”
As we left the house to return to the woods, Bill shook his head.
As we left the house to head back to the woods, Bill shook his head.
“There’s mischief brewin’ in that black rascal’s head. I know him of old. But what comes here?”
“There’s trouble brewing in that little troublemaker’s head. I know him well. But what’s happening here?”
As he spoke, we heard the sound of laughter and shouting in the wood, and presently there issued from it a band of savages, in the midst of whom were a number of men bearing burdens on their shoulders. At first I thought that these burdens were poles with something rolled round them, the end of each pole resting on a man’s shoulder; but on a nearer approach I saw that they were human beings, tied hand and foot, and so lashed to the poles that they could not move. I counted twenty of them as they passed.
As he spoke, we heard laughter and shouting coming from the woods, and soon a group of savages emerged, with several men carrying loads on their shoulders. At first, I thought these loads were poles with something wrapped around them, with each pole resting on a man's shoulder. But as we got closer, I realized they were actually human beings, tied up hand and foot, bound to the poles in a way that they couldn’t move. I counted twenty of them as they went by.
“More murder!” said Bill in a voice that sounded between a hoarse laugh and a groan.
“More murder!” Bill said, his voice somewhere between a raspy laugh and a groan.
“Surely they are not going to murder them?” said I, looking anxiously into Bill’s face.
“Surely they’re not going to kill them?” I said, looking anxiously at Bill’s face.
“I don’t know, Ralph,” replied Bill, “what they’re goin’ to do with them; but I fear they mean no good when they tie fellows up in that way.”
“I don’t know, Ralph,” replied Bill, “what they’re going to do with them; but I worry they don’t have good intentions when they tie people up like that.”
As we continued our way towards the woodcutters, I observed that Bill looked anxiously over his shoulder in the direction where the procession had disappeared. At last he stopped, and turning abruptly on his heel, said:
As we kept moving toward the woodcutters, I noticed that Bill kept nervously glancing back where the procession had vanished. Finally, he halted, turned abruptly on his heel, and said:
“I tell ye what it is, Ralph: I must be at the bottom o’ that affair. Let us follow these black scoundrels and see what they’re goin’ to do.”
“I’ll tell you what it is, Ralph: I need to get to the bottom of this. Let’s follow these black scoundrels and see what they’re up to.”
I must say I had no wish to pry further into their bloody practices; but Bill seemed bent on it, so I turned and went. We passed rapidly through the bush, being guided in the right direction by the shouts of the savages. Suddenly there was a dead silence, which continued for some time, while Bill and I involuntarily quickened our pace until we were running at the top of our speed across the narrow neck of land previously mentioned. As we reached the verge of the wood we discovered the savages surrounding the large war-canoe, which they were apparently on the point of launching. Suddenly the multitude put their united strength to the canoe; but scarcely had the huge machine begun to move when a yell, the most appalling that ever fell upon my ear, rose high above the shouting of the savages. It had not died away when another and another smote upon my throbbing ear, and then I saw that these inhuman monsters were actually launching their canoe over the living bodies of their victims. But there was no pity in the breasts of these men. Forward they went in ruthless indifference, shouting as they went, while high above their voices rang the dying shrieks of those wretched creatures as, one after another, the ponderous canoe passed over them, burst the eyeballs from their sockets, and sent the life-blood gushing from their mouths. Oh reader, this is no fiction! I would not, for the sake of thrilling you with horror, invent so terrible a scene. It was witnessed. It is true—true as that accursed sin which has rendered the human heart capable of such diabolical enormities!
I have to say I didn't want to dig deeper into their brutal practices; but Bill seemed determined to, so I turned and went with him. We quickly moved through the bush, following the direction of the savages’ shouts. Suddenly, there was complete silence, which lingered for a while, as Bill and I instinctively picked up our pace until we were sprinting at full speed across the narrow stretch of land we mentioned earlier. When we reached the edge of the woods, we saw the savages surrounding the large war canoe, which they seemed ready to launch. Suddenly, the crowd put all of their strength into the canoe; but hardly had the massive vessel begun to move when a scream, the most terrifying I’ve ever heard, pierced the air above the savages' yelling. Just as that scream faded, another one and then another rang out, and then I realized that these inhuman monsters were actually launching their canoe over the living bodies of their victims. There was no mercy in the hearts of these men. They kept moving forward with brutal indifference, shouting as they went, while above their voices echoed the dying cries of those poor souls as, one by one, the heavy canoe rolled over them, bursting their eyeballs and spilling their lifeblood. Oh reader, this isn’t fiction! I wouldn’t invent such a horrific scene just to shock you. It was witnessed. It’s true—true as that cursed sin which has made the human heart capable of such monstrous atrocities!
When it was over I turned round and fell upon the grass with a deep groan; but Bill seized me by the arm, and lifting me up as if I had been a child, cried:
When it was over, I turned around and collapsed onto the grass with a deep groan; but Bill grabbed me by the arm and lifted me up as if I were a child, shouting:
“Come along, lad; let’s away!” And so, staggering and stumbling over the tangled underwood, we fled from the fatal spot.
“Come on, kid; let’s go!” And so, tripping and stumbling over the messy underbrush, we ran away from the dangerous place.
During the remainder of that day I felt as if I were in a horrible dream. I scarce knew what was said to me, and was more than once blamed by the men for idling my time. At last the hour to return aboard came. We marched down to the beach, and I felt relief for the first time when my feet rested on the schooner’s deck.
During the rest of the day, I felt like I was in a bad dream. I hardly understood what people were saying to me and was blamed more than once by the guys for wasting time. Finally, it was time to go back on board. We walked down to the beach, and I felt relieved for the first time when my feet touched the schooner’s deck.
In the course of the evening I overheard part of a conversation between the captain and the first mate, which startled me not a little. They were down in the cabin, and conversed in an undertone; but the skylight being off; I overhead every word that was said.
In the evening, I caught part of a conversation between the captain and the first mate that shocked me quite a bit. They were in the cabin talking quietly, but since the skylight was open, I heard every word they said.
“I don’t half-like it,” said the mate. “It seems to me that we’ll only have hard fightin’ and no pay.”
“I don’t really like it,” said the mate. “It seems to me that we’re just going to have tough battles and no pay.”
“No pay!” repeated the captain in a voice of suppressed anger. “Do you call a good cargo all for nothing no pay?”
“No pay!” the captain repeated, his voice filled with barely contained anger. “You call a good cargo all for nothing, no pay?”
“Very true,” returned the mate; “but we’ve got the cargo aboard. Why not cut your cable and take French leave o’ them? What’s the use o’ tryin’ to kill the blackguards when it’ll do us no manner o’ good?”
“Very true,” replied the mate; “but we’ve got the cargo on board. Why not cut your cable and sneak away from them? What’s the point of trying to take out the scoundrels when it won’t benefit us at all?”
“Mate,” said the captain in a low voice, “you talk like a fresh-water sailor. I can only attribute this shyness to some strange delusion, for surely,”—his voice assumed a slightly sneering tone as he said this—“surely I am not to suppose that you have become soft-hearted! Besides, you are wrong in regard to the cargo being aboard; there’s a good quarter of it lying in the woods, and that blackguard chief knows it, and won’t let me take it off. He defied us to do our worst yesterday.”
“Buddy,” the captain said quietly, “you sound like an inexperienced sailor. I can only think this hesitation is due to some odd delusion, because surely,”—his voice turned a bit mocking as he said this—“surely I can’t believe you’ve gone soft-hearted! Plus, you’re mistaken about the cargo being loaded; a good portion of it is still in the woods, and that scoundrel chief knows it and won’t let me take it. He challenged us to do our worst yesterday.”
“Defied us! did he?” cried the mate with a bitter laugh. “Poor, contemptible thing!”
“Defied us, did he?” the mate exclaimed with a bitter laugh. “Pathetic, despicable thing!”
“And yet he seems not so contemptible but that you are afraid to attack him.”
“And yet he doesn’t seem so unworthy that you’re afraid to confront him.”
“Who said I was afraid?” growled the mate sulkily. “I’m as ready as any man in the ship. But, captain, what is it that you intend to do?”
“Who said I was scared?” the mate grumbled sulkily. “I’m just as prepared as any man on the ship. But, captain, what do you plan to do?”
“I intend to muffle the sweeps and row the schooner up to the head of the creek there, from which point we can command the pile of sandal-wood with our gun. Then I shall land with all the men except two, who shall take care of the schooner and be ready with the boat to take us off. We can creep through the woods to the head of the village, where these cannibals are always dancing round their suppers of human flesh; and if the carbines of the men are loaded with a heavy charge of buck-shot, we can drop forty or fifty at the first volley. After that the thing will be easy enough. The savages will take to the mountains in a body, and we shall take what we require, up anchor, and away.”
“I plan to quiet the sails and row the schooner up to the end of the creek, from where we’ll have a clear shot at the stack of sandalwood with our gun. Then I’ll go ashore with all the men except for two, who will stay with the schooner and be ready with the boat to pick us up. We can sneak through the woods to the edge of the village, where these cannibals are always dancing around their meals of human flesh; and if the guys have their carbines loaded with a heavy load of buckshot, we can take out forty or fifty in the first shot. After that, it will be pretty straightforward. The savages will flee to the mountains, and we’ll take what we need, raise the anchor, and head out.”
To this plan the mate at length agreed. As he left the cabin, I heard the captain say:
To this plan, the mate finally agreed. As he left the cabin, I heard the captain say:
“Give the men an extra glass of grog, and don’t forget the buck-shot.”
“Give the guys an extra glass of grog, and don’t forget the buckshot.”
The reader may conceive the horror with which I heard this murderous conversation. I immediately repeated it to Bill, who seemed much perplexed about it. At length he said:
The reader can imagine the shock I felt when I heard this deadly conversation. I quickly told Bill about it, and he looked very confused. Finally, he said:
“I’ll tell you what I’ll do, Ralph. I’ll swim ashore after dark and fix a musket to a tree not far from the place where we’ll have to land, and I’ll tie a long string to the trigger, so that when our fellows cross it they’ll let it off, and so alarm the village in time to prevent an attack, but not in time to prevent us gettin’ back to the boat.—So, Master Captain,” added Bill with a smile that, for the first time, seemed to me to be mingled with good-natured cheerfulness, “you’ll be balked at least for once in your life by Bloody Bill.”
“I’ll tell you what I’m gonna do, Ralph. I’ll swim to shore after dark and set up a musket on a tree not far from where we’re going to land. I’ll tie a long string to the trigger, so when our guys cross it, it’ll fire off and warn the village in time to stop an attack, but not in time to keep us from getting back to the boat. —So, Captain,” Bill added with a smile that, for the first time, seemed mixed with genuine cheerfulness, “you’ll at least get thwarted once in your life by Bloody Bill.”
After it grew dark, Bill put this resolve in practice. He slipped over the side with a musket in his left hand, while with his right he swam ashore and entered the woods. He soon returned, having accomplished his purpose, and got on board without being seen, I being the only one on deck.
After it got dark, Bill put his plan into action. He climbed over the side with a musket in his left hand while using his right to swim to shore and went into the woods. He quickly came back, having achieved what he set out to do, and got back on board without being noticed, since I was the only one on deck.
When the hour of midnight approached, the men were mustered on deck, the cable was cut, and the muffled sweeps got out. These sweeps were immensely large oars, each requiring a couple of men to work it. In a few minutes we entered the mouth of the creek, which was indeed the mouth of a small river, and took about half-an-hour to ascend it, although the spot where we intended to land was not more than six hundred yards from the mouth, because there was a slight current against us, and the mangroves which narrowed the creek impeded the rowers in some places. Having reached the spot, which was so darkened by overhanging trees that we could see with difficulty, a small kedge-anchor attached to a thin line was let softly down over the stern.
As midnight approached, the men gathered on deck, the cable was cut, and the muffled oars were brought out. These oars were incredibly large, requiring a couple of men to handle each one. In a few minutes, we entered the mouth of the creek, which was actually the mouth of a small river, and it took about half an hour to navigate it, even though our landing spot was only about six hundred yards from the mouth. The slight current worked against us, and the mangroves lining the creek made it harder for the rowers in some places. Once we reached the spot, which was so dark due to the overhanging trees that we could barely see, a small kedge anchor connected to a thin line was carefully lowered over the stern.
“Now, lads,” whispered the captain as he walked along the line of men, who were all armed to the teeth, “don’t be in a hurry, aim low, and don’t waste your first shots.”
“Alright, guys,” the captain whispered as he strolled along the line of men, all heavily armed, “don’t rush it, aim low, and save your first shots.”
He then pointed to the boat, into which the men crowded in silence. There was no room to row; but oars were not needed, as a slight push against the side of the schooner sent the boat gliding to the shore.
He then pointed to the boat, where the men silently crowded in. There wasn't enough room to row, but oars weren't necessary, as a gentle push against the side of the schooner sent the boat gliding to the shore.
“There’s no need of leaving two in the boat,” whispered the mate as the men stepped out; “we shall want all our hands. Let Ralph stay.”
“There's no need to leave two in the boat,” whispered the mate as the men got out; “we'll need all our hands. Let Ralph stay.”
The captain assented, and ordered me to stand in readiness with the boat-hook, to shove ashore at a moment’s notice if they should return, or to shove off if any of the savages should happen to approach. He then threw his carbine into the hollow of his arm, and glided through the bushes, followed by his men. With a throbbing heart I awaited the result of our plan. I knew the exact locality where the musket was placed, for Bill had described it to me, and I kept my straining eyes fixed upon the spot. But no sound came, and I began to fear that either they had gone in another direction or that Bill had not fixed the string properly. Suddenly I heard a faint click, and observed one or two bright sparks among the bushes. My heart immediately sank within me, for I knew at once that the trigger had indeed been pulled, but that the priming had not caught. The plan, therefore, had utterly failed. A feeling of dread now began to creep over me as I stood in the boat, in that dark, silent spot, awaiting the issue of this murderous expedition. I shuddered as I glanced at the water that glided past like a dark reptile. I looked back at the schooner; but her hull was just barely visible, while her tapering masts were lost among the trees which overshadowed her. Her lower sails were set, but so thick was the gloom that they were quite invisible.
The captain agreed and told me to be ready with the boat-hook to push ashore at a moment’s notice if they came back, or to shove off if any of the natives got too close. He then tucked his rifle under his arm and moved quietly through the bushes, followed by his men. With a racing heart, I waited to see how our plan would turn out. I knew exactly where the musket was because Bill had pointed it out to me, so I kept my eyes glued to that spot. But no sound came, and I started to worry that they had gone in a different direction or that Bill hadn’t set the string right. Suddenly, I heard a faint click and saw a couple of bright sparks in the bushes. My heart dropped because I realized the trigger had been pulled, but the gunpowder hadn’t ignited. So the plan had completely failed. A sense of dread began to take over me as I stood in the boat in that dark, quiet place, waiting for the outcome of this deadly mission. I shuddered when I looked at the water that flowed by like a dark snake. I glanced back at the schooner, but its hull was barely visible, and its tall masts were lost among the trees overhead. Its lower sails were up, but the darkness was so thick that they were completely hidden.
Suddenly I heard a shot. In a moment a thousand voices raised a yell in the village; again the cry rose on the night air, and was followed by broken shouts as of scattered parties of men bounding into the woods. Then I heard another shout, loud and close at hand; it was the voice of the captain cursing the man who had fired the premature shot. Then came the order, “Forward!” followed by a wild hurrah of our men as they charged the savages. Shots now rang in quick succession, and at last a loud volley startled the echoes of the woods. It was followed by a multitude of wild shrieks, which were immediately drowned in another hurrah from the men, the distance of the sound proving that they were driving their enemies before them towards the sea.
Suddenly, I heard a shot. In an instant, a thousand voices erupted in a yell throughout the village; the cry rose again into the night air, followed by fragmented shouts as groups of men rushed into the woods. Then I heard another shout, loud and nearby; it was the captain cursing the person who had fired the early shot. Next came the command, “Forward!” followed by a wild cheer from our men as they charged at the savages. Shots rang out in quick succession, and finally, a loud volley startled the echoes of the woods. It was followed by a chorus of wild shrieks, which were quickly drowned out by another cheer from the men, indicating that they were pushing their enemies back toward the sea.
While I was listening intently to these sounds, which were now mingled in confusion, I was startled by the rustling of the leaves not far from me. At first I thought it was a party of savages who had observed the schooner, but I was speedily undeceived by observing a body of natives—apparently several hundreds, as far as I could guess in the uncertain light—bounding through the woods towards the scene of battle. I saw at once that this was a party who had outflanked our men, and would speedily attack them in the rear. And so it turned out; for in a short time the shouts increased tenfold, and among them I thought I heard a death-cry uttered by voices familiar to my ear.
While I was listening closely to these sounds, which had now blended into chaos, I was startled by the rustling of leaves nearby. At first, I thought it was a group of savages who had spotted the schooner, but I quickly realized my mistake when I saw a large group of natives—probably several hundred, based on what I could make out in the dim light—charging through the woods toward the battlefield. I immediately understood that this group had outflanked our soldiers and would soon attack them from behind. And that’s exactly what happened; shortly after, the shouts grew exponentially, and among them, I thought I heard a death cry from voices familiar to me.
At length the tumult of battle ceased, and from the cries of exultation that now arose from the savages, I felt assured that our men had been conquered. I was immediately thrown into dreadful consternation. What was I now to do? To be taken by the savages was too horrible to be thought of; to flee to the mountains was hopeless, as I should soon be discovered; and to take the schooner out of the creek without assistance was impossible. I resolved, however, to make the attempt, as being my only hope, and was on the point of pushing off, when my hand was stayed and my blood chilled by an appalling shriek, in which I recognised the voice of one of the crew. It was succeeded by a shout from the savages. Then came another and another shriek of agony, making my ears to tingle, as I felt convinced they were murdering the pirate crew in cold blood. With a bursting heart and my brain whirling as if on fire, I seized the boat-hook to push from shore when a man sprang from the bushes.
At last, the chaos of battle ended, and from the cheers of victory that erupted from the savages, I knew our men had been defeated. I was immediately filled with terror. What was I supposed to do now? Being captured by the savages was too horrifying to imagine; escaping to the mountains seemed impossible since I would soon be found; and taking the schooner out of the creek by myself was out of the question. However, I decided to try, as it was my only chance, and just as I was about to push off, my hand was held back and my blood ran cold at a terrifying scream that I recognized as one of the crew's. It was followed by a shout from the savages. Then there came another and another scream of pain, making my ears ring, as I was sure they were brutally killing the pirate crew. With a pounding heart and my mind racing, I grabbed the boat-hook to push away from the shore when a man jumped out of the bushes.
“Stop! Ralph, stop! There, now, push off!” he cried, and bounded into the boat so violently as nearly to upset her. It was Bill’s voice! In another moment we were on board—the boat made fast, the line of the anchor cut, and the sweeps run out. At the first stroke of Bill’s giant arm the schooner was nearly pulled ashore, for in his haste he forgot that I could scarcely move the unwieldy oar. Springing to the stern, he lashed the rudder in such a position as that, while it aided me, it acted against him, and so rendered the force of our strokes nearly equal. The schooner now began to glide quickly down the creek; but before we reached its mouth, a yell from a thousand voices on the bank told that we were discovered. Instantly a number of the savages plunged into the water and swam towards us; but we were making so much way that they could not overtake us. One, however, an immensely powerful man, succeeded in laying hold of the cut rope that hung from the stern, and clambered quickly upon deck. Bill caught sight of him the instant his head appeared above the taffrail. But he did not cease to row, and did not appear even to notice the savage until he was within a yard of him; then dropping the sweep, he struck him a blow on the forehead with his clenched fist that felled him to the deck. Lifting him up, he hurled him overboard, and resumed the oar. But now a greater danger awaited us; for the savages had outrun us on the bank, and were about to plunge into the water ahead of the schooner. If they succeeded in doing so, our fate was sealed. For one moment Bill stood irresolute. Then drawing a pistol from his belt, he sprang to the brass gun, held the pan of his pistol over the touch-hole, and fired. The shot was succeeded by the hiss of the cannon’s priming; then the blaze and the crashing thunder of the monstrous gun burst upon the savages with such deafening roar that it seemed as if their very mountains had been rent asunder.
“Stop! Ralph, stop! There, now, push off!” he shouted, hopping into the boat so forcefully that it almost tipped over. It was Bill’s voice! In no time, we were on board—the boat secured, the anchor line cut, and the oars out. With the first stroke of Bill’s strong arm, the schooner nearly shot ashore because he forgot that I could barely move the heavy oar. He jumped to the stern and tied the rudder in a way that helped me but worked against him, making our strokes nearly equal. The schooner started to glide swiftly down the creek; but before we reached the mouth, a shout from a thousand voices on the bank revealed that we were seen. Instantly, several of the savages jumped into the water and swam toward us; but we were moving so fast that they couldn’t catch up. One, however, an incredibly strong man, managed to grab the cut rope hanging from the stern and quickly climbed onto the deck. Bill spotted him the moment his head rose above the back of the boat. But he didn’t stop rowing and acted like he didn’t even notice the savage until he was just a yard away; then, dropping the oar, he punched him in the forehead with his fist, knocking him to the deck. Bill picked him up, tossed him overboard, and went back to the oar. But now a bigger danger faced us; the savages had sprinted ahead along the bank and were about to jump into the water in front of the schooner. If they succeeded, we were done for. For a moment, Bill hesitated. Then pulling a pistol from his belt, he rushed to the brass gun, held the pistol’s pan over the touch-hole, and fired. The shot was followed by the hissing of the cannon’s priming; then the explosion and booming roar of the huge gun erupted upon the savages with such a deafening sound that it felt like their very mountains had been shattered.
This was enough. The moment of surprise and hesitation caused by the unwonted sound gave us time to pass the point; a gentle breeze, which the dense foliage had hitherto prevented us from feeling, bulged out our sails; the schooner bent before it, and the shouts of the disappointed savages grew fainter and fainter in the distance as we were slowly wafted out to sea.
This was enough. The surprise and uncertainty from the unexpected sound gave us time to get past the point; a gentle breeze, which the thick trees had kept us from feeling until now, filled our sails; the schooner leaned forward in it, and the shouts of the frustrated natives faded more and more into the distance as we were slowly carried out to sea.
Chapter Twenty Seven.
Reflections—The wounded man—The squall—True consolation—Death.
There is a power of endurance in human beings, both in their bodies and in their minds, which, I have often thought, seems to be wonderfully adapted and exactly proportioned to the circumstances in which individuals may happen to be placed—a power which, in most cases, is sufficient to carry a man through and over every obstacle that may happen to be thrown in his path through life, no matter how high or how steep the mountain may be, but which often forsakes him the moment the summit is gained, the point of difficulty passed, and leaves him prostrated, with energies gone, nerves unstrung, and a feeling of incapacity pervading the entire frame that renders the most trifling effort almost impossible.
There is a remarkable endurance in human beings, both physically and mentally, which I often think is perfectly suited to the situations individuals find themselves in—a strength that, in most cases, is enough to help someone overcome any obstacle life throws their way, regardless of how high or steep the challenge is. However, it often abandons them the moment they reach the top, the tough part behind them, leaving them exhausted, drained, and overwhelmed, making even the smallest effort feel nearly impossible.
During the greater part of that day I had been subjected to severe mental and much physical excitement, which had almost crushed me down by the time I was relieved from duty in the course of the evening. But when the expedition whose failure has just been narrated was planned, my anxieties and energies had been so powerfully aroused that I went through the protracted scenes of that terrible night without a feeling of the slightest fatigue. My mind and body were alike active and full of energy. No sooner was the last thrilling fear of danger past, however, than my faculties were utterly relaxed; and when I felt the cool breezes of the Pacific playing around my fevered brow, and heard the free waves rippling at the schooner’s prow, as we left the hated island behind us, my senses forsook me, and I fell in a swoon upon the deck.
For most of that day, I had been under intense mental stress and a lot of physical excitement, which nearly overwhelmed me by the time I was off duty in the evening. However, when the mission that turned out to be a failure was planned, my worries and energy were so heightened that I got through the long events of that terrible night without feeling even a hint of fatigue. Both my mind and body were active and full of energy. But as soon as the last frightening moment of danger passed, I completely relaxed; when I felt the cool Pacific breeze against my heated forehead and heard the waves gently lapping at the schooner’s bow as we left that hated island behind, I fainted and collapsed on the deck.
From this state I was quickly aroused by Bill, who shook me by the arm, saying:
From this state, I was quickly awakened by Bill, who shook me by the arm, saying:
“Hallo, Ralph, boy! Rouse up, lad; we’re safe now! Poor thing! I believe he’s fainted.” And raising me in his arms he laid me on the folds of the gaff-topsail, which lay upon the deck near the tiller. “Here, take a drop o’ this; it’ll do you good, my boy,” he added in a voice of tenderness which I had never heard him use before, while he held a brandy-flask to my lips.
“Hey, Ralph, wake up, kid! We’re safe now! Poor thing! I think he’s fainted.” Lifting me in his arms, he laid me on the folds of the gaff-topsail that was on the deck near the tiller. “Here, have a sip of this; it’ll help you, my boy,” he added with a softness in his voice that I had never heard from him before, as he held a brandy flask to my lips.
I raised my eyes gratefully as I swallowed a mouthful; next moment my head sank heavily upon my arm, and I fell fast asleep. I slept long, for when I awoke the sun was a good way above the horizon. I did not move on first opening my eyes, as I felt a delightful sensation of rest pervading me, and my eyes were riveted on and charmed with the gorgeous splendour of the mighty ocean that burst upon my sight. It was a dead calm; the sea seemed a sheet of undulating crystal, tipped and streaked with the saffron hues of sunrise, which had not yet merged into the glowing heat of noon; and there was a deep calm in the blue dome above that was not broken even by the usual flutter of the sea-fowl. How long I would have lain in contemplation of this peaceful scene I know not, but my mind was recalled suddenly and painfully to the past and the present by the sight of Bill, who was seated on the deck at my feet, with his head reclining, as if in sleep, on his right arm, which rested on the tiller. As he seemed to rest peacefully, I did not mean to disturb him; but the slight noise I made in raising myself on my elbow caused him to start and look round.
I raised my eyes gratefully as I swallowed a mouthful; the next moment, my head sank heavily onto my arm, and I fell fast asleep. I slept for a long time, because when I finally woke up, the sun was well above the horizon. At first, I didn’t move as I opened my eyes, feeling a wonderful sense of rest wash over me, and my gaze was drawn to the stunning beauty of the vast ocean that stretched before me. It was completely calm; the sea looked like a sheet of shimmering crystal, highlighted and streaked with the warm colors of sunrise, which hadn't yet turned into the intense heat of noon; and there was a deep stillness in the blue sky above that wasn’t disrupted even by the usual flurry of seabirds. I don't know how long I would have stayed lost in thought about this serene scene, but I was suddenly and painfully pulled back to reality by the sight of Bill, who was sitting on the deck at my feet, his head resting as if he were asleep on his right arm, which was propped on the tiller. Since he seemed to be resting peacefully, I didn’t want to disturb him; however, the slight noise I made as I raised myself on my elbow caused him to start and look around.
“Well, Ralph, awake at last, my boy? You have slept long and soundly,” he said, turning towards me.
“Well, Ralph, finally awake, huh? You’ve been sleeping for a long time,” he said, turning towards me.
On beholding his countenance I sprang up in anxiety. He was deadly pale, and his hair, which hung in dishevelled locks over his face, was clotted with blood. Blood also stained his hollow cheeks and covered the front of his shirt, which, with the greater part of his dress, was torn and soiled with mud.
On seeing his face, I jumped up in panic. He was deathly pale, and his hair, which was messy and hanging over his face, was matted with blood. Blood also marked his sunken cheeks and splattered the front of his shirt, which, along with most of his clothes, was ripped and dirty with mud.
“Oh Bill!” said I with deep anxiety, “what is the matter with you? You are ill. You must have been wounded.”
“Oh Bill!” I said with deep worry, “what’s wrong with you? You look sick. You must have been hurt.”
“Even so, lad,” said Bill in a deep, soft voice, while he extended his huge frame on the couch from which I had just risen. “I’ve got an ugly wound, I fear; and I’ve been waiting for you to waken to ask you to get me a drop o’ brandy and a mouthful o’ bread from the cabin lockers. You seemed to sleep so sweetly, Ralph, that I didn’t like to disturb you. But I don’t feel up to much just now.”
“Still, kid,” Bill said in a low, gentle voice as he stretched his large body on the couch I had just left. “I’ve got a nasty wound, I’m afraid; and I’ve been waiting for you to wake up so I could ask you to bring me a bit of brandy and a piece of bread from the cabin storage. You looked so peaceful sleeping, Ralph, that I didn’t want to wake you. But I’m not feeling so well right now.”
I did not wait till he had done talking, but ran below immediately, and returned in a few seconds with a bottle of brandy and some broken biscuit. He seemed much refreshed after eating a few morsels and drinking a long draught of water mingled with a little of the spirits. Immediately afterwards he fell asleep, and I watched him anxiously until he awoke, being desirous of knowing the nature and extent of his wound.
I didn’t wait for him to finish talking; I just hurried below and came back in a few seconds with a bottle of brandy and some broken biscuits. He looked much better after eating a few bites and taking a long drink of water mixed with a bit of the brandy. Soon after, he fell asleep, and I watched him closely until he woke up, eager to find out the nature and extent of his injury.
“Ha!” he exclaimed on awaking suddenly, after a slumber of an hour; “I’m the better of that nap, Ralph. I feel twice the man I was;” and he attempted to rise, but sank back again immediately with a deep groan.
“Ha!” he exclaimed, waking up suddenly after an hour-long nap. “I’m feeling better from that nap, Ralph. I feel twice as strong as I was!” He tried to get up but immediately sank back down with a deep groan.
“Nay, Bill, you must not move, but lie still while I look at your wound. I’ll make a comfortable bed for you here on deck, and get you some breakfast. After that you shall tell me how you got it. Cheer up, Bill!” I added, seeing that he turned his head away; “you’ll be all right in a little, and I’ll be a capital nurse to you, though I’m no doctor.”
“Nah, Bill, you can’t move; just lie still while I check your wound. I’ll make a comfy spot for you here on deck and get you some breakfast. After that, you can tell me how you got it. Keep your chin up, Bill!” I added, noticing he turned his head away; “you’ll be fine in no time, and I’ll take good care of you, even though I’m not a doctor."
I then left him, and lighted a fire in the caboose. While it was kindling, I went to the steward’s pantry and procured the materials for a good breakfast, with which, in little more than half-an-hour, I returned to my companion. He seemed much better, and smiled kindly on me as I set before him a cup of coffee and a tray with several eggs and some bread on it.
I then left him and started a fire in the caboose. While it was getting going, I went to the steward’s pantry and gathered what I needed for a decent breakfast. In just over half an hour, I returned to my friend. He looked much better and smiled kindly at me as I set down a cup of coffee and a tray with several eggs and some bread.
“Now, then, Bill,” said I cheerfully, sitting down beside him on the deck, “let’s fall to. I’m very hungry myself, I can tell you. But—I forgot—your wound,” I added, rising; “let me look at it.”
“Okay, Bill,” I said cheerfully, sitting down next to him on the deck, “let’s get started. I’m really hungry, I have to say. But—I almost forgot—your wound,” I added, getting up; “let me check it out.”
I found that the wound was caused by a pistol-shot in the chest. It did not bleed much, and as it was on the right side, I was in hopes that it might not be very serious. But Bill shook his head. “However,” said he, “sit down, Ralph, and I’ll tell you all about it.
I discovered that the injury was from a gunshot to the chest. It didn't bleed much, and since it was on the right side, I hoped it might not be too serious. But Bill shook his head. “Well,” he said, “sit down, Ralph, and I’ll explain everything to you.
“You see, after we left the boat an’ began to push through the bushes, we went straight for the line of my musket, as I had expected. But by some unlucky chance it didn’t explode, for I saw the line torn away by the men’s legs, and heard the click o’ the lock; so I fancy the priming had got damp and didn’t catch. I was in a great quandary now what to do, for I couldn’t concoct in my mind, in the hurry, any good reason for firin’ off my piece. But they say necessity’s the mother of invention; so just as I was giving it up and clinchin’ my teeth to bide the worst o’t and take what should come, a sudden thought came into my head. I stepped out before the rest, seemin’ to be awful anxious to be at the savages, tripped my foot on a fallen tree, plunged head foremost into a bush, an’ ov coorse my carbine exploded! Then came such a screechin’ from the camp as I never heard in all my life. I rose at once, and was rushin’ on with the rest when the captain called a halt.
“You see, after we left the boat and started pushing through the bushes, we went straight for the path of my musket, just like I expected. But by some bad luck, it didn’t go off, because I saw the line get pulled away by the men’s legs and heard the click of the lock; so I figured the priming got damp and didn’t ignite. I was really confused about what to do, since I couldn’t come up with a good reason for firing my gun in such a rush. But they say necessity is the mother of invention; so just as I was about to give up and brace myself for whatever might happen, a sudden idea popped into my head. I stepped out in front of the others, pretending to be really eager to get to the savages, tripped over a fallen tree, fell headfirst into a bush, and of course my carbine went off! Then there was such a screaming from the camp that I had never heard in my life. I got up immediately and started rushing forward with the others when the captain called a stop.”
“‘You did that a purpose, you villain!’ he said with a tremendous oath, and drawin’ a pistol from his belt, let fly right into my breast. I fell at once, and remembered no more till I was startled and brought round by the most awful yell I ever heard in my life—except, maybe, the shrieks o’ them poor critters that were crushed to death under yon big canoe. Jumpin’ up, I looked round, and through the trees saw a fire gleamin’ not far off; the light of which showed me the captain and men tied hand and foot, each to a post, and the savages dancin’ round them like demons. I had scarce looked for a second when I saw one o’ them go up to the captain flourishing a knife, and before I could wink he plunged it into his breast, while another yell, like the one that roused me, rang upon my ear. I didn’t wait for more, but bounding up, went crashing through the bushes into the woods. The black fellows caught sight of me, however, but not in time to prevent me jumpin’ into the boat, as you know.”
“‘You did that on purpose, you jerk!’ he shouted with a huge curse, and pulling a gun from his belt, shot right into my chest. I collapsed instantly and didn’t remember anything until I was jolted awake by the most horrifying scream I’ve ever heard in my life—except maybe for the cries of those poor creatures crushed under that big canoe. Jumping up, I looked around and through the trees, saw a fire glowing not far off; the light revealed the captain and the men tied up, each to a post, with the savages dancing around them like demons. I barely looked for a second when I saw one of them approach the captain brandishing a knife, and before I could blink, he plunged it into his chest, while another scream, like the one that woke me up, rang in my ears. I didn’t wait for more but sprang up and crashed through the bushes into the woods. The dark guys spotted me, but not in time to stop me from jumping into the boat, as you know.”
Bill seemed to be much exhausted after this recital, and shuddered frequently during the narrative; so I refrained from continuing the subject at that time, and endeavoured to draw his mind to other things.
Bill looked pretty worn out after this story, and he shuddered often while telling it, so I decided not to keep talking about it then and tried to steer his thoughts to something else.
“But now, Bill,” said I, “it behoves us to think about the future, and what course of action we shall pursue. Here we are, on the wide Pacific, in a well-appointed schooner, which is our own—at least, no one has a better claim to it than we have—and the world lies before us. Moreover, here comes a breeze, so we must make up our minds which way to steer.”
“But now, Bill,” I said, “we need to think about the future and what path we'll take. Here we are, out on the vast Pacific, in a well-equipped schooner that belongs to us—at least, no one has a stronger claim to it than we do—and the world is open to us. Plus, here comes a breeze, so we need to decide which direction to go.”
“Ralph, boy,” said my companion, “it matters not to me which way we go. I fear that my time is short now. Go where you will; I’m content.”
“Ralph, dude,” my friend said, “it doesn’t matter to me which way we go. I’m worried that my time is running out now. Go wherever you want; I’m okay with it.”
“Well, then, Bill, I think we had better steer to the Coral Island and see what has become of my dear old comrades, Jack and Peterkin. I believe the island has no name, but the captain once pointed it out to me on the chart, and I marked it afterwards; so, as we know pretty well our position just now, I think I can steer to it. Then, as to working the vessel, it is true I cannot hoist the sails single-handed, but luckily we have enough of sail set already; and if it should come on to blow a squall, I could at least drop the peaks of the main and fore sails, and clew them up partially without help, and throw her head close into the wind, so as to keep her all shaking till the violence of the squall is past. And if we have continued light breezes, I’ll rig up a complication of blocks and fix them to the topsail halyards, so that I shall be able to hoist the sails without help. ’Tis true I’ll require half-a-day to hoist them, but we don’t need to mind that. Then I’ll make a sort of erection on deck to screen you from the sun, Bill; and if you can only manage to sit beside the tiller and steer for two hours every day, so as to let me get a nap, I’ll engage to let you off duty all the rest of the twenty-four hours. And if you don’t feel able for steering, I’ll lash the helm and heave-to while I get you your breakfasts and dinners; and so we’ll manage famously, and soon reach the Coral Island.”
“Well, Bill, I think we should head to Coral Island and see what happened to my old friends, Jack and Peterkin. I don’t think the island has a name, but the captain pointed it out to me on the chart once, and I marked it later; so since we have a good sense of where we are now, I believe I can navigate us there. As for handling the boat, it’s true I can’t raise the sails by myself, but luckily we have enough sail out already; if a squall comes up, I can at least drop the peaks of the main and fore sails, partially tie them up by myself, and turn the boat into the wind to keep it steady until the squall passes. If the winds stay light, I’ll set up a system of blocks and attach them to the topsail halyards so I can raise the sails without help. It’s true it will take me half a day to get them up, but that’s no big deal. Then I’ll build a sort of shelter on deck to protect you from the sun, Bill; and if you can sit by the tiller and steer for two hours each day to let me catch a nap, I promise to relieve you from duty for the rest of the day. If you can’t manage steering, I’ll tie off the helm and heave-to while I make you breakfast and lunch; and we’ll do great and soon reach Coral Island.”
Bill smiled faintly as I ran on in this strain.
Bill smiled slightly as I continued talking like this.
“And what will you do,” said he, “if it comes on to blow a storm?”
“And what will you do,” he asked, “if a storm starts to brew?”
This question silenced me, while I considered what I should do in such a case. At length I laid my hand on his arm and said, “Bill, when a man has done all that he can do, he ought to leave the rest to God.”
This question left me speechless as I thought about what I should do in that situation. Finally, I placed my hand on his arm and said, “Bill, when a man has done everything he can, he should leave the rest to God.”
“Oh Ralph,” said my companion in a faint voice, looking anxiously into my face, “I wish that I had the feelin’s about God that you seem to have, at this hour. I’m dyin’, Ralph; yet I, who have braved death a hundred times, am afraid to die. I’m afraid to enter the next world. Something within tells me there will be a reckoning when I go there. But it’s all over with me, Ralph. I feel that there’s no chance o’ my bein’ saved.”
“Oh Ralph,” said my companion in a weak voice, looking worriedly into my face, “I wish I had the feelings about God that you seem to have right now. I’m dying, Ralph; yet I, who have faced death a hundred times, am scared to die. I’m scared to step into the next world. Something deep down tells me there will be a judgment when I get there. But it’s all over for me, Ralph. I feel like there’s no chance of my being saved.”
“Don’t say that, Bill,” said I in deep compassion; “don’t say that. I’m quite sure there’s hope even for you, but I can’t remember the words of the Bible that make me think so. Is there not a Bible on board, Bill?”
“Don’t say that, Bill,” I said with deep compassion; “don’t say that. I’m really sure there’s hope even for you, but I can’t recall the Bible verses that lead me to believe that. Isn’t there a Bible on board, Bill?”
“No; the last that was in the ship belonged to a poor boy that was taken aboard against his will. He died, poor lad—I think through ill-treatment and fear. After he was gone, the captain found his Bible and flung it overboard.”
“No; the last thing that was on the ship belonged to a poor boy who was taken aboard against his will. He died, poor kid—I think from mistreatment and fear. After he was gone, the captain found his Bible and threw it overboard.”
I now reflected, with great sadness and self-reproach, on the way in which I had neglected my Bible, and it flashed across me that I was actually, in the sight of God, a greater sinner than this blood-stained pirate; for, thought I, he tells me that he never read the Bible and was never brought up to care for it, whereas I was carefully taught to read it by my own mother, and had read it daily as long as I possessed one, yet to so little purpose that I could not now call to mind a single text that would meet this poor man’s case and afford him the consolation he so much required. I was much distressed, and taxed my memory for a long time. At last a text did flash into my mind, and I wondered much that I had not thought of it before.
I now thought, with deep sadness and guilt, about how I had neglected my Bible, and it hit me that, in God's eyes, I was actually a worse sinner than this blood-stained pirate. He told me he never read the Bible and wasn't raised to care about it, while I was taught to read it by my mother and had read it daily as long as I had one. Yet, I had done so little with it that I couldn’t recall a single verse that would help this poor man and give him the comfort he desperately needed. I felt very troubled and strained my memory for a long time. Finally, a verse popped into my mind, and I was surprised I hadn’t thought of it sooner.
“Bill,” said I in a low voice, “‘Believe on the Lord Jesus Christ, and thou shalt be saved.’”
“Bill,” I said quietly, “‘Believe in the Lord Jesus Christ, and you will be saved.’”
“Ay, Ralph, I’ve heard the missionaries say that before now; but what good can it do me? It’s not for me, that; it’s not for the likes o’ me.”
“Yeah, Ralph, I’ve heard the missionaries say that before; but what good is it to me? It’s not meant for me, it’s not for people like me.”
I knew not now what to say, for although I felt sure that that word was for him as well as for me, I could not remember any other word whereby I could prove it.
I didn't know what to say now, because even though I was certain that word was meant for him as much as for me, I couldn't think of any other word to back it up.
After a short pause, Bill raised his eyes to mine and said, “Ralph, I’ve led a terrible life. I’ve been a sailor since I was a boy, and I’ve gone from bad to worse ever since I left my father’s roof. I’ve been a pirate three years now. It is true I did not choose the trade, but I was inveigled aboard this schooner and kept here by force till I became reckless and at last joined them. Since that time my hand has been steeped in human blood again and again. Your young heart would grow cold if I—But why should I go on? ’Tis of no use, Ralph; my doom is fixed.”
After a brief pause, Bill looked into my eyes and said, “Ralph, I’ve lived a horrible life. I’ve been a sailor since I was a kid, and things have just gotten worse since I left my dad’s home. I’ve been a pirate for three years now. It’s true that I didn’t choose this life, but I was tricked onto this schooner and forced to stay until I became reckless and eventually joined them. Since then, my hands have been stained with human blood over and over. Your young heart would harden if I—But why should I keep talking? It’s no use, Ralph; my fate is sealed.”
“Bill,” said I, “‘Though your sins be red like crimson, they shall be white as snow.’ Only believe.”
“Bill,” I said, “‘Even if your sins are as red as crimson, they will become as white as snow.’ Just have faith.”
“Only believe!” cried Bill, starting up on his elbow. “I’ve heard men talk o’ believing as if it was easy. Ha! ’tis easy enough for a man to point to a rope and say, ‘I believe that would bear my weight;’ but ’tis another thing for a man to catch hold o’ that rope and swing himself by it over the edge of a precipice!”
“Just believe!” Bill shouted, propping himself up on his elbow. “I’ve heard guys talk about believing like it’s simple. Ha! It’s easy enough for someone to look at a rope and say, ‘I believe that can hold me;’ but it’s a whole different story for someone to grab that rope and swing themselves off the edge of a cliff!”
The energy with which he said this, and the action with which it was accompanied, were too much for Bill. He sank back with a deep groan. As if the very elements sympathised with this man’s sufferings, a low moan came sweeping over the sea.
The intensity with which he said this, and the way he acted, were overwhelming for Bill. He sank back with a deep groan. As if the elements themselves felt for this man's pain, a low moan swept over the sea.
“Hist, Ralph!” said Bill, opening his eyes; “there’s a squall coming, lad! Look alive, boy! Clew up the foresail! Drop the mainsail peak! Them squalls come quick sometimes.”
“Hey, Ralph!” said Bill, opening his eyes; “there’s a squall coming, kid! Get moving, boy! Tie up the foresail! Drop the mainsail peak! Those squalls can hit fast sometimes.”
I had already started to my feet, and saw that a heavy squall was indeed bearing down on us. It had hitherto escaped my notice, owing to my being so much engrossed by our conversation. I instantly did as Bill desired, for the schooner was lying motionless on the glassy sea. I observed with some satisfaction that the squall was bearing down on the larboard bow, so that it would strike the vessel in the position in which she would be best able to stand the shock. Having done my best to shorten sail, I returned aft, and took my stand at the helm.
I had already gotten to my feet and saw that a heavy storm was indeed coming our way. I hadn’t noticed it before because I was so caught up in our conversation. I immediately did what Bill asked, since the schooner was just sitting still on the calm sea. I felt some relief seeing that the storm was coming from the left side, which meant it would hit the boat at the best angle to handle it. After doing my best to reduce the sails, I made my way to the back and took my position at the helm.
“Now, boy,” said Bill in a faint voice, “keep her close to the wind.”
“Now, kid,” Bill said in a quiet voice, “keep her close to the wind.”
A few seconds afterwards he said, “Ralph, let me hear those two texts again.”
A few seconds later, he said, "Ralph, can I hear those two texts again?"
I repeated them.
I said them again.
“Are ye sure, lad, ye saw them in the Bible?”
“Are you sure, kid, you saw them in the Bible?”
“Quite sure,” I replied.
“I'm sure,” I replied.
Almost before the words had left my lips the wind burst upon us, and the spray dashed over our decks. For a time the schooner stood it bravely, and sprang forward against the rising sea like a war-horse. Meanwhile clouds darkened the sky, and the sea began to rise in huge billows. There was still too much sail on the schooner, and as the gale increased, I feared that the masts would be torn out of her or carried away, while the wind whistled and shrieked through the strained rigging. Suddenly the wind shifted a point, a heavy sea struck us on the bow, and the schooner was almost laid on her beam-ends, so that I could scarcely keep my legs. At the same moment Bill lost his hold of the belaying-pin which had served to steady him, and he slid with stunning violence against the skylight. As he lay on the deck close beside me, I could see that the shock had rendered him insensible; but I did not dare to quit the tiller for an instant, as it required all my faculties, bodily and mental, to manage the schooner. For an hour the blast drove us along, while, owing to the sharpness of the vessel’s bow and the press of canvas, she dashed through the waves instead of breasting over them, thereby drenching the decks with water fore and aft. At the end of that time the squall passed away, and left us rocking on the bosom of the agitated sea.
Almost before the words had left my lips, the wind hit us, and the spray splashed over our decks. For a while, the schooner handled it well, charging ahead against the rising sea like a war horse. Meanwhile, clouds darkened the sky, and the sea began to rise in massive waves. There was still too much sail on the schooner, and as the gale got stronger, I worried that the masts would get torn out or blown away, while the wind howled through the strained rigging. Suddenly the wind shifted slightly, a heavy wave hit us head-on, and the schooner was nearly tipped over, making it hard for me to keep my balance. At the same time, Bill lost his grip on the belaying-pin he was using to steady himself and slammed against the skylight violently. As he lay on the deck right next to me, I could see that the impact had knocked him out; but I couldn't let go of the tiller not even for a second, as it took all my physical and mental strength to manage the schooner. For an hour, the storm pushed us along, and because of the sharpness of the vessel's bow and the amount of sail, she crashed through the waves instead of riding over them, soaking the decks with water from front to back. After that hour, the squall passed, leaving us rocking on the choppy sea.
My first care, the instant I could quit the helm, was to raise Bill from the deck and place him on the couch. I then ran below for the brandy-bottle, and rubbed his face and hands with it, and endeavoured to pour a little down his throat. But my efforts, although I continued them long and assiduously, were of no avail; as I let go the hand which I had been chafing, it fell heavily on the deck. I laid my hand over his heart, and sat for some time quite motionless; but there was no flutter there—the pirate was dead!
My first priority, as soon as I could leave the helm, was to lift Bill from the deck and put him on the couch. I then went below to get the brandy bottle and rubbed it on his face and hands, trying to pour a little down his throat. But my efforts, even though I worked on them for a long time and with determination, didn't work; when I let go of the hand I had been rubbing, it fell heavily onto the deck. I placed my hand over his heart and sat still for a while, but there was no movement—Bill was dead!
Chapter Twenty Eight.
Alone on the deep—Necessity the mother of invention—A valuable book discovered—Natural phenomenon—A bright day in my history.
It was with feelings of awe, not unmingled with fear, that I now seated myself on the cabin skylight and gazed upon the rigid features of my late comrade, while my mind wandered over his past history and contemplated with anxiety my present position. Alone in the midst of the wide Pacific, having a most imperfect knowledge of navigation, and in a schooner requiring at least eight men as her proper crew! But I will not tax the reader’s patience with a minute detail of my feelings and doings during the first few days that followed the death of my companion. I will merely mention that I tied a cannon-ball to his feet, and with feelings of the deepest sorrow, consigned him to the deep.
It was with a mix of awe and fear that I sat on the cabin skylight and looked at the lifeless face of my late friend, my mind drifting through his past and worrying about my current situation. Alone in the vast Pacific, with only a basic understanding of navigation, and on a schooner that needed at least eight men to operate properly! But I won't bore the reader with every detail of my thoughts and actions in the days after my companion's death. I’ll just say that I tied a cannonball to his feet and, filled with deep sorrow, sent him to the depths.
For fully a week after that a steady breeze blew from the east, and as my course lay west and by north, I made rapid progress towards my destination. I could not take an observation, which I very much regretted, as the captain’s quadrant was in the cabin; but from the day of setting sail from the island of the savages I had kept a dead reckoning, and as I knew pretty well now how much leeway the schooner made, I hoped to hit the Coral Island without much difficulty. In this I was the more confident that I knew its position on the chart—which, I understood, was a very good one—and so had its correct bearings by compass.
For a whole week after that, a steady breeze blew in from the east, and since I was heading west and a bit north, I made quick progress toward my destination. I couldn't take a measurement, which I really regretted, because the captain’s quadrant was in the cabin; however, since the day I set sail from the island of the savages, I had been keeping track of my course, and now that I knew pretty well how much drift the schooner had, I was hopeful that I could reach Coral Island without too much trouble. I felt even more confident because I knew its location on the map—which I understood was a pretty accurate one—and I had its correct bearings by compass.
As the weather seemed now quite settled and fine, and as I had got into the trade-winds, I set about preparations for hoisting the topsails. This was a most arduous task, and my first attempts were complete failures, owing, in a great degree, to my reprehensible ignorance of mechanical forces. The first error I made was in applying my apparatus of blocks and pulleys to a rope which was too weak, so that the very first heave I made broke it in two, and sent me staggering against the after-hatch, over which I tripped, and striking against the main-boom, tumbled down the companion-ladder into the cabin. I was much bruised and somewhat stunned by this untoward accident. However, I considered it fortunate that I was not killed. In my next attempt I made sure of not coming by a similar accident, so I unreeved the tackling and fitted up larger blocks and ropes. But although the principle on which I acted was quiet correct, the machinery was now so massive and heavy that the mere friction and stiffness of the thick cordage prevented me from moving it at all. Afterwards, however, I came to proportion things more correctly; but I could not avoid reflecting at the time how much better it would have been had I learned all this from observation and study, instead of waiting till I was forced to acquire it through the painful and tedious lessons of experience.
As the weather seemed pretty settled and nice, and since I was in the trade-winds, I started getting ready to raise the topsails. This turned out to be a really tough task, and my first attempts were total failures, mainly because I didn't know much about how mechanical forces worked. My first mistake was using a setup of blocks and pulleys with a rope that was too weak, so the very first pull I made snapped it in half. I ended up staggering back against the after-hatch, tripping over it, and crashing into the main-boom, which sent me tumbling down the companion ladder into the cabin. I was pretty bruised and a bit dazed from that nasty fall. Still, I thought it was lucky I wasn’t killed. In my next try, I made sure to avoid a similar accident by removing the tackle and setting up larger blocks and ropes. But even though my approach was fundamentally correct, the equipment was so heavy and cumbersome that the friction and stiffness of the thick ropes made it impossible for me to move anything. Eventually, I learned to size things up better; however, I couldn’t help but think how much easier it would have been if I had learned all this through observation and study instead of having to figure it out the hard way through painful and slow lessons of experience.
After the tackling was prepared and in good working order, it took me the greater part of a day to hoist the main topsail. As I could not steer and work at this at the same time, I lashed the helm in such a position that, with a little watching now and then, it kept the schooner in her proper course. By this means I was enabled, also, to go about the deck and down below for things that I wanted as occasion required; also to cook and eat my victuals. But I did not dare to trust to this plan during the three hours of rest that I allowed myself at night, as the wind might have shifted, in which case I should have been blown far out of my course ere I awoke. I was, therefore, in the habit of heaving-to during those three hours—that is, fixing the rudder and the sails in such a position as that, by acting against each other, they would keep the ship stationary. After my night’s rest, therefore, I had only to make allowance for the leeway she had made, and so resume my course.
Once the rigging was set up and working well, it took me most of the day to raise the main topsail. Since I couldn't steer and do that at the same time, I secured the helm in a way that allowed the schooner to stay on course with just a little monitoring now and then. This setup also let me move around the deck and go below to grab what I needed when necessary, as well as to cook and eat my meals. However, I didn't trust this method during the three hours of rest I allowed myself at night, since the wind might have changed, which could blow me off course before I woke up. So, I typically anchored for those three hours—which meant adjusting the rudder and sails so that they counteracted each other and kept the ship in place. After my night’s rest, I just had to account for the drift and continue on my route.
Of course I was, to some extent, anxious lest another squall should come; but I made the best provision I could in the circumstances, and concluded that by letting go the weather-braces of the topsails and the topsail halyards at the same time, I should thereby render these sails almost powerless. Besides this, I proposed to myself to keep a sharp lookout on the barometer in the cabin; and if I observed at any time a sudden fall in it, I resolved that I would instantly set about my multiform appliances for reducing sail, so as to avoid being taken unawares. Thus I sailed prosperously for two weeks, with a fair wind, so that I calculated I must be drawing near to the Coral Island, at the thought of which my heart bounded with joyful expectation.
Of course, I was a bit anxious that another storm might hit, but I did my best under the circumstances. I decided that by letting out the weather-braces of the topsails and the topsail halyards at the same time, I could make those sails almost useless. On top of that, I planned to keep a close eye on the barometer in the cabin; if I noticed a sudden drop, I intended to quickly get ready to reduce the sail to avoid any surprises. For two weeks, I sailed smoothly with a good wind, and I figured I must be getting close to the Coral Island, which filled my heart with joyful excitement.
The only book I found on board, after a careful search, was a volume of Captain Cook’s voyages. This, I suppose, the pirate captain had brought with him in order to guide him, and to furnish him with information regarding the islands of these seas. I found this a most delightful book indeed; and I not only obtained much interesting knowledge about the sea in which I was sailing, but I had many of my own opinions, derived from experience, corroborated, and not a few of them corrected. Besides the reading of this charming book, and the daily routine of occupations, nothing of particular note happened to me during this voyage—except once, when on rising one night, after my three hours’ nap, while it was yet dark, I was amazed and a little alarmed to find myself floating in what appeared to be a sea of blue fire! I had often noticed the beautiful appearance of phosphorescent light, but this far exceeded anything of the sort I ever saw before. The whole sea appeared somewhat like milk, and was remarkably luminous.
The only book I found on board after a thorough search was a volume of Captain Cook’s voyages. I guess the pirate captain brought it along to help him navigate and to provide information about the islands in these waters. I found it to be a really delightful book; not only did I gain a lot of interesting knowledge about the sea I was sailing in, but many of my own opinions based on experience were confirmed, and quite a few were corrected. Besides reading this charming book and sticking to my daily routine, nothing particularly noteworthy happened to me during this voyage—except one night, after getting up from a three-hour nap while it was still dark, I was shocked and a bit scared to find myself floating in what looked like a sea of blue fire! I had often noticed the beautiful phosphorescent light before, but this was way more impressive than anything I'd seen. The entire sea looked somewhat like milk and was incredibly glowing.
I rose in haste, and letting down a bucket into the sea, brought some of the water on board and took it down to the cabin to examine it; but no sooner did I approach the light than the strange appearance disappeared, and when I removed the cabin lamp the luminous light appeared again. I was much puzzled with this, and took up a little of the water in the hollow of my hand and then let it run off, when I found that the luminous substance was left behind on my palm. I ran with it to the lamp, but when I got there it was gone. I found, however, that when I went into the dark my hand shone again; so I took the large glass of the ship’s telescope and examined my hand minutely, when I found that there were on it one or two small patches of a clear, transparent substance like jelly, which were so thin as to be almost invisible to the naked eye. Thus I came to know that the beautiful phosphoric light, which I had so often admired before, was caused by animals; for I had no doubt that these were of the same kind as the medusa or jelly-fish, which are seen in all parts of the world.
I quickly got up, and lowering a bucket into the sea, brought some water on board and took it down to the cabin to check it out; but as soon as I got close to the light, the strange appearance vanished, and when I turned off the cabin lamp, the glowing light showed up again. I was really confused by this, so I scooped a little of the water in the palm of my hand and then let it run off, only to find that the glowing substance was left on my palm. I rushed over to the lamp, but by the time I got there, it was gone. However, I noticed that when I moved into the dark, my hand shone again; so I took the big glass from the ship’s telescope and examined my hand closely, discovering one or two small patches of a clear, jelly-like substance that were so thin they were almost invisible to the naked eye. That’s when I realized that the beautiful phosphorescent light I had admired before was produced by creatures; I had no doubt these were similar to the medusa or jellyfish, which can be found all over the world.
On the evening of my fourteenth day I was awakened out of a nap into which I had fallen by a loud cry, and starting up, I gazed around me. I was surprised and delighted to see a large albatross soaring majestically over the ship. I immediately took it into my head that this was the albatross I had seen at Penguin Island. I had, of course, no good reason for supposing this; but the idea occurred to me, I know not why, and I cherished it, and regarded the bird with as much affection as if he had been an old friend. He kept me company all that day, and left me as night fell.
On the evening of my fourteenth day, I was jolted awake from a nap by a loud cry. Sitting up, I looked around and was both surprised and thrilled to see a huge albatross soaring gracefully over the ship. I immediately thought it was the same albatross I'd seen at Penguin Island. I didn't really have any good reason to think that, but the idea popped into my head for some unknown reason, and I held onto it, watching the bird with as much fondness as if it were an old friend. It kept me company all day and flew away as night fell.
Next morning, as I stood motionless and with heavy eyes at the helm—for I had not slept well—I began to weary anxiously for daylight, and peered towards the horizon, where I thought I observed something like a black cloud against the dark sky. Being always on the alert for squalls, I ran to the bow. There could be no doubt it was a squall, and as I listened I thought I heard the murmur of the coming gale. Instantly I began to work might and main at my cumbrous tackle for shortening sail, and in the course of an hour and a half had the most of it reduced—the topsail yards down on the caps, the topsails clewed up, the sheets hauled in, the main and fore peaks lowered, and the flying-jib down. While thus engaged, the dawn advanced, and I cast an occasional furtive glance ahead in the midst of my labour. But now that things were prepared for the worst, I ran forward again and looked anxiously over the bow. I now heard the roar of the waves distinctly; and as a single ray of the rising sun gleamed over the ocean, I saw—what! could it be that I was dreaming?—that magnificent breaker with its ceaseless roar—that mountain-top! Yes, once more I beheld the Coral Island!
The next morning, as I stood still with heavy eyelids at the helm—I hadn’t slept well—I began to anxiously wait for daylight and strained my eyes toward the horizon, where I thought I saw something like a black cloud against the dark sky. Always on the lookout for squalls, I rushed to the bow. It was clearly a squall, and as I listened, I thought I could hear the murmur of the approaching wind. I immediately started working hard at my bulky equipment to reduce the sail, and in about an hour and a half, I had most of it down—the topsail yards lowered on the caps, the topsails rolled up, the sheets tightened, the main and fore peaks lowered, and the flying-jib taken down. While I was busy, dawn broke, and I stole an occasional glance ahead amid my work. Now that everything was ready for the worst, I went forward again and looked anxiously over the bow. I could clearly hear the roar of the waves; and as a single ray from the rising sun shone over the ocean, I saw—was I dreaming?—that magnificent breaker with its endless roar—that mountain-top! Yes, once again I saw the Coral Island!
Chapter Twenty Nine.
The effect of a cannon-shot—A happy reunion of a somewhat moist nature—Retrospect and explanations—An awful dive—New plans—The last of the Coral Island.
I almost fell upon the deck with the tumult of mingled emotions that filled my heart as I gazed ardently towards my beautiful island. It was still many miles away, but sufficiently near to enable me to trace distinctly the well-remembered outlines of the two mountains. My first impulse was to utter an exclamation of gratitude for being carried to my former happy home in safety; my second, to jump up, clap my hands, shout, and run up and down the deck, with no other object in view than that of giving vent to my excited feelings. Then I went below for the telescope, and spent nearly ten minutes of the utmost impatience in vainly trying to get a focus, and in rubbing the skin nearly off my eyes, before I discovered that having taken off the large glass to examine the phosphoric water with, I had omitted to put it on again.
I almost fell onto the deck with a rush of mixed emotions that filled my heart as I earnestly looked toward my beautiful island. It was still many miles away, but close enough for me to clearly see the familiar shapes of the two mountains. My first instinct was to shout out my thanks for being safely brought back to my former happy home; my second was to jump up, clap my hands, yell, and run back and forth on the deck, with no other goal than to express my excitement. Then I went below to grab the telescope and spent nearly ten minutes in total frustration trying to focus it and rubbing my eyes raw before I realized that after taking off the big lens to check out the glowing water, I had forgotten to put it back on.
After that I looked up impatiently at the sails, which I now regretted having lowered so hastily, and for a moment thought of hoisting the main topsail again; but recollecting that it would take me full half-a-day to accomplish, and that, at the present rate of sailing, two hours would bring me to the island, I immediately dismissed the idea.
After that, I looked up at the sails, feeling impatient. I regretted having lowered them so quickly, and for a moment, I thought about raising the main topsail again. But then I remembered it would take me half a day to do that, and since at the current speed I'd reach the island in two hours, I quickly decided against it.
The remainder of the time I spent in making feverish preparations for arriving and seeing my dear comrades. I remembered that they were not in the habit of rising before six, and as it was now only three, I hoped to arrive before they were awake. Moreover, I set about making ready to let go the anchor, resolving in my own mind that as I knew the depth of water in the passage of the reef and within the lagoon, I would run the schooner in and bring up opposite the bower. Fortunately the anchor was hanging at the cat-head, otherwise I should never have been able to use it. Now I had only to cut the tackling, and it would drop of its own weight. After searching among the flags, I found the terrible black one, which I ran up to the peak. While I was doing this a thought struck me. I went to the powder-magazine, brought up a blank cartridge, and loaded the big brass gun, which, it will be remembered, was unhoused when we set sail; and as I had no means of housing it, there it had stood, bristling alike at fair weather and foul all the voyage. I took care to grease its mouth well, and before leaving the fore part of the ship, thrust the poker into the fire.
The rest of the time, I was busy making frantic preparations to arrive and see my dear friends. I remembered that they usually didn't get up before six, and since it was only three, I hoped to get there before they woke up. I also got ready to drop the anchor, convinced that since I knew the depth of water in the reef passage and the lagoon, I could steer the schooner in and anchor right opposite the bower. Fortunately, the anchor was hanging at the cat-head; otherwise, I wouldn't have been able to use it. Now, I just had to cut the tackle, and it would drop by itself. While I was looking through the flags, I found the fearsome black one and ran it up to the peak. As I was doing this, an idea occurred to me. I went to the powder magazine, grabbed a blank cartridge, and loaded the big brass gun, which, as you may remember, had been uncovered when we set sail; and since I had no way to cover it, it had been exposed to both good and bad weather the whole time. I made sure to grease its mouth well, and before leaving the front of the ship, I poked the fire with the poker.
All was now ready. A steady five-knot breeze was blowing, so that I was now not more than quarter of a mile from the reef. I was soon at the entrance; and as the schooner glided quickly through, I glanced affectionately at the huge breaker as if it had been the same one I had seen there when I bade adieu, as I feared for ever, to the island. On coming opposite the Water Garden, I put the helm hard down. The schooner came round with a rapid, graceful bend, and lost way just opposite the bower. Running forward, I let go the anchor, caught up the red-hot poker, applied it to the brass gun, and saluted the mountains with a bang such as had only once before broke their slumbering echoes!
All was ready now. A steady five-knot breeze was blowing, so I was just a quarter of a mile from the reef. I soon reached the entrance; as the schooner glided through, I looked back at the huge breaker with affection, as if it were the same one I had seen when I said goodbye, fearing it would be forever, to the island. When I was opposite the Water Garden, I turned the helm hard down. The schooner swung around gracefully and slowed down right in front of the bower. Running forward, I dropped the anchor, grabbed the red-hot poker, put it to the brass gun, and saluted the mountains with a bang that had only interrupted their peaceful echoes once before!
Effective although it was, however, it was scarcely equal to the bang with which, instantly after, Peterkin bounded from the bower, in scanty costume, his eyeballs starting from his head with surprise and terror. One gaze he gave, one yell, and then fled into the bushes like a wild cat. The next moment Jack went through exactly the same performance, the only difference being that his movements were less like those of Jack-in-the-box, though not less vigorous and rapid than those of Peterkin.
Effective as it was, it hardly compared to the way Peterkin suddenly burst out of the bower, dressed lightly, his eyes wide with shock and fear. He took one look, let out a yell, and then darted into the bushes like a wild cat. Moments later, Jack did the exact same thing, except his movements were less like a jack-in-the-box, though still just as energetic and quick as Peterkin's.
“Hallo!” I shouted, almost mad with joy. “What ho! Peterkin! Jack! hallo! it’s me!”
“Hey!” I yelled, almost bursting with happiness. “What's up! Peterkin! Jack! hey! it’s me!”
My shout was just in time to arrest them. They halted and turned round, and the instant I repeated the cry I saw that they recognised my voice by both of them running at full speed towards the beach. I could no longer contain myself. Throwing off my jacket, I jumped overboard at the same moment that Jack bounded into the sea. In other moment we met in deep water, clasped each other round the neck, and sank, as a matter of course, to the bottom! We were well-nigh choked, and instantly struggled to the surface, where Peterkin was spluttering about like a wounded duck, laughing and crying by turns, and choking himself with salt water!
My shout was perfectly timed to stop them. They froze and turned around, and as soon as I yelled again, I could see they recognized my voice because both of them sprinted at full speed towards the beach. I couldn't hold back anymore. Throwing off my jacket, I jumped overboard just as Jack dove into the water. In no time, we met in deep water, wrapped our arms around each other's necks, and naturally sank to the bottom! We were close to drowning and quickly fought our way back to the surface, where Peterkin was sputtering like a wounded duck, laughing and crying at the same time, choking on salt water!
It would be impossible to convey to my reader, by description, an adequate conception of the scene that followed my landing on the beach, as we stood embracing each other indiscriminately in our dripping garments, and giving utterance to incoherent rhapsodies, mingled with wild shouts. It can be more easily imagined than described; so I will draw a curtain over this part of my history, and carry the reader forward over an interval of three days.
It would be impossible to describe the scene that unfolded after I landed on the beach. We were there, hugging each other without a care in our soaked clothes, shouting excitedly and saying things that made no sense. It's easier to picture it than to describe it, so I’ll skip over this part of my story and fast forward three days.
During the greater part of that period Peterkin did nothing but roast pigs, taro, and bread-fruit, and ply me with plantains, plums, potatoes, and cocoa-nuts, while I related to him and Jack the terrible and wonderful adventures I had gone through since we last met. After I had finished the account, they made me go all over it again; and when I had concluded the second recital I had to go over it again, while they commented upon it piecemeal. They were much affected by what I told them of the probable fate of Avatea, and Peterkin could by no means brook the idea of the poor girl being converted into a long pig! As for Jack, he clenched his teeth, and shook his fist towards the sea, saying at the same time that he was sorry he had not broken Tararo’s head, and he only hoped that one day he should be able to plant his knuckles on the bridge of that chief’s nose! After they had ‘pumped me dry,’ as Peterkin said, I begged to be informed of what had happened to them during my long absence, and particularly as to how they got out of the Diamond Cave.
During most of that time, Peterkin spent his days roasting pigs, taro, and breadfruit while feeding me plantains, plums, potatoes, and coconuts, as I told him and Jack about the amazing and terrifying adventures I’d experienced since we last saw each other. After I finished my story, they made me go through it all over again. When I wrapped up the second telling, I had to do it again while they commented on every little detail. They were really moved by what I shared about Avatea’s likely fate, and Peterkin couldn't stand the thought of the poor girl being turned into a long pig! As for Jack, he clenched his teeth and shook his fist at the sea, saying he regretted not having smashed Tararo’s head, and he just hoped that one day he’d get a chance to land his knuckles on that chief’s nose! After they had ‘pumped me dry,’ like Peterkin put it, I asked them what had happened to them during my long absence, especially how they managed to escape from the Diamond Cave.
“Well, you must know,” began Jack, “after you had dived out of the cave, on the day you were taken away from us, we waited very patiently for half-an-hour, not expecting you to return before the end of that time. Then we began to upbraid you for staying so long when you knew we would be anxious; but when an hour passed we became alarmed, and I resolved at all hazards to dive out and see what had become of you, although I felt for poor Peterkin, because, as he truly said, ‘If you never come back, I’m shut up here for life.’ However, I promised not to run any risk, and he let me go—which, to say truth, I thought very courageous of him!”
"Well, you should know," Jack started, "after you dived out of the cave on the day you were taken from us, we waited patiently for half an hour, not expecting you to come back before then. After that, we started complaining about how long you were taking when you knew we would be worried. But when an hour went by, we got anxious, and I decided that I had to dive out and see what happened to you, even though I felt bad for poor Peterkin because, as he rightly said, 'If you never come back, I'm stuck here for life.' Still, I promised not to take any risks, and he let me go—which I thought was pretty brave of him!"
“I should just think it was,” interrupted Peterkin, looking at Jack over the edge of a monstrous potato which he happened to be devouring at the time.
“I should just think it was,” interrupted Peterkin, looking at Jack over the edge of a huge potato that he was currently eating.
“Well,” continued Jack, “you may guess my consternation when you did not answer to my halloo. At first I imagined that the pirates must have killed you, and left you in the bush or thrown you into the sea; then it occurred to me that this would have served no end of theirs, so I came to the conclusion that they must have carried you away with them. As this thought struck me, I observed the pirate schooner standing away to the nor’ard, almost hull down on the horizon, and I sat down on the rocks to watch her as she slowly sank from my sight. And I tell you, Ralph, my boy, that I shed more tears that time at losing you than I have done, I verily believe, all my life before—”
“Well,” Jack continued, “you can imagine my shock when you didn’t respond to my call. At first, I thought the pirates might have killed you and left your body in the bushes or thrown you into the sea. Then I realized that wouldn’t have served any purpose for them, so I concluded that they must have taken you with them. As this thought hit me, I saw the pirate schooner heading north, barely visible on the horizon, and I sat on the rocks to watch her slowly disappear from view. And I tell you, Ralph, my boy, that I cried more that time over losing you than I have in my entire life—”
“Pardon me, Jack, for interrupting,” said Peterkin; “surely you must be mistaken in that. You’ve often told me that when you were a baby you used to howl and roar from morning to—”
“Sorry to interrupt, Jack,” said Peterkin, “but you have to be mistaken about that. You’ve often told me that when you were a baby you used to cry and scream from morning to—”
“Hold your tongue, Peterkin!” cried Jack.—“Well, after the schooner had disappeared, I dived back into the cave, much to Peterkin’s relief, and told him what I had seen. We sat down and had a long talk over this matter, and then we agreed to make a regular, systematic search through the woods, so as to make sure at least that you had not been killed. But now we thought of the difficulty of getting out of the cave without your help. Peterkin became dreadfully nervous when he thought of this; and I must confess I felt some alarm, for, of course, I could not hope alone to take him out so quickly as we two together had brought him in. And he himself vowed that if we had been a moment longer with him that time, he would have had to take a breath of salt water. However, there was no help for it, and I endeavoured to calm his fears as well as I could; ‘for,’ said I, ‘you can’t live here, Peterkin,’ to which he replied, ‘Of course not, Jack; I can only die here, and as that’s not at all desirable, you had better propose something.’ So I suggested that he should take a good, long breath, and trust himself to me.
“Keep quiet, Peterkin!” Jack shouted. “Well, after the schooner had vanished, I dove back into the cave, much to Peterkin’s relief, and told him what I had seen. We sat down and had an extensive discussion about it, and then we decided to conduct a thorough search through the woods to ensure that you hadn’t been killed. But then we realized how hard it would be to get out of the cave without your help. Peterkin got really anxious thinking about this; and I have to admit I felt a little worried too, because, obviously, I couldn’t get him out as quickly by myself as we had together when we came in. He even insisted that if we had stayed with him much longer that time, he would have had to take a breath of salt water. Still, there was no other option, and I tried my best to calm his fears. ‘Because,’ I said, ‘you can’t live here, Peterkin,’ to which he replied, ‘Of course not, Jack; I can only die here, and since that’s not at all ideal, you’d better come up with something.’ So I suggested that he take a deep breath and trust me.
“‘Might we not make a large bag of cocoa-nut cloth, into which I could shove my head, and tie it tight round my neck?’ he asked with a haggard smile. ‘It might let me get one breath under water!’
“‘Could we make a big bag out of coconut cloth, where I could stick my head in and tie it around my neck?’ he asked with a tired smile. ‘It might let me take a breath underwater!’”
“‘No use,’ said I; ‘it would fill in a moment and suffocate you. I see nothing for it, Peterkin, if you really can’t keep your breath so long, but to let me knock you down, and carry you out while in a state of insensibility.’
“‘It’s no good,’ I said; ‘it would fill up in an instant and suffocate you. I don’t see any other option, Peterkin, if you really can’t hold your breath that long, than to let me knock you out and carry you out while you're unconscious.’”
“But Peterkin didn’t relish this idea. He seemed to fear that I would not be able to measure the exact force of the blow, and might, on the one hand, hit him so softly as to render a second or third blow necessary, which would be very uncomfortable; or, on the other hand, give him such a smash as would entirely spoil his figurehead, or mayhap knock the life out of him altogether! At last I got him persuaded to try to hold his breath, and commit himself to me; so he agreed, and down we went. But I had not got half-way through when he began to struggle and kick like a wild bull, burst from my grasp, and hit against the roof of the tunnel. I was therefore obliged to force him violently back into the cave again, where he, rose panting to the surface. In short, he had lost his presence of mind, and—”
“But Peterkin didn’t like this idea. He seemed worried that I wouldn’t be able to judge the exact force of the hit, and might, on one hand, hit him so lightly that I’d have to hit him a second or third time, which would be very uncomfortable; or, on the other hand, hit him so hard that it would completely ruin his figurehead, or maybe even knock him out altogether! Eventually, I managed to convince him to hold his breath and trust me; so he agreed, and down we went. But I hadn’t gotten halfway through when he started to struggle and kick like a wild bull, broke free from my grip, and hit the roof of the tunnel. So, I had to force him back into the cave, where he surfaced, panting. In short, he had lost his composure, and—”
“Nothing of the sort!” cried Peterkin indignantly; “I only lost my wind, and if I had not had presence of mind enough to kick as I did, I should have bu’st in your arms!”
“Nothing like that!” shouted Peterkin angrily; “I just lost my breath, and if I hadn’t had the quick thinking to kick like I did, I would have gone crashing into your arms!”
“Well, well, so be it,” resumed Jack with a smile.—“But the upshot of it was that we had to hold another consultation on the point; and I really believe that had it not been for a happy thought of mine, we should have been consulting there yet.”
“Well, well, so be it,” Jack said with a smile. “But the end result was that we had to have another meeting about it; and I honestly believe that if it hadn’t been for my bright idea, we might still be discussing it.”
“I wish we had!” again interrupted Peterkin with a sigh.—“I’m sure, Ralph, if I had thought that you were coming back again I would willingly have awaited your return for months rather than have endured the mental agony which I went through.—But proceed.”
“I wish we had!” Peterkin interrupted again with a sigh. “I’m sure, Ralph, if I had known you were coming back, I would have happily waited for months instead of going through the mental agony I experienced. But go on.”
“The thought was this,” continued Jack—“that I should tie Peterkin’s hands and feet with cords, and then lash him firmly to a stout pole about five feet long, in order to render him quite powerless and keep him straight and stiff. You should have seen his face of horror, Ralph, when I suggested this! But he came to see that it was his only chance, and told me to set about it as fast as I could; ‘for,’ said he, ‘this is no jokin’, Jack, I can tell you, and the sooner it’s done the better.’ I soon procured the cordage and a suitable pole, with which I returned to the cave, and lashed him as stiff and straight as an Egyptian mummy; and, to say truth, he was no bad representation of what an English mummy would be, if there were such things, for he was as white as a dead man.
“The idea was this,” Jack continued, “that I would tie Peterkin’s hands and feet with ropes and then securely fasten him to a sturdy pole about five feet long, to make him totally powerless and keep him straight and stiff. You should have seen the look of horror on his face, Ralph, when I suggested this! But he realized it was his only chance and told me to get on with it as quickly as I could; ‘because,’ he said, ‘this is no joke, Jack, I can tell you, and the sooner it’s done, the better.’ I quickly got the ropes and a suitable pole, and returned to the cave, tying him up as stiff and straight as an Egyptian mummy; and honestly, he looked like what an English mummy would be, if there were such things, because he was as white as a dead man.”
“‘Now,’ said Peterkin in a tremulous voice, ‘swim with me as near to the edge of the hole as you can before you dive; then let me take a long breath; and as I sha’n’t be able to speak after I’ve taken it, you’ll watch my face, and the moment you see me wink—dive! And oh,’ he added earnestly, ‘pray don’t be long!’
“‘Now,’ said Peterkin in a shaky voice, ‘swim with me as close to the edge of the hole as you can before you dive; then let me take a deep breath; and since I won’t be able to speak after that, you’ll need to watch my face, and the moment you see me wink—dive! And oh,’ he added seriously, ‘please don’t take too long!’”
“I promised to pay the strictest attention to his wishes, and swam with him to the outlet of the cave. Here I paused. ‘Now, then,’ said I, ‘pull away at the wind, lad.’
“I promised to pay close attention to what he wanted and swam with him to the cave's exit. Here I stopped. ‘Alright then,’ I said, ‘give it all you’ve got, kid.’”
“Peterkin drew in a breath so long that I could not help thinking of the frog in the fable, that wanted to swell itself as big as the ox. Then I looked into his face earnestly. Slap went the lid of his right eye; down went my head, and up went my heels. We shot through the passage like an arrow, and rose to the surface of the open sea before you could count twenty.
“Peterkin took such a deep breath that I couldn’t help but think of the frog from the fable that tried to puff itself up to the size of an ox. Then I looked intently at his face. The lid of his right eye snapped shut; my head went down, and my heels went up. We shot through the passage like an arrow and surfaced in the open sea before you could count to twenty.
“Peterkin had taken in such an awful load of wind that, on reaching the free air, he let it out with a yell loud enough to have been heard a mile off; and then the change in his feelings was so sudden and great that he did not wait till we landed, but began, tied up as he was, to shout and sing for joy as I supported him with my left arm to the shore. However, in the middle of a laugh that a hyena might have envied, I let him accidentally slip, which extinguished him in a moment.
“Peterkin had taken in such a huge gulp of air that when we got outside, he let it out with a shout loud enough to be heard from a mile away; and then the shift in how he felt was so sudden and intense that he didn’t wait for us to land. Instead, he started shouting and singing for joy, even though he was tied up, while I supported him with my left arm to the shore. However, in the middle of a laugh that a hyena would have envied, I accidentally let him slip, which knocked him out in an instant.”
“After this happy deliverance, we immediately began our search for your dead body, Ralph; and you have no idea how low our hearts sank as we set off; day after day, to examine the valleys and mountain-sides with the utmost care. In about three weeks we completed the survey of the whole island, and had at least the satisfaction of knowing that you had not been killed. But it occurred to us that you might have been thrown into the sea; so we examined the sands and the lagoon carefully, and afterwards went all round the outer reef. One day, while we were upon the reef, Peterkin espied a small, dark object lying among the rocks, which seemed to be quite different from the surrounding stones. We hastened towards the spot, and found it to be a small keg. On knocking out the head we discovered that it was gunpowder.”
“After this happy rescue, we immediately started searching for your dead body, Ralph; and you have no idea how heartbroken we felt as we set off, day after day, to carefully inspect the valleys and mountainsides. After about three weeks, we finished surveying the entire island and at least felt relieved knowing you hadn’t been killed. But then we thought you might have been thrown into the sea, so we carefully examined the sands and the lagoon, and then checked all around the outer reef. One day, while we were on the reef, Peterkin spotted a small, dark object among the rocks that looked different from the surrounding stones. We hurried over to it and found it was a small keg. When we knocked out the head, we discovered it was filled with gunpowder.”
“It was I who sent you that, Jack,” said I with a smile.
“It was me who sent you that, Jack,” I said with a smile.
“Fork out!” cried Peterkin energetically, starting to his feet and extending his open hand to Jack. “Down with the money, sir, else I’ll have you shut up for life in a debtor’s prison the moment we return to England!”
“Pay up!” shouted Peterkin enthusiastically, jumping to his feet and holding out his open hand to Jack. “Hand over the money, or I’ll have you locked up for life in a debtor’s prison as soon as we get back to England!”
“I’ll give you an I.O.U. in the meantime,” returned Jack, laughing, “so sit down and be quiet.—The fact is, Ralph, when we discovered this keg of powder Peterkin immediately took me a bet of a thousand pounds that you had something to do with it, and I took him a bet of ten thousand that you had not.”
“I’ll give you an I.O.U. for now,” Jack replied, laughing, “so sit down and stay quiet. The truth is, Ralph, when we found this keg of powder, Peterkin immediately bet me a thousand pounds that you were involved, and I bet him ten thousand that you weren’t.”
“Peterkin was right, then,” said I, explaining how the thing had occurred.
“Peterkin was right, then,” I said, explaining how it happened.
“Well, we found it very useful,” continued Jack, “although some of it had got a little damp; and we furbished up the old pistol, with which Peterkin is a crack shot now. But to continue. We did not find any other vestige of you on the reef, and finally gave up all hope of ever seeing you again. After this the island became a dreary place to us, and we began to long for a ship to heave in sight and take us off. But now that you’re back again, my dear fellow, it looks as bright and cheerful as it used to do, and I love it as much as ever.
“Well, we found it really useful,” Jack continued, “even though some of it got a bit damp; and we polished up the old pistol, which Peterkin is really good at using now. But to keep going. We didn’t find any other sign of you on the reef, and eventually gave up all hope of ever seeing you again. After that, the island turned into a dull place for us, and we started wishing for a ship to show up and take us away. But now that you’re back, my dear friend, it looks as bright and cheerful as it used to, and I love it just as much as ever.”
“And now,” continued Jack, “I have a great desire to visit some of the other islands of the South Seas. Here we have a first-rate schooner at our disposal, so I don’t see what should hinder us.”
“And now,” continued Jack, “I really want to visit some of the other islands in the South Seas. We have an excellent schooner at our disposal, so I don’t see what could stop us.”
“Just the very thing I was going to propose!” cried Peterkin. “I vote for starting at once.”
“That's exactly what I was going to suggest!” exclaimed Peterkin. “I say we leave right now.”
“Well, then,” said Jack, “it seems to me that we could not do better than shape our course for the island on which Avatea lives, and endeavour to persuade Tararo to let her marry the black fellow to whom she is engaged instead of making a ‘long pig’ of her. If he has a spark of gratitude in him, he’ll do it. Besides, having become champions for this girl once before, it behoves us, as true knights, not to rest until we set her free; at least, all the heroes in all the story-books I have ever read would count it foul disgrace to leave such a work unfinished.”
“Well, then,” said Jack, “I think the best thing to do is head for the island where Avatea lives and try to convince Tararo to let her marry the guy she’s engaged to instead of turning her into a ‘long pig.’ If he has any gratitude in him, he’ll agree. Plus, since we’ve already stood up for this girl once, it’s our duty as true knights to not rest until we set her free; at least, all the heroes from every story I’ve ever read would consider it a disgrace to leave a job like this unfinished.”
“I’m sure I don’t know or care what your knights in story-books would do,” said Peterkin; “but I’m certain that it would be capital fun, so I’m your man whenever you want me.”
“I honestly don’t know or care what your knights in fairy tales would do,” said Peterkin; “but I’m sure it would be a blast, so I’m in whenever you need me.”
This plan of Jack’s was quite in accordance with his romantic, impulsive nature; and having made up his mind to save this black girl, he could not rest until the thing was commenced.
This plan of Jack’s really matched his romantic, impulsive nature; and once he decided to save this black girl, he couldn’t relax until he got started.
“But there may be great danger in this attempt,” he said at the end of a long consultation on the subject. “Will you, lads, go with me in spite of this?”
"But there could be serious danger in this attempt," he said after a long discussion on the topic. "Will you, guys, come with me anyway?"
“Go with you!” we repeated in the same breath.
“Go with you!” we echoed in unison.
“Can you doubt it?” said I.
“Can you doubt it?” I said.
“For a moment?” added Peterkin.
"Just for a sec?" added Peterkin.
I need scarcely say that having made up our minds to go on this enterprise, we lost no time in making preparations to quit the island; and as the schooner was well laden with stores of every kind for a long cruise, we had little to do except to add to our abundant supply a quantity of cocoa-nuts, bread-fruit, taro, yams, plums, and potatoes, chiefly with the view of carrying the fragrance of our dear island along with us as long as we could.
I hardly need to mention that once we decided to undertake this journey, we wasted no time getting ready to leave the island; and since the schooner was already well stocked with supplies for a long trip, we only needed to add a good amount of cocoa nuts, breadfruit, taro, yams, plums, and potatoes, mainly to bring the lovely scent of our beloved island with us for as long as possible.
When all was ready, we paid a farewell visit to the different familiar spots where most of our time had been spent. We ascended the mountain-top, and gazed for the last time at the rich green foliage in the valleys, the white sandy beach, the placid lagoon, and the barrier coral reef with its crested breakers. Then we descended to Spouting Cliff, and looked down at the pale-green monster which we had made such fruitless efforts to spear in days gone by. From this we hurried to the Water Garden, and took a last dive into its clear waters and a last gambol amongst its coral groves. I hurried out before my companions, and dressed in haste, in order to have a long examination of my tank, which Peterkin, in the fulness of his heart, had tended with the utmost care, as being a vivid remembrancer of me rather than out of love for natural history. It was in superb condition: the water as clear and pellucid as crystal; the red and green seaweed of the most brilliant hues; the red, purple, yellow, green, and striped anemones fully expanded, and stretching out their arms as if to welcome and embrace their former master; the starfish, zoophytes, sea-pens, and other innumerable marine insects, looking fresh and beautiful; and the crabs, as Peterkin said, looking as wide-awake, impertinent, rampant, and pugnacious as ever. It was, indeed, so lovely and so interesting that I would scarcely allow myself to be torn away from it.
When everything was ready, we made a final visit to the familiar places where we had spent most of our time. We climbed to the mountain top and took one last look at the lush green trees in the valleys, the white sandy beach, the calm lagoon, and the coral reef with its crashing waves. Then we headed down to Spouting Cliff and peered down at the pale-green beast we had tried so hard to spear in the past. After that, we rushed to the Water Garden and had one last dive into its clear waters and a final frolic among its coral groves. I dashed out ahead of my friends and got dressed quickly so I could spend a long time examining my tank, which Peterkin had looked after with great care, as a vivid reminder of me rather than out of love for marine life. It was in excellent condition: the water as clear as crystal; the red and green seaweed in the brightest colors; the red, purple, yellow, green, and striped anemones fully opened up, reaching out as if to welcome their former owner; the starfish, zoophytes, sea-pens, and countless other marine creatures looking fresh and beautiful; and the crabs, as Peterkin said, looking as alert, cheeky, lively, and combative as ever. It was so lovely and fascinating that I could hardly bring myself to tear away from it.
Last of all, we returned to the bower and collected the few articles we possessed—such as the axe, the pencil-case, the broken telescope, the penknife, the hook made from the brass ring, and the sail-needle, with which we had landed on the island; also the long boots and the pistol, besides several curious articles of costume which we had manufactured from time to time.
Last of all, we went back to the shelter and gathered the few things we had—like the axe, the pencil case, the broken telescope, the penknife, the hook made from the brass ring, and the sail needle we used to reach the island; plus the long boots and the pistol, along with several interesting costume pieces we had made over time.
These we conveyed on board in our little boat, after having carved our names on a chip of iron-wood, thus:
These we brought on board in our small boat after carving our names on a piece of ironwood, like this:
Jack Martin
Ralph Rover
Peterkin Gay
This we fixed up inside of the bower. The boat was then hoisted on board and the anchor weighed, which latter operation cost us great labour and much time, as the anchor was so heavy that we could not move it without the aid of my complex machinery of blocks and pulleys. A steady breeze was blowing off-shore when we set sail, at a little before sunset. It swept us quickly past the reef and out to sea. The shore grew rapidly more indistinct as the shades of evening fell, while our clipper bark bounded lightly over the waves. Slowly the mountain-top sank on the horizon until it became a mere speck. In another moment the sun and the Coral Island sank together into the broad bosom of the Pacific.
This we set up inside the bower. The boat was then lifted on board and the anchor was raised, which took a lot of effort and time since the anchor was so heavy that we couldn't move it without my complicated system of blocks and pulleys. A steady breeze was blowing offshore when we set sail a little before sunset. It quickly carried us past the reef and out to sea. The shore faded fast as evening fell, while our clipper bark glided easily over the waves. Slowly, the mountain top disappeared on the horizon until it was just a tiny speck. In another moment, the sun and Coral Island sank together into the vast Pacific.
Chapter Thirty.
The voyage—The island, and a consultation in which danger is scouted as a thing unworthy of consideration—Rats and cats—The native teacher—Awful revelations—Wonderful effects of Christianity.
Our voyage during the next two weeks was most interesting and prosperous. The breeze continued generally fair, and at all times enabled us to lie our course; for being, as I have said before, clipper-built, the pirate schooner could lie very close to the wind and make little leeway. We had no difficulty now in managing our sails, for Jack was heavy and powerful, while Peterkin was active as a kitten. Still, however, we were a very insufficient crew for such a vessel; and if any one had proposed to us to make such a voyage in it before we had been forced to go through so many hardships from necessity, we would have turned away with pity from the individual making such proposal as from a madman. I pondered this a good deal, and at last concluded that men do not know how much they are capable of doing till they try, and that we should never give way to despair in any undertaking, however difficult it may seem—always supposing, however, that our cause is a good one, and that we can ask the Divine blessing on it.
Our journey over the next two weeks was really interesting and successful. The breeze was mostly favorable, allowing us to stay on course; since, as I mentioned earlier, the pirate schooner was designed like a clipper, it could sail very close to the wind and didn’t drift much. We had no trouble handling the sails now, since Jack was strong and tough, while Peterkin was as lively as a kitten. Still, we were a pretty inexperienced crew for such a ship, and if anyone had suggested making this voyage before we faced so many challenges out of necessity, we would have looked at them with pity, just like you would at a madman. I thought about this a lot and eventually realized that people often underestimate what they can accomplish until they try, and that we should never lose hope in any endeavor, no matter how tough it seems—provided, of course, that our cause is just and that we can seek Divine guidance for it.
Although, therefore, we could now manage our sails easily, we nevertheless found that my pulleys were of much service to us in some things, though Jack did laugh heartily at the uncouth arrangement of ropes and blocks, which had, to a sailor’s eye, a very lumbering and clumsy appearance. But I will not drag my reader through the details of this voyage. Suffice it to say that, after an agreeable sail of about three weeks, we arrived off the island of Mango, which I recognised at once from the description that the pirate Bill had given me of it during one of our conversations.
Although we could easily manage our sails now, we still found that my pulleys were quite helpful in some ways, even though Jack laughed loudly at the awkward setup of ropes and blocks, which looked bulky and clumsy to a sailor's eye. But I won’t bore my reader with the details of this journey. It’s enough to say that after a pleasant sail of about three weeks, we arrived near the island of Mango, which I instantly recognized from the description that the pirate Bill had given me during one of our chats.
As soon as we came within sight of it, we hove the ship to and held a council of war.
As soon as we spotted it, we steered the ship to a halt and held a meeting to discuss our next steps.
“Now, boys,” said Jack as we seated ourselves beside him on the cabin skylight, “before we go further in this business we must go over the pros and cons of it; for although you have so generously consented to stick by me through thick and thin, it would be unfair did I not see that you thoroughly understand the danger of what we are about to attempt.”
“Okay, guys,” said Jack as we settled down next to him on the cabin skylight, “before we dive any deeper into this, we need to weigh the pros and cons; because even though you’ve kindly agreed to stand by me no matter what, it wouldn’t be right if I didn’t make sure you fully understand the risks of what we’re about to do.”
“Oh, bother the danger!” cried Peterkin. “I wonder to hear you, Jack, talk of danger! When a fellow begins to talk about it, he’ll soon come to magnify it to such a degree that he’ll not be fit to face it when it comes—no more than a suckin’ baby.”
“Oh, forget about the danger!” Peterkin exclaimed. “I can’t believe you, Jack, are talking about danger! When someone starts going on about it, they'll end up blowing it out of proportion to the point that they won’t be able to handle it when it arrives—just like a clueless baby.”
“Nay, Peterkin,” replied Jack gravely, “I won’t be jested out of it. I grant you that when we’ve once resolved to act, and have made up our minds what to do, we should think no more of danger. But before we have so resolved, it behoves us to look it straight in the face, and examine into it, and walk round it; for if we flinch at a distant view, we’re sure to run away when the danger is near.—Now, I understand from you, Ralph, that the island is inhabited by thorough-going, out-and-out cannibals, whose principal law is, ‘Might is right, and the weakest goes to the wall?’”
“Nah, Peterkin,” Jack replied seriously, “I won’t be made a fool of. I agree that once we decide to act and know what we need to do, we should put danger out of our minds. But before we make that decision, we need to face the reality of it, examine it, and look at it from all angles; because if we hesitate at a distance, we’re definitely going to run away when the danger is right in front of us. Now, Ralph, I understand from you that the island is home to full-on cannibals, whose main rule is, ‘Might makes right, and the weak get pushed aside?’”
“Yes,” said I; “so Bill gave me to understand. He told me, however, that at the southern side of it the missionaries had obtained a footing amongst an insignificant tribe. A native teacher had been sent there by the Wesleyans, who had succeeded in persuading the chief at that part to embrace Christianity. But instead of that being of any advantage to our enterprise, it seems the very reverse; for the chief Tararo is a determined heathen, and persecutes the Christians—who are far too weak in numbers to offer any resistance—and looks with dislike upon all white men, whom he regards as propagators of the new faith.”
“Yes,” I said; “that’s what Bill made me understand. He mentioned that on the southern side, the missionaries had established a presence among a small tribe. A native teacher had been sent there by the Wesleyans and managed to convince the local chief to adopt Christianity. But rather than helping our cause, it seems to have done the opposite; the chief, Tararo, is a staunch pagan and persecutes the Christians—who are way too few in number to fight back—and he dislikes all white men, seeing them as spreaders of the new faith.”
“’Tis a pity,” said Jack, “that the Christian tribe is so small, for we shall scarcely be safe under their protection, I fear. If Tararo takes it into his head to wish for our vessel, or to kill ourselves, he could take us from them by force. You say that the native missionary talks English?”
“It's a shame,” said Jack, “that the Christian community is so small, because I worry we won't be safe under their protection. If Tararo decides he wants our ship or to harm us, he could easily overpower them. You mentioned that the native missionary speaks English?”
“So I believe.”
"So I think."
“Then, what I propose is this,” said Jack. “We will run round to the south side of the island, and cast anchor off the Christian village. We are too far away just now to have been descried by any of the savages, so we shall get there unobserved, and have time to arrange our plans before the heathen tribes know of our presence. But in doing this we run the risk of being captured by the ill-disposed tribes, and being very ill-used, if not—a—”
“Here’s what I suggest,” Jack said. “Let’s head around to the south side of the island and drop anchor near the Christian village. We’re far enough away right now that none of the savages have spotted us, so we can get there without being seen and have time to organize our plans before the heathen tribes find out we’re here. But by doing this, we risk being captured by the unfriendly tribes and being treated very badly, if not—”
“Roasted alive and eaten!” cried Peterkin. “Come, out with it, Jack! According to your own showing, it’s well to look the danger straight in the face.”
“Roasted alive and eaten!” Peterkin shouted. “Come on, spill it, Jack! According to your own logic, it’s best to confront the danger head-on.”
“Well, that is the worst of it, certainly. Are you prepared, then, to take your chance of that?”
“Well, that is definitely the worst part. Are you ready to take your chances with that?”
“I’ve been prepared and had my mind made up long ago,” cried Peterkin, swaggering about the deck with his hands thrust into his breeches pockets. “The fact is, Jack, I don’t believe that Tararo will be so ungrateful as to eat us, and I’m quite sure that he’ll be too happy to grant us whatever we ask; so the sooner we go in and win the better.”
“I’ve been ready and decided for a long time,” shouted Peterkin, strutting around the deck with his hands in his pants pockets. “The truth is, Jack, I don’t think Tararo will be so ungrateful as to eat us, and I’m pretty sure he’ll be more than happy to give us whatever we ask for; so the sooner we go in and succeed, the better.”
Peterkin was wrong, however, in his estimate of savage gratitude, as the sequel will show.
Peterkin was mistaken in his understanding of savage gratitude, as the following events will demonstrate.
The schooner was now put before the wind, and after making a long run to the southward, we put about and beat up for the south side of Mango, where we arrived before sunset, and hove-to off the coral reef. Here we awaited the arrival of a canoe, which immediately put off on our rounding-to. When it arrived, a mild-looking native, of apparently forty years of age, came on board, and taking off his straw hat, made us a low bow. He was clad in a respectable suit of European clothes; and the first words he uttered, as he stepped up to Jack and shook hands with him, were:
The schooner was now facing the wind, and after heading south for a long stretch, we turned around and sailed towards the south side of Mango, where we got there before sunset and stopped off the coral reef. We waited for a canoe, which set out as soon as we came to a stop. When it arrived, a friendly-looking native, who looked to be about forty, came on board, took off his straw hat, and gave us a respectful bow. He was wearing a neat outfit of European clothes, and the first thing he said when he approached Jack and shook his hand was:
“Good-day, gentlemen. We are happy to see you at Mango. You are heartily welcome.”
“Good day, gentlemen. We're glad to see you at Mango. You are warmly welcome.”
After returning his salutation, Jack exclaimed, “You must be the native missionary teacher of whom I have heard—are you not?”
After responding to his greeting, Jack said, “You must be the local missionary teacher I’ve heard about—am I right?”
“I am. I have the joy to be a servant of the Lord Jesus at this station.”
“I am. I have the privilege of serving the Lord Jesus at this station.”
“You’re the very man I want to see, then,” replied Jack; “that’s lucky. Come down to the cabin, friend, and have a glass of wine. I wish particularly to speak with you. My men there”—pointing to Peterkin and me—“will look after your people.”
“You're exactly the person I was hoping to find,” Jack said. “That's great. Come down to the cabin, my friend, and have a glass of wine. I really want to discuss something with you. My guys over there”—pointing to Peterkin and me—“will take care of your people.”
“Thank you,” said the teacher as he followed Jack to the cabin; “I do not drink wine or any strong drink.”
“Thank you,” said the teacher as he followed Jack to the cabin; “I don’t drink wine or any hard liquor.”
“Oh! then there’s lots of water, and you can have biscuit.”
“Oh! Then there’s plenty of water, and you can have a biscuit.”
“Now, ’pon my word, that’s cool!” said Peterkin; “his men, forsooth! Well, since we are to be men, we may as well come it as strong over these black chaps as we can.—Hallo, there!” he cried to the half-dozen of natives who stood upon the deck, gazing in wonder at all they saw, “here’s for you;” and he handed them a tray of broken biscuit and a can of water. Then thrusting his hands into his pockets, he walked up and down the deck with an enormous swagger, whistling vociferously.
“Wow, that’s awesome!” said Peterkin; “his men, seriously! Well, since we’re supposed to be men, we might as well show these guys what we’ve got.—Hey there!” he shouted to the half-dozen natives who stood on the deck, staring in amazement at everything around them, “this is for you;” and he handed them a tray of broken biscuits and a can of water. Then, shoving his hands into his pockets, he strutted up and down the deck with a big swagger, whistling loudly.
In about half-an-hour Jack and the teacher came on deck, and the latter, bidding us a cheerful good-evening, entered his canoe and paddled to the shore. When he was gone, Peterkin stepped up to Jack, and touching his cap, said:
In about half an hour, Jack and the teacher came on deck, and the teacher, wishing us a cheerful good evening, got into his canoe and paddled to the shore. Once he left, Peterkin approached Jack and, touching his cap, said:
“Well, captain, have you any communications to make to your men?”
“Well, captain, do you have any messages for your men?”
“Yes,” cried Jack: “ready about, mind the helm, and clew up your tongue, while I con the schooner through the passage in the reef. The teacher, who seems a first-rate fellow, says it’s quite deep, and good anchorage within the lagoon close to the shore.”
“Yes,” shouted Jack, “get ready, watch the steering, and keep quiet while I guide the schooner through the reef passage. The teacher, who seems like a great guy, says it’s pretty deep, and there’s good anchorage in the lagoon near the shore.”
While the vessel was slowly advancing to her anchorage, under a light breeze, Jack explained to us that Avatea was still on the island, living amongst the heathens; that she had expressed a strong desire to join the Christians; but Tararo would not let her, and kept her constantly in close confinement.
While the ship was slowly making its way to anchor in a light breeze, Jack told us that Avatea was still on the island, living among the natives; that she had a strong desire to join the Christians; but Tararo wouldn't allow her and kept her tightly confined.
“Moreover,” continued Jack, “I find that she belongs to one of the Samoan Islands, where Christianity had been introduced long before her capture by the heathens of a neighbouring island; and the very day after she was taken she was to have joined the church which had been planted there by that excellent body, the London Missionary Society. The teacher tells me, too, that the poor girl has fallen in love with a Christian chief, who lives on an island some fifty miles or so to the south of this one, and that she is meditating a desperate attempt at escape. So, you see, we have come in the nick of time.—I fancy that this chief is the fellow whom you heard of, Ralph, at the island of Emo.—Besides all this, the heathen savages are at war among themselves, and there’s to be a battle fought the day after to-morrow, in which the principal leader is Tararo; so that we’ll not be able to commence our negotiations with the rascally chief till the day after.”
“Also,” Jack continued, “I found out that she’s from one of the Samoan Islands, where Christianity was introduced long before the heathens from a neighboring island captured her. In fact, the day after she was taken, she was supposed to join the church established there by the wonderful London Missionary Society. The teacher also told me that the poor girl has fallen in love with a Christian chief who lives on an island about fifty miles south of here, and that she’s thinking about making a desperate escape. So, you can see, we’ve arrived just in time. I suspect this chief is the guy you heard about, Ralph, at the island of Emo. On top of all this, the heathen savages are fighting amongst themselves, and there’s going to be a battle the day after tomorrow, with Tararo as the main leader; so we won’t be able to start our negotiations with the shady chief until the day after.”
The village off which we anchored was beautifully situated at the head of a small bay, from the margin of which trees of every description peculiar to the tropics rose in the richest luxuriance to the summit of a hilly ridge, which was the line of demarcation between the possessions of the Christians and those of the neighbouring heathen chief.
The village where we anchored was beautifully located at the end of a small bay, bordered by tropical trees of all kinds that grew in lush abundance up to the top of a hilly ridge, which marked the boundary between the lands of the Christians and those of the nearby pagan chief.
The site of the settlement was an extensive plot of flat land, stretching in a gentle slope from the sea to the mountain. The cottages stood several hundred yards from the beach, and were protected from the glare of the sea by the rich foliage of rows of large Barringtonia and other trees which girt the shore. The village was about a mile in length, and perfectly straight, with a wide road down the middle, on either side of which were rows of the tufted-topped ti-tree, whose delicate and beautiful blossoms, hanging beneath their plume-crested tops, added richness to the scene. The cottages of the natives were built beneath these trees, and were kept in the most excellent order, each having a little garden in front, tastefully laid out and planted, while the walks were covered with black and white pebbles.
The settlement was located on a large, flat area of land that gradually sloped from the sea to the mountains. The cottages were several hundred yards from the beach, shielded from the sun’s glare by thick rows of Barringtonia and other trees lining the shore. The village stretched about a mile in a straight line, with a wide road running down the center, flanked on either side by rows of tufted ti-trees. Their delicate, beautiful blossoms hung beneath their plume-like tops, adding to the area's charm. The native cottages stood beneath these trees and were kept in excellent condition, each featuring a small garden in front, tastefully arranged and planted, with pathways made of black and white pebbles.
Every house had doors and Venetian windows, painted partly with lamp-black made from the candle-nut, and partly with red ochre, which contrasted powerfully with the dazzling coral lime that covered the walls. On a prominent position stood a handsome church, which was quite a curiosity in its way. It was a hundred feet long by fifty broad, and was seated throughout to accommodate upwards of two thousand persons. It had six large folding-doors, and twelve windows with Venetian blinds; and although a large and substantial edifice, it had been built, we were told by the teacher: in the space of two months! There was not a single iron nail in the fabric, and the natives had constructed it chiefly with their stone and bone axes and other tools, having only one or two axes or tools of European manufacture. Everything around this beautiful spot wore an aspect of peace and plenty; and as we dropped our anchor within a stone’s-cast of the substantial coral wharf, I could not avoid contrasting it with the wretched village of Emo, where I had witnessed so many frightful scenes. When the teacher afterwards told me that the people of this tribe had become converts only a year previous to our arrival, and that they had been living before that in the practice of the most bloody system of idolatry, I could not refrain from exclaiming, “What a convincing proof that Christianity is of God!”
Every house had doors and Venetian windows, partly painted with lamp-black made from candle-nuts, and partly with red ochre, which created a striking contrast with the bright coral lime that covered the walls. In a prominent spot stood a beautiful church, which was quite a sight in its own right. It was a hundred feet long and fifty feet wide, and could seat over two thousand people. It had six large folding doors and twelve windows with Venetian blinds; and even though it was a large and solid building, we were told by the teacher that it had been built in just two months! There wasn't a single iron nail in the structure, and the locals had made it mostly with their stone and bone axes and other tools, having only one or two axes or tools of European origin. Everything around this lovely place looked peaceful and prosperous; as we dropped anchor within a stone's throw of the sturdy coral wharf, I couldn't help but compare it to the miserable village of Emo, where I had witnessed so many horrific scenes. When the teacher later told me that the people of this tribe had only converted a year before our arrival, and that they had previously practiced a brutal system of idolatry, I couldn't help but exclaim, “What a compelling proof that Christianity is from God!”
On landing from our little boat we were received with a warm welcome by the teacher and his wife, the latter being also a native, clothed in a simple European gown and a straw bonnet. The shore was lined with hundreds of natives, whose persons were all more or less clothed with native cloth. Some of the men had on a kind of poncho formed of this cloth, their legs being uncovered; others wore clumsily fashioned trousers, and no upper garment except hats made of straw and cloth. Many of the dresses, both of women and men, were grotesque enough, being very bad imitations of the European garb; but all wore a dress of some sort or other. They seemed very glad to see us, and crowded round us as the teacher led the way to his dwelling, where we were entertained, in the most sumptuous manner, on baked pig and all the varieties of fruits and vegetables that the island produced. We were much annoyed, however, by the rats: they seemed to run about the house like domestic animals. As we sat at table, one of them peeped up at us over the edge of the cloth, close to Peterkin’s elbow, who floored it with a blow on the snout from his knife, exclaiming as he did so:
On arriving from our little boat, we received a warm welcome from the teacher and his wife, who was also a local, dressed in a simple European dress and a straw bonnet. The shore was filled with hundreds of locals, all wearing some form of native cloth. Some men had on poncho-like garments made from this cloth, leaving their legs exposed; others wore poorly made trousers with only straw and cloth hats on their heads. Many of the outfits, for both women and men, were quite odd, as they were bad copies of European clothing; but everyone was dressed in some way. They seemed really happy to see us and crowded around as the teacher led us to his home, where we were treated to a lavish meal of roast pig and various fruits and vegetables from the island. However, we were quite annoyed by the rats, which scurried around the house like pets. As we sat at the table, one of them peeked up at us over the edge of the cloth, right next to Peterkin’s elbow, who knocked it out with a quick hit on the snout from his knife, exclaiming as he did so:
“I say, Mister Teacher, why don’t you set traps for these brutes? Surely you are not fond of them!”
“I’m saying, Mister Teacher, why don’t you set traps for these animals? You can’t possibly like them!”
“No,” replied the teacher with a smile. “We would be glad to get rid of them if we could; but if we were to trap all the rats on the island, it would occupy our whole time.”
“No,” said the teacher with a smile. “We’d be happy to get rid of them if we could; but if we tried to catch all the rats on the island, it would take up all our time.”
“Are they, then, so numerous?” inquired Jack.
“Are there really that many?” Jack asked.
“They swarm everywhere. The poor heathens on the north side eat them, and think them very sweet. So did my people formerly; but they do not eat so many now, because the missionary who was last here expressed disgust at it. The poor people asked if it was wrong to eat rats; and he told them that it was certainly not wrong, but that the people of England would be much disgusted were they asked to eat rats.”
“They're everywhere. The poor people on the north side eat them and think they're really sweet. My people used to feel the same way, but they don’t eat as many now because the last missionary who came here was grossed out by it. The poor folks asked if it was wrong to eat rats, and he told them it definitely wasn’t wrong, but that people in England would be really disgusted if they were asked to eat rats.”
We had not been an hour in the house of this kind-hearted man when we were convinced of the truth of his statement as to their numbers; for the rats ran about the floors in dozens, and during our meal two men were stationed at the table to keep them off!
We had not been in this kind-hearted man's house for an hour when we realized he was right about how many rats there were; they scurried across the floors in groups, and while we ate, two men stood at the table to keep them away!
“What a pity you have no cats!” said Peterkin; and he aimed a blow at another reckless intruder, and missed it.
“What a shame you don’t have any cats!” said Peterkin; and he swung at another careless intruder but missed.
“We would indeed be glad to have a few,” rejoined the teacher, “but they are difficult to be got. The hogs, we find, are very good rat-killers; but they do not seem to be able to keep the numbers down. I have heard that they are better than cats.”
“Sure, we’d love to have a few,” the teacher replied, “but they’re hard to find. We’ve noticed that pigs are great at killing rats, but they don’t seem to control their population. I’ve heard they’re better than cats.”
As the teacher said this, his good-natured black face was wrinkled with a smile of merriment. Observing that I had noticed it, he said:
As the teacher said this, his cheerful black face was lined with a grin of amusement. Noticing that I had seen it, he said:
“I smiled just now when I remembered the fate of the first cat that was taken to Rarotonga. This is one of the stations of the London Missionary Society. It, like our own, is infested with rats, and a cat was brought at last to the island. It was a large black one. On being turned loose, instead of being content to stay among men, the cat took to the mountains and lived in a wild state, sometimes paying visits during the night to the houses of the natives; some of whom, living at a distance from the settlement, had not heard of the cat’s arrival, and were dreadfully frightened in consequence, calling it a ‘monster of the deep,’ and flying in terror away from it. One night the cat—feeling a desire for company, I suppose—took its way to the house of a chief who had recently been converted to Christianity, and had begun to learn to read and pray. The chief’s wife, who was sitting awake at his side while he slept, beheld with horror two fires glistening in the doorway, and heard with surprise a mysterious voice. Almost petrified with fear, she awoke her husband, and began to upbraid him for forsaking his old religion and burning his god, who, she declared, was now come to be avenged of them. ‘Get up and pray! get up and pray!’ she cried. The chief arose, and on opening his eyes, beheld the same glaring lights and heard the same ominous sound. Impelled by the extreme urgency of the case, he commenced, with all possible vehemence, to vociferate the alphabet, as a prayer to God to deliver them from the vengeance of Satan! On hearing this, the cat, as much alarmed as themselves, fled precipitately away, leaving the chief and his wife congratulating themselves on the efficacy of their prayer.”
“I just smiled when I remembered what happened to the first cat that was brought to Rarotonga. This is one of the locations for the London Missionary Society. Like our own place, it was overrun with rats, and eventually, a cat was brought to the island. It was a big black cat. When it was set free, instead of staying close to people, the cat ran off to the mountains and lived wild, sometimes coming back at night to visit the homes of the locals. Some of those who lived far from the settlement hadn't heard about the cat's arrival and were absolutely terrified, calling it a ‘monster from the depths’ and running away in fear. One night, the cat—probably looking for some company—wandered to the house of a chief who had recently converted to Christianity and had begun to learn how to read and pray. The chief's wife, who was awake beside him while he slept, was horrified to see two glowing eyes in the doorway and heard a strange voice. Almost frozen with fear, she woke her husband and began scolding him for abandoning his old religion and for burning his idol, which she declared had come to take revenge. ‘Get up and pray! Get up and pray!’ she shouted. The chief got up, and when he opened his eyes, he saw the same glaring lights and heard the same eerie sound. Feeling the urgency of the situation, he started to loudly recite the alphabet, praying to God to save them from Satan's wrath! Upon hearing this, the cat, just as scared as they were, ran away quickly, leaving the chief and his wife feeling relieved at the power of their prayer.”
We were much diverted with this anecdote, which the teacher related in English so good that we certainly could not have supposed him a native but for the colour of his face and the foreign accent in his tone. Next day we walked out with this interesting man, and were much entertained and instructed by his conversation as we rambled through the cool, shady groves of bananas, citrons, limes, and other trees, or sauntered among the cottages of the natives, and watched them while they laboured diligently in the taro-beds or manufactured the tapa, or native cloth. To some of these Jack put questions, through the medium of the missionary; and the replies were such as to surprise us at the extent of their knowledge. Indeed, Peterkin very truly remarked that “they seemed to know a considerable deal more than Jack himself!”
We found this story quite entertaining, which the teacher told in English so well that we definitely wouldn’t have guessed he was a native speaker if it weren't for his complexion and foreign accent. The next day, we went out with this interesting man and were thoroughly entertained and educated by his conversation as we strolled through the cool, shady groves filled with bananas, citrons, limes, and other trees, or meandered among the villagers' cottages, watching them as they worked hard in the taro beds or made tapa, or native cloth. Jack asked some of them questions through the missionary, and the answers surprised us with the depth of their knowledge. In fact, Peterkin accurately pointed out that “they seemed to know quite a lot more than Jack himself!”
Among other pieces of interesting information that we obtained was the following, in regard to coral formations:
Among other pieces of interesting information we gathered was the following about coral formations:
“The islands of the Pacific,” said our friend, “are of three different kinds or classes. Those of the first class are volcanic, mountainous, and wild—some shooting their jagged peaks into the clouds at an elevation of ten and fifteen thousand feet. Those of the second class are of crystallised limestone, and vary in height from one hundred to five hundred feet. The hills on these are not so wild or broken as those of the first class, but are richly clothed with vegetation, and very beautiful. I have no doubt that the Coral Island on which you were wrecked was one of this class. They are supposed to have been upheaved from the bottom of the sea by volcanic agency; but they are not themselves volcanic in their nature, neither are they of coral formation. Those of the third class are the low coralline islands, usually having lagoons of water in their midst. They are very numerous.
“The islands of the Pacific,” our friend said, “fall into three different categories. The first category consists of volcanic islands that are rugged and mountainous—some of them reach heights of ten to fifteen thousand feet with sharp peaks piercing the clouds. The second category is made up of limestone islands, which vary in height from one hundred to five hundred feet. The hills on these islands are less jagged than those in the first category, but they’re lush with vegetation and very beautiful. I’m sure the Coral Island where you got stranded belongs to this category. It's thought that they were pushed up from the ocean floor by volcanic activity; however, they aren’t volcanic themselves, nor are they formed from coral. The third category includes the low coral islands, which usually have lagoons of water in the middle. There are many of these islands.”
“As to the manner in which coral islands and reefs are formed, there are various opinions on this point. I will give you what seems to me the most probable theory—a theory, I may add, which is held by some of the good and scientific missionaries. It is well known that there is much lime in salt water; it is also known that coral is composed of lime. It is supposed that the polypes, or coral insects, have the power of attracting this lime to their bodies, and with this material they build their little cells or habitations. They choose the summit of a volcano, or the top of a submarine mountain, as a foundation on which to build, for it is found that they never work at any great depth below the surface. On this they work. The polypes on the mountain-top, of course, reach the surface first; then those at the outer edges reach the top sooner than the others between them and the centre, thus forming the coral reef surrounding the lagoon of water and the central island. After that, the insects within the lagoon cease working. When the surface of the water is reached, these myriads of wonderful creatures die. Then birds visit the spot, and seeds are thus conveyed thither, which take root and spring up and flourish. Thus are commenced those coralline islets of which you have seen so many in these seas. The reefs round the large islands are formed in a similar manner. When we consider,” added the missionary, “the smallness of the architects used by our heavenly Father in order to form those lovely and innumerable islands, we are filled with much of that feeling which induced the ancient king to exclaim, ‘How manifold, O Lord, are Thy works! in wisdom hast Thou made them all.’”
“As for how coral islands and reefs are formed, there are various opinions on this matter. I’ll share what seems to me the most likely theory—a theory, I should mention, that is supported by some knowledgeable and scientific missionaries. It’s well known that there’s a lot of lime in saltwater; it’s also known that coral is made of lime. It’s believed that the polyps, or coral insects, can attract this lime to their bodies, and with this material, they build their small cells or homes. They prefer the top of a volcano or the peak of a submerged mountain as a base for building because they tend not to work at great depths below the surface. They begin their work at the mountain top, of course, reaching the surface first; then those on the outer edges get to the top sooner than the ones in the center, thus forming the coral reef that surrounds the lagoon and the central island. After that, the insects inside the lagoon stop working. When they reach the water's surface, these countless amazing creatures die. Then birds come to the area, bringing seeds that take root and thrive. This is how those coral islets you’ve seen so many of in these seas begin. The reefs around larger islands form in a similar way. When we think about,” the missionary added, “the tiny creatures used by our heavenly Father to create those beautiful and countless islands, we feel a lot of that same awe that led the ancient king to exclaim, ‘How manifold, O Lord, are Thy works! in wisdom hast Thou made them all.’”
We all heartily agreed with the missionary in this sentiment, and felt not a little gratified to find that the opinions which Jack and I had been led to form, from personal observation on our Coral Island, were thus to a great extent corroborated.
We all fully agreed with the missionary on this point, and felt quite pleased to discover that the views Jack and I had developed from our personal experiences on our Coral Island were largely supported.
The missionary also gave us an account of the manner in which Christianity had been introduced among them. He said: “When missionaries were first sent here, three years ago, a small vessel brought them; and the chief, who is now dead, promised to treat well the two native teachers who were left with their wives on the island. But scarcely had the boat which landed them returned to the ship than the natives began to maltreat their guests, taking away all they possessed, and offering them further violence, so that when the boat was sent in haste to fetch them away, the clothes of both men and women were torn nearly off their backs.
The missionary also shared how Christianity was brought to their community. He said: “When missionaries first arrived here three years ago, a small boat brought them. The chief, who has since passed away, promised to take good care of the two local teachers and their wives who stayed on the island. But hardly had the boat that dropped them off returned to the ship before the locals started to mistreat their guests, stealing everything they had and threatening them with more violence. By the time the boat was quickly sent back to get them, the clothes of both the men and women were almost ripped off their backs.
“Two years after this the vessel visited them again, and I, being in her, volunteered to land alone, without any goods whatever, begging that my wife might be brought to me the following year—that is, this year; and, as you see, she is with me. But the surf was so high that the boat could not land me; so with nothing on but my trousers and shirt, and with a few catechisms and a Bible, besides some portions of the Scripture translated into the Mango tongue, I sprang into the sea, and swam ashore on the crest of a breaker. I was instantly dragged up the beach by the natives; who, on finding I had nothing worth having upon me, let me alone. I then made signs to my friends in the ship to leave me, which they did. At first the natives listened to me in silence, but laughed at what I said while I preached the Gospel of our blessed Saviour Jesus Christ to them. Afterwards they treated me ill, sometimes; but I persevered, and continued to dwell among them, and dispute, and exhort them to give up their sinful ways of life, burn their idols, and come to Jesus.
“Two years later, the ship came back, and since I was on board, I volunteered to go ashore alone, without bringing anything, asking that my wife be brought to me the next year—that is, this year; and as you can see, she is with me. But the waves were so high that the boat couldn't drop me off; so wearing only my pants and shirt, along with a few catechisms and a Bible, plus some Bible passages translated into the Mango language, I jumped into the water and swam to shore on the back of a wave. The locals quickly pulled me up on the beach; when they saw I didn't have anything valuable on me, they left me alone. I then signaled to my friends on the ship to leave me, and they did. At first, the locals listened to me quietly, but they laughed at what I said while I preached the Gospel of our blessed Savior Jesus Christ to them. Later, they treated me poorly at times, but I didn’t give up, and I kept living among them, discussing, and urging them to give up their sinful lifestyles, burn their idols, and come to Jesus.”
“About a month after I landed, I heard that the chief was dead. He was the father of the present chief, who is now a most consistent member of the Church. It is a custom here that when a chief dies his wives are strangled and buried with him. Knowing this, I hastened to his house to endeavour to prevent such cruelty if possible. When I arrived, I found two of the wives had already been killed, while another was in the act of being strangled. I pleaded hard for her, but it was too late; she was already dead. I then entreated the son to spare the fourth wife, and after much hesitation, my prayer was granted; but in half-an-hour afterwards this poor woman repented of being unfaithful, as she termed it, to her husband, and insisted on being strangled, which was accordingly done.
“About a month after I arrived, I heard that the chief had died. He was the father of the current chief, who is now a devoted member of the Church. It’s a custom here that when a chief dies, his wives are killed and buried with him. Knowing this, I rushed to his house to try to prevent such cruelty if I could. When I got there, I found that two of the wives had already been killed, and another was in the process of being strangled. I pleaded hard for her, but it was too late; she was already dead. I then begged the son to spare the fourth wife, and after a lot of hesitation, my request was granted; but half an hour later, this poor woman regretted being unfaithful, as she called it, to her husband, and insisted on being killed, which was done.
“All this time the chief’s son was walking up and down before his father’s house with a brow black as thunder. When he entered I went in with him, and found, to my surprise, that his father was not dead! The old man was sitting on a mat in a corner, with an expression of placid resignation on his face.
“All this time, the chief’s son was pacing back and forth in front of his father’s house, looking furious. When he went inside, I followed him and was surprised to see that his father was not dead! The old man was sitting on a mat in the corner, wearing a calm and resigned expression on his face.”
“‘Why,’ said I, ‘have you strangled your father’s wives before he is dead?’
“‘Why,’ I asked, ‘have you killed your father's wives before he's even dead?’”
“To this the son replied, ‘He is dead. That is no longer my father. He is as good as dead now. He is to be buried alive.’
“To this the son replied, ‘He’s dead. He’s not my father anymore. He might as well be dead now. He is to be buried alive.’”
“I now remembered having heard that it is a custom among the Feejee Islanders that when the reigning chief grows old and infirm, the heir to the chieftainship has a right to depose his father, in which case he is considered as dead, and is buried alive. The young chief was now about to follow this custom, and despite my earnest entreaties and pleadings, the old chief was buried that day before my eyes in the same grave with his four strangled wives! Oh, my heart groaned when I saw this! and I prayed to God to open the hearts of these poor creatures, as He had already opened mine, and pour into them the light and the love of the Gospel of Jesus. My prayer was answered very soon. A week afterwards the son, who was now chief of the tribe, came to me, bearing his god on his shoulders, and groaning beneath its weight. Flinging it down at my feet, he desired me to burn it!
“I now remembered hearing that it's a tradition among the Fijian Islanders that when the ruling chief grows old and weak, the heir to the chieftainship has the right to depose his father, in which case he is regarded as dead and buried alive. The young chief was about to follow this tradition, and despite my desperate pleas, the old chief was buried that day before my eyes in the same grave with his four strangled wives! Oh, my heart ached when I saw this! I prayed to God to open the hearts of these poor people, as He had already opened mine, and fill them with the light and love of the Gospel of Jesus. My prayer was answered very soon. A week later, the son, who was now chief of the tribe, came to me, carrying his idol on his shoulders and groaning under its weight. He threw it down at my feet and demanded that I burn it!”
“You may conceive how overjoyed I was at this. I sprang up and embraced him, while I shed tears of joy. Then we made a fire and burned the god to ashes, amid an immense concourse of the people, who seemed terrified at what was being done, and shrank back when we burned the god, expecting some signal vengeance to be taken upon us; but seeing that nothing happened, they changed their minds, and thought that our God must be the true one after all. From that time the mission prospered steadily; and now, while there is not a single man in the tribe who has not burned his household gods and become a convert to Christianity, there are not a few, I hope, who are true followers of the Lamb, having been plucked as brands from the burning by Him who can save unto the uttermost. I will not tell you more of our progress at this time; but you see,” he said, waving his hand around him, “the village, and the church did not exist a year ago!”
“You can imagine how thrilled I was about this. I jumped up and hugged him, crying tears of joy. Then we made a fire and burned the idol to ashes, with a huge crowd watching, who seemed scared by what was happening and stepped back when we burned the idol, expecting some kind of punishment to come our way; but when nothing happened, they changed their minds and thought our God might actually be the true one after all. From that moment, the mission steadily thrived; and now, while there isn't a single person in the tribe who hasn't burned their household idols and converted to Christianity, I hope there are many who are true followers of the Lamb, having been saved from destruction by Him who can save to the utmost. I won't share more about our progress right now; but you see,” he said, waving his hand around, “the village and the church didn't exist a year ago!”
We were indeed much interested in this account, and I could not help again in my heart praying to God to prosper those missionary societies that send such inestimable blessings to these islands of dark and bloody idolatry. The teacher also added that the other tribes were very indignant at this one for having burned its gods, and threatened to destroy it altogether; but they had done nothing yet. “And if they should,” said the teacher, “the Lord is on our side; of whom shall we be afraid?”
We were really intrigued by this story, and I couldn't help but silently pray to God to support those missionary groups that bring such incredible blessings to these islands filled with dark and violent idol worship. The teacher also mentioned that the other tribes were really upset with this one for burning its gods and threatened to wipe it out completely; however, they hadn't taken any action yet. "And if they do," the teacher said, "the Lord is on our side; who should we be afraid of?"
“Have the missionaries many stations in these seas?” inquired Jack.
“Do the missionaries have a lot of stations in these seas?” Jack asked.
“Oh yes. The London Missionary Society have a great many in the Tahiti group, and other islands in that quarter. Then the Wesleyans have the Feejee Islands all to themselves, and the Americans have many stations in other groups. But still, my friend, there are hundreds of islands here, the natives of which have never heard of Jesus, or the good word of God, or the Holy Spirit; and thousands are living and dying in the practice of those terrible sins and bloody murders of which you have already heard.—I trust, my friends,” he added, looking earnestly into our faces—“I trust that if you ever return to England, you will tell your Christian friends that the horrors which they hear of in regard to these islands are literally true, and that when they have heard the worst, the ‘half has not been told them;’ for there are perpetrated here foul deeds of darkness of which man may not speak. You may also tell them,” he said, looking around with a smile, while a tear of gratitude trembled in his eye and rolled down his coal-black cheek—“tell them of the blessings that the Gospel has wrought here!”
“Oh yes. The London Missionary Society has a lot of people in the Tahiti group and other nearby islands. The Wesleyans have the Feejee Islands all to themselves, and the Americans have many stations in other groups. But still, my friend, there are hundreds of islands here where the natives have never heard of Jesus, or the good word of God, or the Holy Spirit; and thousands are living and dying caught up in those terrible sins and bloody murders you’ve already heard about.—I hope, my friends,” he added, looking earnestly into our faces—“I hope that if you ever go back to England, you will tell your Christian friends that the horrors they hear about regarding these islands are literally true, and that when they’ve heard the worst, the ‘half has not been told them;’ because there are vile deeds of darkness happening here that people can’t even talk about. You can also tell them,” he said, looking around with a smile, while a tear of gratitude trembled in his eye and rolled down his coal-black cheek—“tell them about the blessings that the Gospel has brought here!”
We assured our friend that we would certainly not forget his request. On returning towards the village, about noon, we remarked on the beautiful whiteness of the cottages.
We assured our friend that we definitely wouldn’t forget his request. On our way back to the village around noon, we commented on how beautifully white the cottages were.
“That is owing to the lime with which they are plastered,” said the teacher. “When the natives were converted, as I have described, I set them to work to build cottages for themselves, and also this handsome church which you see. When the framework and other parts of the house were up, I sent the people to fetch coral from the sea. They brought immense quantities. Then I made them cut wood, and piling the coral above it, set it on fire.
“That's because of the lime they used for the plaster,” said the teacher. “When the locals were converted, as I mentioned, I had them build cottages for themselves, as well as this beautiful church you see. Once the framework and other parts of the house were complete, I had the people gather coral from the sea. They brought back huge amounts. Then I had them cut wood, and stacking the coral on top of it, I set it on fire.
“‘Look! look!’ cried the poor people in amazement; ‘what wonderful people the Christians are! He is roasting stones! We shall not need taro or bread-fruit any more; we may eat stones!’
“‘Look! Look!’ yelled the poor people in amazement; ‘how amazing the Christians are! He is roasting stones! We won’t need taro or breadfruit anymore; we can eat stones!’”
“But their surprise was still greater when the coral was reduced to a fine, soft, white powder. They immediately set up a great shout, and mingling the lime with water, rubbed their faces and their bodies all over with it, and ran through the village screaming with delight. They were also much surprised at another thing they saw me do. I wished to make some household furniture, and constructed a turning-lathe to assist me. The first thing that I turned was the leg of a sofa, which was no sooner finished than the chief seized it with wonder and delight, and ran through the village exhibiting it to the people, who looked upon it with great admiration. The chief then, tying a string to it, hung it round his neck as an ornament! He afterwards told me that if he had seen it before he became a Christian, he would have made it his god!”
“But they were even more surprised when the coral was ground into a fine, soft, white powder. They immediately erupted in cheers, mixing the lime with water and rubbing it all over their faces and bodies, running through the village, shouting with joy. They were also amazed by another thing I did. I wanted to make some furniture, so I built a lathe to help me. The first thing I turned was a leg for a sofa, and as soon as it was done, the chief grabbed it in awe and ran through the village showing it off to everyone, who admired it greatly. The chief then tied a string to it and wore it around his neck as an ornament! He later told me that if he had seen it before becoming a Christian, he would have made it his god!”
As the teacher concluded this anecdote we reached his door. Saying that he had business to attend to, he left us to amuse ourselves as we best could.
As the teacher wrapped up his story, we arrived at his door. He mentioned he had things to take care of and left us to entertain ourselves as best we could.
“Now, lads,” said Jack, turning abruptly towards us, and buttoning up his jacket as he spoke, “I’m off to see the battle. I’ve no particular fondness for seein’ bloodshed; but I must find out the nature o’ these fellows and see their customs with my own eyes, so that I may be able to speak of it again, if need be, authoritatively. It’s only six miles off, and we don’t run much more risk than that of getting a rap with a stray stone or an overshot arrow. Will you go?”
“Alright, guys,” Jack said, turning quickly to face us and buttoning up his jacket as he spoke, “I’m heading out to see the battle. I don’t really enjoy watching violence, but I need to understand these people and see their customs firsthand, so I can talk about it later with authority if necessary. It’s only six miles away, and we’re not at much greater risk than getting hit by a stray stone or an overthrown arrow. Who’s coming with me?”
“To be sure we will,” said Peterkin.
“To be sure we will,” Peterkin said.
“If they chance to see us, we’ll cut and run for it,” added Jack.
“If they happen to see us, we’ll bolt,” Jack added.
“Dear me!” cried Peterkin; “you run! I thought you would scorn to run from any one.”
“Wow!” Peterkin exclaimed; “you run! I thought you’d refuse to run from anyone.”
“So I would, if it were my duty to fight,” returned Jack coolly; “but as I don’t want to fight, and don’t intend to fight, if they offer to attack us I’ll run away, like the veriest coward that ever went by the name of Peterkin. So come along.”
“So I would, if it were my duty to fight,” Jack replied calmly; “but since I don’t want to fight and have no intention of fighting, if they try to attack us, I’ll just run away, like the biggest coward ever called Peterkin. So let’s go.”
Chapter Thirty One.
A strange and bloody battle—The lion bearded in his den—Frightful scenes of cruelty, and fears for the future.
We had ascertained from the teacher the direction to the spot on which the battle was to be fought, and after a walk of two hours, reached it. The summit of a bare hill was the place chosen; for, unlike most of the other islanders, who are addicted to bush-fighting, those of Mango are in the habit of meeting on open ground. We arrived before the two parties had commenced the deadly struggle, and creeping as close up as we dared among the rocks, we lay and watched them.
We had confirmed with the teacher where the battle was going to take place, and after two hours of walking, we finally got there. The chosen location was the top of a bare hill; unlike most other islanders, who prefer fighting in the bush, the people of Mango typically meet in open areas. We arrived before the two sides started their intense fight, and creeping as close as we could among the rocks, we lay down and watched them.
The combatants were drawn up face to face, each side ranged in rank four deep. Those in the first row were armed with long spears; the second with clubs to defend the spearmen; the third row was composed of young men with slings; and the fourth consisted of women, who carried baskets of stones for the slingers, and clubs and spears with which to supply the warriors. Soon after we arrived, the attack was made with great fury. There was no science displayed. The two bodies of savages rushed headlong upon each other and engaged in a general mélée, and a more dreadful set of men I have never seen. They wore grotesque war-caps, made of various substances and decorated with feathers. Their faces and bodies were painted so as to make them look as frightful as possible; and as they brandished their massive clubs, leaped, shouted, yelled, and dashed each other to the ground, I thought I had never seen men look so like demons before.
The fighters were lined up face to face, each side arranged four ranks deep. The front row was armed with long spears; the second row had clubs to protect the spearmen; the third row was made up of young men with slings; and the fourth consisted of women who carried baskets of stones for the slingers, along with clubs and spears to supply the warriors. Soon after we arrived, the attack began with great intensity. There was no strategy involved. The two groups of warriors charged at each other and engaged in a chaotic brawl, and I’ve never seen a more terrifying group of men. They wore bizarre war caps made from various materials and decorated with feathers. Their faces and bodies were painted to look as horrifying as possible, and as they swung their heavy clubs, jumped, shouted, yelled, and knocked each other down, I thought I had never seen men look so much like demons before.
We were much surprised at the conduct of the women, who seemed to be perfect furies, and hung about the heels of their husbands in order to defend them. One stout young woman we saw, whose husband was hard pressed and about to be overcome: she lifted a large stone, and throwing it at his opponent’s head, felled him to the earth. But the battle did not last long. The band most distant from us gave way and were routed, leaving eighteen of their comrades dead upon the field. These the victors brained as they lay; and putting some of their brains on leaves, went off with them, we were afterwards informed, to their temples to present them to their gods as an earnest of the human victims who were soon to be brought there.
We were really surprised by how the women acted; they were like fierce warriors, sticking close to their husbands to protect them. We saw one strong young woman whose husband was getting seriously overwhelmed. She picked up a large stone and threw it at his opponent's head, knocking him down. But the fight didn’t go on for long. The group that was farthest from us started to retreat and was defeated, leaving eighteen of their companions dead on the ground. The victors then smashed their heads while they lay there and took some of their brains on leaves, later informing us they were heading to their temples to offer them to their gods as a sign of the human sacrifices that would soon be made there.
We hastened back to the Christian village with feelings of the deepest sadness at the sanguinary conflict which we had just witnessed.
We hurried back to the Christian village, feeling deeply sad about the bloody conflict we had just seen.
Next day, after breakfasting with our friend the teacher, we made preparations for carrying out our plan. At first the teacher endeavoured to dissuade us.
Next day, after having breakfast with our friend the teacher, we got ready to execute our plan. At first, the teacher tried to talk us out of it.
“You do not know,” said he, turning to Jack, “the danger you run in venturing amongst these ferocious savages. I feel much pity for poor Avatea; but you are not likely to succeed in saving her, and you may die in the attempt.”
“You don’t understand,” he said, turning to Jack, “the danger you face by getting involved with these brutal savages. I feel really sorry for poor Avatea, but you probably won’t manage to save her, and you could end up dying trying.”
“Well,” said Jack quietly, “I am not afraid to die in a good cause.”
“Well,” Jack said quietly, “I’m not afraid to die for a good cause.”
The teacher smiled approvingly at him as he said this, and after a little further conversation, agreed to accompany us as interpreter—saying that although Tararo was unfriendly to him, he had hitherto treated him with respect.
The teacher smiled approvingly at him as he said this, and after a bit more conversation, agreed to join us as an interpreter—saying that even though Tararo was unfriendly to him, he had always treated him with respect.
We now went on board the schooner, having resolved to sail round the island and drop anchor opposite the heathen village. We manned her with natives, and hoped to overawe the savages by displaying our brass gun to advantage. The teacher soon after came on board, and setting our sails, we put to sea. In two hours more we made the cliffs reverberate with the crash of the big gun, which we fired by way of salute, while we ran the British ensign up to the peak and cast anchor. The commotion on shore showed us that we had struck terror into the hearts of the natives; but seeing that we did not offer to molest them, a canoe at length put off and paddled cautiously towards us. The teacher showed himself, and explaining that we were friends and wished to palaver with the chief, desired the native to go and tell him to come on board.
We boarded the schooner, having decided to sail around the island and anchor in front of the native village. We crewed her with locals, hoping to intimidate the villagers by showcasing our brass gun effectively. Soon after, the teacher came on board, and after setting our sails, we headed out to sea. In two hours, we made the cliffs echo with the booming of the big gun, which we fired as a salute while hoisting the British flag to the peak and dropping anchor. The chaos on shore indicated that we had instilled fear in the hearts of the locals; however, noticing that we meant them no harm, a canoe eventually approached us, paddling cautiously. The teacher introduced himself and explained that we were friends who wanted to speak with the chief, asking the native to go and inform him to come on board.
We waited long and with much impatience for an answer. During this time the native teacher conversed with us again, and told us many things concerning the success of the Gospel among those islands; and perceiving that we were by no means so much gratified as we ought to have been at the hearing of such good news, he pressed us more closely in regard to our personal interest in religion, and exhorted us to consider that our souls were certainly in as great danger as those of the wretched heathen whom we pitied so much if we had not already found salvation in Jesus Christ. “Nay, further,” he added, “if such be your unhappy case, you are, in the sight of God, much worse than these savages—forgive me, my young friends, for saying so—for they have no knowledge, no light, and do not profess to believe; while you, on the contrary, have been brought up in the light of the blessed Gospel and call yourselves Christians. These poor savages are indeed the enemies of our Lord; but you, if ye be not true believers, are traitors!”
We waited a long time, feeling very impatient for an answer. During this waiting period, the local teacher spoke with us again and shared many stories about the success of the Gospel in those islands. Noticing that we weren't as happy as we should have been at hearing such good news, he pressed us more about our personal interest in religion and urged us to consider that our souls were just as much in danger as those miserable heathens we felt sorry for if we hadn’t already found salvation in Jesus Christ. “Moreover,” he added, “if that’s your unfortunate situation, you are, in God's eyes, far worse than these savages—please forgive me, my young friends, for saying this—because they have no knowledge or light and don’t claim to believe; while you, on the other hand, have been raised in the light of the blessed Gospel and call yourselves Christians. These poor savages may indeed be enemies of our Lord; but you, if you are not true believers, are traitors!”
I must confess that my heart condemned me while the teacher spoke in this earnest manner, and I knew not what to reply. Peterkin, too, did not seem to like it, and, I thought, would willingly have escaped. But Jack seemed deeply impressed, and wore an anxious expression on his naturally grave countenance, while he assented to the teacher’s remarks, and put to him many earnest questions. Meanwhile the natives who composed our crew, having nothing particular to do, had squatted down on the deck and taken out their little books containing the translated portions of the New Testament, along with hymns and spelling-books, and were now busily engaged—some vociferating the alphabet, others learning prayers off by heart, while a few sang hymns—all of them being utterly unmindful of our presence. The teacher soon joined them, and soon afterwards they all engaged in a prayer, which was afterwards translated to us, and proved to be a petition for the success of our undertaking and for the conversion of the heathen.
I have to admit that I felt guilty while the teacher spoke so sincerely, and I didn’t know how to respond. Peterkin also seemed uncomfortable and looked like he wanted to leave. But Jack appeared really moved, wearing a worried expression on his usually serious face, and he agreed with what the teacher said, asking him many thoughtful questions. Meanwhile, the natives on our crew, having nothing specific to do, sat down on the deck and pulled out their little books with translated parts of the New Testament, along with hymns and spelling books. They were all busy—some loudly reciting the alphabet, others memorizing prayers, while a few sang hymns—completely ignoring our presence. The teacher joined them soon after, and shortly after that, they all participated in a prayer, which was later translated for us. It turned out to be a request for success in our mission and for the conversion of the heathen.
While we were thus engaged a canoe put off from shore, and several savages leaped on deck, one of whom advanced to the teacher and informed him that Tararo could not come on board that day, being busy with some religious ceremonies before the gods, which could on no account be postponed. He was also engaged with a friendly chief, who was about to take his departure from the island, and therefore begged that the teacher and his friends would land and pay a visit to him. To this the teacher returned answer that we would land immediately.
While we were busy, a canoe pushed off from the shore, and several natives jumped on board. One of them approached the teacher and told him that Tararo couldn't come on board that day because he was tied up with some religious ceremonies for the gods, which couldn’t be postponed. He was also busy with a friendly chief who was about to leave the island, and he asked the teacher and his friends to go ashore and visit him. The teacher responded that we would land right away.
“Now, lads,” said Jack as we were about to step into our little boat, “I’m not going to take any weapons with me, and I recommend you to take none either. We are altogether in the power of these savages; and the utmost we could do, if they were to attack us, would be to kill a few of them before we were ourselves overpowered. I think that our only chance of success lies in mild measures. Don’t you think so?”
“Alright, guys,” said Jack as we were about to get into our small boat, “I’m not bringing any weapons, and I suggest you don’t either. We’re completely at the mercy of these savages; and the most we could manage if they attacked us would be to take out a few of them before being overwhelmed ourselves. I believe our best shot at success is through peaceful actions. Don’t you agree?”
To this I assented gladly; and Peterkin replied by laying down a huge bell-mouthed blunderbuss, and divesting himself of a pair of enormous horse-pistols, with which he had purposed to overawe the natives! We then jumped into our boat and rowed ashore.
To this, I happily agreed; and Peterkin responded by setting down a massive bell-shaped blunderbuss and taking off a pair of huge horse pistols that he had planned to use to impress the locals! We then jumped into our boat and rowed to shore.
On reaching the beach we were received by a crowd of naked savages, who shouted a rude welcome, and conducted us to a house or shed where a baked pig and a variety of vegetables were prepared for us. Having partaken of these, the teacher begged to be conducted to the chief; but there seemed some hesitation, and after some consultation among themselves, one of the men stood forward and spoke to the teacher.
On arriving at the beach, we were greeted by a group of naked locals, who shouted a blunt welcome and led us to a hut where a roasted pig and a selection of vegetables were ready for us. After eating, the teacher asked to be taken to the chief, but there was some hesitation. After a bit of discussion among themselves, one of the men stepped forward and spoke to the teacher.
“What says he?” inquired Jack when the savage had concluded.
“What does he say?” Jack asked when the savage had finished.
“He says that the chief is just going to the temple of his god, and cannot see us yet; so we must be patient, my friend.”
“He says that the chief is just going to his god's temple and can't see us yet, so we need to be patient, my friend.”
“Well,” cried Jack, rising, “if he won’t come to see me, I’ll e’en go and see him. Besides, I have a great desire to witness their proceedings at this temple of theirs. Will you go with me, friend?”
“Well,” shouted Jack, standing up, “if he won’t come to see me, I’ll just go see him. Besides, I really want to check out what’s happening at their temple. Will you come with me, friend?”
“I cannot,” said the teacher, shaking his head. “I must not go to the heathen temples and witness their inhuman rites, except for the purpose of condemning their wickedness and folly.”
“I can’t,” said the teacher, shaking his head. “I shouldn’t go to the pagan temples and see their brutal rituals, except to highlight their evil and foolishness.”
“Very good,” returned Jack; “then I’ll go alone, for I cannot condemn their doings till I have seen them.”
“Sounds good,” Jack replied. “In that case, I’ll go by myself because I can’t judge what they’re doing until I’ve seen it for myself.”
Jack arose, and we, having determined to go also, followed him through the banana-groves to a rising ground immediately behind the village, on the top of which stood the Buré, or temple, under the dark shade of a group of iron-wood trees. As we went through the village I was again led to contrast the rude huts and sheds, and their almost naked, savage-looking inhabitants, with the natives of the Christian village, who, to use the teacher’s scriptural expression, were now “clothed and in their right mind.”
Jack got up, and since we decided to go too, we followed him through the banana groves to a hill just behind the village, where the Buré, or temple, stood under the dark shade of some ironwood trees. As we walked through the village, I couldn't help but compare the rough huts and sheds, along with their almost naked, wild-looking residents, to the people of the Christian village, who, as the teacher would say, were now “dressed and in their right mind.”
As we turned into a broad path leading towards the hill, we were arrested by the shouts of an approaching multitude in the rear. Drawing aside into the bushes, we awaited their coming up; and as they drew near, we observed that it was a procession of the natives, many of whom were dancing and gesticulating in the most frantic manner. They had an exceedingly hideous aspect, owing to the black, red, and yellow paints with which their faces and naked bodies were bedaubed. In the midst of these came a band of men carrying three or four planks, on which were seated, in rows, upwards of a dozen men. I shuddered involuntarily as I recollected the sacrifice of human victims at the island of Emo, and turned with a look of fear to Jack as I said:
As we turned onto a wide path leading up the hill, we were startled by the shouts of a large crowd behind us. We stepped into the bushes to wait for them to pass, and as they got closer, we saw it was a procession of locals, many of whom were dancing and waving their arms wildly. They looked incredibly frightening because their faces and bare bodies were smeared with black, red, and yellow paint. Among them was a group of men carrying three or four planks, with over a dozen men sitting in rows on them. I felt a chill as I remembered the human sacrifices at the island of Emo, and I turned to Jack with a scared expression and said:
“Oh Jack! I have a terrible dread that they are going to commit some of their cruel practices on these wretched men. We had better not go to the temple. We shall only be horrified without being able to do any good, for I fear they are going to kill them.”
“Oh Jack! I have a terrible fear that they’re going to inflict some of their cruel practices on these unfortunate men. We should probably avoid the temple. We’ll just be horrified without being able to help, because I’m afraid they’re going to kill them.”
Jack’s face wore an expression of deep compassion as he said in a low voice, “No fear, Ralph; the sufferings of these poor fellows are over long ago.”
Jack’s face showed a look of deep compassion as he said softly, “Don’t worry, Ralph; these poor guys have suffered long enough.”
I turned with a start as he spoke, and glancing at the men, who were now quite near to the spot where we stood, saw that they were all dead. They were tied firmly with ropes in a sitting posture on the planks, and seemed, as they bent their sightless eyeballs and grinning mouths over the dancing crew below, as if they were laughing in ghastly mockery at the utter inability of their enemies to hurt them now. These, we discovered afterwards, were the men who had been slain in the battle of the previous day, and were now on their way to be first presented to the gods and then eaten. Behind these came two men leading between them a third, whose hands were pinioned behind his back. He walked with a firm step, and wore a look of utter indifference on his face as they led him along, so that we concluded he must be a criminal who was about to receive some slight punishment for his faults. The rear of the procession was brought up by a shouting crowd of women and children, with whom we mingled and followed to the temple.
I jumped in surprise when he spoke, and glancing at the men, who were now very close to where we stood, I saw that they were all dead. They were tied up tightly with ropes in a sitting position on the boards, and as they stared with their unseeing eyes and grinning mouths down at the dancing crew below, it looked like they were laughing in a twisted way at how powerless their enemies were to hurt them now. We later found out that these were the men killed in the battle the day before, and they were on their way to be first presented to the gods and then eaten. Behind them, two men were leading a third, whose hands were tied behind his back. He walked with confidence and wore a completely indifferent expression as they brought him along, so we figured he must be a criminal about to face some minor punishment for his crimes. The end of the procession was filled with a shouting crowd of women and children, and we joined them and followed to the temple.
Here we arrived in a few minutes. The temple was a tall, circular building, open at one side. Around it were strewn heaps of human bones and skulls. At a table inside sat the priest, an elderly man with a long grey beard. He was seated on a stool, and before him lay several knives, made of wood, bone, and splinters of bamboo, with which he performed his office of dissecting dead bodies. Farther in lay a variety of articles that had been dedicated to the god, and among them were many spears and clubs. I observed among the latter some with human teeth sticking in them, where the victims had been clubbed in their mouths.
Here we arrived in just a few minutes. The temple was a tall, circular building, open on one side. Surrounding it were piles of human bones and skulls. Inside, at a table, sat the priest, an old man with a long gray beard. He was on a stool, and in front of him were several knives made of wood, bone, and bamboo splinters, which he used to dissect dead bodies. Deeper inside were various items dedicated to the god, including many spears and clubs. I noticed that some of the clubs had human teeth stuck in them, where the victims had been struck in the mouth.
Before this temple the bodies, which were painted with vermilion and soot, were arranged in a sitting posture; and a man called a “dan-vosa” (orator) advanced, and laying his hands on their heads, began to chide them, apparently, in a low, bantering tone. What he said we knew not, but as he went on he waxed warm, and at last shouted to them at the top of his lungs, and finally finished by kicking the bodies over and running away, amid the shouts and laughter of the people, who now rushed forward. Seizing the bodies by a leg or an arm, or by the hair of the head, they dragged them over stumps and stones and through sloughs until they were exhausted. The bodies were then brought back to the temple and dissected by the priest, after which they were taken out to be baked.
Before this temple, the bodies, which were covered in red paint and soot, were arranged in a sitting position. A man called a “dan-vosa” (orator) stepped forward, placed his hands on their heads, and started to scold them in a low, teasing tone. We couldn't hear exactly what he said, but as he continued, he got more intense and eventually shouted at them at the top of his lungs. He ended by kicking the bodies over and running away, while the crowd erupted in shouts and laughter as they rushed forward. They grabbed the bodies by a leg, an arm, or the hair and dragged them over obstacles like stumps and stones and through muddy areas until they were worn out. The bodies were then taken back to the temple, where the priest dissected them, after which they were brought out to be baked.
Close to the temple a large fire was kindled, in which stones were heated red hot. When ready these were spread out on the ground, and a thick coating of leaves strewn over them to slack the heat. On this “lovo,” or oven, the bodies were then placed, covered over, and left to bake.
Close to the temple, a large fire was started, heating stones until they were glowing red. Once they were ready, these stones were spread out on the ground, and a thick layer of leaves was laid over them to keep the heat in. The bodies were then placed on this "lovo," or oven, covered up, and left to cook.
The crowd now ran with terrible yells towards a neighbouring hill or mound, on which we observed the framework of a house lying ready to be erected. Sick with horror, yet fascinated by curiosity, we staggered after them mechanically, scarce knowing where we were going or what we did, and feeling a sort of impression that all we saw was a dreadful dream.
The crowd now sprinted with loud screams toward a nearby hill or mound, where we saw the structure of a house waiting to be built. Sick with fear but intrigued by curiosity, we stumbled after them automatically, hardly aware of where we were headed or what we were doing, feeling as if everything we saw was just a terrible dream.
Arrived at the place, we saw the multitude crowding round a certain spot. We pressed forward, and obtained a sight of what they were doing. A large wooden beam or post lay on the ground, beside the other parts of the framework of the house, and close to the end of it was a hole about seven feet deep and upwards of two feet wide. While we looked, the man whom we had before observed with his hands pinioned was carried into the circle. His hands were now free, but his legs were tightly strapped together. The post of the house was then placed in the hole, and the man put in beside it. His head was a good way below the surface of the hole, and his arms were clasped round the post. Earth was now thrown in until all was covered over and stamped down; and this, we were afterwards told, was a ceremony usually performed at the dedication of a new temple or the erection of a chief’s house!
Arriving at the spot, we saw a crowd gathered around a specific area. We pushed our way through to see what was happening. A large wooden beam or post lay on the ground, along with other parts of the house's framework. Near the end of it was a hole about seven feet deep and over two feet wide. While we were watching, the man we had seen earlier with his hands tied was brought into the circle. His hands were now free, but his legs were tightly bound together. The post for the house was then placed in the hole, and the man was positioned beside it. His head was well below the surface of the hole, with his arms wrapped around the post. Dirt was then thrown in until everything was covered and packed down; we were later told that this was a ritual usually performed during the dedication of a new temple or when a chief’s house was built!
“Come, come,” cried Jack on beholding this horrible tragedy; “we have seen enough, enough—far more than enough! Let us go.”
“Come on, come on,” shouted Jack as he witnessed this awful scene; “we’ve seen enough, way more than enough! Let’s get out of here.”
Jack’s face looked ghastly pale and haggard as we hurried back to rejoin the teacher; and I have no doubt that he felt terrible anxiety when he considered the number and ferocity of the savages, and the weakness of the few arms which were ready indeed to essay, but impotent to effect, Avatea’s deliverance from these ruthless men.
Jack’s face looked ghostly pale and worn out as we rushed back to join the teacher, and I’m sure he felt a deep anxiety when he thought about the number and intensity of the savages, along with the weakness of the few weapons that were prepared to try, but unable to actually save Avatea from these ruthless men.
Chapter Thirty Two.
An unexpected discovery, and a bold, reckless defiance, with its consequences—Plans of escape, and heroic resolves.
When we returned to the shore and related to our friend what had passed, he was greatly distressed, and groaned in spirit; but we had not sat long in conversation when we were interrupted by the arrival of Tararo on the beach, accompanied by a number of followers bearing baskets of vegetables and fruits on their heads.
When we got back to the shore and told our friend what had happened, he was really upset and sighed heavily; but we hadn't been talking for long when we were interrupted by Tararo arriving on the beach with several followers carrying baskets of vegetables and fruits on their heads.
We advanced to meet him, and he expressed, through our interpreter, much pleasure in seeing us.
We moved forward to greet him, and he conveyed, through our interpreter, great joy in seeing us.
“And what, is it that my friends wish to say to me?” he inquired.
“And what is it that my friends want to say to me?” he asked.
The teacher explained that we came to beg that Avatea might be spared.
The teacher explained that we came to ask for Avatea to be spared.
“Tell him,” said Jack, “that I consider that I have a right to ask this of him, having not only saved the girl’s life, but the lives of his own people also; and say that I wish her to be allowed to follow her own wishes, and join the Christians.”
“Tell him,” said Jack, “that I believe I have the right to ask this of him, having not only saved the girl’s life but also the lives of his own people; and let him know that I want her to be allowed to follow her own wishes and join the Christians.”
While this was being translated the chief’s brow lowered, and we could see plainly that our request met with no favourable reception. He replied with considerable energy and at some length.
While this was being translated, the chief frowned, and we could clearly see that our request was not well received. He responded with a lot of intensity and at some length.
“What says he?” inquired Jack.
“What does he say?” asked Jack.
“I regret to say that he will not listen to the proposal. He says he has pledged his word to his friend that the girl shall be sent to him, and a deputy even now on this island awaiting the fulfilment of the pledge.”
“I’m sorry to say that he won’t consider the proposal. He says he promised his friend that the girl will be sent to him, and there’s even a representative on this island right now waiting for the promise to be kept.”
Jack bit his lip in suppressed anger. “Tell Tararo,” he exclaimed with a flashing eye, “that if he does not grant my demand it will be worse for him. Say I have a big gun on board my schooner that will blow his village into the sea if he does not give up the girl.”
Jack bit his lip to hold back his anger. “Tell Tararo,” he said with a fierce look, “that if he doesn’t meet my demands, it’ll be bad for him. Let him know I have a powerful gun on my schooner that can destroy his village if he doesn’t hand over the girl.”
“Nay, my friend,” said the teacher gently, “I will not tell him that. We must ‘overcome evil with good.’”
“Nah, my friend,” the teacher said softly, “I won’t tell him that. We have to ‘overcome evil with good.’”
“What does my friend say?” inquired the chief, who seemed nettled by Jack’s looks of defiance.
“What does my friend say?” the chief asked, looking annoyed by Jack’s defiant expression.
“He is displeased,” replied the teacher.
"He's not happy," the teacher replied.
Tararo turned away with a smile of contempt, and walked towards the men who carried the baskets of vegetables, and who had now emptied the whole on the beach in an enormous pile.
Tararo turned away with a sneer and walked over to the men carrying the baskets of vegetables, which they had now dumped in a huge pile on the beach.
“What are they doing there?” I inquired.
“What are they doing there?” I asked.
“I think that they are laying out a gift which they intend to present to some one,” said the teacher.
“I think they’re preparing a gift that they plan to give to someone,” said the teacher.
At this moment a couple of men appeared, leading a young girl between them, and going towards the heap of fruits and vegetables, placed her on top of it. We started with surprise and fear, for in the young female before us we recognised the Samoan girl, Avatea.
At that moment, a couple of guys showed up, guiding a young girl between them, and headed towards the pile of fruits and vegetables, placing her on top of it. We were taken aback with shock and fear, for in the young woman before us, we recognized the Samoan girl, Avatea.
We stood rooted to the earth with surprise and thick-coming fears.
We stood frozen in place, shocked and filled with overwhelming fear.
“Oh my dear young friend!” whispered the teacher in a voice of deep emotion; while he seized Jack by the arm, “she is to be made a sacrifice even now!”
“Oh my dear young friend!” the teacher whispered, his voice filled with emotion as he grabbed Jack by the arm, “she is about to be sacrificed right now!”
“Is she?” cried Jack with a vehement shout, spurning the teacher aside, and dashing over two natives who stood in his way, while he rushed towards the heap, sprang up its side, and seized Avatea by the arm. In another moment he dragged her down, placed her back to a large tree, and wrenching a war-club from the hand of a native who seemed powerless and petrified with surprise, whirled it above his head, and yelled, rather than shouted, while his face blazed with fury, “Come on, the whole nation of you, an ye like it, and do your worst!”
“Is she?” Jack shouted fiercely, pushing the teacher aside and barreling past two natives who were in his way, as he rushed towards the pile, climbed up its side, and grabbed Avatea by the arm. Moments later, he pulled her down, positioned her against a large tree, and yanked a war club from the hand of a native who looked stunned and frozen with disbelief. He swung it above his head and yelled, more than shouted, with his face burning with rage, “Come on, all of you, if you want to, and give it your best shot!”
It seemed as though the challenge had been literally accepted; for every savage on the ground ran precipitately at Jack with club and spear, and doubtless would speedily have poured out his brave blood on the sod had not the teacher rushed in between them, and raising his voice to its utmost, cried:
It felt like the challenge had genuinely been taken; every savage on the ground rushed at Jack with clubs and spears, and would have quickly spilled his blood on the ground if the teacher hadn't jumped in between them and shouted at the top of his lungs:
“Stay your hands, warriors! It is not your part to judge in this matter! It is for Tararo, the chief, to say whether or not the young man shall live or die!”
“Hold on, warriors! It's not your place to decide this! It's up to Tararo, the chief, to determine whether the young man lives or dies!”
The natives were arrested; and I know not whether it was the gratifying acknowledgment of his superiority thus made by the teacher, or some lingering feeling of gratitude for Jack’s former aid in time of need, that influenced Tararo, but he stepped forward, and waving his hand, said to his people, “Desist. The young man’s life is mine.” Then turning to Jack, he said, “You have forfeited your liberty and life to me. Submit yourself, for we are more numerous than the sand upon the shore. You are but one: why should you die?”
The natives were arrested; and I don’t know if it was the pleasing recognition of his superiority from the teacher or some lingering sense of gratitude for Jack’s past help that influenced Tararo, but he stepped forward, waved his hand, and said to his people, “Stop. The young man’s life is mine.” Then turning to Jack, he said, “You have given up your freedom and your life to me. Surrender, for there are many more of us than there are grains of sand on the shore. You are just one: why should you die?”
“Villain!” exclaimed Jack passionately. “I may die, but assuredly I shall not perish alone! I will not submit until you promise that this girl shall not be injured!”
“Villain!” Jack shouted passionately. “I might die, but I won’t go down alone! I won’t back down until you promise that this girl won’t be harmed!”
“You are very bold,” replied the chief haughtily, “but very foolish. Yet I will say that Avatea shall not be sent away—at least, for three days.”
“You're really bold,” the chief replied arrogantly, “but also very foolish. However, I will say that Avatea will not be sent away—at least, not for three days.”
“You had better accept these terms,” whispered the teacher entreatingly. “If you persist in this mad defiance, you will be slain and Avatea will be lost. Three days are worth having.”
“You should accept these terms,” the teacher whispered urgently. “If you keep up this crazy defiance, you will be killed and Avatea will be lost. Three days are worth having.”
Jack hesitated a moment, then lowered his club, and throwing it moodily to the ground, crossed his arms on his breast and hung down his head in silence.
Jack paused for a moment, then lowered his club and, feeling down, tossed it to the ground. He crossed his arms over his chest and hung his head in silence.
Tararo seemed pleased by his submission, and told the teacher to say that he did not forget his former services, and therefore would leave him free as to his person, but that the schooner would be detained till he had further considered the matter.
Tararo looked satisfied with his submission and told the teacher to say that he remembered his past services, so he would leave him free regarding his person, but the schooner would be held until he had thought about it more.
While the teacher translated this, he approached as near to where Avatea was standing as possible without creating suspicion, and whispered to her a few words in the native language. Avatea, who, during the whole of the foregoing scene, had stood leaning against the tree perfectly passive, and seemingly quite uninterested in all that was going on, replied by a single rapid glance of her dark eye, which was instantly cast down again on the ground at her feet.
While the teacher translated this, he moved as close to where Avatea was standing as he could without raising any suspicion, and whispered a few words to her in the native language. Avatea, who had been leaning against the tree the entire time, perfectly still and seemingly indifferent to everything happening around her, responded with a quick look from her dark eye, which she immediately cast down to the ground at her feet.
Tararo now advanced, and taking the girl by the hand, led her unresistingly away; while Jack, Peterkin, and I returned with the teacher on board the schooner.
Tararo now moved forward, taking the girl by the hand and leading her away without any resistance, while Jack, Peterkin, and I went back with the teacher on the schooner.
On reaching the deck we went down to the cabin, where Jack threw himself, in a state of great dejection, on a couch; but the teacher seated himself by his side, and laying his hand upon his shoulder, said:
On reaching the deck, we went down to the cabin, where Jack threw himself onto a couch, feeling very down. However, the teacher sat beside him and, placing his hand on Jack's shoulder, said:
“Do not give way to anger, my young friend. God has given us three days, and we must use the means that are in our power to free this poor girl from slavery. We must not sit in idle disappointment; we must act—”
“Don’t let anger take over, my young friend. God has given us three days, and we need to use the resources we have to free this poor girl from slavery. We can't just sit around feeling disappointed; we must take action—”
“Act!” cried Jack, raising himself and tossing back his hair wildly. “It is mockery to talk of acting when one is bound hand and foot. How can I act? I cannot fight a whole nation of savages single-handed. Yes,” he said with a bitter smile, “I can fight them; but I cannot conquer them, or save Avatea.”
“Act!” shouted Jack, sitting up and tossing his hair back in frustration. “It's ridiculous to talk about acting when I'm tied up. How can I act? I can't take on an entire nation of savages by myself. Yes,” he said with a bitter smile, “I can fight them; but I can't defeat them or save Avatea.”
“Patience, my friend: your spirit is not a good one just now. You cannot expect that blessing which alone can ensure success unless you are more submissive. I will tell you my plans if you will listen.”
“Take it easy, my friend: you’re not in the best place mentally right now. You can’t expect the kind of blessing that guarantees success unless you’re more open to it. I’ll share my plans with you if you’re willing to listen.”
“Listen!” cried Jack eagerly. “Of course I will, my good fellow! I did not know you had any plans. Out with them! I only hope you will show me how I can get the girl on board of this schooner, and I’d up anchor and away in no time. But proceed with your plans.”
“Hey!” Jack said excitedly. “Of course I will, my friend! I didn’t realize you had any plans. Spill them! I just hope you can tell me how to get the girl on this schooner, and I’ll be off in no time. But go ahead with your plans.”
The teacher smiled sadly. “Ah, my friend, if one fathom of your anchor-chain were to rattle as you drew it in, a thousand warriors would be standing on your deck! No, no; that could not be done. Even now your ship would be taken from you were it not that Tararo has some feeling of gratitude towards you. But I know Tararo well. He is a man of falsehood, as all the unconverted savages are. The chief to whom he has promised this girl is very powerful, and Tararo must fulfil his promise. He has told you that he would do nothing to the girl for three days, but that is because the party who are to take her away will not be ready to start for three days. Still, as he might have made you a prisoner during those three days, I say that God has given them to us.”
The teacher smiled sadly. “Ah, my friend, if just one part of your anchor chain were to rattle as you pulled it in, a thousand warriors would be standing on your deck! No, no; that can’t happen. Even now, your ship would be taken from you if it weren’t for Tararo having some sense of gratitude towards you. But I know Tararo well. He’s a man of lies, like all the unconverted savages. The chief he promised this girl to is very powerful, and Tararo *must* keep his promise. He told you he wouldn’t do anything to the girl for three days, but that’s only because the group coming to take her won’t be ready to leave for three days. Still, since he could have made you a prisoner during those three days, I say that God has given us this time.”
“Well, but what do you propose to do?” said Jack impatiently.
“Well, what do you want to do?” Jack asked impatiently.
“My plan involves much danger; but I see no other, and I think you have courage to brave it. It is this. There is an island about fifty miles to the south of this, the natives of which are Christians, and have been so for two years or more, and the principal chief is Avatea’s lover. Once there, Avatea would be safe. Now, I suggest that you should abandon your schooner. Do you think that you can make so great a sacrifice?”
“My plan carries a lot of risks, but I don’t see any other options, and I believe you have the courage to face it. Here’s the idea: there’s an island about fifty miles south of here, where the locals are Christians and have been for over two years, and the main chief is Avatea’s partner. Once there, Avatea would be safe. I propose that you should leave your schooner behind. Do you think you can make such a big sacrifice?”
“Friend,” replied Jack, “when I make up my mind to go through with a thing of importance, I can make any sacrifice.”
"Friend," Jack replied, "when I decide to follow through on something important, I'm willing to make any sacrifice."
The teacher smiled. “Well, then, the savages could not conceive it possible that for the sake of a girl you would voluntarily lose your fine vessel; therefore, as long as she lies here, they think they have you all safe. So I suggest that we get a quantity of stores conveyed to a sequestered part of the shore, provide a small canoe, put Avatea on board, and you three would paddle to the Christian island.”
The teacher smiled. “So, the savages can’t imagine that you’d willingly give up your great ship for a girl; as long as she’s here, they believe they have you all under control. I recommend that we move a supply of goods to a hidden spot on the shore, arrange for a small canoe, put Avatea on board, and then you three can paddle to the Christian island.”
“Bravo!” cried Peterkin, springing up and seizing the teacher’s hand. “Missionary, you’re a regular brick! I didn’t think you had so much in you!”
“Bravo!” shouted Peterkin, jumping up and grabbing the teacher’s hand. “Missionary, you’re awesome! I didn’t think you had this much in you!”
“As for me,” continued the teacher, “I will remain on board till they discover that you are gone. Then they will ask me where you are gone to, and I will refuse to tell.”
“As for me,” the teacher continued, “I’ll stay on board until they realize you’re missing. Then they’ll ask me where you went, and I’ll refuse to say.”
“And what’ll be the result of that?” inquired Jack.
“And what will be the result of that?” Jack asked.
“I know not. Perhaps they will kill me; but,” he added, looking at Jack with a peculiar smile, “I too am not afraid to die in a good cause!”
“I don’t know. They might kill me; but,” he added, looking at Jack with a strange smile, “I’m also not afraid to die for a good cause!”
“But how are we to get hold of Avatea?” inquired Jack.
“But how are we supposed to find Avatea?” Jack asked.
“I have arranged with her to meet us at a particular spot, to which I will guide you to-night. We shall then arrange about it. She will easily manage to elude her keepers, who are not very strict in watching her, thinking it impossible that she could escape from the island. Indeed, I am sure that such an idea will never enter their heads. But, as I have said, you run great danger. Fifty miles in a small canoe, on the open sea, is a great voyage to make. You may miss the island, too, in which case there is no other in that direction for a hundred miles or more; and if you lose your way and fall among other heathens, you know the law of Feejee—a castaway who gains the shore is doomed to die. You must count the cost, my young friend.”
“I’ve set up a meeting with her at a specific spot that I’ll take you to tonight. We can figure things out then. She’ll have no trouble sneaking away from her guards, who aren’t very strict in watching her, thinking it’s impossible for her to escape the island. Honestly, I’m sure they’d never even consider that. But, like I said, you’re taking a huge risk. Fifty miles in a small canoe on the open sea is quite a journey. You might miss the island entirely, and if you do, there's no other land for a hundred miles or more in that direction; if you get lost and end up among other tribes, you know the law of Feejee—a shipwrecked person who reaches the shore is destined to die. You really need to think this through, my young friend.”
“I have counted it,” replied Jack. “If Avatea consents to run the risk, most certainly I will; and so will my comrades also. Besides,” added Jack, looking seriously into the teacher’s face, “your Bible—our Bible—tells of One who delivers those who call on Him in the time of trouble; who holds the winds in His fists, and the waters in the hollow of His hand.”
“I’ve counted on it,” Jack replied. “If Avatea is willing to take the risk, then I definitely will; and so will my friends. Besides,” Jack added, looking seriously at the teacher, “your Bible—our Bible—talks about One who rescues those who call on Him when they’re in trouble; who holds the winds in His hands and the waters in the palm of His hand.”
We now set about active preparations for the intended voyage: collected together such things as we should require, and laid out on the deck provisions sufficient to maintain us for several weeks, purposing to load the canoe with as much as she could hold consistently with speed and safety. These we covered with a tarpaulin, intending to convey them to the canoe only a few hours before starting. When night spread her sable curtain over the scene, we prepared to land; but first kneeling along with the natives and the teacher, the latter implored a blessing on our enterprise. Then we rowed quietly to the shore and followed our sable guide, who led us by a long détour in order to avoid the village, to the place of rendezvous. We had not stood more than five minutes under the gloomy shade of the thick foliage when a dark figure glided noiselessly up to us.
We began preparing actively for the upcoming voyage, gathering everything we would need and laying out enough provisions on the deck to last us several weeks. We planned to load the canoe with as much as it could carry without compromising speed and safety. We covered the supplies with a tarp, intending to move them to the canoe just a few hours before departure. As night fell, we got ready to land. First, we kneeled with the locals and the teacher, who asked for a blessing on our journey. Then, we quietly rowed to shore and followed our dark guide, who led us in a long detour to avoid the village, heading to our meeting spot. We had only been standing for about five minutes under the thick, gloomy shade when a dark figure quietly approached us.
“Ah, here you are!” said Jack as Avatea approached.—“Now, then, tell her what we’ve come about, and don’t waste time.”
“Hey, there you are!” Jack said as Avatea came closer.—“Alright, tell her why we’re here, and let’s not waste any time.”
“I understan’ leetl’ English,” said Avatea in a low voice.
“I understand a little English,” said Avatea in a low voice.
“Why, where did you pick up English?” exclaimed Jack in amazement. “You were dumb as a stone when I saw you last.”
“Wow, where did you learn English?” Jack exclaimed in surprise. “You were as quiet as a rock the last time I saw you.”
“She has learned all she knows of it from me,” said the teacher, “since she came to the island.”
“She has learned everything she knows about it from me,” said the teacher, “ever since she arrived on the island.”
We now gave Avatea a full explanation of our plans, entering into all the details, and concealing none of the danger, so that she might be fully aware of the risk she ran. As we had anticipated, she was too glad of the opportunity thus afforded her to escape from her persecutors to think of the danger or risk.
We now provided Avatea with a complete rundown of our plans, covering all the details and not hiding any of the dangers, so she would know exactly what risks she was facing. As we expected, she was so grateful for the chance to escape from her tormentors that she didn't consider the dangers or risks involved.
“Then you’re willing to go with us, are you?” said Jack.
“Then you're gonna come with us, right?” said Jack.
“Yis, I willing to go.”
"Yes, I am willing to go."
“And you’re not afraid to trust yourself out on the deep sea so far?”
“And you’re not scared to trust yourself out in the deep sea this far?”
“No, I not ’fraid to go. Safe with Christian.”
“No, I'm not afraid to go. I'm safe with Christian.”
After some further consultation the teacher suggested that it was time to return, so we bade Avatea good-night; and having appointed to meet at the cliff where the canoe lay on the following night, just after dark, we hastened away—we to row back to the schooner with muffled oars, Avatea to glide back to her prison-hut among the Mango savages.
After some more discussion, the teacher suggested it was time to go back, so we said goodnight to Avatea. We planned to meet at the cliff where the canoe was the next night, just after dark, and then we quickly left—we headed back to the schooner with silent oars, while Avatea slipped back to her prison hut among the Mango tribes.
Chapter Thirty Three.
The flight—The pursuit—Despair and its results—The lion bearded in his den again—Awful danger threatened and wonderfully averted—A terrific storm.
As the time for our meditated flight drew near, we became naturally very fearful lest our purpose should be discovered, and we spent the whole of the following day in a state of nervous anxiety. We resolved to go ashore and ramble about the village, as if to observe the habits and dwellings of the people, as we thought that an air of affected indifference to the events of the previous day would be more likely than any other course of conduct to avert suspicion as to our intentions. While we were thus occupied, the teacher remained on board with the Christian natives, whose powerful voices reached us ever and anon as they engaged in singing hymns or in prayer.
As the time for our planned escape approached, we naturally felt very anxious that our plan might be discovered, and we spent the entire next day in a state of nervous worry. We decided to go ashore and stroll around the village, pretending to observe the habits and homes of the locals, thinking that acting indifferent to the events of the previous day would be the best way to avoid raising any suspicion about our intentions. While we were occupied with this, the teacher stayed on the boat with the Christian natives, whose strong voices occasionally reached us as they sang hymns or prayed.
At last the long and tedious day came to a close, the sun sank into the sea, and the short-lived twilight of those regions, to which I have already referred, ended abruptly in a dark night. Hastily throwing a few blankets into our little boat, we stepped into it, and whispering farewell to the natives in the schooner, rowed gently over the lagoon, taking care to keep as near to the beach as possible. We rowed in the utmost silence and with muffled oars, so that had any one observed us at the distance of a few yards, he might have almost taken us for a phantom boat or a shadow on the dark water. Not a breath of air was stirring; but fortunately the gentle ripple of the sea upon the shore, mingled with the soft roar of the breaker on the distant reef, effectually drowned the slight plash that we unavoidably made in the water by the dipping of our oars.
At last, the long and tedious day came to an end, the sun sank into the sea, and the brief twilight of those regions, which I've mentioned before, suddenly faded into a dark night. Quickly tossing a few blankets into our small boat, we climbed in and whispered goodbye to the natives on the schooner, then gently rowed across the lagoon, making sure to stay as close to the beach as possible. We rowed in complete silence with muffled oars, so that if anyone had seen us from just a few yards away, they might have mistaken us for a ghost boat or a shadow on the dark water. Not a breath of air was blowing; but luckily, the gentle ripple of the sea on the shore, mixed with the soft roar of the breakers on the distant reef, effectively drowned out the slight splash we made in the water with our oars.
A quarter of an hour sufficed to bring us to the overhanging cliff under whose black shadow our little canoe lay, with her bow in the water, ready to be launched, and most of her cargo already stowed away. As the keel of our little boat grated on the sand, a hand was laid upon the bow, and a dim form was seen.
Fifteen minutes was enough to get us to the overhanging cliff where our little canoe rested in the dark shadow, with its bow in the water, ready to go, and most of its cargo already packed. As the bottom of our little boat scraped against the sand, a hand appeared on the bow, and a faint figure was visible.
“Ha!” said Peterkin in a whisper as he stepped upon the beach; “is that you, Avatea?”
“Ha!” Peterkin whispered as he stepped onto the beach, “Is that you, Avatea?”
“Yis, it am me,” was the reply.
“Yeah, it's me,” was the reply.
“All right—Now, then, gently—Help me to shove off the canoe,” whispered Jack to the teacher.—“And, Peterkin, do you shove these blankets aboard; we may want them before long.—Avatea, step into the middle: that’s right.”
“All right—Now, easy—Help me push the canoe off,” Jack whispered to the teacher. “And, Peterkin, you grab these blankets and load them in; we might need them soon. Avatea, step into the middle: that’s right.”
“Is all ready?” whispered the teacher.
“Is everything ready?” whispered the teacher.
“Not quite,” replied Peterkin.—“Here, Ralph, lay hold o’ this pair of oars, and stow them away if you can. I don’t like paddles. After we’re safe away, I’ll try to rig up rowlocks for them.”
“Not quite,” replied Peterkin. “Here, Ralph, grab this pair of oars and put them away if you can. I don’t like paddles. Once we’re safe, I’ll try to set up rowlocks for them.”
“Now, then, in with you and shove off!”
“Alright, come on in and get going!”
One more earnest squeeze of the kind teacher’s hand, and with his whispered blessing yet sounding in our ears, we shot like an arrow from the shore, sped over the still waters of the lagoon, and paddled as swiftly as strong arms and willing hearts could urge us over the long swell of the open sea.
One more tight squeeze of the kind teacher’s hand, and with his whispered blessing still ringing in our ears, we shot like an arrow from the shore, sped over the calm waters of the lagoon, and paddled as quickly as our strong arms and eager hearts could push us over the long swell of the open sea.
All that night and the whole of the following day we plied our paddles in almost total silence and without a halt, save twice to recruit our failing energies with a mouthful of food and a draught of water. Jack had taken the bearing of the island just after starting, and laying a small pocket-compass before him, kept the head of the canoe due south, for our chance of hitting the island depended very much on the faithfulness of our steersman in keeping our tiny bark exactly and constantly on its proper course. Peterkin and I paddled in the bow, and Avatea worked untiringly in the middle.
All that night and the entire next day, we paddled in almost complete silence without stopping, except twice to grab a bite to eat and take a sip of water. Jack had taken the island's bearing right after we set off and, using a small pocket compass, kept the canoe heading due south because our chance of reaching the island relied heavily on our steersman staying on course. Peterkin and I paddled at the front, while Avatea tirelessly worked in the middle.
As the sun’s lower limb dipped on the gilded edge of the sea Jack ceased working, threw down his paddle, and called a halt.
As the sun's bottom edge sank into the sparkling sea, Jack stopped working, dropped his paddle, and called it a day.
“There!” he cried, heaving a deep, long-drawn sigh; “we’ve put a considerable breadth of water between us and these black rascals, so now we’ll have a hearty supper and a sound sleep.”
“There!” he exclaimed, letting out a deep, long sigh. “We’ve put a good distance between us and those nasty guys, so now we can have a nice dinner and a good night’s sleep.”
“Hear, hear!” cried Peterkin. “Nobly spoken, Jack!—Hand me a drop of water, Ralph.—Why, girl, what’s wrong with you? You look just like a black owl blinking in the sunshine!”
“Hear, hear!” shouted Peterkin. “Well said, Jack!—Give me a sip of water, Ralph.—Hey, girl, what’s wrong with you? You look just like a black owl squinting in the sunlight!”
Avatea smiled. “I sleepy,” she said; and as if to prove the truth of this, she laid her head on the edge of the canoe and fell fast asleep.
Avatea smiled. “I’m sleepy,” she said; and to show how true it was, she rested her head on the edge of the canoe and fell fast asleep.
“That’s uncommon sharp practice,” said Peterkin with a broad grin. “Don’t you think we should awake her to make her eat something first? Or perhaps,” he added with a grave, meditative look—“perhaps we might put some food in her mouth, which is so elegantly open at the present moment, and see if she’d swallow it while asleep.—If so, Ralph, you might come round to the front here and feed her quietly, while Jack and I are tucking into the victuals. It would be a monstrous economy of time.”
“That’s some pretty underhanded thinking,” said Peterkin with a wide grin. “Don’t you think we should wake her up to eat something first? Or maybe,” he added with a serious, thoughtful expression—“maybe we could put some food in her mouth, which is conveniently open right now, and see if she’d swallow it while she’s still asleep.—If that works, Ralph, you could come over here and feed her quietly while Jack and I dig into the food. It’d save us a lot of time.”
I could not help smiling at Peterkin’s idea, which indeed, when I pondered it, seemed remarkably good in theory; nevertheless, I declined to put it in practice, being fearful of the result should the victuals chance to go down the wrong throat. But on suggesting this to Peterkin, he exclaimed:
I couldn't help but smile at Peterkin's idea, which, when I thought about it, actually seemed really good in theory. However, I decided not to try it out because I was worried about what could happen if the food went down the wrong way. But when I brought this up to Peterkin, he shouted:
“Down the wrong throat, man! Why, a fellow with half-an-eye might see that if it went down Avatea’s throat it could not go down the wrong throat!—unless, indeed, you have all of a sudden become inordinately selfish, and think that all the throats in the world are wrong ones except your own. However, don’t talk so much, and hand me the pork before Jack finishes it. I feel myself entitled to at least one minute morsel.”
“Down the wrong throat, man! Anyone with half an eye could see that if it went down Avatea’s throat, it couldn’t go down the wrong throat!—unless you’ve suddenly become incredibly selfish and think all the throats in the world are wrong except your own. Anyway, stop talking so much and pass me the pork before Jack eats it all. I deserve at least one bite.”
“Peterkin, you’re a villain—a paltry little villain!” said Jack quietly as he tossed the hind legs (including the tail) of a cold roast pig to his comrade; “and I must again express my regret that unavoidable circumstances have thrust your society upon me, and that necessity has compelled me to cultivate your acquaintance. Were it not that you are incapable of walking upon the water, I would order you, sir, out of the canoe!”
“Peterkin, you’re a jerk—a pathetic little jerk!” said Jack quietly as he tossed the hind legs (including the tail) of a cold roast pig to his friend; “and I must say again how sorry I am that unavoidable circumstances have forced your company on me, and that necessity has made me get to know you. If it weren't for the fact that you can't walk on water, I would kick you out of the canoe right now!”
“There! you’ve awakened Avatea with your long tongue,” retorted Peterkin, with a frown, as the girl gave vent to a deep sigh. “No,” he continued, “it was only a snore. Perchance she dreameth of her black Apollo.—I say, Ralph, do leave just one little slice of that yam! Between you and Jack I run a chance of being put on short allowance, if not—yei-a-a-ow!”
“There! You’ve woken Avatea up with your constant chatter,” Peterkin said, frowning as the girl let out a deep sigh. “No,” he continued, “that was just a snore. Maybe she’s dreaming about her dark Apollo.—Hey, Ralph, can you just save me one tiny slice of that yam? With you and Jack around, I might end up with hardly any if not—yei-a-a-ow!”
Peterkin’s concluding remark was a yawn of so great energy that Jack recommended him to postpone the conclusion of his meal till next morning—a piece of advice which he followed so quickly that I was forcibly reminded of his remark, a few minutes before, in regard to the sharp practice of Avatea.
Peterkin’s final comment was such an exaggerated yawn that Jack suggested he finish his meal in the morning—a piece of advice he took so quickly that it made me remember something he had said a few minutes earlier about the sneaky behavior of Avatea.
My readers will have observed, probably, by this time, that I am much given to meditation: they will not, therefore, be surprised to learn that I fell into a deep reverie on the subject of sleep, which was continued without intermission into the night, and prolonged without interruption into the following morning. But I cannot feel assured that I actually slept during that time, although I am tolerably certain that I was not awake.
My readers have probably noticed by now that I tend to meditate a lot; so they won’t be surprised to hear that I fell into a deep thought about sleep, which carried on without pause into the night and continued without break into the following morning. However, I can’t be sure that I actually slept during that time, although I’m fairly certain that I wasn’t awake.
Thus we lay, like a shadow, on the still bosom of the ocean, while the night closed in, and all around was calm, dark, and silent.
Thus we lay, like a shadow, on the still surface of the ocean, as night fell, and all around was calm, dark, and silent.
A thrilling cry of alarm from Peterkin startled us in the morning, just as the grey dawn began to glimmer in the east.
A loud cry of alarm from Peterkin woke us up in the morning, just as the grey dawn started to appear in the east.
“What’s wrong?” cried Jack, starting up.
“What’s wrong?” Jack exclaimed, sitting up abruptly.
Peterkin replied by pointing, with a look of anxious dread, towards the horizon; and a glance sufficed to show us that one of the largest-sized war-canoes was approaching us!
Peterkin replied by pointing, with a look of worried fear, towards the horizon; and a quick look was enough to reveal that one of the biggest war canoes was coming our way!
With a groan of mingled despair and anger, Jack seized his paddle, glanced at the compass, and in a suppressed voice commanded us to “Give way!” But we did not require to be urged. Already our four paddles were glancing in the water, and the canoe bounded over the glassy sea like a dolphin, while a shout from our pursuers told that they had observed our motions.
With a mix of frustration and anger, Jack grabbed his paddle, looked at the compass, and quietly told us to "Get moving!" But we didn’t need any encouragement. Our four paddles were already slicing through the water, and the canoe sprang over the smooth sea like a dolphin, while a shout from our chasers indicated that they had noticed what we were doing.
“I see something like land ahead,” said Jack in a hopeful tone. “It seems impossible that we could have made the island yet; still, if it is so, we may reach it before these fellows can catch us, for our canoe is light and our muscles are fresh.”
“I see what looks like land up ahead,” Jack said hopefully. “It seems unlikely that we've reached the island already; still, if it is, we might get there before those guys can catch us, since our canoe is light and our muscles are feeling good.”
No one replied; for, to say truth, we felt that in a long chase we had no chance whatever with a canoe which held nearly a hundred warriors. Nevertheless, we resolved to do our utmost to escape, and paddled with a degree of vigour that kept us well in advance of our pursuers. The war-canoe was so far behind us that it seemed but a little speck on the sea, and the shouts to which the crew occasionally gave vent came faintly towards us on the morning breeze. We therefore hoped that we should be able to keep in advance for an hour or two, when we might perhaps reach the land ahead. But this hope was suddenly crushed by the supposed land, not long after, rising up into the sky, thus proving itself to be a fog-bank!
No one answered because, to be honest, we realized that in a long chase we had no chance against a canoe carrying almost a hundred warriors. Still, we decided to do everything we could to escape and paddled with enough energy to stay well ahead of our pursuers. The war canoe was so far behind that it looked like a tiny dot on the sea, and the shouts from the crew occasionally reached us faintly on the morning breeze. So, we hoped we could stay ahead for an hour or two, and maybe reach the land ahead. But this hope was suddenly shattered when what we thought was land rose up into the sky, revealing itself to be a fog bank!
A bitter feeling of disappointment filled each heart, and was expressed on each countenance, as we beheld this termination to our hopes. But we had little time to think of regret. Our danger was too great and imminent to permit of a moment’s relaxation from our exertions. No hope now animated our bosoms; but a feeling of despair, strange to say, lent us power to work, and nerved our arms with such energy that it was several hours ere the savages overtook us. When we saw that there was indeed no chance of escape, and that paddling any longer would only serve to exhaust our strength without doing any good, we turned the side of our canoe towards the approaching enemy and laid down our paddles.
A deep sense of disappointment filled everyone's hearts and showed on our faces as we faced the end of our hopes. But we had little time to dwell on regret. Our danger was too severe and immediate to allow for even a moment of rest. We had no hope left, but strangely, the sense of despair actually gave us the strength to keep going, and fueled our arms with such energy that it took several hours for the savages to catch up with us. When we realized there was no real chance of escaping and that paddling any longer would just wear us out without making a difference, we turned our canoe toward the approaching enemy and laid down our paddles.
Silently, and with a look of bitter determination on his face, Jack lifted one of the light boat-oars that we had brought with us, and resting it on his shoulder, stood up in an attitude of bold defiance. Peterkin took the other oar and also stood up, but there was no anger visible on his countenance: when not sparkling with fun, it usually wore a mild, sad expression, which was deepened on the present occasion as he glanced at Avatea, who sat with her face resting in her hands upon her knees. Without knowing very well what I intended to do, I also arose and grasped my paddle with both hands.
Silently, with a fierce look on his face, Jack picked up one of the light boat oars we had brought along, resting it on his shoulder as he stood up in a bold stance. Peterkin grabbed the other oar and stood up too, but there was no anger on his face; when he wasn’t beaming with laughter, he usually had a gentle, sad expression, which was even more noticeable now as he looked at Avatea, who sat with her face in her hands resting on her knees. Not entirely sure of my plan, I also got up and took hold of my paddle with both hands.
On came the large canoe like a war-horse of the deep, with the foam curling from its sharp bow, and the spear-heads of the savages glancing in the beams of the rising sun. Perfect silence was maintained on both sides; and we could hear the hissing water, and see the frowning eyes of the warriors, as they came rushing on. When about twenty yards distant, five or six of the savages in the bow rose, and laying aside their paddles, took up their spears. Jack and Peterkin raised their oars, while, with a feeling of madness whirling in my brain, I grasped my paddle and prepared for the onset. But before any of us could strike a blow, the sharp prow of the war-canoe struck us like a thunderbolt on the side and hurled us into the sea!
On came the large canoe like a war-horse of the sea, with foam curling from its sharp bow, and the spear-heads of the warriors glinting in the beams of the rising sun. There was complete silence on both sides; we could hear the hissing water and see the fierce eyes of the fighters as they charged toward us. When they were about twenty yards away, five or six of the warriors in the front stood up, put their paddles aside, and grabbed their spears. Jack and Peterkin raised their oars, while I, feeling a surge of chaos in my mind, clutched my paddle and braced for the attack. But before any of us could swing a blow, the sharp prow of the war-canoe hit us like a thunderbolt on the side and threw us into the sea!
What occurred after this I cannot tell, for I was nearly drowned; but when I recovered from the state of insensibility into which I had been thrown, I found myself stretched on my back, bound hand and foot, between Jack and Peterkin, in the bottom of the large canoe.
What happened after that, I can't say, because I was almost drowned; but when I came to from the unconscious state I had fallen into, I found myself lying on my back, tied hand and foot, between Jack and Peterkin, in the bottom of the big canoe.
In this condition we lay the whole day, during which time the savages only rested one hour. When night came they rested again for another hour, and appeared to sleep just as they sat. But we were neither unbound nor allowed to speak to each other during the voyage, nor was a morsel of food or a draught of water given to us. For food, however, we cared little; but we would have given much for a drop of water to cool our parched lips. And we would have been glad, too, had they loosened the cords that bound us; for they were tightly fastened, and occasioned us much pain. The air, also, was unusually hot—so much so that I felt convinced that a storm was brewing. This also added to our sufferings. However, these were at length relieved by our arrival at the island from which we had fled.
In this condition, we lay the entire day, during which the savages only took one hour of rest. When night came, they rested again for another hour and seemed to sleep while sitting. However, we were neither untied nor allowed to talk to each other during the journey, and we didn't receive a crumb of food or a sip of water. We cared little for food; we would have given a lot for a drop of water to cool our dry lips. We also would have been grateful if they had loosened the ropes binding us, as they were tied tightly and caused us much pain. The air was unusually hot—so much so that I was convinced a storm was on the way. This too added to our discomfort. However, our suffering was finally eased by our arrival at the island from which we had escaped.
While we were being led ashore, we caught a glimpse of Avatea, who was seated in the hinder part of the canoe. She was not fettered in any way. Our captors now drove us before them towards the hut of Tararo, at which we speedily arrived, and found the chief seated with an expression on his face that boded us no good. Our friend the teacher stood beside him, with a look of anxiety on his mild features.
While we were being led ashore, we spotted Avatea, who was sitting at the back of the canoe. She wasn't tied up at all. Our captors urged us forward toward Tararo's hut, which we reached quickly, and saw the chief sitting there with a look that didn't promise anything good for us. Our friend the teacher stood next to him, looking anxious on his gentle face.
“How comes it,” said Tararo, turning to the teacher, “that these youths have abused our hospitality?”
“How is it,” said Tararo, turning to the teacher, “that these young people have taken advantage of our hospitality?”
“Tell him,” replied Jack, “that we have not abused his hospitality, for his hospitality has not been extended to us. I came to the island to deliver Avatea, and my only regret is that I have failed to do so. If I get another chance, I will try to save her yet.”
“Tell him,” Jack replied, “that we haven't taken advantage of his hospitality because he hasn't offered us any. I came to the island to bring Avatea, and my only regret is that I couldn't do that. If I get another chance, I'll try to save her still.”
The teacher shook his head. “Nay, my young friend, I had better not tell him that: it will only incense him.”
The teacher shook his head. “No, my young friend, I’d better not tell him that: it will just make him angry.”
“I care not,” replied Jack. “If you don’t tell him that, you’ll tell him nothing, for I won’t say anything softer.”
“I don't care,” replied Jack. “If you don’t tell him that, you won’t tell him anything, because I won’t say anything nicer.”
On hearing Jack’s speech, Tararo frowned, and his eye flashed with anger.
On hearing Jack's speech, Tararo frowned, and his eyes flashed with anger.
“Go, presumptuous boy!” he said. “My debt to you cancelled. You and your companions shall die!”
“Get lost, arrogant kid!” he said. “I’m done with you. You and your friends will die!”
As he spoke he rose and signed to several of attendants, who seized Jack and Peterkin and violently by the collars, and dragging us from the house of the chief, led us through the wood to the outskirts of the village. Here they thrust us into a species of natural cave in a cliff, and having barricaded the entrance, left us in total darkness.
As he talked, he stood up and gestured to a few attendants, who grabbed Jack and Peterkin by the collars and forcefully pulled us out of the chief's house, leading us through the woods to the edge of the village. There, they shoved us into a kind of natural cave in a cliff, and after blocking the entrance, left us in complete darkness.
After feeling about for some time—for our legs were unshackled, although our wrists were still bound with thongs—we found a low ledge of rock running along one side of the cavern. On this we seated ourselves, and for a long time maintained unbroken silence.
After searching around for a while—since our legs were free, but our wrists were still tied—we found a low rock ledge along one side of the cave. We sat down on it and stayed silent for a long time.
At last I could restrain my feelings no longer. “Alas! dear Jack and Peterkin,” said I, “what is to become of us? I fear that we are doomed to die.”
At last, I couldn’t hold back my feelings anymore. “Oh no! dear Jack and Peterkin,” I said, “what’s going to happen to us? I’m worried that we’re destined to die.”
“I know not,” replied Jack in a tremulous voice—“I know not. Ralph, I regret deeply the hastiness of my violent temper, which, I must confess, has been the chief cause of our being brought to this sad condition. Perhaps the teacher may do something for us. But I have little hope.”
“I don’t know,” Jack replied with a shaky voice. “I don’t know. Ralph, I deeply regret how quickly I lost my temper, which, I have to admit, has been the main reason we ended up in this unfortunate situation. Maybe the teacher can help us. But I have little hope.”
“Ah no!” said Peterkin with a heavy sigh; “I am sure he can’t help us. Tararo doesn’t care more for him than for one of his dogs.”
“Ah no!” Peterkin said with a heavy sigh. “I’m sure he can’t help us. Tararo doesn’t care about him any more than one of his dogs.”
“Truly,” said I, “there seems no chance of deliverance, unless the Almighty puts forth His arm to save us. Yet I must say I have great hope, my comrades; for we have come to this dark place by no fault of ours—unless it be a fault to try to succour a woman in distress.”
“Honestly,” I said, “it seems like there’s no way out, unless God intervenes to save us. Still, I have a lot of hope, my friends; because we ended up in this dark place through no fault of our own—unless trying to help a woman in trouble is considered a fault.”
I was interrupted in my remarks by a noise at the entrance to the cavern, which was caused by the removal of the barricade. Immediately after three men entered, and taking us by the collars of our coats, led us away through the forest. As we advanced we heard much shouting and beating of native drums in the village, and at first we thought that our guards were conducting us to the hut of Tararo again. But in this we were mistaken. The beating of drums gradually increased, and soon after we observed a procession of the natives coming towards us. At the head of this procession we were placed, and then we all advanced together towards the temple where human victims were wont to be sacrificed!
I was cut off in my speech by a noise at the entrance to the cave, caused by the removal of the barricade. Right after that, three men came in and grabbed us by the collars of our coats, leading us away through the forest. As we walked, we heard a lot of shouting and the beating of native drums coming from the village, and at first, we thought our captors were taking us back to Tararo's hut. But we were wrong. The drumbeats grew louder, and soon we saw a parade of natives coming toward us. We were put at the front of this procession, and then we all moved together toward the temple where human sacrifices were usually made!
A thrill of horror ran through my heart as I recalled to mind the awful scenes that I had before witnessed at that dreadful spot. But deliverance came suddenly from a quarter whence we little expected it. During the whole of that day there had been an unusual degree of heat in the atmosphere, and the sky assumed that lurid aspect which portends a thunderstorm. Just as we were approaching the horrid temple, a growl of thunder burst overhead, and heavy drops of rain began to fall.
A chill of fear ran through my heart as I remembered the terrible scenes I had seen at that awful place. But help came unexpectedly from a direction we didn't anticipate. Throughout that day, the heat in the air was unusually intense, and the sky took on a grim look that suggested a thunderstorm. Just as we were getting close to the frightening temple, a growl of thunder rumbled above us, and heavy raindrops started to fall.
Those who have not witnessed gales and storms in tropical regions can form but a faint conception of the fearful hurricane that burst upon the island of Mango at this time. Before we reached the temple the storm burst upon us with a deafening roar; and the natives, who knew too well the devastation that was to follow, fled right and left through the woods in order to save their property, leaving us alone in the midst of the howling storm. The trees around us bent before the blast like willows, and we were about to flee in order to seek shelter when the teacher ran toward us with a knife in his hand.
Those who haven't experienced hurricanes and storms in tropical areas can only have a vague idea of the terrifying hurricane that hit the island of Mango at this moment. Before we arrived at the temple, the storm hit us with a thunderous roar; the locals, who were all too familiar with the destruction that was about to happen, ran in all directions through the woods to save their belongings, leaving us alone in the middle of the raging storm. The trees around us bent in the wind like willows, and just as we were about to run for cover, the teacher came running toward us with a knife in his hand.
“Thank the Lord,” he said, cutting our bonds, “I am in time! Now, seek the shelter of the nearest rock.”
“Thank God,” he said, cutting our ties, “I made it just in time! Now, find the nearest rock for shelter.”
This we did without a moment’s hesitation, for the whistling wind burst, ever and anon, like thunderclaps among the trees, and tearing them from their roots, hurled them with violence to the ground. Rain cut across the land in sheets, and lightning played like forked serpents in the air, while high above the roar of the hissing tempest the thunder crashed and burst and rolled in awful majesty.
We did this without a second thought, as the howling wind erupted every now and then, like thunder among the trees, ripping them from their roots and violently throwing them to the ground. Rain poured down in sheets, and lightning flashed like forked snakes in the sky, while high above the deafening storm, the thunder crashed, echoed, and rolled with terrifying grandeur.
In the village the scene was absolutely appalling. Roofs were blown completely off the houses in many cases, and in others the houses themselves were levelled with the ground. In the midst of this the natives were darting to and fro—in some instances saving their goods, but in many others seeking to save themselves from the storm of destruction that whirled around them. But terrific although the tempest was on land, it was still more tremendous on the mighty ocean. Billows sprang, as it were, from the great deep, and while their crests were absolutely scattered into white mist, they fell upon the beach with a crash that seemed to shake the solid land. But they did not end there. Each successive wave swept higher and higher on the beach until the ocean lashed its angry waters among the trees and bushes, and at length, in a sheet of white, curdled foam, swept into the village and upset and carried off, or dashed into wreck, whole rows of the native dwellings! It was a sublime, an awful scene, calculated, in some degree at least, to impress the mind of beholders with the might and majesty of God.
In the village, the scene was absolutely devastating. In many cases, roofs were completely blown off the houses, and in others, the houses themselves were flattened to the ground. Amidst this chaos, the locals were rushing around—sometimes saving their belongings, but often trying to escape the storm of destruction that surrounded them. But as terrible as the storm was on land, it was even more intense on the vast ocean. Waves surged forth from the deep, and while their crests were scattered into white mist, they crashed onto the beach with a force that seemed to shake the earth itself. But that wasn't the end. Each wave grew higher and higher on the beach until the ocean lashed its furious waters among the trees and bushes, and finally, in a torrent of white, foamy spray, swept into the village, uprooting and destroying whole rows of homes! It was a magnificent, terrifying scene, likely intended, at least in some way, to impress onlookers with the power and majesty of God.
We found shelter in a cave that night and all the next day, during which time the storm raged in fury. But on the night following, it abated somewhat; and in the morning we went to the village to seek for food, being so famished with hunger that we lost all feeling of danger and all wish to escape in our desire to satisfy the cravings of nature. But no sooner had we obtained food than we began to wish that we had rather endeavoured to make our escape into the mountains. This we attempted to do soon afterwards; but the natives were now able to look after us, and on our showing a disposition to avoid observation and make towards the mountains, we were seized by three warriors, who once more bound our wrists and thrust us into our former prison.
We found shelter in a cave that night and all the next day, while the storm raged intensely. But on the following night, it calmed down a bit, and in the morning we went to the village to look for food, feeling so starved that we completely lost our sense of danger and any desire to escape just to satisfy our hunger. As soon as we got food, though, we started wishing we had instead tried to escape into the mountains. We attempted to do that soon after, but the locals were now able to keep an eye on us. When we showed a desire to avoid being seen and head toward the mountains, three warriors caught us, tied our wrists again, and shoved us back into our old prison.
It is true Jack made a vigorous resistance, and knocked down the first savage who seized him with a well-directed blow of his fist, but he was speedily overpowered by others. Thus we were again prisoners, with the prospect of torture and a violent death before us.
It’s true Jack fought back fiercely and knocked down the first savage who grabbed him with a strong punch, but he was quickly overwhelmed by others. So, we found ourselves prisoners again, facing the possibility of torture and a brutal death ahead of us.
Chapter Thirty Four.
Imprisonment—Sinking hopes—Unexpected freedom to more than one, and in more senses than one.
For a long, long month we remained in our dark and dreary prison, during which dismal time we did not see the face of a human being except that of the silent savage who brought us our daily food.
For a long, long month, we stayed in our dark and gloomy prison, during which time we didn’t see another person except for the silent savage who delivered our daily food.
There have been one or two seasons in my life during which I have felt as if the darkness of sorrow and desolation that crushed my inmost heart could never pass away until death should make me cease to feel. The present was such a season.
There have been a couple of times in my life when I felt like the weight of sorrow and despair that crushed my heart would never go away until death finally stopped my feelings. This is one of those times.
During the first part of our confinement we felt a cold chill at our hearts every time we heard a footfall near the cave, dreading lest it should prove to be that of our executioner. But as time dragged heavily on we ceased to feel this alarm, and began to experience such a deep, irrepressible longing for freedom that we chafed and fretted in our confinement like tigers. Then a feeling of despair came over us, and we actually longed for the time when the savages would take us forth to die. But these changes took place very gradually, and were mingled sometimes with brighter thoughts; for there were times when we sat, in that dark cavern on our ledge of rock, and conversed almost pleasantly about the past until we well-nigh forgot the dreary present. But we seldom ventured to touch upon the future.
During the first part of our confinement, we felt a chill in our hearts every time we heard footsteps near the cave, fearing it might be our executioner. But as time dragged on, we stopped feeling that fear and started to feel an intense, uncontainable longing for freedom that made us restless and agitated like tigers in a cage. Eventually, a sense of despair settled in, and we even wished for the time when the savages would take us out to die. However, these changes happened slowly and were sometimes mixed with brighter thoughts; there were moments when we sat in that dark cave on our rock ledge, chatting almost pleasantly about the past until we nearly forgot the bleak present. But we rarely dared to talk about the future.
A few decayed leaves and boughs formed our bed, and a scanty supply of yams and taro, brought to us once a day, constituted our food.
A few rotting leaves and branches made up our bed, and a limited amount of yams and taro, delivered to us once a day, made up our meals.
“Well, Ralph, how have you slept?” said Jack in a listless tone on rising one morning from his humble couch. “Were you much disturbed by the wind last night?”
“Well, Ralph, how did you sleep?” said Jack in a tired tone as he got up one morning from his simple couch. “Did the wind bother you much last night?”
“No,” said I. “I dreamed of home all night, and I thought that my mother smiled upon me and beckoned me to go to her; but I could not, for I was chained.”
“No,” I said. “I dreamed of home all night, and I thought my mother was smiling at me and calling me to her; but I couldn’t, because I was trapped.”
“And I dreamed too,” said Peterkin; “but it was of our happy home on the Coral Island. I thought we were swimming in the Water Garden. Then the savages gave a yell, and we were immediately in the cave at Spouting Cliff, which, somehow or other changed into this gloomy cavern; and I awoke to find it true.”
“And I dreamed too,” said Peterkin; “but it was about our happy home on Coral Island. I thought we were swimming in the Water Garden. Then the savages let out a loud yell, and suddenly we were in the cave at Spouting Cliff, which somehow turned into this dark cavern; and I woke up to find it was real.”
Peterkin’s tone was so much altered by the depressing influence of his long imprisonment that, had I not known it was he who spoke, I should scarcely have recognised it, so sad was it, and so unlike to the merry, cheerful voice we had been accustomed to hear. I pondered this much, and thought of the terrible decline of happiness that may come on human beings in so short a time; how bright the sunshine in the sky at one time, and in a short space bow dark the overshadowing cloud! I had no doubt that the Bible would have given me much light and comfort on this subject if I had possessed one, and I once more had occasion to regret deeply having neglected to store my memory with its consoling truths.
Peterkin’s tone had changed so much from the depressing effect of his long imprisonment that, if I hadn’t known it was him speaking, I would hardly have recognized it. It sounded so sad and was such a departure from the cheerful voice we were used to hearing. I thought a lot about this and considered how quickly a person's happiness can decline; one moment the sun is shining, and in a short time, dark clouds can take over! I had no doubt that the Bible would have provided me with much insight and comfort on this topic if I had one, and once again, I deeply regretted not filling my mind with its comforting truths.
While I meditated thus, Peterkin again broke the silence of the cave by saying, in a melancholy tone, “Oh, I wonder if we shall ever see our dear island more!”
While I was meditating, Peterkin once again interrupted the silence of the cave, saying in a sad tone, “Oh, I wonder if we will ever see our beloved island again!”
His voice trembled, and covering his face with both hands, he bent down his head and wept. It was an unusual sight for me to see our once joyous companion in tears, and I felt a burning desire to comfort him; but, alas! what could I say? I could hold out no hope; and although I essayed twice to speak, the words refused to pass my lips. While I hesitated Jack sat down beside him and whispered a few words in his ear, while Peterkin threw himself on his friend’s breast and rested his head on his shoulder.
His voice shook, and covering his face with both hands, he bent his head down and cried. It was strange for me to see our once cheerful friend in tears, and I felt a strong urge to comfort him; but, unfortunately! what could I say? I had no hope to offer; and even though I tried to speak twice, the words wouldn't come out. While I was unsure, Jack sat down beside him and whispered a few words in his ear, while Peterkin threw himself onto his friend’s chest and rested his head on his shoulder.
Thus we sat for some time in deep silence. Soon after we heard footsteps at the entrance of the cave, and immediately our jailer entered. We were so much accustomed to his regular visits, however, that we paid little attention to him, expecting that he would set down our meagre fare as usual and depart. But, to our surprise, instead of doing so, he advanced towards us with a knife in his hand, and going up to Jack, he cut the thongs that bound his wrists; then he did the same to Peterkin and me! For fully five minutes we stood in speechless amazement, with our freed hands hanging idly by our sides. The first thought that rushed into my mind was that the time had come to put us to death; and although, as I have said before, we actually wished for death in the strength of our despair, now that we thought it drew really near I felt all the natural love of life revive in my heart, mingled with a chill of horror at the suddenness of our call.
So we sat in deep silence for a while. Soon after, we heard footsteps at the cave entrance, and our jailer walked in. We were so used to his regular visits that we hardly paid attention, expecting him to drop off our meager food and leave. But to our surprise, instead of doing that, he came toward us with a knife in hand and approached Jack, cutting the ropes that bound his wrists. Then he did the same for Peterkin and me! For a full five minutes, we stood there in speechless amazement, our freed hands hanging limply by our sides. My first thought was that it was time for us to be killed; and even though we had wished for death out of despair, now that it seemed to be actually happening, I felt all the natural love of life awaken in my heart, mixed with a chill of horror at the suddenness of our situation.
But I was mistaken. After cutting our bonds the savage pointed to the cave’s mouth, and we marched, almost mechanically, into the open air. Here, to our surprise, we found the teacher standing under a tree, with his hands clasped before him, and the tears trickling down his dark cheeks. On seeing Jack, who came out first, he sprang towards him, and clasping him in his arms, exclaimed:
But I was wrong. After slicing through our ropes, the savage pointed to the entrance of the cave, and we walked, almost like robots, into the fresh air. To our surprise, we found the teacher standing under a tree, his hands together in front of him, with tears flowing down his dark cheeks. When he saw Jack, who was the first to emerge, he rushed towards him and hugged him tightly, exclaiming:
“Oh my dear young friend, through the great goodness of God you are free!”
“Oh my dear young friend, thanks to the incredible goodness of God, you are free!”
“Free?” cried Jack.
"Free?" yelled Jack.
“Ay, free!” repeated the teacher, shaking us warmly by the hands again and again—“free to go and come as you will. The Lord has unloosed the bonds of the captive, and set the prisoners free. A missionary has been sent to us, and Tararo has embraced the Christian religion! The people are even now burning their gods of wood! Come, my dear friends, and see the glorious sight!”
“Sure, free!” the teacher said, shaking our hands warmly over and over. “Free to come and go as you please. The Lord has released the bonds of the captives and set the prisoners free. A missionary has come to us, and Tararo has accepted the Christian faith! The people are even now burning their wooden idols! Come, my dear friends, and see this glorious sight!”
We could scarcely credit our senses. So long had we been accustomed, in our cavern, to dream of deliverance, that we imagined for a moment this must surely be nothing more than another vivid dream. Our eyes and minds were dazzled, too, by the brilliant sunshine, which almost blinded us after our long confinement to the gloom of our prison, so that we felt giddy with the variety of conflicting emotions that filled our throbbing bosoms; but as we followed the footsteps of our sable friend, and beheld the bright foliage of the trees, and heard the cries of the paroquets, and smelt the rich perfume of the flowering shrubs, the truth—that we were really delivered from prison and from death—rushed with overwhelming power into our souls, and with one accord, while tears sprang to our eyes, we uttered a loud, long cheer of joy.
We could hardly believe our eyes. After so long dreaming of escape in our cave, we thought for a moment that this must just be another intense dream. The bright sunshine nearly blinded us, dazzling our eyes and minds after being stuck in the dark for so long. We felt lightheaded from the mix of conflicting emotions swelling inside us; but as we followed our dark-skinned friend, saw the bright leaves of the trees, heard the calls of the parrots, and smelled the rich scent of the blooming flowers, the reality hit us—we were truly free from prison and death. Overcome with emotion, tears in our eyes, we all shouted a loud, joyous cheer.
It was replied to by a shout from a number of the natives who chanced to be near. Running towards us, they shook us by the hand with every demonstration of kindly feeling. They then fell behind, and forming a sort of procession, conducted us to the dwelling of Tararo.
It was answered with a shout from some nearby locals. They rushed over to us, shaking our hands and showing us lots of warmth. Then they fell back and formed a kind of procession to lead us to Tararo's home.
The scene that met our eyes here was one that I shall never forget. On a rude bench in front of his house sat the chief. A native stood on his left hand, who from his dress seemed to be a teacher. On his right stood an English gentleman, who I at once, and rightly, concluded was a missionary. He was tall, thin, and apparently past forty, with a bald forehead and thin grey hair. The expression of his countenance was the most winning I ever saw, and his clear grey eyes beamed with a look that was frank, fearless, loving, and truthful. In front of the chief was an open space, in the centre of which lay a pile of wooden idols, ready to be set on fire; and around these were assembled thousands of natives, who had come to join in or to witness the unusual sight. A bright smile overspread the missionary’s face as he advanced quickly to meet us, and he shook us warmly by the hands.
The scene that greeted us was one I'll never forget. Sitting on a rough bench in front of his house was the chief. To his left stood a native who, based on his clothing, seemed to be a teacher. To his right was an English gentleman, who I immediately and accurately guessed was a missionary. He was tall, thin, and probably in his forties, with a bald forehead and thin gray hair. The expression on his face was the most charming I’d ever seen, and his clear gray eyes shone with a look that was honest, courageous, loving, and sincere. In front of the chief was an open area, in the center of which lay a pile of wooden idols, ready to be set on fire; surrounding this were thousands of natives who had come to participate in or witness the unusual event. A bright smile spread across the missionary’s face as he quickly approached us, shaking our hands warmly.
“I am overjoyed to meet you, my dear young friends,” he said. “My friend and your friend, the teacher, has told me your history; and I thank our Father in heaven with all my heart, that He has guided me to this island and made me the instrument of saving you.”
“I’m so happy to meet you, my dear young friends,” he said. “My friend and your friend, the teacher, has shared your story with me; and I thank our Father in heaven from the bottom of my heart for leading me to this island and allowing me to help save you.”
We thanked the missionary most heartily, and asked him, in some surprise, how he had succeeded in turning the heart of Tararo in our favour.
We thanked the missionary very warmly and asked him, a bit surprised, how he managed to win Tararo's favor for us.
“I will tell you that at a more convenient time,” he answered, “meanwhile we must not forget the respect due to the chief. He waits to receive you.”
“I'll let you know at a better time,” he replied, “but in the meantime, we must remember to show respect to the chief. He's waiting to see you.”
In the conversation that immediately followed between us and Tararo, the latter said that the light of the Gospel of Jesus Christ had been sent to the island, and that to it we were indebted for our freedom. Moreover, he told us that we were at liberty to depart in our schooner whenever we pleased, and that we should be supplied with as much provision as we required. He concluded by shaking hands with us warmly, and performing the ceremony of rubbing noses.
In the conversation that followed between us and Tararo, he mentioned that the light of the Gospel of Jesus Christ had come to the island, and that we owed our freedom to it. He also told us that we could leave in our schooner whenever we wanted, and that we would be given as much food as we needed. He ended by warmly shaking our hands and performing the ceremony of rubbing noses.
This was indeed good news to us, and we could hardly find words to express our gratitude to the chief and to the missionary.
This was definitely good news for us, and we could barely find the words to express our thanks to the chief and the missionary.
“And what of Avatea?” inquired Jack.
“And what about Avatea?” Jack asked.
The missionary replied by pointing to a group of natives, in the midst of whom the girl stood. Beside her was a tall, strapping fellow, whose noble mien and air of superiority bespoke him a chief of no ordinary kind. “That youth is her lover. He came this very morning in his war-canoe to treat with Tararo for Avatea. He is to be married in a few days, and afterwards returns to his island home with his bride.”
The missionary pointed to a group of locals, where the girl stood among them. Next to her was a tall, strong man whose dignified presence and confident demeanor showed that he was a chief of no ordinary status. “That guy is her boyfriend. He arrived this morning in his war canoe to negotiate with Tararo for Avatea. They’re getting married in a few days, and then he’ll take his bride back to his island home.”
“That’s capital!” said Jack as he stepped up to the savage and gave him a hearty shake of the hand. “I wish you joy, my lad!—And you too, Avatea!”
“That’s awesome!” said Jack as he approached the savage and gave him a firm handshake. “Congrats, my friend!—And you too, Avatea!”
As Jack spoke, Avatea’s lover took him by the hand and led him to the spot where Tararo and the missionary stood, surrounded by most of the chief men of the tribe. The girl herself followed and stood on his left hand, while her lover stood on his right, and commanding silence, made the following speech, which was translated by the missionary:
As Jack spoke, Avatea’s partner took him by the hand and guided him to where Tararo and the missionary were standing, surrounded by most of the tribe's chief men. The girl herself followed and stood to his left, while her partner stood to his right. After calling for silence, he delivered the following speech, which the missionary translated:
“Young friend, you have seen few years, but your head is old. Your heart, also, is large and very brave. I and Avatea are your debtors; and we wish, in the midst of this assembly, to acknowledge our debt, and to say that it is one which we can never repay. You have risked your life for one who was known to you only for a few days. But she was a woman in distress, and that was enough to secure to her the aid of a Christian man. We, who live in these islands of the sea, know that the true Christians always act thus. Their religion is one of love and kindness. We thank God that so many Christians have been sent here: we hope many more will come. Remember that I and Avatea will think of you, and pray for you and your brave comrades, when you are far away.”
“Young friend, you may not have lived many years, but you are wise beyond your age. Your heart is also big and very courageous. Avatea and I owe you a great debt; we want to acknowledge it here in front of everyone, and to express that it’s a debt we can never fully repay. You risked your life for someone you had only known for a few days. But she was a woman in need, and that was enough to earn the help of a good man. We, who live on these islands, know that true Christians always act this way. Their faith is grounded in love and kindness. We thank God for the many Christians who have come here: we hope even more will arrive. Remember that Avatea and I will think of you, and pray for you and your brave friends when you’re far away.”
To this kind speech Jack returned a short, sailor-like reply, in which he insisted that he had only done for Avatea what he would have done for any woman under the sun. But Jack’s forte did not lie in speech-making, so he terminated rather abruptly by seizing the chief’s hand and shaking it violently, after which he made a hasty retreat.
To this kind comment, Jack gave a brief, sailor-like response, insisting that he had only done for Avatea what he would have done for any woman anywhere. However, Jack wasn’t great at making speeches, so he wrapped it up quickly by grabbing the chief’s hand and shaking it vigorously, then he hurried away.
“Now, then, Ralph and Peterkin,” said Jack as we mingled with the crowd, “it seems to me that, the object we came here for having been satisfactorily accomplished, we have nothing more to do but get ready for sea as fast as we can, and hurrah for old England!”
“Alright, Ralph and Peterkin,” said Jack as we joined the crowd, “it looks to me like we’ve successfully completed the task we came here for, so all that’s left to do is get ready to set sail as quickly as possible, and cheers for old England!”
“That’s my idea precisely,” said Peterkin, endeavouring to wink; but he had wept so much of late, poor fellow, that he found it difficult. “However, I’m not going away till I see these fellows burn their gods.”
"That's exactly my idea," said Peterkin, trying to wink; but he had cried so much lately, poor guy, that he found it hard to do. "Anyway, I'm not leaving until I see these guys burn their idols."
Peterkin had his wish, for in a few minutes afterwards fire was put to the pile, the roaring flames, ascended, and amid the acclamations of the assembled thousands, the false gods of Mango were reduced to ashes!
Peterkin got his wish, because a few minutes later, fire was set to the pile, the roaring flames shot up, and with the cheers of the gathered thousands, the false gods of Mango were turned to ashes!
Chapter Thirty Five.
Conclusion.
To part is the lot of all mankind. The world is a scene of constant leave-taking, and the hands that grasp in cordial greeting to-day are doomed ere long to unite for the last time when the quivering lips pronounce the word “Farewell.” It is a sad thought, but should we on that account exclude it from our minds? May not a lesson worth learning be gathered in the contemplation of it? May it not, perchance, teach us to devote our thoughts more frequently and attentively to that land where we meet but part no more?
To part is the fate of every person. The world is a place of constant goodbyes, and the hands that warmly shake today are destined to join for the last time when quivering lips say “Goodbye.” It’s a sad thought, but does that mean we should ignore it? Could we perhaps learn something valuable by thinking about it? Might it inspire us to focus more on that place where we meet and never part again?
How many do we part from in this world with a light good-bye whom we never see again! Often do I think, in my meditations on this subject, that if we realised more fully the shortness of the fleeting intercourse that we have in this world with many of our fellow-men, we would try more earnestly to do them good, to give them a friendly smile, as it were, in passing (for the longest intercourse on earth is little more than a passing word and glance), and show that we have sympathy with them in the short, quick struggle of life by our kindly words and looks and actions.
How many people do we say a brief goodbye to in this world, never to see them again! I often think, as I reflect on this, that if we understood better how brief our interactions are with many of our fellow humans, we would make more effort to do them good, to offer a friendly smile as we pass (since even the longest interactions on earth are just a passing word and glance), and to show our sympathy for them in the quick, intense struggle of life through our kind words, looks, and actions.
The time soon drew near when we were to quit the islands of the South Seas; and strange though it may appear, we felt deep regret at parting with the natives of the island of Mango, for after they embraced the Christian faith, they sought, by showing us the utmost kindness, to compensate for the harsh treatment we had experienced at their hands. And we felt a growing affection for the native teachers and the missionary, and especially for Avatea and her husband.
The time was approaching when we would leave the islands of the South Seas; and strangely enough, we felt a deep sadness about saying goodbye to the people of Mango. After they adopted the Christian faith, they tried to make up for the rough treatment we had received from them by showing us incredible kindness. We grew to care for the local teachers and the missionary, especially Avatea and her husband.
Before leaving we had many long and interesting conversations with the missionary, in one of which he told us that he had been making for the island of Rarotonga when his native-built sloop was blown out of its course, during a violent gale, and driven to this island. At first the natives refused to listen to what he had to say; but after a week’s residence among them, Tararo came to him and said that he wished to become a Christian and would burn his idols. He proved himself to be sincere, for, as we have seen, he persuaded all his people to do likewise. I use the word “persuaded” advisedly, for, like all the other Feejee chiefs, Tararo was a despot, and might have commanded obedience to his wishes; but he entered so readily into the spirit of the new faith that he perceived at once the impropriety of using constraint in the propagation of it. He set the example, therefore; and that example was followed by almost every man of the tribe.
Before we left, we had many long and interesting talks with the missionary. In one of those conversations, he told us that he was heading to the island of Rarotonga when his native-built sloop was blown off course during a violent storm and ended up on this island. At first, the locals refused to listen to him, but after a week of living among them, Tararo approached him and said he wanted to become a Christian and would burn his idols. He proved to be sincere because, as we’ve seen, he convinced all his people to do the same. I use the word “convinced” deliberately, because, like all the other chiefs from Fiji, Tararo was a tyrant and could have forced his wishes upon them; however, he embraced the spirit of the new faith so fully that he immediately recognized it would be wrong to use force to spread it. So, he led by example, and that example was followed by nearly every man in the tribe.
During the short time that we remained at the island repairing our vessel and getting her ready for sea, the natives had commenced building a large and commodious church under the superintendence of the missionary, and several rows of new cottages were marked out; so that the place bid fair to become, in a few months, as prosperous and beautiful as the Christian village at the other end of the island.
During the brief period we stayed on the island fixing our ship and preparing her for the sea, the locals started constructing a large and spacious church under the guidance of the missionary, and several rows of new cottages were laid out; so it looked like the place would soon become as thriving and lovely as the Christian village at the other end of the island.
After Avatea was married, she and her husband were sent away loaded with presents, chiefly of an edible nature. One of the native teachers went with them, for the purpose of visiting still more distant islands of the sea, and spreading, if possible, the light of the glorious Gospel there.
After Avatea got married, she and her husband left with a lot of gifts, mostly food. One of the local teachers accompanied them to visit even more distant islands and, if possible, share the light of the glorious Gospel there.
As the missionary intended to remain for several weeks longer in order to encourage and confirm his new converts, Jack and Peterkin and I held a consultation in the cabin of our schooner—which we found just as we had left her, for everything that had been taken out of her was restored. We now resolved to delay our departure no longer. The desire to see our beloved native land was strong upon us, and we could not wait.
As the missionary planned to stay for a few more weeks to support and solidify his new converts, Jack, Peterkin, and I had a discussion in the cabin of our schooner—which we found exactly how we left it, since everything that had been removed had been put back. We decided that we wouldn’t delay our departure any longer. The urge to see our cherished homeland was overwhelming, and we couldn’t hold off any longer.
Three natives volunteered to go with us to Tahiti, where we thought it likely that we should be able to procure a sufficient crew of sailors to man our vessel; so we accepted their offer gladly.
Three locals volunteered to join us in Tahiti, where we believed we could find enough sailors to crew our ship; so we happily accepted their offer.
It was a bright, clear morning when we hoisted the snow-white sails of the pirate schooner and left the shores of Mango. The missionary and thousands of the natives came down to bid us God-speed and to see us sail away. As the vessel bent before a light, fair wind, we glided quickly over the lagoon under a cloud of canvas.
It was a bright, clear morning when we raised the white sails of the pirate schooner and set off from the shores of Mango. The missionary and thousands of locals came down to wish us well and watch us sail away. As the ship leaned with a light, gentle breeze, we glided swiftly over the lagoon under a canopy of canvas.
Just as we passed through the channel in the reef the natives gave us a loud cheer; and as the missionary waved his hat, while he stood on a coral rock with his grey hairs floating in the wind, we heard the single word “Farewell” borne faintly over the sea.
Just as we went through the channel in the reef, the locals cheered for us loudly; and as the missionary waved his hat while standing on a coral rock with his gray hair blowing in the wind, we heard the word “Farewell” softly carried over the sea.
That night, as we sat on the taffrail gazing out upon the wide sea and up into the starry firmament, a thrill of joy, strangely mixed with sadness, passed through our hearts; for we were at length “homeward bound” and were gradually leaving far behind us the beautiful, bright-green coral islands of the Pacific Ocean.
That night, as we sat on the railing looking out at the vast sea and up at the starry sky, a rush of joy, oddly mixed with sadness, filled our hearts; for we were finally "homeward bound" and were slowly leaving behind the beautiful, bright-green coral islands of the Pacific Ocean.
Download ePUB
If you like this ebook, consider a donation!